As filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission on March 28, 2012
 
Registration No. 333-
 
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
 
FORM S-l
REGISTRATION STATEMENT
UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933
 
Customers Bancorp, Inc.
(Exact Name of Registrant as Specified in Its Charter)
 
Pennsylvania
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
 
6022
(Primary Standard Industrial
Classification Code Number)
 
1015 Penn Avenue
Suite 103
Wyomissing PA 19610
(610) 933-2000
27-2290659
(l.R.S. Employer
Identification Number)
 
 
(Address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area code, of registrant's principal executive offices)
 
Jay S. Sidhu
Customers Bancorp, Inc.
1015 Penn Avenue
Suite 103
Wyomissing PA 19610
(610) 933-2000
(Name, address, including zip code, and telephone number, including area code, of agent for service)
 
With a Copy to:
   
Eric D. Schoenborn, Esq.
Stradley Ronon Stevens & Young, LLP
LibertyView
457 Haddonfield Road, Suite 100
Cherry Hill, NJ 08002-2223
Scott Brown, Esq.
Kilpatrick Townsend & Stockton LLP
Suite 900, 607 14th Street, NW
Washington, DC  20005-2018
 
If any of the securities being registered on this Form are to be offered on a delayed or continuous basis pursuant to Rule 415 under the Securities Act of 1933 check the following box:  
 
If this Form is filed to register additional securities for an offering pursuant to Rule 462(b) under the Securities Act, please check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.  
 
If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(c) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.  
 
If this Form is a post-effective amendment filed pursuant to Rule 462(d) under the Securities Act, check the following box and list the Securities Act registration statement number of the earlier effective registration statement for the same offering.  
 
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
 
  Large accelerated filer      [   ]
Accelerated Filer    
[   ]
       
Non-accelerated filer [X]    (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)
Smaller reporting company    
[   ]
 
CALCULATION OF REGISTRATION FEE
 
Title of Each Class
of Securities to be Registered
 
Proposed
Maximum
Aggregate
Offering Price (1)(2)
 
Amount of
Registration Fee
Voting Common Stock, par value $1.00 per share
 
$115,000,000
 
$13,179
 
(1)
Estimated solely for purposes of calculating the registration fee in accordance with Rule 457(o) under the Securities Act of 1933. This amount represents the proposed maximum aggregate offering price of the securities registered hereunder to be sold by the Registrant.
(2)
Includes shares of Voting Common Stock which may be sold pursuant to the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares of Voting Common Stock.

The Registrant hereby amends this Registration Statement on such date as may be necessary to delay its effective date until the Registrant shall file a further amendment which specifically states that this Registration Statement shall thereafter become effective in accordance with Section 8(a) of the Securities Act of 1933, or until this Registration Statement shall become effective on such date as the Securities and Exchange Commission, acting pursuant to said Section 8(a), may determine.
 
 
 
 

 
 
 
The information in this preliminary prospectus is not complete and may be changed. We may not sell these securities until the registration statement filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission is effective. This preliminary prospectus is not an offer to sell nor does it seek an offer to buy these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer or sale is not permitted.
 
Subject to Completion, dated [­­­­­­­­        ], 2012
 
PROSPECTUS
 
            Shares
 
Customers Bancorp, Inc.
 
Voting Common Stock

This prospectus relates to the initial public offering of our Voting Common Stock. We are offering              shares of our Voting Common Stock. We will bear all expenses of registration incurred in connection with this offering, which expenses will be deducted from the proceeds of the offering.
 
Prior to this offering, there has been no established public market for our Voting Common Stock.  It is currently estimated that the public offering price per share of our Voting Common Stock will be between $         and $         per share. We intend to apply to list our Voting Common Stock on the Nasdaq Global Market under the symbol “CUBI.”
 

See “ Risk Factors ” beginning on page 14 to read about risk factors you should consider before making an investment decision to purchase our Voting Common Stock.

 
The shares of our Voting Common Stock that you purchase in this offering will not be savings accounts, deposits or other obligations of any of our bank or non-bank subsidiaries and are not insured or guaranteed by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation or any other governmental agency.
 
Neither the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission nor any state securities commission has approved or disapproved of these securities or passed upon the adequacy or accuracy of this prospectus. Any representation to the contrary is a criminal offense.
 
   
Per Share
   
Total
 
Initial public offering price
  $       $    
Underwriting discounts
  $       $    
Proceeds, before expenses, to us
  $       $    
                 
We have granted the underwriters the option to purchase up to an additional              shares of our Voting Common Stock from us at the initial public offering price less the underwriting discounts.
 
The underwriters expect to deliver the shares of our Voting Common Stock against payment in New York, New York on ______________ ___, 2012.
 
Macquarie Capital
  
Keefe, Bruyette & Woods
 

 

Prospectus dated ________, 2012
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
 

TABLE OF CONTENTS
 

 
Page
   
Prospectus Summary
1
Risk Factors
14
Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements
31
Use of Proceeds
33
Dividend Policy
33
Capitalization
34
Dilution
35
Selected Historical Consolidated Financial Information
37
Management's Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
40
Business 72
Supervision and Regulation
81
Management
88
Executive Compensation
92
Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners 109
Transactions with Related Parties
110
Market Price of Common Stock and Dividends 113
Shares Eligible for Future Sale
115
Description of Capital Stock 117
Material U.S. Federal Tax Considerations
123
Underwriting
127
Legal Matters
130
Experts
130
Where You Can Find More Information
130
Index to Financial Statements
F-1
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
i

 
 
 
 
Unless we state otherwise or the context otherwise requires, references in this prospectus to "Customers Bancorp" refer to Customers Bancorp, Inc., a Pennsylvania corporation and references in this prospectus to “Customers Bank” or the “Bank”  refer to Customers Bank, a Pennsylvania-chartered bank and wholly-owned subsidiary of Customers Bancorp.  All share and per share information have been restated to reflect the Reorganization (as defined below), including that three shares of Customers Bank were exchanged for one share of Customers Bancorp in the Reorganization.  Unless we state otherwise or the context otherwise requires, references in this prospectus to "we," "our," "us" and the "Company" refer to Customers Bancorp and its consolidated subsidiary for all periods on or after September 17, 2011 and refer to Customers Bank for all periods before September 17, 2011.


About this Prospectus
 
We have not, and the underwriters have not, authorized anyone to provide any information other than that contained in this prospectus or in any free writing prospectus prepared by or on behalf of us or to which we have referred you. We and the underwriters take no responsibility for, and can provide no assurance as to the reliability of, any other information that others may give you. If anyone provides you with different or inconsistent information you should not rely on it.  We are not, and the underwriters are not, making an offer of these securities in any jurisdiction where the offer is not permitted.  The information contained in this prospectus is accurate only as of the date of this prospectus.  Our business, financial condition, results of operations or prospects may have changed since that date.
 
No action is being taken in any jurisdiction outside the United States to permit a public offering of our securities or possession or distribution of this prospectus in that jurisdiction. Persons who come into possession of this prospectus in jurisdictions outside the United States are required to inform themselves about, and to observe, any restrictions as to the offering and the distribution of this prospectus applicable to those jurisdictions.
 
Unless otherwise expressly stated or the context otherwise requires, all information in this prospectus assumes that the underwriters have not exercised their option to purchase additional shares of Voting Common Stock.
 
Market Data
 
Market data used in this prospectus has been obtained from independent industry sources and publications as well as from research reports prepared for other purposes. Industry publications and surveys and forecasts generally state that the information contained therein has been obtained from sources believed to be reliable. We have not independently verified the data obtained from these sources, and we cannot assure you of the accuracy or completeness of the data. Forward-looking information obtained from these sources is subject to the same qualifications and the additional uncertainties regarding the other forward-looking statements in this prospectus.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
ii

 
 
 
PROSPECTUS SUMMARY
 
This summary highlights selected information contained elsewhere in this prospectus. This summary does not contain all of the information that you should consider before making an investment decision to purchase Voting Common Stock in this offering. Before making an investment decision to purchase our Voting Common Stock, you should read the entire prospectus carefully, including the section entitled "Risk Factors," our consolidated financial statements, and the related notes thereto and management's discussion and analysis of financial condition and results of operations included elsewhere in this prospectus.
 
 
Company Overview
 
Customers Bancorp was incorporated in Pennsylvania in April 2010 to facilitate a reorganization into a bank holding company structure pursuant to which Customers Bank became a wholly-owned subsidiary of Customers Bancorp (the “Reorganization”) on September 17, 2011.  Pursuant to the Reorganization, all of the issued and outstanding shares of Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock of Customers Bank were exchanged on a three-to-one basis for shares of Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock, respectively, of Customers Bancorp (i.e., each three shares of Customers Bank being exchanged for one share of Customers Bancorp).  In December 2010, Customers Bank changed its name from New Century Bank.  New Century Bank was incorporated in 1994 and is a Pennsylvania state chartered bank and a member of the Federal Reserve System.

Customers Bancorp, through its wholly-owned subsidiary Customers Bank, provides financial products and services to small businesses, not-for-profits and consumers through its fourteen branches in Southeastern Pennsylvania (Bucks, Berks, Chester and Delaware Counties), Rye, New York (Westchester County) and Hamilton, New Jersey (Mercer County).  Customers Bank also provides liquidity to the mortgage market nationwide through the operation of its mortgage warehouse business.  At December 31, 2011, Customers Bancorp had total assets of $2.08 billion, including net loans (including held for sale loans) of $1.50 billion, total deposits of $1.58 billion and shareholders’ equity of $147.8 million.

Our management team consists of experienced banking executives.  The team is led by our Chairman and Chief Executive Officer Jay Sidhu, who joined Customers Bank in June 2009. Mr. Sidhu brings 36 years of banking experience, including 20 years as the Chief Executive Officer of Sovereign Bank and 17 years as the Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of Sovereign Bancorp. In addition to Mr. Sidhu, most of the members of our current management team joined us following Mr. Sidhu’s arrival in 2009 and have extensive experience working together at Sovereign with Mr. Sidhu. This team has significant experience in building a banking organization, in completing and integrating mergers and acquisitions, as well as developing existing valuable community and business relationships in our core markets.
 
Our Strategy

Our strategic plan is to become a leading regional bank holding company through organic growth and value-added acquisitions.  We differentiate ourselves from our competitors through our focus on and understanding of the banking needs of small businesses, not-for-profits and consumers. We will also focus on certain low-cost, low-risk specialty lending segments such as warehouse lending.  Our lending is funded by our branch model, which seeks higher deposit levels than a typical branch, combined with lower branch operating expenses, without sacrificing exceptional customer service.  We also create franchise value through our disciplined approach to acquisitions, both in terms of identifying targets and structuring transactions, including Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (“FDIC”)-assisted transactions of troubled financial institutions.  Risk management practices are an important part of the strategies we initiate.
 
 
 
 
 
- 1 -

 
 

 
A central part of this strategy is generating core deposit customers to support growth of a strong and stable loan portfolio. We believe we can achieve this through exceptional convenience and pricing flexibility for deposits while remaining more responsive to our customers’ needs and providing a high level of personal and specialized service.  We will strive for flexibility and responsiveness in operating and growing our franchise, while maintaining tight internal controls and adhering to the following “Critical Success Factors:”

·  
Talent - Attract, retain and develop a seasoned and innovative executive management team, experienced high-producing relationship managers to accelerate organic growth and experienced business development officers;
 
·  
Profitability - Create a culture that focuses on profitability and delivering services in a cost-effective, efficient manner with the goal of increasing our revenues significantly faster than our expenses;
 
·  
Superior Asset Quality - Develop and adhere to conservative underwriting policies while maintaining diversified portfolios of earning assets and a conservative level of loan loss reserves;
 
·  
Risk Management - Manage other enterprise-wide risks, including minimizing interest rate risk through positioning the balance sheet so as to not place directional speculation on interest rate movements; and
 
·  
Capital - Maintain an adequate capital cushion that insulates us from adverse economic climates.
 
 
We intend to achieve our objectives under these guidelines by adhering to a combination of the following strategies:

·  
Organic growth through “High Touch, High Tech” Strategy.   We focus our customer service efforts on relationship banking, personalized service and the ability to quickly make credit and other business decisions. Relationship managers, available 12 hours a day, seven days a week, are assigned for all customers, establishing a single point of contact for all issues and products. This “concierge banking” approach allows Customers Bank to provide services in a convenient and expeditious manner, delivered by experienced bankers, and enhances the overall customer experience, offering pricing flexibility, speed and convenience.  This approach is supplemented with sophisticated high technology services, such as remote deposit capture and mobile banking, collectively creating “virtual branch banks.”  We can open accounts at the location of the customer and remote account opening is also available via our web site.  To ensure functionality across the customer base, Customers Bank will not only provide the technology, but also set up and train customers on how to benefit from this technology.  We believe that the combination of our “concierge banking” approach and creation of a more inexpensive network of “virtual” branches, which require less staff and smaller branch locations, provides greater convenience and cost savings.  We believe this allows us to capture market share from and have a competitive advantage over larger institutions, which we expect will continue to contribute to the profitability of our franchise and allows us to generate core deposits.

·  
Value-Added Acquisitions . We plan to take advantage of acquisition opportunities that will add immediate value to our core franchise. The recent U.S. recession and the related crisis in the financial services industry present a unique opportunity for us to execute our acquisition strategy.  Many banks are trading at historically low multiples and are in need of capital at a time when traditional sources of capital have diminished.  The current weakness in the banking sector and the potential duration of any recovery provide us with an opportunity to successfully execute our strategy.  Our management team has a long history of identifying targets, assessing and pricing risk and executing acquisitions. We believe our acquisition strategy will deliver transactions that add substantial value while minimizing potential risks.

Our acquisition strategy focuses on community banks, primarily in Pennsylvania, New Jersey, New York, Maryland, Connecticut and Delaware. We seek to achieve sufficient scale in each market that we enter by acquiring healthy, distressed, undercapitalized and weakened banking institutions that have stable core deposit franchises, local market share, quantifiable risks or that are acquired from the FDIC with federal assistance, and that offer synergies through add-on acquisitions, expense reduction and organic growth opportunities. We also seek to purchase assets and banking platforms, as well as assumptions of deposits from the FDIC and possibly enter into loss mitigation arrangements with the FDIC in connection with such purchases.
 
 
 
 
- 2 -

 
 

 
·  
Creative and Efficient Integration . We will seek to integrate acquired banks into our existing model, where our operational strategies and systems will have already proven themselves in our core banking franchise.  Our strategy includes maximizing customer retention, improving on the products and services offered to new customers, and a seamless integration and conversion focusing on achieving appropriate cost savings. As we grow our franchise, we will seek to capitalize on the existing goodwill, customer loyalty and brand values. We intend to actively manage banks we acquire, integrate and reposition existing management to maximize the use of their talents and evaluate the competitive models of our acquired franchises to determine how best our overall company can profit from the strongest features of each business.

·  
Lending initiatives focused on small business and specialty lending.   We maintain a specialty lending line, warehouse lending, that is relatively low risk and low cost.  Warehouse lending is a national business where we provide liquidity to non-depository mortgage companies to fund their mortgage pipelines.  We have also established a multi-family and commercial real estate segment that is focused in the Mid-Atlantic region, which targets the refinancing of existing loans utilizing conservative underwriting standards.

·  
Expand fee-based services and products.   We will provide fee-based services for core retail and small business customers including cash management, deposit services, merchant services and asset management.  We are working with vendors to expand our suite of fee-based services.  Our management team has significant experience in building these capabilities and creating sales processes to increase fee revenue.

·  
Maintain strong risk management culture .  We are very focused on maintaining a strong risk management culture.  We employ conservative underwriting in our lending, with a loan committee chaired by our Chief Credit Officer.  Customer Bank’s Risk Management Committee performs an independent review of all risks at Customers Bank, and the Bank's Management Risk Committee, chaired by the Head of Enterprise Risk Management, reviews all risks.  We intend to maintain strong capital levels and utilize our investment portfolio to primarily manage liquidity and interest rate risk.
 
 
Our Financial Targets
 
We hope through the execution of our strategy we will achieve certain financial goals, which are outlined below.  The table below also contains these goals and compares our 2011 fourth quarter unaudited results against these goals.
 
Category
Metric
Fourth Quarter 2011
Long Term Goal
Return on Capital
Return on Equity
8.47%
10.0-12.0%
Return on Assets
0.66%
1.0-1.1%
Capital Adequacy
Tier I Leverage Ratio
7.59%
8.0-10.0%
Total - Risk Based Capital Ratio
11.43%
12.0%+
Fee Revenue/Total Revenue
23.62%
15.0-25.0%
Income Generation
Net Interest Margin
3.05%
3.0%+
Efficiency Ratio
63.74%
≤50.0%
Balance Sheet Management
Loan to Deposit Ratio
95.9%
70.0-90.0%
 

 
- 3 -

 
 

Our Competitive Strengths

· 
Experienced and respected management team. An integral element of our business strategy is to capitalize on and leverage the prior experience of our executive management team. The management team is led by our Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, Jay Sidhu, who is the former Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of Sovereign Bancorp. In addition to Mr. Sidhu, most of the members of our current management team have extensive experience working together at Sovereign with Mr. Sidhu, including Richard Ehst, President and Chief Operating Officer of Customers Bancorp, Warren Taylor, President of Community Banking for Customers Bank, and Thomas Brugger, Chief Financial Officer of Customers Bancorp. During their tenure at Sovereign, the team established a track record of producing strong financial results, integrating acquisitions, managing risk, working with regulators and achieving organic growth and expense control. In addition, our warehouse lending group is led by Glenn Hedde, who brings more than 23 years of experience in this sector. This team has significant experience in successfully building a banking organization as well as existing valuable community and business relationships in our core markets.
 
·  
Unique Asset Generation Strategy. We focus on local market lending combined with relatively low-risk specialty lending segments.  Our local market asset generation provides consumer lending products, such as mortgage loans and home equity loans.  We have also established a multi-family and commercial real estate product line that is focused on the Mid-Atlantic region.  The strategy is to focus on refinancing existing loans with conservative underwriting and to keep costs low.  Through the multi-family and commercial real estate product, we earn interest income, fee income and generate commercial deposits.  We also maintain a specialty lending business, warehousing lending, which is a national business where we provide liquidity to non-depository mortgage companies to fund their mortgage pipelines. Through the warehouse lending business, we earn interest income and generate fees.
 
·  
Attractive risk profile.   We have sought to maintain high asset quality and moderate credit risk by using conservative underwriting standards and early identification of potential problem assets.  We have also formed a special assets department to both manage our covered assets portfolio and to review our other classified and non-performing assets.  As shown below, a significant portion of our loan portfolio has been subjected to acquisition accounting adjustments and, in some cases, is also subject to loss sharing agreements with the FDIC (“Loss Sharing Agreements”):
 
·  
as of December 31, 2011, approximately 22.87% of our loans (by dollar amount) were acquired loans and all of those loans were adjusted to their estimated fair values at the time of acquisition; and
 
·  
as of December 31, 2011, 8.32% of our loans and 45.74% of our other real estate owned (“OREO”) (each by dollar amount) were covered by a loss sharing arrangement with the FDIC in which the FDIC will reimburse us for 80% of our losses on these assets.
 
Please refer to the Asset Quality tables regarding legacy and acquired loans beginning on page 59 in the Management’s Discussion and Analysis section.

·  
Superior Community Banking Model.   We expect to drive organic growth by employing our “concierge banking” strategy, which provides specific relationship managers for all customers, delivering an appointment banking approach available 12 hours a day, seven days a week. This allows us to provide services in a personalized, convenient and expeditious manner.  This approach, coupled with superior technology, including remote account opening, remote deposit capture and mobile banking, results in a competitive advantage over larger institutions, which we believe contributes to the profitability of our franchise and allows us to generate core deposits.  Our “high tech, high touch,” model requires less staff and smaller branch locations to operate, thereby significantly reducing our operating costs.
 
 
 
 
- 4 -

 
 
 
 
·  
Acquisition Expertise.   The depth of our management team and their experience working together and successfully completing acquisitions provides us with unique insight in identifying and analyzing potential markets and acquisition targets. Our team’s experience, which includes the acquisition and integration of over 30 institutions, as well as numerous branch acquisitions, provides us a substantial advantage in pursuing and consummating future acquisitions.  Additionally, we believe our strengths in structuring transactions to limit our risk, our experience in the financial reporting and regulatory process related to troubled bank acquisitions, and our ongoing risk management expertise, particularly in problem loan workouts, collectively enable us to capitalize on the potential of the franchises we acquire. With our depth of operational experience in connection with completing merger and acquisition transactions, we expect to be able to integrate and reposition acquired franchises cost-efficiently and with a minimum disruption to customer relationships.
 
We believe our ability to operate efficiently is enhanced by our centralized management structure, our access to attractive labor and real estate costs in our markets, and an infrastructure that is unencumbered by legacy systems. Furthermore, we anticipate additional expense synergies from the integration of our recent acquisitions, which we believe will enhance our financial performance.
 

 
Our Markets
Market Criteria

We look to grow organically as well as through selective acquisitions in our current and prospective markets.  We believe there is significant opportunity to both enhance our presence in our current markets and enter new complementary markets that meet our objectives.

We focus on markets that we believe are characterized by some or all of the following:

·  
Population density
·  
Concentration of business activity
·  
Attractive deposit bases; large market share held by large banks
·  
Advantageous competitive landscape that provides opportunity to achieve meaningful market presence
·  
Lack of consolidation in the banking sector and corresponding opportunities for add-on transactions
·  
Potential for economic growth over time
·  
Management experience in the applicable markets

Current Markets

Our current markets are broadly defined as the greater Philadelphia region and Berks County in Pennsylvania, Mercer County, New Jersey and Southeastern New York.  The table below describes certain key statistics regarding our presence in these markets as of June 30, 2011:
 
 
 
 
 
- 5 -

 

 
Market
 
Deposit Market Share Rank
   
Offices
   
Deposits
(in millions)
   
Deposit
Market Share
 
                         
Philadelphia-Camden-Wilmington, PA, NJ, DE, MSA
    27       8     $ 947.6       0.23 %
                                 
Berks County, PA (1)
    9       6       271.9       3.07  
                                 
Mercer County, NJ
    19       1       141.7       1.17  
                                 
Westchester County, NY
    26       1       170.7       0.37  
_________________
(1)  
Includes deposits and offices of Berkshire Bank.  See “Berkshire Bank Acquisition.”

Source:  FDIC Website as of June 30, 2011
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
- 6 -

 

 
We believe that these markets have highly attractive demographic, economic and competitive dynamics that are consistent with our objectives and favorable to executing our organic growth and acquisition strategy. The table below describes certain key demographic statistics regarding these markets.
 
Market Environment
Market
Deposits ($bn)
# of Businesses (thousands)
Market Population (millions)
Population Density Current (#/sq. mi.)
Population Growth
(%) (2000 to 2011)
Median Household
Income ($) 2011
Household Income
Growth (%) (2000-2011)
Top 3 Competitor Combined Deposit Market Share (%)
Philadelphia – Camden – Wilmington, PA-NJ-DE-MD
417.2
219
6.0
1,228.9
5.2
58,051
20.4
53
Berks, PA
8.8
14
0.4
482.0
10.5
54,769
22.5
59
Mercer, NJ
12.1
16
0.4
1,638.2
4.9
71,646
26.0
49
Westchester, NY
46.5
41
0.9
2,203.0
2.7
81,147
27.5
53
U.S.
     
88.0
10.4
50,227
19.1
33
 

Source: SNL Financial; Deposit data as of June 30, 2011

 
 
 
 

 
- 7 -

 

Prospective Markets

Our organic growth strategy focuses on expanding market share in our existing and contiguous markets by generating deposits through personalized service and taking advantage of technology and through our commercial, consumer and specialized lending products.  Our acquisition strategy primarily focuses on undervalued and troubled community banks in Pennsylvania, New Jersey, New York, Maryland, Connecticut and Delaware, where such acquisitions further our objectives and meet our critical success factors.  As we evaluate potential acquisition opportunities, we believe there are many banking institutions that continue to face credit challenges, capital constraints and liquidity issues and that lack the scale and management expertise to manage the increasing regulatory burden.

Our Acquisitions

Since July 2010, we have completed three acquisitions, two of which were FDIC-assisted transactions. On September 17, 2011, we acquired Berkshire Bancorp, Inc. and its subsidiary, Berkshire Bank, which served Berks County, Pennsylvania.  On the closing date, Berkshire Bancorp had total assets of approximately $132.5 million, including total loans of $98.4 million, and total liabilities of approximately $122.8 million, including total deposits of $121.9 million.  The transaction was immediately accretive to earnings.

On July 9, 2010, Customers Bank acquired substantially all of the assets and assumed all of the non-brokered deposits and substantially all other liabilities of USA Bank from the FDIC, as receiver.  The transaction consisted of assets with a fair value of $221.1 million, including $124.7 million of loans (with a corresponding unpaid principal balance (“UPB”), of $153.6 million), a $22.7 million FDIC loss sharing receivable and $3.4 million of foreclosed assets. Liabilities with a fair value of $202.1 million were also assumed, including $179.3 million of non-brokered deposits.  Customers Bank also received cash consideration from the FDIC of $25.6 million.  Furthermore, Customers Bank recognized a bargain purchase gain before taxes of $28.2 million, which represented 12.2% of the fair value of the total assets acquired.  Customers Bank entered into this transaction to expand its franchise into a lucrative new market, accrete its book value per share and add significant capital.

On September 17, 2010, Customers Bank acquired substantially all of the assets and assumed all of the non-brokered deposits and substantially all other liabilities of ISN Bank from the FDIC, as receiver.  The transaction consisted of assets with a fair value of $83.9 million, including $51.3 million of loans (with a corresponding UPB of $58.2 million), a $5.6 million FDIC loss sharing receivable and $1.2 million of foreclosed assets. Liabilities with a fair value of $75.8 million were also assumed, including $71.9 million of non-brokered deposits.  Customers Bank received cash consideration from the FDIC of $5.9 million.  Furthermore, Customers Bank recognized a bargain purchase gain before taxes of $12.1 million, which represented 14.4% of the fair value of the total assets acquired. Customers Bank entered into this transaction to enhance book value per share, add capital and enter the New Jersey market in a more efficient manner than de novo expansion.

 
We believe we have structured acquisitions that limit our credit risk, which has positioned us for attractive risk-adjusted returns.
 
 
 

 
- 8 -

 
 
Additional Information

Our principal executive offices are located at 1015 Penn Avenue, Suite 103, Wyomissing, Pennsylvania, 19610. Our telephone number is (610) 993-2000. Our Internet address is www.customersbank.com. Information on, or accessible through, our web site is not part of this prospectus.

The Offering
 
Voting Common Stock offered by us
____  shares of Voting Common Stock.
 
Option of underwriters to purchase additional shares of Voting Common Stock from us
____ shares of Voting Common Stock.
 
Common stock to be outstanding after this offering
____ shares of Voting Common Stock and  ____ shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock. (1)
 
Use of proceeds
Assuming an initial public offering price of $____   per share, which is the midpoint of the offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, we estimate that the net proceeds to us from the sale of our Voting Common Stock in this offering will be $____ (or $ ____ if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares of Voting Common Stock from us), after deducting estimated underwriting discounts and offering expenses. We intend to use our net proceeds from this offering (i) to fund our  organic growth; (ii) to fund the acquisition of depository and non-bank institutions; and (iii) for working capital and other general corporate purposes. For additional information, see “Use of Proceeds.”
 
Regulatory ownership restrictions
We are a bank holding company. A holder of shares of Voting Common Stock (or group of holders acting in concert) that (i) directly or indirectly owns, controls or has the power to vote more than 5% of the total voting power of the Company, (ii) directly or indirectly owns, controls or has the power to vote 10% or more of any class of voting securities of the Company, (iii) directly or indirectly owns, controls or has the power to vote 25% or more of the total equity of the Company, or (iv) is otherwise deemed to “control” the Company under applicable regulatory standards, may be subject to important restrictions, such as prior regulatory notice or approval requirements and applicable provisions of the FDIC Statement of Policy on Qualifications for Failed Bank Acquisitions. For a further discussion of regulatory ownership restrictions, see “Supervision and Regulation.”
   
Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock
The Voting Common Stock possesses all of the voting power for all matters requiring action by holders of our common stock, with certain limited exceptions. Our articles of incorporation provide that, except with respect to voting rights, the Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock are treated equally.
   
Dividend Policy 
We have never paid cash dividends to holders of our common stock. We do not expect to declare or pay any cash or other dividends on our common stock in the foreseeable future after the completion of this offering.  For additional information, see “Dividend Policy.”
 
Listing
We intend to apply to list our Voting Common Stock on the Nasdaq Global Market under the trading symbol “CUBI.”
 
Risk factors
Investing in our Voting Common Stock involves risks. Please read the section entitled “Risk Factors” beginning on page 14 for a discussion of various matters you should consider before making an investment decision to purchase our Voting Common Stock.
 
 


 
(1)
Based on 8,503,541 shares of Voting Common Stock and 2,844,142 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2011.  Unless otherwise indicated, information contained in this prospectus regarding the number of shares of our common stock outstanding after this offering does not include shares underlying awards issuable under our Bonus Recognition and Retention Program * and   an aggregate of up to _____ shares of Voting Common Stock and ___ shares of Non-Voting Common Stock as of December 31, 2011, which is comprised of:
 
 
 
 
- 9 -

 
 
 
 
·  
up to _____ shares of Voting Common Stock which may be issued by us upon exercise in full of the underwriters’ option to purchase additional shares of our Voting Common Stock;
 
·  
35,289 shares of Voting Common Stock underlying restricted stock units awarded but not yet vested under the Amended and Restated 2004 Incentive Equity and Deferred Compensation Plan, as amended (“2004 Plan”);
 
·  
589,005 shares of Voting Common Stock and 81,036 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock issuable upon exercise of outstanding warrants with exercise prices from $10.50 to $73.01 per share, of which all were vested as of December 31, 2011;
 
·  
1,194,695 shares of Voting Common Stock issuable upon exercise of outstanding stock options under our 2010 Stock Option Plan ("2010 Stock Option Plan") and 2004 Plan with a weighted average exercise price of $11.13 per share, of which 6,592 shares were vested as of December 31, 2011;
 
·  
2,603,350 shares of Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock reserved for future issuance under the 2004 Plan and 2010 Stock Option Plan (excluding (i) the 1,229,984 shares issuable upon exercise of outstanding stock options and vesting of restricted stock units as noted above and (ii) the 15% limitation currently in place on the number of shares that can be awarded under the 2010 Stock Option Plan at any point in time – see footnote 3 to the  disclosure under “Equity Compensation Plans” for more details on this 15% limitation); and
 
·  
6,736 shares of Voting Common Stock issuable to directors as compensation for service as a director (see “Director Compensation” for details).
 
*  The Bonus Recognition and Retention Program does not provide for a specific number of shares to be reserved under this formula-based plan.  By its terms, the award of restricted stock units under this plan is limited by the amount of the cash bonuses paid to the participants in the plan.  See the description of the Bonus Recognition and Retention Program in this prospectus under the heading “Executive Compensation -Bonus Recognition and Retention Program.”
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 
 
- 10 -

 

Summary Selected Historical Consolidated Financial Information

 
Customers Bancorp and Subsidiary

The following table presents Customers Bancorp’s summary consolidated financial data.  We derived our balance sheet and income statement data for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010, 2009, 2008 and 2007 from our audited financial statements.  The summary consolidated financial data should be read in conjunction with, and are qualified in their entirety by, our financial statements and the accompanying notes and the other information included elsewhere in this prospectus.

Dollars in thousands except per share data

   
2011(1)
     
2010(2) 
     
2009 
     
2008
     
2007
 
For the Period
                                     
Interest income
 
$
61,439
   
$
30,907
   
$
13,486
   
$
15,502
   
$
17,659
 
Interest expense
   
22,463
     
11,546
     
6,336
     
8,138
     
10,593
 
Net interest income
   
38,976
     
19,361
     
7,150
     
7,364
     
7,066
 
Provision for loan losses
   
9,450
     
10,397
     
11,778
     
611
     
444
 
Bargain purchase gain on bank acquisitions
   
     
40,254
     
     
     
 
Total non-interest income (loss) excluding bargain purchase gains
   
13,652
     
5,349
     
1,043
     
(350
   
356
 
Total non-interest expense
   
37,309
     
26,101
     
9,650
     
7,654
     
6,908
 
Income (loss) before taxes
   
5,869
     
28,466
     
(13,235
)
   
(1,251
   
70
 
Income tax expense (benefit)
   
1,835
     
4,731
     
     
(426
   
(160
Net income (loss)
   
4,034
     
23,735
     
(13,235
)
   
(825
   
230
 
Net income (loss) attributable to common shareholders
 
$
3,990
   
$
23,735
   
$
(13,235
)
 
$
(825
)
 
$
230
 
Basic earnings (loss) per share (3)
 
$
0.40
   
$
3.78
   
$
(10.98
)
 
$
(1.23
 
$
0.33
 
Diluted earnings (loss) per share (3)
 
$
0.39
   
$
3.69
   
$
(10.98
)
 
$
(1.23
)
 
$
0.33
 
At Period End
                                       
Total assets
 
$
2,077,532
   
$
1,374,407
   
$
349,760
   
$
274,038
   
$
272,004
 
Cash and cash equivalents
   
73,570
     
238,724
     
68,807
     
6,295
     
6,683
 
Investment securities (4)
   
398,684
     
205,828
     
44,588
     
32,061
     
40,779
 
Loans held for sale
   
174,999
     
199,970
     
     
     
 
Loans receivable not covered by Loss Sharing Agreements with the FDIC (5)
   
1,216,265
     
514,087
     
230,258
     
223,752
     
214,569
 
Allowance for loan and lease losses
   
15,032
     
15,129
     
10,032
     
2,876
     
2,460
 
Loans receivable covered under Loss Sharing Agreements with the FDIC (5)
   
126,276
     
164,885
     
     
     
 
FDIC loss sharing receivable (5)
   
13,077
     
16,702
     
     
     
 
Deposits
   
1,583,189
     
1,245,690
     
313,927
     
237,842
     
220,345
 
Other borrowings
   
331,000
     
11,000
     
     
     
 
Shareholders’ equity
   
147,748
     
105,140
     
21,503
     
16,849
     
16,830
 
Tangible common equity(6)
 
$
146,150
   
$
105,140
   
$
21,503
   
$
15,869
   
$
16,830
 
Selected Ratios and Share
       Data
                                       
Return on average assets
   
0.24
   
3.40
%
   
(4.69
)%
   
(0.30
)%
   
0.09
%
Return on average equity
   
3.56
   
41.29
%
   
(65.35
)%
   
(4.98
)%
   
1.40
%
Book value per share (3)
 
$
13.02
   
$
12.52
   
$
11.68
   
$
25.00
   
$
24.97
 
 
 
 
 
- 11 -

 
 
 
 
Tangible book value per common share(3) (6)
 
$
12.88
   
$
12.52
   
$
11.68
   
$
23.54
   
$
24.97
 
Common shares outstanding (3)
   
11,347,683
     
8,398,014
     
1,840,902
     
673,693
     
673,693
 
Net interest margin
   
2.44
%
   
2.70
%
   
2.62
%
   
2.82
%
   
2.83
%
Equity to assets
   
7.11
%
   
7.65
%
   
6.14
%
   
6.15
%
   
6.19
%
Tangible common equity to tangible assets(6)
   
7.04
%
   
7.65
%
   
6.14
%
   
5.79
%
   
6.19
%
Tier 1 leverage ratio - Bank
   
7.33
%
   
8.67
%
   
6.68
%
   
6.21
%
   
6.22
%
Tier 1 leverage ratio – Customers Bancorp
   
7.59
%
   
 %
   
%
   
%
   
%
Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio - Bank
   
9.97
%
   
19.65
%
   
9.76
%
   
7.87
%
   
8.03
%
Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio - Customers Bancorp
   
10.32
%
   
%
   
%
   
%
   
%
Total risk-based capital ratio - Bank
   
11.08
%
   
21.14
%
   
11.77
%
   
10.50
%
   
10.62
%
Total risk-based capital ratio – Customers Bancorp
   
11.43
%
   
%
   
%
   
%
   
%
Asset Quality - Non-Covered Assets
                                       
Non-performing loans (5)
 
 $
45,137
   
$
27,055
   
$
19,150
   
$
7,175
   
$
2,069
 
Non-performing loans to total non-covered loans (5)
   
3.71
%
   
5.26
%
   
8.32
%
   
3.21
%
   
1.63
%
Other real estate owned (5)
 
$
7,316
   
$
1,906
   
$
1,155
   
$
1,519
   
$
 
Non-performing assets (5)
 
$
52,453
   
$
28,961
   
$
20,305
   
$
8,694
   
$
2,069
 
Non-performing, non-covered assets to total non-covered assets (5)
   
2.70
%
   
2.41
%
   
5.81
%
   
3.17
%
   
1.28
%
Allowance for loan and lease losses to total non-covered loans (5)
   
1.24
%
   
2.94
%
   
4.36
%
   
1.29
%
   
1.15
%
Allowance for loan and lease losses to non-performing, non-covered loans (5)
   
33.30
%
   
55.92
%
   
52.39
%
   
40.08
%
   
70.41
%
Net charge offs
 
$
9,547
   
$
5,250
   
$
4,622
   
$
195
   
$
13
 
Net charge offs to average non-covered loans(5)
   
1.13
%
   
1.00
%
   
2.05
%
   
0.09
%
   
0.01
%
Asset Quality - Covered Assets
                                       
Non-performing loans (5)
   
45,213
     
43,454
     
     
     
 
Non-performing loans to total covered loans
   
35.80
%
   
26.35
%
   
     
     
 
Other real estate owned (5)
   
6,166
     
5,342
     
     
     
 
Non-performing assets (5)
   
51,379
     
48,796
     
     
     
 
Non-performing assets to total covered assets
   
38.79
%
   
28.67
%
                       
 
(1) On September 17, 2011, we completed our acquisition of Berkshire Bancorp, Inc. All transactions since the acquisition date are included in our consolidated financial statements.
 
(2) During the third quarter of 2010, we acquired two banks in FDIC assisted transactions. All transactions since the acquisition dates are included in our consolidated financial statements.
 
(3) Effective September 17, 2011, Customers Bank reorganized into the holding company structure pursuant to which all of the issued and outstanding common stock of the Bank was exchanged on a three to one basis for common stock of Customers Bancorp ( i.e., each three shares of Customers Bank being exchanged for one share of Customers Bancorp). All share and per share information has been restated retrospectively to reflect the reorganization.
 
(4) Includes available-for-sale and held-to-maturity investment securities.
 
 
 
 
 
 
- 12 -

 
 
 
(5) Certain loans and other real estate owned (described as “covered”) acquired in the two FDIC assisted transactions are subject to Loss Sharing Agreements between Customers Bank and the FDIC. If certain provisions within the Loss Sharing Agreements are maintained, the FDIC will reimburse Customers Bank for 80% of the unpaid principal balance and certain expenses. A loss sharing receivable was recorded based upon the credit evaluation of the acquired loan portfolio and the estimated periods for repayments. Loans receivable and assets that are not subject to the Loss Sharing Agreement are described as “non-covered”.
 
(6) Our selected financial data contains non-GAAP financial measures calculated using non-GAAP amounts. These measures include tangible common equity and tangible book value per common share and tangible common equity to tangible assets.
 
Management uses these non-GAAP measures to present historical periods comparable to the current period presentation.   In addition, we believe the use of these non-GAAP measures provides additional clarity when assessing our financial results and use of equity.  These disclosures should not be viewed as substitutes for results determined to be in accordance with GAAP, nor are they necessarily comparable to non-GAAP performance measures that may be presented by other entities. We calculate tangible common equity by excluding preferred stock and goodwill from total shareholders’ equity. Tangible book value per common share equals tangible common equity divided by common shares outstanding.  A reconciliation of each of these Non-GAAP financial measures against the most directly comparable GAAP measures is set forth below.
 
 
   
(Dollars in thousands, except per share data)
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
Shareholders’ equity
  $ 147,748     $ 105,140     $ 21,503     $ 16,849     $ 16,830  
Less:
                                       
     Preferred stock
                      (980 )      
     Intangible assets
    (1,598 )                        
Tangible common equity
  $ 146,150     $ 105,140     $ 21,503     $ 15,869     $ 16,830  
                                         
Shares outstanding
    11,348       8,398       1,841       674       674  
                                         
Book value per share
  $ 13.02     $ 12.52     $ 11.68     $ 25.01     $ 24.97  
Less:  effect of excluding intangible
                                       
   assets and preferred stock
    (0.14 )     -       -       (1.45 )     -  
Tangible book value per share
  $ 12.88     $ 12.52     $ 11.68     $ 23.54     $ 24.97  
                                         
Total assets
  $ 2,077,532     $ 1,374,407     $ 349,760     $ 274,038     $ 272,004  
Less:  intangible assets
    (1,598 )     -       -       -       -  
Total tangible assets
  $ 2,075,934     $ 1,374,407     $ 349,760     $ 274,038     $ 272,004  
                                         
Equity to assets
    7.11 %     7.65 %     6.15 %     6.15 %     6.19 %
Less:  effect of excluding intangible
                                       
   assets and preferred stock
    (0.07 )                 (0.36 )      
Tangible common equity to tangible
                                       
   assets
    7.04 %     7.65 %     6.15 %     5.79 %     6.19 %



 
 
- 13 -

 

 
RISK FACTORS
 
Investing in our Voting Common Stock involves a high degree of risk. You should carefully consider the following risk factors, as well as all of the other information contained in this prospectus, including our consolidated historical financial statements and the related notes thereto, before making an investment decision to purchase our Voting Common Stock. The occurrence or realization of any of the following risks could materially and adversely affect our business, prospects, financial condition, liquidity, results of operations, cash flows and capital levels. In any such case, the market price of our Voting Common Stock could decline substantially, and you could lose all or part of your investment.
 
Risks Related to Our Banking Operations

Our level of assets categorized as doubtful, substandard or special mention expose us to increased lending risk.  If our allowance for loan losses is insufficient to absorb losses in our loan portfolio, our earnings could decrease.

Lending money is a substantial part of our business, and each loan carries a risk that it will not be repaid in accordance with its terms or that any underlying collateral will not be sufficient to assure repayment. This risk is affected by, among other things:
 
·  
the financial condition and cash flows of the borrower and/or the project being financed;
·  
the changes and uncertainties as to the future value of the collateral, in the case of a collateralized loan;
·  
the discount on the loan at the time of its acquisition;
·  
the duration of the loan;
·  
the credit history of a particular borrower; and
·  
changes in economic and industry conditions.

At December 31, 2011, our delinquent loans greater than 90 days and non-accrual loans not covered under the Loss Sharing Agreements with the FDIC totaled $38.9 million, which represented 2.77% of total loans not covered under the Loss Sharing Agreements, and our allowance for loan losses totaled $15.0 million, which represented 1.24% of total loans not covered under the Loss Sharing Agreements with the FDIC. We make various assumptions and judgments about the collectability of our loan portfolio, including the creditworthiness of our borrowers and the probability of receiving payment, as well as the value of real estate and other assets serving as collateral for the repayment of many of our loans. Loans covered under the Loss Sharing Agreements totaled $126.3 million at December 31, 2011. In determining the amount of the allowance for loan losses, significant factors considered include loss experience in particular segments of the portfolio, trends and absolute levels of classified and criticized loans, trends and absolute levels in delinquent loans, trends in risk ratings, trends in industry charge-offs by particular segments and changes in existing general economic and business conditions affecting our lending areas and the national economy. If our assumptions are incorrect, our allowance for loan losses may not be sufficient to cover losses inherent in our loan portfolio, resulting in additions to the allowance.  Material additions to our allowance could materially decrease net income. Our regulators, as an integral part of their examination process, periodically review our allowance for loan losses and may require us to increase our allowance for loan losses by recognizing additional provisions for loan losses charged to expense, or to decrease our allowance for loan losses by recognizing loan charge-offs, net of recoveries. Any such additional provisions for loan losses or charge-offs, as required by these regulatory agencies, could have a material adverse effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

Our emphasis on commercial and mortgage warehouse lending may expose us to increased lending risks.

We intend to continue to emphasize the origination of commercial and specialty loans, including mortgage warehouse financing. Commercial loans generally expose a lender to greater risk of non-payment and loss than one- to four-family residential mortgage loans because repayment of the loans often depends on the successful operation of the property and the income stream of the borrowers. Such loans typically involve larger loan balances to single borrowers or groups of related borrowers compared to one- to four-family residential mortgage loans. In addition, since such loans generally entail greater credit risk than one- to four-family residential mortgage loans, we may need to increase our allowance for loan losses in the future to account for the likely increase in probable incurred credit losses associated with the growth of such loans. Also, we expect that many of our commercial borrowers will have more than one loan outstanding with us. Consequently, an adverse development with respect to one loan or one credit relationship can expose us to a significantly greater risk of loss compared to an adverse development with respect to a one- to four-family residential mortgage loan.

As a mortgage warehouse lender, we provide a form of financing to mortgage bankers by purchasing the underlying residential mortgages on a short-term basis under a master repurchase agreement. We are subject to the risks associated with such lending, including, but not limited to, the risks of fraud, bankruptcy and default of the underlying residential borrower, any of which could result in credit losses. The risk of fraud associated with this type of lending includes, but is not limited to, the risk of financing nonexistent loans or fictitious mortgage loan transactions, or that the collateral delivered is fraudulent creating exposure that could result in the loss of the full amount financed on the underlying residential mortgage loan .
 
 
 
 
 
- 14 -

 

 
Decreased residential mortgage originations and pricing decisions of competitors may adversely affect our profitability.

We do not currently operate in the residential mortgage origination business.  However we may originate, sell and service residential mortgage loans in the future. If we do, changes in interest rates and pricing decisions by our loan competitors may adversely affect demand for our residential mortgage loan products, the revenue realized on the sale of loans and revenues received from servicing such loans for others, and ultimately reduce our net income. New regulations, increased regulatory reviews, and/or changes in the structure of the secondary mortgage markets which we would utilize to sell mortgage loans, may be introduced and may increase costs and make it more difficult to operate a residential mortgage origination business.

Federal Home Loan Bank of Pittsburgh may not pay dividends or repurchase capital stock in the future.

On December 23, 2008, the Federal Home Loan Bank of Pittsburgh (“FHLB”) announced that it would voluntarily suspend the payment of dividends and the repurchase of excess capital stock until further notice. The FHLB announced at that time that it expected its ability to pay dividends and add to retained earnings to be significantly curtailed due to low short-term interest rates, an increased cost of maintaining liquidity, other than temporary impairment charges, and constrained access to debt markets at attractive rates. While FHLB announced on February 22, 2012 that a dividend would be paid and capital stock repurchase would resume, capital stock repurchases from member banks are reviewed on a quarterly basis by the FHLB.  Such dividends and capital stock repurchases may not continue in the future.  As of December 31, 2011, we held $17.9 million of FHLB capital stock.

The fair value of our investment securities can fluctuate due to market conditions outside of our control.

As of December 31, 2011, the fair value of our investment securities portfolio was approximately $409.9 million.  We have historically taken a conservative investment strategy, with concentrations of securities that are backed by government sponsored enterprises. In the future, we may seek to increase yields through more aggressive strategies, which may include a greater percentage of corporate securities and structured credit products. Factors beyond our control can significantly influence the fair value of securities in our portfolio and can cause potential adverse changes to the fair value of these securities. These factors include, but are not limited to, rating agency actions in respect of the securities, defaults by the issuer or with respect to the underlying securities, and changes in market interest rates and continued instability in the capital markets. Any of these factors, among others, could cause other-than-temporary impairments and realized and/or unrealized losses in future periods and declines in other comprehensive income, which could have a material adverse effect on us. The process for determining whether impairment of a security is other-than-temporary usually requires complex, subjective judgments about the future financial performance and liquidity of the issuer and any collateral underlying the security in order to assess the probability of receiving all contractual principal and interest payments on the security.

We may not be able to meet the cash flow requirements of deposit withdrawals and other business needs or support earnings growth unless we maintain sufficient liquidity.

We need adequate liquidity to fund our balance sheet growth in order for us to be able to successfully grow our revenues, make loans and to repay deposit and other liabilities as they become due or are demanded by customers.  This liquidity can be gathered in both wholesale and non-wholesale funding markets. Our asset growth over the past few years has been funded with various forms of deposits and wholesale funding, which is defined as wholesale deposits (primarily certificates of deposit) and borrowed funds (FHLB advances, Federal advances and Federal fund line borrowings). Wholesale funding at December 31, 2011 represented approximately 17.6% of total funding compared with approximately 6.0% at December 31, 2010.  Wholesale funding generally costs more than deposits generated from our traditional branch system and is subject to certain practical limits such as the FHLB’s maximum borrowing capacity and our liquidity policy limits.  Additionally, regulators might consider wholesale funding beyond certain points to be imprudent and might suggest that future asset growth be reduced or halted.  In the absence of wholesale funding sources, we might need to reduce earning asset growth through the reduction of current production, sale of assets, and/or the participating out of future and current loans or leases. Alternatively, we may need to seek third party funding or other sources of liquidity.  This in turn might reduce our future net income.
 
 
 
 
 
- 15 -

 

 
Downgrades in U.S. Government and federal agency securities could adversely affect Customers Bancorp and the Bank

The long-term impact of the downgrade of the U.S. Government and federal agencies from an AAA to an AA+ credit rating is currently unknown.  However, in addition to causing economic and financial market disruptions, the recent downgrade, and any future downgrades and/or failures to raise the U.S. debt limit if necessary in the future, could, among other things, materially adversely affect the market value of the U.S. and other government and governmental agency securities that we hold, the availability of those securities as collateral for borrowing, and our ability to access capital markets on favorable terms, as well as have other material adverse effects on the operation of our business and our financial results and condition. In particular, it could increase interest rates and disrupt payment systems, money markets, and long-term or short-term fixed income markets, adversely affecting the cost and availability of funding, which could negatively affect profitability. Also, the adverse consequences as a result of the downgrade could extend to the borrowers of the loans the Bank makes and, as a result, could adversely affect its borrowers’ ability to repay their loans.

We may not be able to retain or develop a strong core deposit base or other low-cost funding sources.

We depend on checking, savings and money market deposit account balances and other forms of customer deposits as our primary source of funding for our lending activities. Our future growth will largely depend on our ability to retain and grow a strong, low-cost deposit base. Because 45% of our deposit base as of December 31, 2011 is time deposits, the large majority of which we acquired, it may prove harder to maintain and grow our deposit base than would otherwise be the case, especially since many of them currently pay interest at above-market rates. During the 12 months following December 31, 2011, $495.4 million of our time deposits are scheduled to mature.

We are working to transition certain of our customers to lower cost traditional banking services as higher cost funding sources, such as high interest time deposits, mature. Many banks in the United States are struggling to maintain depositors in light of the recent financial crisis, and there may be competitive pressures to pay higher interest rates on deposits, which could increase funding costs and compress net interest margins. Customers may not transition to lower yielding savings and investment products, which could materially and adversely affect us. In addition, with recent concerns about bank failures, customers have become concerned about the extent to which their deposits are insured by the FDIC, particularly customers that may maintain deposits in excess of insured limits. Customers may withdraw deposits in an effort to ensure that the amount that they have on deposit with us is fully insured and may place them in other institutions or make investments that are perceived as being more secure. Further, even if we are able to grow and maintain our deposit base, the account and deposit balances can decrease when customers perceive alternative investments, such as the stock market, as providing a better risk/return tradeoff. If customers move money out of bank deposits, we could lose a relatively low cost source of funds, increasing our funding costs and reducing our net interest income and net income. Additionally, any such loss of funds could result in lower loan originations, which could materially and adversely affect us.

We may not be able to maintain consistent earnings or profitability.

We have had periods in which we experienced operating losses, including in 2009, portions of 2010 and the first quarter of 2011. Although we made a profit in the second, third and fourth quarter of 2011 and for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2011, we may not be able to remain profitable in future periods, of, if profitable, our earnings may not remain consistent or increase in the future.  Our earnings also may be reduced by any increased expenses associated with increased assets, such as additional employee compensation expense, and increased interest expense on any liabilities incurred or deposits solicited to fund increases in assets. If earnings do not grow proportionately with our assets or equity, our overall profitability may be adversely affected.

Continued or worsening general business and economic conditions could materially and adversely affect us.

Our business and operations are sensitive to general business and economic conditions in the United States, which remain guarded. If the U.S. economy is unable to steadily emerge from the recent recession that began in 2007 or we experience worsening economic conditions, such as a so-called “double-dip” recession, we could be materially and adversely affected. Weak economic conditions may be characterized by deflation, fluctuations in debt and equity capital markets, including a lack of liquidity and/or depressed prices in the secondary market for mortgage loans, increased delinquencies on loans, residential and commercial real estate price declines and lower home sales and commercial activity. All of these factors would be detrimental to our business. Our business is significantly affected by monetary and related policies of the U.S. federal government, its agencies and government-sponsored entities. Changes in any of these policies are influenced by macroeconomic conditions and other factors that are beyond our control and could have a material adverse effect on us.
 
 
 
 
 
- 16 -

 

 
Downturns in the local economies and depressed banking markets could materially and adversely affect our financial condition and results of operations.

Our loan and deposit activities are largely based in Suburban Philadelphia, Central New Jersey and Southeastern New York State. As a result, our financial performance depends largely upon economic conditions in this region. This region has recently experienced deteriorating local economic conditions and a continued downturn in the regional real estate market that could harm our financial condition and results of operations because of the geographic concentration of loans within this region and because a large percentage of the loans are secured by real property.  If there is further decline in real estate values, the collateral for our loans will provide less security. As a result, the ability to recover on defaulted loans by selling the underlying real estate will be diminished, and we will be more likely to suffer losses on defaulted loans.  Additionally, a significant portion of our loan portfolio is invested in commercial real estate loans. Often in a commercial real estate transaction, repayment of the loan is dependent on rental income.

Economic conditions may affect the tenant’s ability to make rental payments on a timely basis, and may cause some tenants not to renew their leases, each of which may impact the debtor’s ability to make loan payments. Further, if expenses associated with commercial properties increase dramatically, the tenant’s ability to repay, and therefore the debtor’s ability to make timely loan payments, could be adversely affected.  All of these factors could increase the amount of non-performing loans, increase our provision for loan and lease losses and reduce our net income.

Our business is highly susceptible to credit risk.

As a lender, we are exposed to the risk that our customers will be unable to repay their loans according to their terms and that the collateral securing the payment of their loans (if any) may not be sufficient to assure repayment. The risks inherent in making any loan include risks with respect to the ability of borrowers to repay their loans and, if applicable, the period of time over which the loan is repaid, risks relating to proper loan underwriting and guidelines, risks resulting from changes in economic and industry conditions, risks inherent in dealing with individual borrowers and risks resulting from uncertainties as to the future value of collateral. Our credit standards, procedures and policies may not prevent us from incurring substantial credit losses, particularly in light of market developments in recent years.  Additionally, we may restructure originated or acquired loans if we believe the borrowers are likely to fully repay their restructured obligations. We may also be subject to legal or regulatory requirements for restructured loans. For our originated loans, if interest rates or other terms are modified subsequent to extension of credit or if terms of an existing loan are renewed because a borrower is experiencing financial difficulty and a concession is granted, we may be required to classify such action as a troubled debt restructuring (which we refer to in this prospectus as a “TDR”). With respect to restructured loans, we may grant concessions to borrowers experiencing financial difficulties in order to facilitate repayment of the loan by (1) reduction of the stated interest rate for the remaining life of the loan to lower than the current market rate for new loans with similar risk or (2) extension of the maturity date. In situations where a TDR is unsuccessful and the borrower is unable to satisfy the terms of the restructured loan, the loan would be placed on nonaccrual status and written down to the underlying collateral value less estimated selling costs.

We depend on our executive officers and key personnel to implement our strategy and could be harmed by the loss of their services.

We believe that the implementation of our strategy will depend in large part on the skills of our executive management team and our ability to motivate and retain these and other key personnel. Accordingly, the loss of service of one or more of our executive officers or key personnel could reduce our ability to successfully implement our growth strategy and materially and adversely affect us. Leadership changes will occur from time to time, and if significant resignations occur, we may not be able to recruit additional qualified personnel. We believe our executive management team possesses valuable knowledge about the banking industry and that their knowledge and relationships would be very difficult to replicate.  Although our Chief Executive Officer, President and Chief Financial Officer have entered into employment agreements with us, it is possible that they may not complete the term of their respective employment agreements or may choose not to renew their respective employment agreements upon expiration. Our success also depends on the experience of our branch managers and lending officers and on their relationships with the customers and communities they serve. The loss of these key personnel could negatively impact our banking operations. The loss of key senior personnel, or the inability to recruit and retain qualified personnel in the future, could have a material adverse effect on us.
 
 
 
 
 
- 17 -

 

 
Customers Bancorp’s chairman and chief executive officer also serves as Non-Executive Chairman of the holding company for another financial institution and such responsibilities could affect his ability to devote sufficient time to our operations.

Customers Bancorp’s Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, Jay S. Sidhu, also serves as Non-Executive Chairman of the Board of Atlantic Coast Financial Corporation, a holding company for Atlantic Coast Bank, a federal savings bank with branches in Florida and Georgia. Mr. Sidhu’s duties at Atlantic Coast Financial Corporation have the potential to cause him to devote less of his time to our operations, thereby potentially reducing his effectiveness in overseeing the strategic plan. A reduction in the time that Mr. Sidhu may devote to our operations could adversely affect our ability to successfully implement our strategic plan and results of operations.

We face significant competition from other financial institutions and financial services providers, which may materially and adversely affect us.

Consumer and commercial banking is highly competitive. Our markets contain a large number of community and regional banks as well as a significant presence of the country’s largest commercial banks. We compete with other state and national financial institutions, including savings and loan associations, savings banks and credit unions, for deposits and loans. In addition, we compete with financial intermediaries, such as consumer finance companies, mortgage banking companies, insurance companies, securities firms, mutual funds and several government agencies, as well as major retailers, in providing various types of loans and other financial services. Some of these competitors may have a long history of successful operations in our markets, greater ties to local businesses and more expansive banking relationships, as well as better established depositor bases. Competitors may also have greater resources and access to capital and may possess an advantage by being capable of maintaining numerous banking locations in more convenient sites, operating more ATMs and conducting extensive promotional and advertising campaigns or operating a more developed Internet platform. Competitors may also exhibit a greater tolerance for risk and behave more aggressively with respect to pricing in order to increase their market share.

The financial services industry could become even more competitive as a result of legislative, regulatory and technological changes and continued consolidation. Increased competition among financial services companies due to the recent consolidation of certain competing financial institutions may adversely affect our ability to market our products and services. Technological advances have lowered barriers to entry and made it possible for banks to compete in our market without a retail footprint by offering competitive rates, as well as non-banks to offer products and services traditionally provided by banks. Our ability to compete successfully depends on a number of factors, including, among others:

·  
the ability to develop, maintain and build upon long-term customer relationships based on high quality, personal service, effective and efficient products and services, high ethical standards and safe and sound assets;
·  
the scope, relevance and competitive pricing of products and services offered to meet customer needs and demands;
·  
the ability to provide customers with maximum convenience of access to services and availability of banking representatives;
·  
the ability to attract and retain highly qualified employees to operate our business;
·  
the ability to expand our market position;
·  
customer access to our decision makers, and customer satisfaction with our level of service; and
·  
the ability to operate our business effectively and efficiently.

Failure to perform in any of these areas could significantly weaken our competitive position, which could materially and adversely affect us.

We are affected by a variety of factors, including changes in interest rates, which can impact the value of financial instruments held by us.

Like other financial services institutions, we have asset and liability structures that are essentially monetary in nature and are directly affected by many factors, including domestic and international economic and political conditions, broad trends in business and finance, legislation and regulation affecting the national and international business and financial communities, monetary and fiscal policies, inflation, currency values, market conditions, the availability and terms (including cost) of short-term or long-term funding and capital, the credit capacity or perceived creditworthiness of customers and counterparties and the level and volatility of trading markets. Such factors can impact customers and counterparties of a financial services institution and may impact the value of financial instruments held by a financial services institution.
 
 
 
 
 
- 18 -

 

 
Our earnings and cash flows largely depend upon the level of our net interest income, which is the difference between the interest income we earn on loans, investments and other interest-earning assets, and the interest we pay on interest-bearing liabilities, such as deposits and borrowings. Because different types of assets and liabilities may react differently and at different times to market interest rate changes, changes in interest rates can increase or decrease our net interest income. When interest-bearing liabilities mature or reprice more quickly than interest-earning assets in a period, an increase in interest rates would reduce net interest income. Similarly, when interest-earning assets mature or reprice more quickly, and because the magnitude of repricing of interest-earning assets is often greater than interest-bearing liabilities, falling interest rates would reduce net interest income.

Accordingly, changes in the level of market interest rates affect our net yield on interest-earning assets and liabilities, loan and investment securities portfolios and our overall results. Changes in interest rates may also have a significant impact on any future loan origination revenues. Historically, there has been an inverse correlation between the demand for loans and interest rates. Loan origination volume and revenues usually decline during periods of rising or high interest rates and increase during periods of declining or low interest rates. Changes in interest rates also have a significant impact on the carrying value of a significant percentage of the assets, both loans and investment securities, on our balance sheet. We may incur debt in the future and that debt may also be sensitive to interest rates and any increase in interest rates could materially and adversely affect us. Interest rates are highly sensitive to many factors beyond our control, including general economic conditions and policies of various governmental and regulatory agencies, particularly the Federal Reserve. Adverse changes in the Federal Reserve’s interest rate policies or other changes in monetary policies and economic conditions could materially and adversely affect us.

We are dependent on our information technology and telecommunications systems and third-party servicers, and systems failures, interruptions or breaches of security could have a material adverse effect on us.

Our business is highly dependent on the successful and uninterrupted functioning of our information technology and telecommunications systems and third-party servicers. We outsource many of our major systems, such as data processing, loan servicing and deposit processing systems. The failure of these systems, or the termination of a third-party software license or service agreement on which any of these systems is based, could interrupt our operations. Because our information technology and telecommunications systems interface with and depend on third-party systems, we could experience service denials if demand for such services exceeds capacity or such third-party systems fail or experience interruptions. If significant, sustained or repeated, a system failure or service denial could compromise our ability to operate effectively, damage our reputation, result in a loss of customer business, and/or subject us to additional regulatory scrutiny and possible financial liability, any of which could have a material adverse effect on us.

In addition, we provide our customers with the ability to bank remotely, including over the Internet and over the telephone. The secure transmission of confidential information over the Internet and other remote channels is a critical element of remote banking. Our network could be vulnerable to unauthorized access, computer viruses, phishing schemes and other security breaches. We may be required to spend significant capital and other resources to protect against the threat of security breaches and computer viruses, or to alleviate problems caused by security breaches or viruses. To the extent that our activities or the activities of our customers involve the storage and transmission of confidential information, security breaches and viruses could expose us to claims, regulatory scrutiny, litigation and other possible liabilities. Any inability to prevent security breaches or computer viruses could also cause existing customers to lose confidence in our systems and could materially and adversely affect us.

Additionally, financial products and services have become increasingly technology-driven.  Our ability to meet the needs of our customers competitively, and in a cost-efficient manner, is dependent on the ability to keep pace with technological advances and to invest in new technology as it becomes available. Many of our competitors have greater resources to invest in technology than we do and may be better equipped to market new technology-driven products and services. The ability to keep pace with technological change is important, and the failure to do so could have a material adverse impact on our business and therefore on our financial condition and results of operations.
 
 
 
 
 
- 19 -

 

 
We intend to engage in acquisitions of other businesses from time to time.  These acquisitions may not produce revenue or earnings enhancements or cost savings at levels or within timeframes originally anticipated and may result in unforeseen integration difficulties.

On September 17, 2011, we completed the acquisition of Berkshire Bancorp, Inc. We regularly evaluate opportunities to strengthen our current market position by acquiring and investing in banks and in other complementary businesses, or opening new branches, and when appropriate opportunities arise, subject to regulatory approval, we plan to engage in acquisitions of other businesses and in opening new branches. Such transactions could, individually or in the aggregate, have a material effect on our operating results and financial condition, including short and long-term liquidity. Our acquisition activities could be material to our business. For example, we could issue additional shares of Voting Common Stock in a purchase transaction, which could dilute current shareholders’ value or ownership interest. These activities could require us to use a substantial amount of cash, other liquid assets and/or incur debt. Our acquisition activities could involve a number of additional risks, including the risks of:

·  
incurring time and expense associated with identifying and evaluating potential acquisitions and negotiating potential transactions, resulting in our attention being diverted from the operation of our existing business;
·  
using inaccurate estimates and judgments to evaluate credit, operations, management and market risks with respect to the target institution or assets;
·  
potential exposure to unknown or contingent liabilities of banks and businesses we acquire;
·  
the time and expense required to integrate the operations and personnel of the combined businesses;
·  
experiencing higher operating expenses relative to operating income from the new operations;
·  
creating an adverse short-term effect on our results of operations;
·  
losing key employees and customers as a result of an acquisition that is poorly received; or
·  
significant problems relating to the conversion of the financial and customer data of the entity being acquired into our financial and customer product systems.

Depending on the condition of any institutions or assets that are acquired, any acquisition may, at least in the near term, materially adversely affect our capital and earnings and, if not successfully integrated following the acquisition, may continue to have such effects. We may not be successful in overcoming these risks or any other problems encountered in connection with pending or potential acquisitions. Our inability to overcome these risks could have an adverse effect on levels of reported net income, return on equity and return on assets, and the ability to achieve our business strategy and maintain market value.

Our acquisitions generally will require regulatory approvals, and failure to obtain them would restrict our growth.

We intend to complement and expand our business by pursuing strategic acquisitions of community banking franchises. Generally, any acquisition of target financial institutions, banking centers or other banking assets by us will require approval by, and cooperation from, a number of governmental regulatory agencies, possibly including the Federal Reserve, the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency and the FDIC, as well as state banking regulators. In acting on applications, federal banking regulators consider, among other factors:

·  
the effect of the acquisition on competition;
·  
the financial condition, liquidity, results of operations, capital levels and future prospects of the applicant and the bank(s) involved;
·  
the quantity and complexity of previously consummated acquisitions;
·  
the managerial resources of the applicant and the bank(s) involved;
·  
the convenience and needs of the community, including the record of performance under the Community Reinvestment Act of 1977 (the “CRA”);
·  
the effectiveness of the applicant in combating money laundering activities; and
·  
the extent to which the acquisition would result in greater or more concentrated risks to the stability of the United States banking or financial system.

Such regulators could deny our application based on the above criteria or other considerations, which would restrict our growth, or the regulatory approvals may not be granted on terms that are acceptable to us. For example, we could be required to sell banking centers as a condition to receiving regulatory approvals, and such a condition may not be acceptable to us or may reduce the benefit of any acquisition.
 
 
 
 
 
 
- 20 -

 

 
The success of future acquisition transactions will depend on our ability to successfully identify and consummate acquisitions of banking franchises that meet our investment objectives. Because of the intense competition for acquisition opportunities and the limited number of potential targets, we may not be able to successfully consummate acquisitions on attractive terms, or at all.

The success of future acquisition transactions will depend on our ability to successfully identify and consummate transactions with target banking franchises that meet our investment objectives. There are significant risks associated with our ability to identify and successfully consummate these acquisitions. There are a limited number of acquisition opportunities, and we expect to encounter intense competition from other banking organizations competing for acquisitions and also from other investment funds and entities looking to acquire financial institutions. Many of these entities are well established and have extensive experience in identifying and consummating acquisitions directly or through affiliates. Many of these competitors possess ongoing banking operations with greater financial, technical, human and other resources and access to capital than we do. Our competitors may be able to achieve greater cost savings, through consolidating operations or otherwise, than we could. These competitive limitations give others an advantage in pursuing certain acquisitions. In addition, increased competition may drive up the prices for the acquisitions we pursue and make the other acquisition terms more onerous, which would make the identification and successful consummation of those acquisitions less attractive to us. Competitors may be willing to pay more for acquisitions than we believe are justified, which could result in us having to pay more for them than we prefer or to forego the opportunity. As a result, we may be unable to successfully identify and consummate acquisitions on attractive terms, or at all, that are necessary to grow our business.

We will generally establish the pricing of transactions and the capital structure of banking franchises to be acquired by us on the basis of financial projections for such banking franchises. In general, projected operating results will be based on the judgment of our management team. Projections are estimates of future results that are based upon assumptions made at the time that the projections are developed and the projected results may vary significantly from actual results. General economic, political and market conditions can have a material adverse impact on the reliability of such projections. In the event that the projections made in connection with our acquisitions, or future projections with respect to new acquisitions, are not accurate, such inaccuracies could materially and adversely affect us.

We are subject to certain risks related to FDIC-assisted acquisitions.

In evaluating potential acquisition opportunities we may seek to acquire failed banks through FDIC-assisted acquisitions. We recently completed the acquisition, from the FDIC, of (1) assets of the former USA Bank, which had been headquartered in Port Chester, New York, and (2) assets of the former ISN Bank, which had been headquartered in Cherry Hill, New Jersey. While the FDIC may, in such acquisitions, provide assistance to mitigate certain risks, such as sharing in exposure to loan losses, and providing indemnification against certain liabilities of the failed institution, we may not be able to accurately estimate our potential exposure to loan losses and other potential liabilities, or the difficulty of integration, in acquiring such institutions.

The success of past FDIC-assisted acquisitions, and any FDIC-assisted acquisitions in which we may participate in the future, will depend on a number of factors, including our ability to:

·  
fully integrate, and to integrate successfully, the branches acquired into bank operations;
·  
limit the outflow of deposits held by new customers in the acquired branches and to successfully retain and manage interest-earning assets (loans) acquired in FDIC-assisted acquisitions;
·  
retain existing deposits and generate new interest-earning assets in the geographic areas previously served by the acquired banks;
·  
effectively compete in new markets in which we did not previously have a presence;
·  
successfully deploy the cash received in the FDIC-assisted acquisitions into assets bearing sufficiently high yields without incurring unacceptable credit or interest rate risk;
·  
control the incremental non-interest expense from the acquired branches in a manner that enables us to maintain a favorable overall efficiency ratio;
·  
retain and attract the appropriate personnel to staff the acquired branches; and
·  
earn acceptable levels of interest and non-interest income, including fee income, from the acquired branches.

As with any acquisition involving a financial institution, particularly one involving the transfer of a large number of bank branches (as is often the case with FDIC-assisted acquisitions), there may be higher than average levels of service disruptions that would cause inconveniences or potentially increase the effectiveness of competing financial institutions in attracting our customers.  Integrating the acquired branches could present unique challenges and opportunities because of the nature of the transactions.  Integration efforts will also likely divert our management’s attention and resources. It is not known whether we will be able to integrate acquired branches successfully, and the integration process could result in the loss of key employees, the disruption of ongoing business or inconsistencies in standards, controls, procedures and policies that adversely affect our ability to maintain relationships with clients, customers, depositors and employees or to achieve the anticipated benefits of the FDIC-assisted acquisitions. We may also encounter unexpected difficulties or costs during integration that could materially and adversely affect our earnings and financial condition.  Additionally, we may be unable to compete effectively in the market areas previously served by the acquired branches or to manage any growth resulting from FDIC-assisted acquisitions effectively.
 
 
 
 
 
- 21 -

 
 

 
Our willingness and ability to grow acquired branches following FDIC-assisted acquisitions depend on several factors, most importantly the ability to retain certain key personnel that we hire or transfer in connection with FDIC-assisted acquisitions. Our failure to retain these employees could adversely affect the success of FDIC-assisted acquisitions and our future growth.

Our ability to continue to receive benefits of our Loss Sharing Agreements with the FDIC is conditioned upon compliance with certain requirements under the Purchase and Assumption Agreements.

Pursuant to the Purchase and Assumption Agreements we signed in connection with our FDIC-assisted acquisitions of USA Bank and ISN Bank (“Purchase and Assumption Agreements”), we are the beneficiary of Loss Sharing Agreements that require the FDIC to fund a portion of the losses on a majority of the assets acquired in connection with the transactions. Our ability to recover a portion of losses and retain the loss sharing protection is subject to compliance with certain requirements imposed on us in the Purchase and Assumption Agreements. The requirements of the Loss Sharing Agreements relate primarily to loan servicing standards concerning the assets covered by the Loss Sharing Agreements (the “Covered Assets”), as well as obtaining the consents of the FDIC to engage in certain corporate transactions that may be deemed under the agreements to constitute a transfer of the loss sharing benefits. For example, FDIC approval will be required for any merger we undertake that would result in the pre-merger shareholders of such entity owning less than 66.66% of the equity of the surviving entity.

As the loan servicing standards evolve, we may experience difficulties in complying with the requirements of the Loss Sharing Agreements, which could result in Covered Assets losing some or all of their loss sharing coverage. In accordance with the terms of the Loss Sharing Agreements, we are subject to audits by the FDIC through its designated agent. The required terms of the Loss Sharing Agreements are extensive and failure to comply with any of the guidelines could result in a specific asset or group of assets losing their loss sharing coverage.

In such instances in which the consent of the FDIC is required under the Purchase and Assumption Agreements, the FDIC may withhold its consent to such transactions or may condition its consent on terms that we do not find acceptable, which may cause us not to engage in a corporate transaction that might otherwise benefit shareholders or to pursue such a transaction without obtaining the FDIC’s consent, which could result in termination of the Loss Sharing Agreements with the FDIC.

FDIC-assisted acquisition opportunities may not become available and increased competition may make it more difficult for us to bid on failed bank transactions on terms considered to be acceptable.

Our near-term business strategy includes consideration of potential acquisitions of failing banks that the FDIC plans to place in receivership. The FDIC may not place banks that meet our strategic objectives into receivership. Failed bank transactions are attractive opportunities in part because of loss sharing arrangements with the FDIC that limit the acquirer’s downside risk on the purchased loan portfolio and, apart from our assumption of deposit liabilities, we have significant discretion as to the non-deposit liabilities that we assume. In addition, assets purchased from the FDIC are marked to their fair value and in many cases there is little or no addition to goodwill arising from an FDIC-assisted acquisition. The bidding process for failing banks could become very competitive, and the increased competition may make it more difficult for us to bid on terms we consider to be acceptable. Further, all FDIC-assisted acquisitions would require us to obtain applicable regulatory approval.

If we do not open new branches as planned or do not achieve profitability on new branches, earnings may be reduced.

We plan to open approximately four to six new branches each year over the next few years in and around our target markets of southeastern Pennsylvania, New Jersey, New York, Maryland, Connecticut and Delaware. These plans may change. The opening of new branches is subject to regulatory approvals. We cannot predict whether the banking regulators will agree with our growth plans or if or when they will provide the necessary branch approvals. Numerous factors contribute to the performance of a new branch, such as the ability to select a suitable location, competition, our ability to hire and retain qualified personnel, and the effectiveness of our marketing strategy. It takes time for a new branch to generate significant deposits and loan volume to offset expenses, some of which, like salaries and occupancy expense, are relatively fixed costs. The initial cost, including capital asset purchases, for each new branch to open would be in a range of approximately $200,000 to $250,000. These new branches may not become profitable. During the period of time before a branch can become profitable, operating a branch will negatively impact net income.
 
 
 
 
- 22 -

 
 

 
To the extent that we are unable to increase loans through organic loan growth, we may be unable to successfully implement our growth strategy, which could materially and adversely affect us.

In addition to growing our business through strategic acquisitions, we also intend to grow our business through organic loan growth.  While loan growth has been strong and our loan balances have increased from December 31, 2010 to December 31, 2011, much of this growth has come from our warehouse lending business and loans that we have acquired.  This warehouse lending business tends to be volatile and we have seen strong growth due to the low interest rate environmental and strong refinancing activity.  If the Bank is unsuccessful with diversifying its loan originations, our results of operations and financial condition could be negatively impacted.

We may not be able to effectively manage our growth.

Our future operating results depend to a large extent on our ability to successfully manage our rapid growth. Our rapid growth has placed, and it may continue to place, significant demands on our operations and management. Whether through additional acquisitions or organic growth, our current plan to expand our business is dependent upon our ability to:

·  
continue to implement and improve our operational, credit, financial, management and other internal risk controls and processes and our reporting systems and procedures in order to manage a growing number of client relationships;
·  
scale our technology platform;
·  
integrate our acquisitions and develop consistent policies throughout the various businesses; and
·  
attract and retain management talent.

We may not successfully implement improvements to, or integrate, our management information and control systems, procedures and processes in an efficient or timely manner and may discover deficiencies in existing systems and controls. In particular, our controls and procedures must be able to accommodate an increase in loan volume in various markets and the infrastructure that comes with new banking centers and banks. Thus, our growth strategy may divert management from our existing franchises and may require us to incur additional expenditures to expand our administrative and operational infrastructure and, if we are unable to effectively manage and grow our banking franchise, we could be materially and adversely affected. In addition, if we are unable to manage future expansion in our operations, we may experience compliance and operational problems, have to slow the pace of growth, or have to incur additional expenditures beyond current projections to support such growth, any one of which could materially and adversely affect us.

We may face risks related to minority investments.

From time to time, we may make or consider making minority investments in other financial institutions or technology companies in the financial services business. If we do so, we may not be able to influence the activities of companies in which we invest, and may suffer losses due to these activities. Investments in foreign companies could pose additional risks as a result of distance, language barriers and potential lack of information (for example, foreign institutions, including foreign financial institutions, may not be obligated to provide as much information regarding their operations as those in the United States).

Some institutions we may acquire may have distressed assets and we may not be able to realize the value predicted from these assets or have sufficient provision for future losses, or accurately estimate the future write-downs taken in respect of, these assets.

The decline in real estate values in many markets across the United States and weakened general economic conditions may result in increases in delinquencies and losses in the loan portfolios and other assets of financial institutions that we acquire in amounts that exceed initial forecasts developed during the due diligence investigation prior to acquiring those institutions. In addition, asset values may be impaired in the future due to factors that cannot currently be predicted, including significant deterioration in economic conditions and further declines in collateral values and credit quality indicators. Any of these events could adversely affect the financial condition, liquidity, capital position and value of institutions acquired and of our business as a whole. Further, as a registered bank holding company, if we acquire bank subsidiaries, they may become subject to cross-guaranty liability under applicable banking law. If we do so and any of the foregoing adverse events occur with respect to one subsidiary, they may adversely affect other subsidiaries.  Current economic conditions have created an uncertain environment with respect to asset valuations and we may not be able to sell assets of target institutions, even if it is determined to be in our best interests to do so. The institutions we will target may have substantial amounts of asset classes for which there is currently limited or no marketability.
 
 
 
 
- 23 -

 
 

 
As a result of an investment or acquisition transaction, we may be required to take write-downs or write-offs, restructuring and impairment or other charges that could have a significant negative effect on our financial condition and results of operations.

We conduct due diligence investigations of target institutions we intend to acquire. Intensive due diligence is time consuming and expensive due to the operations, accounting, finance and legal professionals who must be involved in the due diligence process. Even if extensive due diligence is conducted on a target institution with which we may be combined, this diligence may not reveal all material issues that may affect a particular target institution, and factors outside our control or the control of the target institution may later arise. If, during the diligence process, we fail to identify issues specific to a target institution or the environment in which the target institution operates, we may be forced to later write down or write off assets, restructure operations or incur impairment or other charges that could result in reporting losses. These charges may also occur if we are not successful in integrating and managing the operations of the target institution with which we combine. In addition, charges of this nature may cause us to violate net worth or other covenants to which we may be subject as a result of assuming preexisting debt held by a target institution or by virtue of obtaining debt financing.

Resources could be expended in considering or evaluating potential investment or acquisition transactions that are not consummated, which could materially and adversely affect subsequent attempts to locate and acquire or merge with another business.

We anticipate that the investigation of each specific target institution and the negotiation, drafting and execution of relevant agreements, disclosure documents and other instruments will require substantial management time and attention and substantial costs for accountants, attorneys and others. If a decision is made not to complete a specific investment or acquisition transaction, the costs incurred up to that point for the proposed transaction likely would not be recoverable. Furthermore, even if an agreement is reached relating to a specific target institution, we may fail to consummate the investment or acquisition transaction for any number of reasons, including those beyond our control. Any such event will result in a loss of the related costs incurred, which could materially and adversely affect subsequent attempts to locate and acquire or merge with another institution.

Risks Relating to the Regulation of Our Industry

The enactment of the Dodd-Frank Act Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”) may have a material adverse effect on our business.

The key effects of the Dodd-Frank Act on our business are:

·  
changes to regulatory capital requirements;
·  
exclusion of hybrid securities, including trust preferred securities, issued on or after May 19, 2010 from Tier 1 capital;
·  
creation of new government regulatory agencies (such as the Financial Stability Oversight Council, which will oversee systemic risk, and the Consumer Financial Protection Bureau, which will develop and enforce rules for bank and non-bank providers of consumer financial products);
·  
potential limitations on federal preemption;
·  
changes to deposit insurance assessments;
·  
regulation of debit interchange fees we earn;
·  
changes in retail banking regulations, including potential limitations on certain fees we may charge; and
·  
changes in regulation of consumer mortgage loan origination and risk retention.
 
 
 
 
 
- 24 -

 

 
In addition, the Dodd-Frank Act restricts the ability of banks to engage in certain proprietary trading or to sponsor or invest in private equity or hedge funds. The Dodd-Frank Act also contains provisions designed to limit the ability of insured depository institutions, their holding companies and their affiliates to conduct certain swaps and derivatives activities and to take certain principal positions in financial instruments.

Some provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act became effective immediately upon its enactment. Many provisions, however, will require regulations to be promulgated by various federal agencies in order to be implemented, some of which have been proposed by the applicable federal agencies. The provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act may have unintended effects, which will not be clear until implementation. The changes resulting from the Dodd-Frank Act could limit our business activities, require changes to certain of our business practices, impose upon us more stringent capital, liquidity and leverage requirements or otherwise materially and adversely affect us. These changes may also require us to invest significant management attention and resources to evaluate and make any changes necessary to comply with new statutory and regulatory requirements. Failure to comply with the new requirements could also materially and adversely affect us. For a more detailed description of the Dodd-Frank Act, see “Business–Supervision and Regulation—Federal Banking Laws—Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act.”

We operate in a highly regulated environment and the laws and regulations that govern our operations, corporate governance, executive compensation and accounting principles, or changes in them, or our failure to comply with them, could materially and adversely affect us.

We are subject to extensive regulation, supervision, and legislation that govern almost all aspects of our operations. Intended to protect customers, depositors and the Deposit Insurance Fund (the “DIF”), these laws and regulations, among other matters, prescribe minimum capital requirements, impose limitations on the business activities in which we can engage, limit the dividends or distributions that we can pay, restrict the ability of institutions to guarantee our debt, and impose certain specific accounting requirements on us that may be more restrictive and may result in greater or earlier charges to earnings or reductions in our capital than under accounting principles generally accepted in the United States (“GAAP”). Compliance with laws and regulations can be difficult and costly, and changes to laws and regulations often impose additional compliance costs. Our failure to comply with these laws and regulations, even if the failure follows a good faith effort or reflects a difference in interpretation, could subject us to restrictions on our business activities, fines and other penalties, any of which could materially and adversely affect us. Further, any new laws, rules and regulations could make compliance more difficult or expensive and also materially and adversely affect us.

The FDIC’s restoration plan and the related increased assessment rate could materially and adversely affect us.

The FDIC insures deposits at FDIC-insured depository institutions up to applicable limits. The amount of a particular institution’s deposit insurance assessment is based on that institution’s risk classification under an FDIC risk-based assessment system. An institution’s risk classification is assigned based on its capital levels and the level of supervisory concern the institution poses to its regulators. Market developments have significantly depleted the DIF of the FDIC and reduced the ratio of reserves to insured deposits. As a result of recent economic conditions and the enactment of the Dodd-Frank Act, the FDIC has increased the deposit insurance assessment rates and thus raised deposit insurance premiums for many insured depository institutions. If these increases are insufficient for the DIF to meet its funding requirements, there may need to be further special assessments or increases in deposit insurance premiums. We are generally unable to control the amount of premiums that we are required to pay for FDIC insurance. If there are additional bank or financial institution failures, we may be required to pay even higher FDIC premiums than the recently increased levels. Any future additional assessments, increases or required prepayments in FDIC insurance premiums may materially and adversely affect us, including by reducing our profitability or limiting our ability to pursue certain business opportunities.

Federal banking agencies periodically conduct examinations of our business, including compliance with laws and regulations, and our failure to comply with any supervisory actions to which we become subject as a result of such examinations could materially and adversely affect us.

Federal banking agencies periodically conduct examinations of our business, including our compliance with laws and regulations. If, as a result of an examination, a federal banking agency were to determine that the financial condition, capital resources, asset quality, earnings prospects, management, liquidity or other aspects of any of our operations had become unsatisfactory, or that the Company or its management was in violation of any law or regulation, it may take a number of different remedial actions as it deems appropriate. These actions include the power to enjoin “unsafe or unsound” practices, to require affirmative actions to correct any conditions resulting from any violation or practice, to issue an administrative order that can be judicially enforced, to direct an increase in our capital, to restrict our growth, to assess civil monetary penalties against our officers or directors, to remove officers and directors and, if it is concluded that such conditions cannot be corrected or there is an imminent risk of loss to depositors, to terminate our deposit insurance. If we become subject to such regulatory actions, we could be materially and adversely affected.
 
 
 
 
 
- 25 -

 

 
The Federal Reserve may require us to commit capital resources to support our subsidiary banks.

As a matter of policy, the Federal Reserve, which examines us and our subsidiaries, expects a bank holding company to act as a source of financial and managerial strength to a subsidiary bank and to commit resources to support such subsidiary bank. Under the “source of strength” doctrine, the Federal Reserve may require a bank holding company to make capital injections into a troubled subsidiary bank and may charge the bank holding company with engaging in unsafe and unsound practices for failure to commit resources to such a subsidiary bank. In addition, the Dodd-Frank Act directs the federal bank regulators to require that all companies that directly or indirectly control an insured depository institution serve as a source of strength for the institution. Under this requirement, we could be required to provide financial assistance to Customers Bank or any other subsidiary banks we may own in the future should they experience financial distress. A capital injection may be required at times when we do not have the resources to provide it and therefore we may be required to borrow the funds or raise additional equity capital from third parties. Any financing that must be done by the holding company in order to make the required capital injection may be difficult and expensive and may not be available on attractive terms, or at all, which likely would have a material adverse effect on us.

The short-term and long-term impact of the new regulatory capital standards and the forthcoming new capital rules on U.S. banks is uncertain.

On September 12, 2010, the Group of Governors and Heads of Supervision, the oversight body of the Basel Committee, announced an agreement to a strengthened set of capital requirements for internationally active banking organizations in the United States and around the world, known as “Basel III”.  Basel III increases the requirements for minimum common equity, minimum Tier 1 capital, and minimum total capital, to be phased in over time until fully phased in by January 1, 2019.

Various provisions of the Dodd-Frank Act increase the capital requirements of bank holding companies, such as Customers Bancorp, and non-bank financial companies that are supervised by the Federal Reserve. The leverage and risk-based capital ratios of these entities may not be lower than the leverage and risk-based capital ratios for insured depository institutions. In particular, bank holding companies, many of which have long relied on trust preferred securities as a component of their regulatory capital, will no longer be permitted to count trust preferred securities toward their Tier 1 capital. While the Basel III changes and other regulatory capital requirements will likely result in generally higher regulatory capital standards, it is not known at this time how any new standards will ultimately be applied to us and our bank subsidiary.

We face a risk of noncompliance and enforcement action with the Bank Secrecy Act and other anti-money laundering statutes and regulations.

The federal Bank Secrecy Act, the Uniting and Strengthening America by Providing Appropriate Tools Required to Intercept and Obstruct Terrorism Act of 2001 (the “PATRIOT Act”) and other laws and regulations require financial institutions, among other duties, to institute and maintain an effective anti-money laundering program and file suspicious activity and currency transaction reports as appropriate. The federal Financial Crimes Enforcement Network, established by the U.S. Treasury Department to administer the Bank Secrecy Act, is authorized to impose significant civil money penalties for violations of those requirements, and has recently engaged in coordinated enforcement efforts with the individual federal banking regulators, as well as the U.S. Department of Justice, Drug Enforcement Administration, and Internal Revenue Service. There is also increased scrutiny of compliance with the rules enforced by the Office of Foreign Assets Control (the “OFAC”). If our policies, procedures and systems are deemed deficient or the policies, procedures and systems of the financial institutions that we have already acquired or may acquire in the future are deficient, we would be subject to liability, including fines and regulatory actions (such as restrictions on our ability to pay dividends and the necessity to obtain regulatory approvals to proceed with certain aspects of our business plan, including our acquisition plans), which could materially and adversely affect us. Failure to maintain and implement adequate programs to combat money laundering and terrorist financing could also have serious reputational consequences for us.
 
 
 
 
 
- 26 -

 

 
Risks Relating to Our Voting Common Stock

There is currently no public market for our Voting Common Stock and an active, liquid market for our Voting Common Stock may not develop.

Before this offering, there has been no established public market for our Voting Common Stock.  We intend to apply to having our Voting Common Stock listed on the Nasdaq Global Market, but our application may not be approved.  Even if approved, an active, liquid trading market for our Voting Common Stock may not develop.  Accordingly, shareholders may not be able to sell their shares of our Voting Common Stock at the volume, prices and times desired.  We cannot predict the extent to which investor interest will lead to an active trading market in our Voting Common Stock or how liquid that market might become. A public trading market having the desired characteristics of depth, liquidity and orderliness depends upon the presence in the marketplace of willing buyers and sellers of our Voting Common Stock at any given time, which presence will be dependent upon the individual decisions of investors, over which we have no control.  The lack of an established market could have a material adverse effect on the value of our Voting Common Stock.

Even if an established trading market develops, the market price of our Voting Common Stock may be highly volatile, which may make it difficult for shareholders to sell their shares of our Voting Common Stock at the volume, prices and times desired. There are many factors that may impact the market price of our Voting Common Stock, including, without limitation:

·  
general market conditions, including price levels and volume;
·  
national, regional and local economic or business conditions;
·  
the effects of, and changes in, trade, monetary and fiscal policies, including the interest rate policies of the Federal Reserve;
·  
our actual or projected financial condition, liquidity, results of operations, cash flows and capital levels;
·  
publication of research reports about us, our competitors or the financial services industry generally, or changes in, or failure to meet, securities analysts’ estimates of our financial and operating performance, or lack of research reports by industry analysts or ceasing of coverage;
·  
market valuations, as well as the financial and operating performance and prospects, of similar companies;
·  
future issuances or sales, or anticipated sales, of our common stock or other securities convertible into or exchangeable or exercisable for our common stock;
·  
additions or departures of key personnel;
·  
the availability, terms and deployment of capital;
·  
the impact of changes in financial services laws and regulations (including laws concerning taxes, banking, securities and insurance);
·  
unanticipated regulatory or judicial proceedings, and related liabilities and costs;
·  
the timely implementation of services and products by us and the acceptance of such services and products by customers;
·  
our ability to continue to grow our business internally and through acquisitions and successful integration of new or acquired financial institutions, banking centers or other banking assets while controlling costs;
·  
compliance with laws and regulatory requirements, including those of federal, state and local agencies;
·  
our failure to satisfy the continuing listing requirements of the Nasdaq Global Market;
·  
our failure to comply with the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002;
·  
changes in accounting principles, policies and guidelines;
·  
actual, potential or perceived accounting problems affecting us;
·  
rapidly changing technology;
·  
other economic, competitive, governmental, regulatory and technological factors affecting our operations, pricing, products and services; and
·  
other news, announcements or disclosures (whether by us or others) related to us, our competitors, our core markets or the financial services industry.

The stock markets in general have experienced substantial fluctuations and volatility that has often been unrelated to the operating performance and prospects of particular companies. These broad market movements may materially and adversely affect the market price of our Voting Common Stock.
 
 
 
 
 
- 27 -

 

 
You will incur immediate dilution as a result of this offering.

If you purchase our Voting Common Stock in this offering, you will pay more for your shares than the pro forma net tangible book value of your shares. As a result, you will incur immediate dilution of $_______ per share, assuming an initial public offering price of $_____ per share, which is the midpoint of the offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, representing the difference between such assumed initial public offering price and our pro forma net tangible book value per share of common stock as of December 31, 2011. Accordingly, if we were liquidated at our pro forma net tangible book value, you would not receive the full amount of your investment. See “Dilution.”

You may incur dilution in your ability to affect and impact shareholder votes.

We may from time to time offer the holders of our issued and outstanding shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock the right to convert each share of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock held by them into one share of Voting Common Stock, subject to each holder not holding more than 4.9% of our Voting Common Stock after completion of this offering. These conversions may occur simultaneously with the consummation of this offering.  If all of the holders of our issued and outstanding shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock elect to convert all of their eligible shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock into shares of Voting Common Stock, there could be an additional 2,844,142 shares of Voting Common Stock issued and outstanding, with each share of Voting Common Stock entitling the holder thereof to one vote on all matters submitted to our shareholders for approval.  As a result, you should expect that you may incur additional dilution in your ability to affect and impact shareholder votes.
 
We do not expect to pay dividends on our Voting Common Stock in the foreseeable future, and our ability to pay dividends is subject to regulatory limitations.

We have not historically declared or paid dividends on our Voting Common Stock and we do not expect to do so in the near future. Any future determination relating to dividend policy will be made at the discretion of our board of directors and will depend on a number of factors, including earnings and financial condition, liquidity and capital requirements, the general economic and regulatory climate, ability to service any equity or debt obligations senior to the Voting Common Stock, and other factors deemed relevant by the board of directors.

In addition, as a bank holding company, we are subject to general regulatory restrictions on the payment of cash dividends. Federal bank regulatory agencies have the authority to prohibit bank holding companies from engaging in unsafe or unsound practices in conducting their business, which depending on the financial condition and liquidity of the holding company at the time, could include the payment of dividends. Further, various federal and state statutory provisions limit the amount of dividends that our bank subsidiary can pay to us as its holding company without regulatory approval. See “Market Price of Common Stock and Dividends - Dividends on Voting Common Stock” for further detail regarding restrictions on our ability to pay dividends.

We may issue additional shares of our common stock following this offering, which could adversely affect the value or voting power of the Voting Common Stock.

Actual or anticipated issuances or sales of substantial amounts of our common stock following this offering could cause the value of our Voting Common Stock to decline significantly and make it more difficult for us to sell equity or equity-related securities in the future at a time and on terms that we deem appropriate.  The issuance of any shares of our common stock in the future also would, and equity-related securities could, dilute the percentage ownership interest held by shareholders prior to such issuance. Actual issuances of our Voting Common Stock could also significantly dilute the voting power of our Voting Common Stock.

We have also made grants of restricted stock units and stock options with respect to shares of Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock.   We may also issue further equity-based awards in the future.  As such shares are issued upon vesting and as such options may be exercised and the underlying shares are or become freely tradeable, the value or voting power of our Voting Common Stock may be adversely affected and our ability to sell more equity or equity-related securities could also be adversely affected.
 
 
 
 
 
- 28 -

 
 

 
The market price of our Voting Common Stock could decline significantly if our existing shareholders sell their freely tradeable shares.
 
Almost all of our outstanding shares of Voting Common Stock are freely tradeable, and the holders thereof have had limited ability to sell their shares in the over-the-counter market.  As of February 29, 2012, there were 8,084,541 shares of Voting Common Stock that are freely tradeable, and assuming all of our holders of  Class B Non-Voting Common Stock convert into Voting Common Stock, there will be another 2,278,294 shares of Voting Common Stock that are freely tradeable.  Of such freely tradeable shares of Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock, 1,511,908 will be subject to lock-up agreements for 90 days after the closing of this offering, but the balance will remain freely tradeable. Upon the listing of our shares of Voting Common Stock on NASDAQ,  our existing shareholders not subject to such lock-up agreements may seek to sell their shares of Voting Common Stock and gain liquidity.  Depending on how many shares may be offered for sale, the market price of our Voting Common Stock could be adversely affected and may decline significantly.
 
Future issuances of debt and equity securities, which would dilute the holdings of our existing holders of Voting Common and may be senior to our Voting Common Stock for the purposes of making distributions, periodically or upon liquidation, may negatively affect the market price of our Voting Common Stock.

In the future, we may issue debt or equity securities or incur other borrowings. If we incur debt in the future, our future interest costs could increase, and adversely affect our liquidity, cash flows and results of operations. Additional common stock issuances, directly or through convertible or exchangeable securities, warrants or options, will generally dilute the holdings of our existing holders of Voting Common Stock and such issuances or the perception of such issuances may reduce the market price of our Voting Common Stock. Our preferred stock, if issued, would likely have a preference on distribution payments, periodically or upon liquidation, which could eliminate or otherwise limit our ability to make distributions to holders of our Voting Common Stock. Because our decision to issue debt or equity securities or incur other borrowings in the future will depend on market conditions and other factors beyond our control, the amount, timing, nature or success of our future capital raising efforts is uncertain. Thus, holders of our Voting Common Stock bear the risk that our future issuances of debt or equity securities or our incurrence of other borrowings will negatively affect the value of our Voting Common Stock.

Our directors and executive officers can influence the outcome of shareholder votes and, in some cases, shareholders may have no opportunity to evaluate and affect the decision regarding a potential investment or acquisition transaction.

As of February 29, 2012, the directors and executive officers of Customers Bancorp as a group owned a total of 666,600 shares of Voting Common Stock and exercisable options or warrants to purchase up to an additional 286,584 shares of Voting Common Stock, which potentially gives them, as a group, the ability to control approximately 10.8% of the issued and outstanding Voting Common Stock.  In addition, directors of Customers Bank who are not directors of Customers Bancorp own an additional 887,501 shares of Voting Common Stock, which if combined with the directors and officers of Customers Bancorp, potentially gives them, as a group, the ability to control approximately 21.23% of the issued and outstanding Voting Common Stock.  We believe ownership of stock causes directors and officers to have the same interests as shareholders, but it also gives them the ability to vote as shareholders for matters that are in their personal interest, which may be contrary to the wishes of other shareholders.  Shareholders will not necessarily be provided with an opportunity to evaluate the specific merits or risks of one or more target institutions. In those instances, decisions regarding a potential investment or acquisition transaction will be made by our board of directors. Except in limited circumstances as required by applicable law, consummation of an acquisition will not require the approval of holders of Voting Common Stock. Accordingly, a shareholder may not have an opportunity to evaluate and affect the decision regarding potential investment or acquisition transactions.

Provisions in our articles of incorporation and bylaws may inhibit a takeover of us, which could discourage transactions that would otherwise be in the best interests of our shareholders and could entrench management.

Provisions of our articles of incorporation and bylaws, and applicable provisions of Pennsylvania law and the federal Change in Bank Control Act may delay, inhibit or prevent someone from gaining control of our business through a tender offer, business combination, proxy contest or some other method even though some of our shareholders might believe a change in control is desirable. They might also increase the costs of completing a transaction in which we acquire another financial services business, merge with another financial institution, or sell our business to another financial institution. These increased costs could reduce the value of the shares held by our shareholders upon completion of these types of transactions.
 
 
 
 
 
- 29 -

 
 

 
Shareholders may be deemed to be acting in concert or otherwise in control of us and our bank subsidiaries, which could impose prior approval requirements and result in adverse regulatory consequences for such holders.

We are a bank holding company regulated by the Federal Reserve. Any entity (including a “group” composed of natural persons) owning 25% or more of a class of our outstanding shares of voting stock, or a lesser percentage if such holder or group otherwise exercises a “controlling influence” over us, may be subject to regulation as a “bank holding company” in accordance with the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended (the “BHCA”). In addition, (1) any bank holding company or foreign bank with a U.S. presence is required to obtain the approval of the Federal Reserve under the BHCA to acquire or retain 5% or more of a class of our outstanding shares of voting stock, and (2) any person other than a bank holding company may be required to obtain prior regulatory approval under the Change in Bank Control Act to acquire or retain 10% or more of our outstanding shares of voting stock. Any shareholder that is deemed to “control” the Company for bank regulatory purposes would become subject to prior approval requirements and ongoing regulation and supervision. Such a holder may be required to divest amounts equal to or exceeding 5% of the voting shares of investments that may be deemed incompatible with bank holding company status, such as an investment in a company engaged in non-financial activities. Regulatory determination of “control” of a depository institution or holding company is based on all of the relevant facts and circumstances. Potential investors are advised to consult with their legal counsel regarding the applicable regulations and requirements.

Our common stock owned by holders determined by a bank regulatory agency to be acting in concert would be aggregated for purposes of determining whether those holders have control of a bank or bank holding company. Each shareholder obtaining control that is a “company” would be required to register as a bank holding company. “Acting in concert” generally means knowing participation in a joint activity or parallel action towards the common goal of acquiring control of a bank or a parent company, whether or not pursuant to an express agreement. The manner in which this definition is applied in individual circumstances can vary and cannot always be predicted with certainty. Many factors can lead to a finding of acting in concert, including where: (i) the shareholders are commonly controlled or managed; (ii) the shareholders are parties to an oral or written agreement or understanding regarding the acquisition, voting or transfer of control of voting securities of a bank or bank holding company; (iii) the shareholders each own stock in a bank and are also management officials, controlling shareholders, partners or trustees of another company; or (iv) both a shareholder and a controlling shareholder, partner, trustee or management official of such shareholder own equity in the bank or bank holding company.

The FDIC’s recent policy statement imposing restrictions and criteria on private investors in failed bank acquisitions may apply to us and certain of our investors, including a prohibition on sales or transfers of our securities by such investors until three years from such investor’s acquisition of shares of common stock without FDIC approval.

On August 26, 2009, the FDIC issued a policy statement imposing restrictions and criteria on certain institutions and private investors in failed bank acquisitions. The policy statement is broad in scope and both complex and potentially ambiguous in its application. In most cases it would apply to an investor with more than 5% of the total voting power of an acquired depository institution or its holding company, but in certain circumstances it could apply to investors holding fewer voting shares. The policy statement will be applied to us if we make additional failed bank acquisitions from the FDIC or if the FDIC changes its interpretation of the policy statement or determines at some future date that it should be applied because of our circumstances.

In the event the policy statement applies to us, investors subject to the policy statement could be prohibited from selling or transferring their interests for three years. They also would be required to provide the FDIC with information about the investor and all entities in the investor’s ownership chain, including information on the size of the capital fund or funds, its diversification, its return profile, its marketing documents, and its management team and business model. Investors owning 80% or more of two or more banks or savings associations would be required to pledge their proportionate interests in each institution to cross-guarantee the FDIC against losses to the DIF.

Under the policy statement, the FDIC also could prohibit investment through ownership structures involving multiple investment vehicles that are owned or controlled by the same parent company. Investors that directly or indirectly hold 10% or more of the equity of a bank or savings association in receivership also would not be eligible to bid to become investors in the deposit liabilities of that failed institution. In addition, an investor using ownership structures with entities that are domiciled in bank secrecy jurisdictions would not be eligible to own a direct or indirect interest in an insured depository institution unless the investor’s parent company is subject to comprehensive consolidated supervision as recognized by the Federal Reserve and the investor enters into certain agreements with the U.S. bank regulators regarding access to information, maintenance of records and compliance with U.S. banking laws and regulations. If the policy statement applies, we (including any failed bank we acquire) could be required to maintain a ratio of Tier 1 common equity to total assets of at least 10% for a period of 3 years, and thereafter maintain a capital level sufficient to be well capitalized under regulatory standards during the remaining period of ownership of the investors. Our bank subsidiary also may be prohibited from extending any new credit to investors that own at least 10% of our equity.
 
 
 
 
 
- 30 -

 

 

CAUTIONARY NOTE REGARDING
FORWARD -LOOKING STATEMENTS
 
This Prospectus, including audited financial statements, as well as other written or oral communications made from time to time by us may contain certain forward-looking information within the meaning of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, and the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (“Exchange Act”). These statements relate to future events or future predictions, including events or predictions relating to future financial performance, and are generally identifiable by the use of forward-looking terminology such as “believe,” “expect,” “may,” “will,” “should,” “plan,” “intend,” or “anticipate” or the negative thereof or comparable terminology, identify forward-looking statements, which are generally historical in nature. These forward-looking statements are only predictions and estimates regarding future events and circumstances and involve known and unknown risks, uncertainties and other factors, including the risks described under “Risk Factors” that may cause actual results, levels of activity, performance or achievements to be materially different from any future results, levels of activity, performance or achievements expressed or implied by such forward-looking statements. This information is based on various assumptions that may not prove to be correct.  In addition to the risks described in the “Risk Factors” section of this Prospectus, important factors to consider and evaluate in such forward-looking statements include:
 
 
·
Changes in the external competitive market factors that might impact results of operations;
 
·
Changes in laws and regulations, including without limitation changes in capital requirements under the federal prompt corrective action regulations;
 
·
Changes in business strategy or an inability to execute strategy due to the occurrence of unanticipated events;
 
·
Ability to identify potential candidates for, and consummate, acquisition or investment transactions;
 
·
Failure to complete any or all of the transactions described herein on the terms currently contemplated;
 
·
Local, regional and national economic conditions and events and the impact they may have on Customers Bancorp and their customers;
 
·
Ability to attract deposits and other sources of liquidity;
 
·
Changes in the financial performance and/or condition of Customers Bancorp’s borrowers;
 
·
Changes in the level of non-performing and classified assets and charge-offs;
 
·
Changes in estimates of future loan loss reserve requirements based upon the periodic review thereof under relevant regulatory and accounting requirements;
 
·
Changes in Customers Bancorp’s capital structure resulting from future capital offerings or acquisitions;
 
·
The integration of Customers Bancorp’s recent FDIC-assisted acquisitions may present unforeseen challenges;
 
·
Inflation, interest rate, securities market and monetary fluctuations;
 
·
The timely development and acceptance of new banking products and services and perceived overall value of these products and services by users;
 
·
Changes in consumer spending, borrowing and saving habits;
 
·
Technological changes;
 
·
The ability to increase market share and control expenses;
 
·
Volatility in the credit and equity markets and its effect on the general economy;
 
·
The effect of changes in accounting policies and practices, as may be adopted by the regulatory agencies, as well as the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board, the Financial Accounting Standards Board and other accounting standard setters;
 
·
The businesses of Customers Bancorp and subsidiaries, not integrating successfully or such integration being more difficult, time-consuming or costly than expected;
 
·
Material differences in the actual financial results of merger and acquisition activities compared with expectations, such as with respect to the full realization of anticipated cost savings and revenue enhancements within the expected time frame, including as to the merger;
 
·
Revenues following the merger being lower than expected; and
 
·
Deposit attrition, operating costs, customer loss and business disruption following the merger, including, without limitation, difficulties in maintaining relationships with employees, being greater than expected.
 
 
 
 
 
- 31 -

 

 
These forward-looking statements are subject to significant uncertainties and contingencies, many of which are beyond the control of Customers Bancorp.  Although the expectations reflected in the forward-looking statements are currently believed to be reasonable, future results, levels of activity, performance or achievements cannot be guaranteed.  Accordingly, there can be no assurance that actual results will meet expectations or will not be materially lower than the results contemplated in this document and the attachments hereto.  You are cautioned not to place undue reliance on these forward-looking statements, which speak only as of the date of this document or, in the case of documents referred to, the dates of those documents .
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 

 

 
- 32 -

 
 
USE OF PROCEEDS

We estimate that the net proceeds to us from the sale of our Voting Common Stock in this offering will be approximately $___, or approximately $___ if the underwriters' option to purchase additional shares of our Voting Common Stock from us is exercised in full, assuming an initial public offering price of $___ per share, which is the midpoint of the offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, and after deducting estimated underwriting discounts and offering expenses. Each $1.00 increase (decrease) in the assumed initial public offering price of $___ per share of Voting Common Stock would increase (decrease) the net proceeds to us of this offering by $___, or $___ if the underwriters' option to purchase additional shares of our Voting Common Stock from us is exercised in full, assuming that the number of shares of Voting Common Stock offered by us, as set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, remains the same and after deducting estimated underwriting discounts and offering expenses.
 
We intend to use the net proceeds from this offering: (i) to fund our organic growth in a manner consistent with our growth strategy; (ii) to fund the acquisition of depository institutions through traditional unassisted and FDIC-assisted bank acquisitions, as well as through selective acquisitions of banking franchises and non-bank institutions that are consistent with our growth strategy; and (iii) for working capital and other general corporate purposes.  While we are constantly assessing various acquisition opportunities, we currently do not have any binding commitments or agreements for any acquisitions.
 
Pending use of the net proceeds as described above, we intend to invest the net proceeds in bank accounts at Customers Bank.
 
DIVIDEND POLICY
 
We intend to follow a policy of retaining earnings, if any, to increase our net worth and reserves over the next few years. We have not historically declared or paid dividends on our Voting Common Stock and we do not expect to do so in the near future. Any future determination relating to our dividend policy will be made at the discretion of our board of directors and will depend on a number of factors, including our earnings and financial condition, liquidity and capital requirements, the general economic and regulatory climate, our ability to service any equity or debt obligations senior to Voting Common Stock, and other factors deemed relevant by our board of directors.  See “Description of Capital Stock – Dividend Rights” and “Market Price of Common Stock and Dividends - Dividends on Voting Common Stock” for further detail regarding restrictions on our ability to pay dividends.
 
 
 
- 33 -

 
 

 
CAPITALIZATION
 
The following table sets forth our cash and cash equivalents and our capitalization as of December 31, 2011 on an actual basis and on an as adjusted basis to give effect to our sale of shares of Voting Common Stock in this offering at an assumed initial public offering price of $_____ per share, which is the midpoint of the offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, after deducting estimated underwriting discounts and offering expenses.
 
This table should be read in conjunction with “Selected Historical Consolidated Financial Information,” “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations” and our consolidated financial statements, as well as the statements of assets acquired and liabilities assumed and the related notes thereto appearing elsewhere in this prospectus.
 
   
At Dec. 31, 2011
   
Actual
    As Adjusted  
   
(unaudited)
   
(dollars in thousands, except
share and per share data)
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 73,570     $  
Long-term debt
    13,000          
Shareholders’ equity:
               
Common stock, par value $1.00 per share; 100,000,000 shares of Voting Common stock authorized, 8,503,541   shares of Voting Common Stock issued and outstanding (actual), and _____ shares of Voting Common Stock issued and outstanding (as adjusted);  100,000,000 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock authorized, 2,844,142   shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock issued and outstanding (actual) and _____ shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock issued and outstanding (as adjusted) (1)
    11,395        
Additional Paid-in capital
    122,602        
Retained earnings
    14,496        
Accumulated other comprehensive income
    (245 )      
        Less: cost of treasury stock, 47,619 shares at December 31, 2011
    (500 )        
                 
Total shareholders’ equity
  $ 147,748     $    
                 
Total capitalization
  $ 234,318     $    
 
 
 
 
- 34 -

 
 
 
DILUTION
 
If you invest in our Voting Common Stock, your ownership interest will be diluted by the amount by which the initial offering price per share paid by the purchasers of Voting Common Stock in this offering exceeds the net tangible book value per share of our Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock following this offering. As of December 31, 2011, our net tangible book value was approximately $146.1 million, or $12.88 per share of common stock based on 11,347,683 shares of common stock issued and outstanding (including 8,503,541 shares of Voting Common Stock and 2,844,142 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock). Net tangible book value per share equals total consolidated tangible assets minus total consolidated liabilities divided by the number of shares of our Voting Common Stock outstanding and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock.
 
Our net tangible book value, as of December 31, 2011 would have been approximately $          , or $___ per share of common stock based on _____ shares of common stock issued and outstanding (including shares of Voting Common Stock and _____ shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock), after giving effect to the sale by us of ____ shares of Voting Common Stock in this offering at an assumed initial public offering price of $___ per share, the midpoint of the offering price range set forth on the cover page of this prospectus, after deducting the estimated underwriting discounts and offering expenses.
 
This represents an immediate increase in the net tangible book value of $_____ per share to existing stockholders and an immediate dilution in the net tangible book value of $_____ per share to the new investors who purchase our Voting Common Stock in this offering.
 
The following table illustrates this per share dilution:
             
Assumed initial public offering price per share
        $    
Net tangible book value per share as of December 31, 2011
  $ 12.88          
Increase in net tangible book value per share attributable to this offering
               
                 
Net tangible book value per share after this offering
               
                 
Dilution per share to new investors
          $    
 
 
Each $1.00 increase (decrease) in the assumed initial public offering price of $_____ per share of Voting Common Stock would increase (decrease) our net tangible book value as of December 31, 2011 by approximately $_____ million, or approximately $_____ per share, and the pro forma dilution per share to new investors in this offering by approximately $_____ per share, assuming that the number of shares offered by us, as set forth on the cover of this prospectus, remains the same and after deducting estimated underwriting discounts and offering expenses. The number of shares offered by us in this offering may be increased or decreased from the number of shares on the cover page of this prospectus. Each increase of 1.0 million shares in the number of shares offered by us, together with a $1.00 increase in the assumed offering price of $_____ per share of Voting Common Stock, would increase  our net tangible book value as of December 31, 2011 by approximately $_____ million, or approximately $_____ per share, and the pro forma dilution per share to new investors in this offering by approximately $_____ per share.  Similarly, a decrease of 1.0 million shares in the number of shares of Voting Common Stock offered by us, together with a $1.00 decrease in the assumed public offering price of approximately $_____ per share, would decrease our net tangible book value, as of December 31, 2011, by approximately $_____ million, or $_____ per share, and the pro forma dilution per share to new investors in this offering would be approximately $_____ per share. The as adjusted information discussed above is illustrative only and will adjust based on the actual initial public offering price and other terms of this offering determined at pricing.
 
If the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares of our Voting Common Stock in full in this offering, our net tangible book value at December 31, 2011 would be $_____ million, or $_____ per share, representing an immediate increase in the net tangible book value of $_____ per share to existing stockholders and an immediate dilution in the net tangible book value of $_____ per share to the new investors who purchase our Voting Common Stock in this offering.
 
The following table summarizes, as of December 31, 2011, the difference between existing stockholders and new investors with respect to the number of shares of Voting Common Stock purchased from us, the total consideration paid to us for these shares and the average price per share paid by our existing stockholders and to be paid by the new investors in this offering. The calculation below reflecting the effect of shares purchased by new investors is based on the assumed initial public offering price of $_____ per share, which is the midpoint of the offering price range set forth in the cover of this prospectus, before deducting estimated underwriting discounts and offering expenses.
 

 
- 35 -

 
 
 
                                 
 
  
Shares Purchased
   
Total Consideration
   
Average
Price
 
  
  
Number
  
Percent
   
  Amount  
  
  Percent  
   
Per Share
 
Existing stockholders
  
 
  
 
    
   
  
 
    
 
$
            
  
New investors
  
 
  
 
    
   
  
 
    
 
$
 
  
 
  
 
  
         
  
             
Total
  
 
  
 
100.0
   
  
 
100.0
 
$
 
  
 
The discussion and tables above include 8,503,541 shares of Voting Common Stock and 2,844,142 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock issued and outstanding as of December 31, 2011, and excludes 35,289 shares Voting Common Stock underlying restricted stock units awarded but not yet vested under the 2004 Plan; 589,005 shares of Voting Common Stock and 81,036 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock issuable upon exercise of outstanding warrants with exercise prices from $10.50 to $73.01 per share, of which all were vested as of December 31, 2011; 1,194,695 shares of Voting Common Stock issuable upon exercise of outstanding stock options issuable under our 2010 Stock Option Plan and 2004 Plan with a weighted average exercise price of $11.13 per share, of which 6,592 shares were vested as of December 31, 2011;  and 6,736 shares of Voting Common Stock issuable to directors as compensation for service as a director (see “Director Compensation” for details).
   
To the extent any outstanding options are exercised, there will be further dilution to new investors. To the extent all outstanding options had been exercised as of December 31, 2011, the net tangible book value per share after this offering would be $_____ and total dilution per share to new investors would be $_____.

If the underwriters exercise their option to purchase additional shares in full:
·  
The percentage of shares of Voting Common Stock held by existing stockholders will decrease to approximately _____% of the total number of shares of our Voting Common Stock outstanding after this offering; and
 
·  
The number of shares held by new investors will increase to _____________, or approximately ______% of the total number of shares of our Voting Common Stock outstanding after this offering.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
- 36 -

 

 
 
SELECTED HISTORICAL CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL INFORMATION

Customers Bancorp and Subsidiary

The following table presents Customers Bancorp’s summary consolidated financial data.  We derived our balance sheet and income statement data for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010, 2009, 2008 and 2007 from our audited financial statements.  The summary consolidated financial data should be read in conjunction with, and are qualified in their entirety by, our financial statements and the accompanying notes and the other information included elsewhere in this prospectus.

Dollars in thousands except per share data

 
 
2011(1)
   
2010(2)
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
For the Period
                             
Interest income
  $ 61,439     $ 30,907     $ 13,486     $ 15,502     $ 17,659  
Interest expense
    22,463       11,546       6,336       8,138       10,593  
Net interest income
    38,976       19,361       7,150       7,364       7,066  
Provision for loan losses
    9,450       10,397       11,778       611       444  
Bargain purchase gain on bank acquisitions
          40,254                    
Total non-interest income (loss) excluding bargain purchase gains
    13,652       5,349       1,043       (350     356  
Total non-interest expense
    37,309       26,101       9,650       7,654       6,908  
Income (loss) before taxes
    5,869       28,466       (13,235 )     (1,251     70  
Income tax expense (benefit)
    1,835       4,731             (426     (160
Net income (loss)
    4,034       23,735       (13,235 )     (825     230  
Net income (loss) attributable to common shareholders
  $ 3,990     $ 23,735     $ (13,235 )   $ (825 )   $ 230  
Basic earnings (loss) per share (3)
  $ 0.40     $ 3.78     $ (10.98 )   $ (1.23 )   $ 0.33  
Diluted earnings (loss) per share (3)
  $ 0.39     $ 3.69     $ (10.98 )   $ (1.23 )   $ 0.33  
At Period End
                                       
Total assets
  $ 2,077,532     $ 1,374,407     $ 349,760     $ 274,038     $ 272,004  
Cash and cash equivalents
    73,570       238,724       68,807       6,295       6,683  
Investment securities (4)
    398,684       205,828       44,588       32,061       40,779  
Loans held for sale
    174,999       199,970                    
Loans receivable not covered by Loss Sharing Agreements with the FDIC (5)
    1,216,265       514,087       230,258       223,752       214,569  
Allowance for loan and lease losses
    15,032       15,129       10,032       2,876       2,460  
Loans receivable covered under Loss Sharing Agreements with the FDIC (5)
    126,276       164,885                    
FDIC loss sharing receivable (5)
    13,077       16,702                    
Deposits
    1,583,189       1,245,690       313,927       237,842       220,345  
Other borrowings
    331,000       11,000                    
Shareholders’ equity
    147,748       105,140       21,503       16,849       16,830  
Tangible common equity(6)
  $ 146,150     $ 105,140     $ 21,503     $ 15,869     $ 16,830  
Selected Ratios and Share  Data
                                       
Return on average assets
    0.24     3.40 %     (4.69 )%     (0.30 )%     0.09 %
Return on average equity
    3.56     41.29 %     (65.35 )%     (4.98 )%     1.40 %
Book value per share (3)
  $ 13.02     $ 12.52     $ 11.68     $ 25.00     $ 24.97  
Tangible book value per common share(3) (6)
  $ 12.88     $ 12.52     $ 11.68     $ 23.54     $ 24.97  
Common shares  outstanding (3)
    11,347,683       8,398,014       1,840,902       673,693       673,693  
Net interest margin
    2.44 %     2.70 %     2.62 %     2.82 %     2.83 %
Equity to assets
    7.11 %     7.65 %     6.14 %     6.15 %     6.19 %
 
 
 
 
- 37 -

 
 
 
Tangible common equity to tangible assets (6)
    7.04 %     7.65 %     6.14 %     5.79 %     6.19 %
Tier 1 leverage ratio - Bank
    7.33 %     8.67 %     6.68 %     6.21 %     6.22 %
Tier 1 leverage ratio – Customers Bancorp
    7.59 %     %     %     %     %
Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio - Bank
    9.97 %     19.65 %     9.76 %     7.87 %     8.03 %
Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio - Customers Bancorp
    10.32 %     %     %     %     %
Total risk-based capital ratio - Bank
    11.08 %     21.14 %     11.77 %     10.50 %     10.62 %
Total risk-based capital ratio – Customers Bancorp
    11.43 %     %     %     %     %
Asset Quality - Non-Covered Assets
                                       
Non-performing loans (5)
  $ 45,137     $ 27,055     $ 19,150     $ 7,175     $ 2,069  
Non-performing loans to total non-covered
loans (5)
    3.71 %     5.26 %     8.32 %     3.21 %     1.63 %
Other real estate owned (5)
  $ 7,316     $ 1,906     $ 1,155     $ 1,519     $  
Non-performing assets (5)
  $ 52,453     $ 28,961     $ 20,305     $ 8,694     $ 2,069  
Non-performing, non-covered assets to total non-covered assets (5)
    2.70 %     2.41 %     5.81 %     3.17 %     1.28 %
Allowance for loan and lease losses to total non-covered loans (5)
    1.24 %     2.94 %     4.36 %     1.29 %     1.15 %
Allowance for loan and lease losses to non-performing, non-covered loans (5)
    33.30 %     55.92 %     52.39 %     40.08 %     70.41 %
Net charge offs
  $ 9,547     $ 5,250     $ 4,622     $ 195     $ 13  
Net charge offs to average non-covered loans (5)
    1.13 %     1.00 %     2.05 %     0.09 %     0.01 %
Asset Quality - Covered Assets
                                       
Non-performing loans (5)
  45,213     43,454                    
Non-performing loans to total covered loans
    35.80 %     26.35 %                  
Other real estate owned (5)
  6,166     5,342                    
Non-performing assets (5)
    51,379       48,796                    
Non-performing assets to total covered assets
    38.79 %     28.67 %      —        —        —  

(1)  On September 17, 2011, we completed our acquisition of Berkshire Bancorp, Inc. All transactions since the acquisition date are included in our consolidated financial statements.
 
(2)  During the third quarter of 2010, we acquired two banks in FDIC assisted transactions. All transactions since the acquisition dates are included in our consolidated financial statements.
 
(3)  Effective September 17, 2011, Customers Bank reorganized into the holding company structure pursuant to which all of the issued and outstanding common stock of the Bank was exchanged on a three to one basis for common stock of Customers Bancorp (i.e., each of three shares of Customers Bank  being exchanged for one share of Customers Bancorp).  All share and per share information has been restated retrospectively to reflect the Reorganization.
 
 
 
- 38 -

 
 
 
(4)  Includes available-for-sale and held-to-maturity investment securities.
 
(5)  Certain loans and other real estate owned (described as “covered”) acquired in the two FDIC assisted transactions are subject to Loss Sharing Agreements between Customers Bank and the FDIC. If certain provisions within the Loss Sharing Agreements are maintained, the FDIC will reimburse Customers Bank for 80% of the unpaid principal balance and certain expenses. A loss sharing receivable was recorded based upon the credit evaluation of the acquired loan portfolio and the estimated periods for repayments. Loans receivable and assets that are not subject to the Loss Sharing Agreement are described as “non-covered”.
 
(6)  Our selected financial data contains non-GAAP financial measures calculated using non-GAAP amounts. These measures include tangible common equity and tangible book value per common share and tangible common equity to tangible assets.
 
Management uses these non-GAAP measures to present historical periods comparable to the current period presentation.   In addition, we believe the use of these non-GAAP measures provides additional clarity when assessing our financial results and use of equity.  These disclosures should not be viewed as substitutes for results determined to be in accordance with GAAP, nor are they necessarily comparable to non-GAAP performance measures that may be presented by other entities. We calculate tangible common equity by excluding preferred stock and goodwill from total shareholders’ equity. Tangible book value per common share equals tangible common equity divided by common shares outstanding.  A reconciliation of each of these Non-GAAP financial measures against the most directly comparable GAAP measure is set forth below.
 
   
(Dollars in thousands, except per share data)
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
Shareholders’ equity
  $ 147,748     $ 105,140     $ 21,503     $ 16,849     $ 16,830  
Less:
                                       
     Preferred stock
                      (980 )      
     Intangible assets
    (1,598 )                        
Tangible common equity
  $ 146,150     $ 105,140     $ 21,503     $ 15,869     $ 16,830  
                                         
Shares outstanding
    11,348       8,398       1,841       674       674  
                                         
Book value per share
  $ 13.02     $ 12.52     $ 11.68     $ 25.01     $ 24.97  
Less:  effect of excluding intangible
                                       
   assets and preferred stock
    (0.14 )     -       -       (1.45 )     -  
Tangible book value per share
  $ 12.88     $ 12.52     $ 11.68     $ 23.56     $ 24.97  
                                         
Total assets
  $ 2,077,532     $ 1,374,407     $ 349,760     $ 274,038     $ 272,004  
Less:  intangible assets
    (1,598 )     -       -       -       -  
Total tangible assets
  $ 2,075,934     $ 1,374,407     $ 349,760     $ 274,038     $ 272,004  
                                         
Equity to assets
    7.11 %     7.65 %     6.15 %     6.15 %     6.19 %
Less:  effect of excluding intangible
                                       
   assets and preferred stock
    (0.07 )                 (0.36 )      
Tangible common equity to tangible
                                       
   assets
    7.04 %     7.65 %     6.15 %     5.79 %     6.19 %



 
- 39 -

 

MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS
OF FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS
OF CUSTOMERS BANCORP
 
The following discussion and analysis presents material factors affecting our financial condition as of December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010 and results of operations for the three years in the period ended December 31, 2011.  This discussion and analysis should be read in conjunction with our financial statements, notes thereto and other financial information appearing elsewhere in this prospectus.
 
Critical Accounting Policies
 
We have adopted various accounting policies that govern the application of GAAP and that are consistent with general practices within the banking industry in the preparation of our financial statements.  Our significant accounting policies are described in footnote 3 to our audited financial statements.

Certain accounting policies involve significant judgments and assumptions by us that have a material impact on the carrying value of certain assets and liabilities.  We consider these accounting policies to be critical accounting policies.  The judgment and assumptions used are based on historical experience and other factors, which are believed to be reasonable under the circumstances.  Because of the nature of the judgments and assumptions management makes, actual results could differ from these judgments and estimates, which could have a material impact on the carrying values of our assets and liabilities and our results of operations.

The following is a summary of the policies we recognize as involving critical accounting estimates:  Allowance for Loan Losses, Stock-Based Compensation, Unrealized Gains and Losses on Available for Sale Securities, Fair Value, Acquisition Accounting, FDIC Receivable for Loss, and Deferred Income Taxes.

Allowance for Loan Losses.   We maintain an allowance for loan losses at a level management believes is sufficient to absorb estimated probable credit losses.  Management’s determination of the adequacy of the allowance is based on periodic evaluations of the loan portfolio and other relevant factors.  However, this evaluation is inherently subjective as it requires significant estimates by management.  Consideration is given to a variety of factors in establishing these estimates including historical losses, current and anticipated economic conditions, the size and composition of the loan portfolio, delinquency statistics, criticized and classified assets and impaired loans, results of internal loan reviews, borrowers’ perceived financial and management strengths, the adequacy of underlying collateral, the dependence on collateral, or the strength of the present value of future cash flows and other relevant factors.  These factors may be susceptible to significant change.  To the extent actual outcomes differ from management estimates, additional provisions for loan losses may be required which may adversely affect our results of operations in the future.

Stock-Based Compensation.   We recognize compensation expense for stock options and their management stock purchase plans (collectively, stock based compensation plans) in accordance with FASB ASC 718 Compensation –
Stock Compensation.   Expense related to stock based compensation plans granted will generally be measured based on the fair value of the option at the grant date, with compensation expense recognized over the service period, which is usually the vesting period.  We will utilize the Black-Scholes option-pricing model to estimate the fair value of each option on the date of grant.  The Black-Scholes model takes into consideration the exercise price and expected life of the option, the current price of the underlying stock and our expected volatility, the expected dividends on the stock and the current risk-free interest rate for the expected life of the option.  Our estimate of the fair value of a stock option is based on expectations derived from historical experience and may not necessarily equate to our market value when fully vested.
 
Unrealized Gains and Losses on Securities Available for Sale.   We receive estimated fair values of debt securities from independent valuation services and brokers.  In developing these fair values, the valuation services and brokers use estimates of cash flows based on historical performance of similar instruments in similar rate environments.  Debt securities available for sale are mostly comprised of mortgage backed securities and U.S. government agency securities.  We use various indicators in determining whether a security is other-than-temporarily impaired, including for equity securities, if the market value is below its cost for an extended period of time with low expectation of recovery or, for debt securities, when it is probable that the contractual interest and principal will not be collected.  The debt securities are monitored for changes in credit ratings because adverse changes in credit ratings could indicate a change in the estimated cash flows of the underlying collateral or issuer.  The unrealized losses associated with securities that management does not intend to sell, and more likely than not that we will be required to sell prior to maturity or market price recovery, are not considered to be other than temporary as of December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, because the unrealized losses are related to changes in interest rates and do not affect the expected cash flows of the underlying collateral or issuer.
 
 
 
 
- 40 -

 
 
 
Fair Value .   The fair value of a financial instrument is defined as the amount at which the instrument could be exchanged in a current transaction between willing parties, other than in a forced or liquidation sale. Management estimates the fair value of a financial instrument using a variety of valuation methods. Where financial instruments are actively traded and have quoted market prices, quoted market prices are used for fair value. When the financial instruments are not actively traded, other observable market inputs, such as quoted prices of securities with similar characteristics, may be used, if available, to determine fair value. When observable market prices do not exist, we estimate fair value. The valuation methods and inputs consider factors such as types of underlying assets or liabilities, rates of estimated credit losses, interest rate or discount rate and collateral. The best estimate of fair value involves assumptions including, but not limited to, various performance indicators, such as historical and projected default and recovery rates, credit ratings, current delinquency rates, loan-to-value ratios and the possibility of obligor refinancing.  US GAAP requires the use of fair values in determining the carrying values of certain assets and liabilities, as well as for specific disclosures.  The most significant uses of fair values include impaired loans and foreclosed property and the net assets acquired in business combinations. 
 
Acquisition Accounting.  Assets acquired and liabilities assumed in our FDIC-assisted acquisitions are recorded at their fair values.  The fair value of a loan portfolio acquired in a business combination requires greater levels of management estimates and judgment than the remainder of purchased assets or assumed liabilities.  The credit risks inherent and evidenced in the FDIC-assisted transactions resulted in substantially all loans purchased in the transaction being purchased with a credit discount.  On the date of acquisition, when the loans have evidence of credit deterioration since their origination and we believe it is probable that we will not collect all contractually required principal and interest payments, we refer to the difference between contractually required payments and the cash flows expected to be collected as the non-accretable discount.  We must estimate expected cash flows at each reporting date.  Subsequent decreases to the expected cash flows will generally result in a provision for loan losses.  Subsequent increases in cash flows result in a reversal of the provision for loan losses to the extent of prior charges and adjusted accretable discount, which will have a positive effect on interest income. 
 
Because we record loans acquired in connection with FDIC-assisted acquisitions at fair value, we record no allowance for loan losses related to the acquired covered loans on the acquisition date, given that the fair value of the loans acquired incorporates assumptions regarding credit risk.  The acquired loans are recorded at fair value in accordance with the fair value methodology, exclusive of the loss share agreements with the FDIC. 
 
The acquired covered loans are subject to the accounting prescribed by FASB ASC Topic 310 Receivables, and subsequent changes to the basis of the loss share agreements also follow that model.  Deterioration in the credit quality of the loans (immediately recorded as an adjustment to the allowance for loan losses) would immediately increase the basis of the loss share agreements, with the offset recorded through the consolidated statement of operations.  Increases in the credit quality or cash flows of loans (reflected as an adjustment to the discount and accreted into income over the remaining life of the loans) decrease the basis of the loss share agreements.  That decrease is accreted into income over either the same period or the life of the loss share agreements, whichever is shorter. Loss assumptions used in the basis of the covered loans are consistent with the loss assumptions used to measure the FDIC receivable.  Fair value accounting incorporates into the fair value of the FDIC receivable an element of the time value of money, which is accreted back into income over the life of the loss share agreements.
 
FDIC Receivable for Loss Share Agreements.  The majority of the loans and other real estate assets acquired in an FDIC-assisted acquisition are covered under loss share agreements with the FDIC in which the FDIC has agreed to reimburse us for 80% of all losses incurred in connection with those assets.  We estimated the amount that we will receive from the FDIC under the loss share agreements that will result from losses incurred as we dispose of covered loans and other real estate assets, and we recorded the estimate as a receivable from the FDIC.
 
The FDIC loss sharing receivable is measured separately from the related covered assets because it is not contractually embedded in the assets and is not transferable if we sell the assets.  We estimated the fair value of the FDIC loss sharing receivable using the present value of cash flows related to the loss share agreements based on the expected reimbursements for losses and the applicable loss share percentages.  We review and update the fair value of the FDIC receivable prospectively as loss estimates related to covered loans and other real estate owned change.  Subsequent decreases in the amount expected to be collected result in a provision for loan and lease losses, an increase in the allowance for loan and lease losses, and a proportional adjustment to the FDIC receivable for the estimated amount to be reimbursed.  Subsequent increases in the amount expected to be collected results in the reversal of any previously-recorded provision for loan and lease losses and related allowance for loan and lease losses and adjustments to the FDIC receivable, or prospective adjustment to the accretable discount if no provision for loan and lease losses had been recorded.  The ultimate realization of the FDIC loss sharing receivable depends on the performance of the underlying covered assets, the passage of time and claims paid by the FDIC. The accretion of the FDIC receivable discount is recorded into noninterest income using the level yield method over the estimated life of the receivable.  In November 2010, we received the first reimbursement under the USA Bank Loss Sharing Agreement.  During 2011, we received reimbursements under both the USA Bank and ISN Loss Sharing Agreements.
 
 
 
 
- 41 -

 
 
Deferred Income Taxes.   We provide for deferred income taxes on the asset and liability method whereby deferred tax assets are recognized for deductible temporary differences and deferred tax liabilities are recognized for taxable temporary differences.  Temporary differences are the differences between the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and net operating loss carry-forwards and their tax basis.  The valuation allowance previously applied to the net deferred tax assets was reversed when, in the opinion of management, it is more likely than not that the deferred tax assets will be realized.  Deferred tax assets and liabilities are adjusted for the effects of changes in tax laws and rates on the date of enactment.  If the Bank concludes that it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax asset will not be realized or if losses continue, the balance of deferred tax assets will be reduced by a valuation allowance.
 
Background and Reorganization
 
Customers Bancorp was formed in April 2010 to facilitate the Reorganization.  Pursuant to the Reorganization, all of the issued and outstanding shares of Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock of Customers Bank were exchanged on a three-to-one basis for shares of Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock, respectively, of Customers Bancorp ( i.e., each three shares of Customers Bank being exchanged for one share of Customers Bancorp).  Customers Bancorp is authorized to issue up to 100,000,000 shares of Voting Common Stock, 100,000,000 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock and 100,000,000 shares of preferred stock.  All share and per share information has been restated to reflect the Reorganization.
 
In the Reorganization, the Bank’s issued and outstanding shares of Voting Common Stock of 22,525,825 shares and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock of 6,834,895 shares converted into 7,508,473 shares of Customers Bancorp’s Voting Common Stock and 2,278,294 shares of Customers Bancorp’s Class B Non-Voting Common Stock.  Cash was paid in lieu of fractional shares.  Outstanding warrants to purchase 1,410,732 shares of the Bank’s Voting Common Stock with a weighted-average exercise price of $3.55 per share and 243,102 shares of the Bank’s Class B Non-Voting Common Stock with a weighted-average exercise price of $3.50 per share were converted into warrants to purchase 470,260 shares of Customers Bancorp’s Voting Common Stock with a weighted-average exercise price of $10.64 per share and warrants to purchase 81,036 shares of Customers Bancorp’s Class B Non-Voting Common Stock with a weighted-average exercise price of $10.50 per share.  Outstanding stock options to purchase 2,572,404 shares of the Bank’s Voting Common Stock with a weighted- average exercise price of $3.50 per share and stock options to purchase 231,500 shares of the Bank’s Class B Non-Voting Common Stock with a weighted-average exercise price of $4.00 per share were converted into stock options to purchase 855,774 shares of Customers Bancorp’s Voting Common Stock with a weighted-average exercise price of $10.49 per share and stock options to purchase 77,166 shares of Customers Bancorp’s Class B Non-Voting Common Stock with a weighted-average exercise price of $12.00 per share.
 
Accordingly, descriptions of balance sheet and income statement items prior to September 17, 2011 represent those of Customers Bank, and descriptions of balance sheet and income statement items after September 17, 2011 represent the consolidated results of Customers Bancorp. The consolidated results of operations and financial condition presented for those periods after the Reorganization Date, September 17, 2011, include combined results for Customers Bancorp and Customers Bank.  All share and per share information has been retrospectively restated to reflect the Reorganization, including that each three shares of Customers Bank were exchanged for one share of Customers Bancorp in the Reorganization.
 
Overview
 
Like most financial institutions, we derive the majority of our income from interest we receive on our interest-earning assets, such as loans and investments.  Our primary source of funds for making these loans and investments is our deposits, on which we pay interest.  Consequently, one of the key measures of our success is our amount of net interest income, or the difference between the income on our interest-earning assets and the expense on our interest-bearing liabilities, such as deposits and borrowings.  Another key measure is the spread between the yield we earn on these interest-earning assets and the rate it pays on our interest-bearing liabilities, which is called our net interest spread.
 
There are risks inherent in all loans, so we maintain an allowance for loan losses to absorb probable losses on existing loans that may become uncollectible.  We maintain this allowance by charging a provision for loan losses against our operating earnings.  We have included a detailed discussion of this process, as well as several tables describing our allowance for loan losses.
 
 
 
 
- 42 -

 
 
 
The external environment continues to be very challenging as the economy struggles through a recession.  Many business customers in our market experienced a loss of revenues and there was an increase in bankruptcies.  Many overleveraged real estate customers were forced to take action to improve their cash flow due to high vacancy rates and a reduction in rents due to the reduced demand for space during the downturn.  Unemployment flattened in 2011 after increasing throughout 2010 as companies reduced expenses to manage through the challenging times.  These conditions produced stress in the asset quality of the loan portfolio, primarily the commercial real estate portfolio.  There continues to be uncertainty in the external environment in 2012 and it is likely that these challenging conditions will continue in the next few years.
 
In the first quarter of 2011, we began executing on a plan to improve earnings, deploy excess cash on the balance sheet and match future loan growth with deposit growth.  We deployed some cash into investments and deposit growth was slowed during 2011 while our loan origination platform was enhanced.  We expanded our small business lending team, built a new consumer lending platform, expanded our warehouse lending platform and entered the multifamily lending business.  We believe these efforts were successful as deposit growth is now aligned with loan originations.  We believe there are significant opportunities for growth in both lending and deposit generation in 2012 and beyond.  However, if there is a material change in the external environment or our management cannot successfully execute our plans, growth may be more difficult than expected.
 
Results of Operations

For the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010

We had net income of $4.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 compared to a net income of $23.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2010.  Net interest income increased $19.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 to $39.0 million compared to $19.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2010.  The decrease in provision for loan losses of $947,000 over that in 2010 was primarily due to the shift in reserve allocations from specific reserves to general reserves based on impaired loan valuations and charge-off activity.  Year over year, general reserves increased by $1.9 million while the specific reserve decreased by $2.0 million. The Bank provided provisions in its general reserve that replaced loan charge-offs on the loans that had specific reserves.  Also, an increase in non-covered loan balances does not correlate to a pro rata increase in the allowance for loan and lease loss reserves (“ALLL”) as these loans may carry lower credit risk based on stricter underwriting guidelines and, consequently, are assigned a lower loss factor. Loan balances were allocated reserves based on the assigned factors in the ALLL calculation.  The increase in delinquencies was considered in the qualitative factor analysis within the ALLL calculation. In addition, charge-offs, all of which relate to the Pre-2009 segment of the portfolio were included in the historical loss factor allocation in the ALLL calculation.   See the Asset Quality disclosure and table beginning on page 58 in this Management’s Discussion and Analysis section.
 
The charge-offs incurred in 2011 decreased the specific reserves by $2 million and provided a cushion for additional provision required in the general reserve.  The ALLL ratio for non-covered loans declined to 1.24% at December 31, 2011 from 2.94% at December 31, 2010 primarily due to the significant growth in the non-covered loan balance during 2011. Non-interest income increased $8.3 million to $13.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 compared to $5.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2010 excluding the bargain purchase gains on bank acquisitions of $40.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2010.  This net increase (excluding the bargain purchase gains) in non-interest income was due to an increase in mortgage warehouse transactions fees, an increase in bank-owned life insurance income, a net gain on sales of investment securities, and an increase in income related to the FDIC loss-sharing receivable. The increase of $11.1 million in non-interest expense to $37.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2011 from $26.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2010 was due to the acquisitions completed in 2011, an increase in the number of employees and branches in connection with our growth strategy, expenses related to loan workouts, increased charges for impaired loans, and increased premiums for FDIC insurance. On a diluted per share basis, the net income was $0.39 per share for 2011 compared to a net income of $3.69 per share for 2010.  Our return on average assets was 0.24% in 2011.  Our return on average equity was 3.56% in 2011.
 
For the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009

We had net income of $23.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2010 compared to a net loss of $13.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2009.  Net interest income increased $12.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2010 to $19.4 million compared to $7.2 million for the year ended December 31, 2009.  The decrease in provision for loan losses of $1.4 million over that in 2009 was primarily due to the non-performing loans not increasing as significantly in 2010 when compared to 2009 and the addition of new loan products that do not require as high a level of reserves.  The allowance for loan and lease losses to non-covered loans ratio declined to 2.94% at December 31, 2010 from 4.36% at December 31, 2009.  Non-interest income increased $4.3 million to $5.4 million, when excluding the bargain purchase gains on bank acquisitions of $40.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2010 compared to $1.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2009.  The increase of $16.5 million in non-interest expense to $26.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2010 from $9.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2009 was due to the two bank acquisitions completed in 2010 and an increase in the number of employees at Customers Bancorp in connection with Customers Bancorp’s growth strategy, expenses related to loan workouts, increased charges for impaired loans, and increased premiums for FDIC insurance, higher technology costs and additional expenses to maintain and expand the current infrastructure.  On a diluted per share basis, the net income was $3.69 per share for 2010 compared to a net loss of $10.98 per share for 2009.  Customers Bancorp’s return on average assets was 3.40% in 2010.  Customers Bancorp’s return on average equity was 41.3% in 2010.
 
 
 
 
- 43 -

 
 

 
NET INTEREST INCOME

Net interest income (the difference between the interest earned on loans, investments and interest-earning deposits with banks, and interest paid on deposits, borrowed funds and subordinated debt) is the primary source of Customers Bancorp’s earnings.  The following table summarizes Customers Bancorp’s net interest income and related spread and margin for the periods indicated (dollars in thousands):
   
Year ended December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
Average balance
   
Interest income or expense
   
Average yield or cost (%)
   
Average balance
   
Interest income or expense
   
Average yield or cost (%)
   
Average balance
   
Interest income or expense
   
Average yield or cost (%)
 
Assets
                                                     
 Interest earning deposits
  $ 164,468     $ 415       0.25 %   $ 128,133     $ 303       0.24 %   $ 11,578     $ 6       0.05 %
Federal funds sold
    2,285       3       0.13       11,176       20       0.18       2,411       7       0.29  
Investment securities, taxable (C)
    481,106       14,064       2.92       49,569       1,382       2.79       27,375       1,107       4.04  
Investment securities, non taxable (C)
    2,080       86       4.13       2,516       110       4.37       4,507       191       4.24  
Loans (A)
    938,134       46,682       4.98       523,753       29,021       5.54       225,436       12,142       5.39  
Restricted stock
    11,739       189       1.61       3,219       71       2.21       1,845       33       1.79  
Total interest-earning assets
    1,599,812       61,439       3.84       718,366       30,907       4.30       273,152       13,486       4.94  
Allowance for loan and lease losses
    (15,316 )                     (13,310 )                     (6,454 )                
Non-interest-earning assets
    68,051                       157,028                       45,201                  
Total assets
  $ 1,652,547                     $ 862,084                     $ 311,899                  
Liabilities
                                                                       
Interest checking
  $ 20,499       96       0.47 %   $ 12,009       68       0.57 %   $ 10,186       89       0.87  
Money market
    505,269       6,705       1.33       190,972       3,609       1.89       35,372       461       1.30  
Other Savings
    13,407       91       0.68       11,222       76       0.68       11,218       98       0.87  
Certificates of deposit
    808,637       14,969       1.85       369,757       7,359       1.99       168,996       5,081       3.01  
Total interest bearing deposits
    1,347,812       21,861       1.62       583,960       11,112       1.90       225,772       5,729       2.54  
Other borrowings
    68,553       602       0.88       13,582       434       3.20       17,233       607       3.52  
Total interest-bearing liabilities
    1,416,365       22,463       1.59       597,542       11,546       1.93       243,005       6,336       2.61  
Non-interest-bearing deposits
    98,036                       50,708                       17,715                  
Total deposits & borrowings
    1,514,401               1.48       648,250               1.78       260,720               2.43  
Other non-interest-bearing liabilities
    24,743                       144,820                       32,003                  
Total liabilities
    1,539,144                       793,070                       292,723                  
Shareholders’ equity
    113,403                       69,014                       19,176                  
Total liabilities & shareholders’ equity
  $ 1,652,547                     $ 862,084                     $ 311,899                  
Net interest earnings
            38,976                       19,361                       7,150          
Tax equivalent adjustment (B)
            44                       57                       98          
Net interest earnings tax equivalent
          $ 39,020                     $ 19,418                     $ 7,248          
Interest spread
                    2.36 %                     2.52 %                     2.51 %
Net interest margin
                    2.44 %                     2.70 %                     2.62 %
Net interest margin tax equivalent (B)
                    2.44 %                     2.70 %                     2.65 %

(A) Includes non-accrual loans, the effect of which is to reduce the yield earned on loans, and deferred loan fees.
(B) Full tax equivalent basis, using a 35% statutory tax rate to approximate interest income as a taxable asset.
(C) For presentation in this table, balances and the corresponding average rates for investment securities are based upon historical cost, adjusted for amortization of premiums and accretion of discounts.
 
 
 
- 44 -

 

 
The following table presents the dollar amount of changes in interest income and interest expense for the major categories of our interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities.  Information is provided for each category of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities with respect to (i) changes attributable to volume (i.e., changes in average balances multiplied by the prior-period average rate) and (ii) changes attributable to rate (i.e., changes in average rate multiplied by prior-period average balances).  For purposes of this table, changes attributable to both rate and volume, which cannot be segregated, have been allocated proportionately to the change due to volume and the change due to rate:
 
   
2011 vs. 2010
   
2010 vs. 2009
 
   
Increase (decrease) due
to
change in
         
Increase (decrease) due
to
change in
       
   
Rate
   
Volume
   
Total
   
Rate
   
Volume
   
Total
 
   
( dollars in thousands)
 
Interest income
                                   
Interest earning deposits
 
$
16
   
$
96
   
$
112
   
$
22
   
$
275
   
$
297
 
Federal funds sold
   
(5
)
   
(12
   
(17
)
   
(3
)
   
16
     
13
 
Investment securities, taxable
   
64
     
12,618
     
12,682
     
(350
)
   
625
     
275
 
Investment securities, non taxable
   
(6
   
(18
)
   
(24
)
   
15
     
(96
)
   
(81
)
Loans
   
(2,954
)
   
20,615
     
17,661
     
338
     
16,541
     
16,879
 
Restricted stock
   
(19
)
   
137
     
118
     
8
     
30
     
38
 
Total interest income
 
(2,904
 )
 
33,436
   
30,532
   
30
   
17,391
   
17,421
 
Interest expense
                                               
Interest checking
 
(12
)
 
40
   
28
   
(31
)
 
10
   
(21
)
Money market
   
  (1,075
   
4,171
     
3,096
     
209
     
2,939
     
3,148
 
Savings
   
-
     
15
     
15
     
(21
)
   
(1
)
   
(22
)
Certificates of deposit
   
(513
)
   
8,123
     
7,610
     
(1,724
)
   
4,002
     
2,278
 
Total interest bearing deposits
   
(1,600
)
   
12,349
     
10,749
     
(1,567
)
   
6,950
     
5,383
 
Borrowings
   
(315
)
   
483
     
168
     
(55
)
   
(118
)
   
(173
)
Total interest expense
   
(1,915
)
   
12,832
     
10,917
     
(1,622
)
   
6,832
     
5,210
 
Net interest income
 
$
(989
)
 
$
20,604
   
$
19,615
   
$
1,652
   
$
10,559
   
$
12,211
 

For the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010

Net interest income was $39.0 million for the year ended December 31, 2011, compared to $19.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2010, an increase of $19.6 million or 101%. This net increase was attributable to increases in average volume of average interest-earning assets, offset by an increase in average interest-bearing liabilities, as a result of:

·  
the inclusion of the acquired USA Bank and ISN Bank loans and deposits, for all of 2011, as opposed to less than six months in 2010;
·  
the acquisition of Berkshire Bancorp in September 2011;
·  
the purchase of a $105.8 million manufactured housing loan portfolio in August 2010;
·  
a $172.3 million increase in average mortgage warehouse loans due to our strategy to grow the mortgage warehouse lending business;
·  
significant increases in average money market accounts and average certificates of deposit due to our efforts to obtain new business and the related increase in average investment securities as a result of the deployment of the cash flow generated by these deposit accounts; and
·  
increases in interest-bearing deposits due to the USA Bank, ISN Bank, and Berkshire Bank acquisitions.

The key measure of our net interest income is net interest margin.  Our net interest margin decreased to 2.44% for 2011 from 2.70% for 2010.  This decrease was primarily the result of a decrease in the yield of average loans of 56 basis points as well as a decrease of 60 basis points in restricted stock.  This was offset by a decrease in the total interest-bearing deposits of 28 basis points, primarily driven by a decrease in the cost of funds of money market accounts which dropped 56 basis points. These decreases in yields were attributable to the continuing lower interest rate environment.
 
 
 
 
- 45 -

 

 
For the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009

Net interest income was $19.4 million for the year ended December 31, 2010, compared to $7.1 million for 2009, an increase of $12.2 million or 170%.  Interest income was $31.0 million in 2010 compared to $13.5 million in 2009, an increase of $17.5 million or 129%.  The yield on interest earning assets decreased to 4.30% in 2010 from 4.94% in 2009.  Interest expense was $11.5 million in 2010, an increase of $5.2 million or 82%, from $6.3 million in 2009.  The increase in interest income reflects the increase in average earning assets of $445.2 million primarily from the acquisitions of two banks in the second half of 2010 that contributed interest earning assets of approximately $180 million, the purchase of a $105.8 million manufactured housing loan portfolio on August 6, 2010, and an increase in interest bearing cash from the new branches opened in 2010.   The increase in interest expense was due to an increase in average interest bearing liabilities of $354.5 million of which approximately $77 million is related to the two 2010 bank acquisitions and an increase of $281.7 million in interest bearing liabilities from new branches and organic growth. The cost of funds decreased to 1.78% in 2010 from 2.43% in 2009 due to changes in the interest rates charged on time deposit accounts.

The key measure of our net interest income is its net interest margin.  Our net interest margin increased slightly to 2.70% in 2010 from 2.65% in 2009.  This slight increase was primarily attributable to an increase in loans with higher yields offset by a higher volume of deposits and other borrowings.  Deposit costs were close to a floor as short-term market interest rates hovered around 0% throughout the year.  
 
PROVISION FOR LOAN LOSSES

For the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010

We establish an allowance for loan and lease losses through a provision for loan losses charged as an expense on the statement of operations.  The loan portfolio is reviewed and evaluated on a quarterly basis to evaluate our outstanding loans and to measure both the performance of the portfolio and the adequacy of the allowance for loan and lease losses. Future adjustments may be necessary to the provision for loan losses, and consequently the allowance for loan and lease losses, if economic conditions or loan quality differ substantially from the assumptions management used in the evaluation of the level of the allowance for loan and lease losses as compared to outstanding loans.

During 2011, the provision for loan losses was $9.5 million, a decrease of $947,000 from $10.4 million in 2010.  This decrease was primarily due to the shift in reserve allocations from specific reserves to general reserves based on impaired loan valuations and charge-off activity. The charge-offs incurred in 2011 decreased the specific reserves by $2 million and provided a cushion for additional provision required in general reserve. The level of delinquent, non-performing, and impaired loans have continued to increase throughout 2011 due the continued decline in the economy and commercial real estate market. 

As is typical with community banks, we have a high concentration (89.4%) of our loans secured by real estate. Construction and commercial real estate represent 25.3% of the total loan portfolio, a slight decrease from 2010.  It is in the construction and commercial real estate secured portion of the loan portfolio that we are experiencing the most difficulty with delinquent and non-accrual loans. Although we believe that we have identified and appropriately allocated reserves against the riskiest of our loans in the construction and commercial real estate portfolios, the possibility of further deterioration before the real estate market turns presents the need for potential increased allocations of the allowance for loan and lease losses in that area in the future.

Other than the concentrations in construction and commercial real estate, we have  no large exposures in other risky industries such as restaurants, home heating oil businesses or other industries that are typically viewed as high risk. The majority of our borrowers are small, local businesses and individuals with investments in residential or commercial real estate. The typical borrower provides self-prepared or accountant assisted financial statements and tax returns that are not audited and therefore are less reliable than information that would be obtained from more sophisticated borrowers. The absence of objectively verified financial information is a challenge to all community banks and represents a layer of risk that must be considered in judging the adequacy of the allowance for loan and lease losses.
 
 
 
 
- 46 -

 
 

 
Net charge-offs were $9.5 million and $5.3 million, respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010.

See “Credit Risk” and “Asset Quality” sections for further information regarding our provision for loan losses, allowance for loan losses and net charge-offs generally, and additional discussion of our non-performing loans.

For the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009

During 2010, the provision for loan losses was $10.4 million, a decrease of $1.4 million from $11.8 million in 2009.  This decrease was primarily due to a stabilization of the elevated volumes of non-performing non-covered loans in the second half of 2010.  Real estate values in our market area decreased during 2010 related to the significant economic downturn faced by the national and regional economies in 2010.

As is typical with community banks, we have a high concentration (93.1%) of our loans secured by real estate. Construction and commercial real estate represent 30.9% of the total loan portfolio, a significant decrease from 2009.  Construction loans decreased to $13.4 million from our historical portfolio or 2.6% of the total loan portfolio, a decrease from 9.5% in 2009.  In 2010, our loan portfolio mix changed to 44.7% of the total loan portfolio being comprised of loans to provide liquidity to mortgage originators under mortgage warehouse repurchase facilities and 11.9% of manufactured housing loans in 2010, when these two portfolio segments were 7.5% of the total loan portfolio in 2009. It is in the construction and commercial real estate secured portion of the loan portfolio that we experienced the most difficulty with delinquent and non-accrual loans.

The majority of our borrowers are small, local businesses and individuals with investments in residential or commercial real estate. The typical borrower provides self-prepared or accountant assisted financial statements and tax returns that are not audited and therefore are less reliable than information that would be obtained from more sophisticated borrowers. The cost of audited financial statements would be prohibitive for many of our small borrowers. The absence of objectively verified financial information is a challenge to all community banks and represents a layer of risk that must be considered in judging the adequacy of the allowance for loan and lease losses.

Net charge-offs were $5.3 million and $4.6 million, respectively, for the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009.

NON-INTEREST INCOME

The chart below shows our results in the various components of non-interest income for each of the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009.

   
Years Ended December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(dollars in thousands)
 
Service fees
 
$
698
   
$
643
   
$
458
 
Mortgage warehouse transaction fees
   
5,581
     
2,631
     
70
 
Bank owned life insurance
   
1,404
     
228
     
229
 
Net gain on sales of investment securities
   
2,731
     
1,114
     
236
 
Gains on sales of SBA loans
   
329
     
98
     
 
Impairment charge on investment securities
   
     
     
(15
)
Bargain purchase gain on bank acquisitions
   
     
40,254
     
 
Accretion of FDIC loss sharing receivable
   
1,955
     
     
 
Gain (loss) on sale of OREO
   
367
     
(67
)
   
(31
)
Other
   
587
     
702
     
96
 
Total non-interest income
 
$
13,652
   
$
45,603
   
$
1,043
 

For the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010

Non-interest income was $13.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2011, a decrease of $32.0 million from non-interest income of $45.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2010.  This net decrease primarily was due to $40.3 million in bargain purchase gains on bank acquisitions recognized in 2010. In addition, mortgage warehouse transaction fees for 2011 increased $3.0 million, when compared to 2010. Furthermore, during 2011, we recognized increased income on bank-owned life insurance of $1.2 million, increased gains on the sales of investment securities of $1.6 million, and net adjustments of $2.0 million related to our FDIC loss sharing receivable in 2011.
 
 
 
 
- 47 -

 
 
 
·  
The increase in mortgage warehouse transactional fees for 2011 was the result of increased volume in 2011.

·  
The increase in bank owned life insurance income was due to the purchase of an additional $20 million of BOLI in December 2010 and the acquisition of $2.5 million in BOLI relating to Berkshire Bancorp, Inc.
 
·  
The increase in net gains on sales of investment securities was the result of our sales of $180.0 million of investment securities for net gains of $2.7 million. In 2010, we sold $153.2 million of investment securities for net gains of $1.1 million.

·  
The increase in income related to our FDIC loss sharing receivable was the result of additional adjustments to the loss sharing assets, charge-offs of covered loans, and impairments of covered OREO.

For the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009

In July 2010 and September 2010, we acquired two banks in FDIC assisted transactions and recorded a bargain purchase gain of $40.3 million.  Excluding the bargain purchase gain on bank acquisitions, non-interest income increased $4.3 million from $1.1 million to $5.4 million.  The increase was primarily related to the transactional fees earned by the mortgage warehouse division of $2.6 million.  The mortgage warehouse division was started in the second half of 2009. Also, the gains of $1.1 million on the sales of investment securities recognized in 2010 increased compared to a gain of $236,000 in 2009.

Service fees, including mortgage warehouse fees, represent the largest component of non-interest income and were $3.3 million in 2010, an increase of $2.7 million from $528,000 in 2009 primarily due to an increase in loan fee income and the growth in the mortgage warehouse division in 2010.  Late fees on loans were $89,000 in 2010.
 
We sold investment securities in 2010 for a gain of $1.1 million, compared to a gain of $236,000 in 2009.  The gain in 2010 was primarily due to the sales of $56.2 million of mortgage backed securities.

Other non-interest income included $520,000 of increases in the FDIC loss sharing receivable recorded for the two FDIC assisted transactions and $98,000 gain on the sale of an SBA loan.  

NON-INTEREST EXPENSE

The chart below shows our results in the various components of non-interest expense for each of the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009.

   
Years Ended December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
(dollars in thousands)
 
Salaries and employee benefits
 
$
16,718
   
$
14,031
   
$
4,267
 
Occupancy
   
3,242
     
1,897
     
1,261
 
Technology, communication and bank operations
   
3,169
     
2,431
     
1,000
 
Advertising and promotion
   
994
     
1,007
     
191
 
Professional services
   
4,837
     
2,833
     
510
 
Merger related expenses
   
531
     
-
     
-
 
FDIC assessments, taxes, and regulatory fees
   
2,366
     
1,613
     
892
 
Impairment charges on other real estate owned
   
576
     
635
     
350
 
Loan workout and other real estate owned
   
1,988
     
682
     
531
 
Other
   
2,888
     
972
     
648
 
Total non-interest expenses
 
$
37,309
   
$
26,101
   
$
9,650
 
 
 
 
 
- 48 -

 
 

 
For the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010

Non-interest expense was $37.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2011, an increase of $11.2 million when compared to non-interest expense of $26.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2010. Salaries and employee benefits, which represent the largest component of non-interest expense, increased $2.7 million; occupancy expense increased $1.3 million; technology, communications, and bank operations expense increased $700,000; professional services expense increased $2.0 million; FDIC assessments, taxes, and regulatory fees increased $800,000; loan workout and other real estate owned expenses increased $1.3 million; and other expenses increased $1.9 million.

·  
The increase in salaries and employee benefits expense primarily was due to an increase in the total number of employees from 133 full-time equivalents at December 31, 2010 to 205 full-time equivalents at December 31, 2011. This increase in our workforce was the result of the Berkshire acquisition and the need for additional employees to support our growth strategy. In addition, share-based compensation expense decreased $1.3 million from December 31, 2010 to December 31, 2011 because there were one-time share-based awards in 2010 that vested immediately.
 
·  
The increase in occupancy expense was the result of the Berkshire acquisition which added five additional branches and the opening of additional branches to support our growth strategy.  

·  
The increase in technology, communications, and bank operations expense was due to the Berkshire acquisition, our expanded branch network and additional network support for the opening of the two new branches and executive offices in Wyomissing, Pennsylvania.
 
·  
The increase in professional services expense was primarily attributable to legal expenses related to regulatory filings and ongoing litigation with a vendor from one of the acquired banks.
 
·  
The increase in FDIC assessments, taxes, and regulatory fees was attributed to increases in FDIC premiums primarily as a result of the growth of our assessment base (average consolidated total assets minus average tangible equity) and additional Pennsylvania shares tax expense in 2011 also due to our increased asset size.
 
·  
The increase in loan workout and other real estate owned expenses was due to increased volume of non-covered, non-performing assets.
 
·  
The increase in other expenses generally can be attributed to the Berkshire acquisition in 2011 and the USA Bank and ISN Bank acquisitions in 2010 as well as general growth of the infrastructure.

For the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009

Non-interest expense increased $16.5 million from $9.7 million in 2009 to $26.1 million in 2010.  Salaries and employee benefits represent the largest component of non-interest expense and were $14.0 million in 2010 compared to $4.3 million in 2009, an increase of $9.8 million. At December 31, 2009, we had sixty-two employees and grew to 133 employees at December 31, 2010, adding $4.7 million in salaries and benefits in 2010.  The additional employees were added to continue to build our infrastructure and support the growth strategy of the management team added in 2009.  Also, fifteen employees were added from the two banks that we acquired in 2010.  In addition, the management stock purchase plan, incentive compensation items either through bonus or stock-based compensation and the supplemental executive retirement plan for Customers Bancorp’s Chief Executive Officer came into effect in 2010.  The management stock purchase plan and the SERP became vested in July 2010 and $1.8 million and $2.5 million, respectively, were recorded for each plan during the third quarter of 2010.

Occupancy expense increased $636,000 as a result of opening four new branches in Pennsylvania, New Jersey and New York.   Technology, communications and bank operations expense was $2.4 million in 2010, an increase of $1.4 million or 143.1% over $1.0 million in 2009 due to the expansion of the Bank and employing technology to service customers in a proactive manner.  Our advertising and promotion expense increased $816,000 in 2010 to $1.0 million for the promotion of the new Bank strategy and mission and to support an increased market area.
 
 
 
 
 
- 49 -

 

 
Expenses related to professional services increased 455.5% or $2.3 million to $2.8 million from $510,000 in 2009.  This increase was primarily attributable to legal expenses related to regulatory filings, the two FDIC assisted acquisitions and litigation related to one of our vendors.  Consulting fees increased to $507,000 in 2010 from $193,000 in 2009 to add the specialty knowledge and experience to support management in our growth.

FDIC assessments, taxes and regulatory fees increased 80.8% or $721,000 to $1.6 million in 2010 from $892,000 in 2009.  This increase is attributable to a broader deposit base and increases in premiums.

Impairment charges on other real estate owned increased $285,000 to $635,000 in 2010 from $350,000 in 2009.  This increase was primarily attributable to deteriorating market values on real estate and increased other real estate owned.  Loan workout and other real estate owned expenses increased 28% or $151,000 to $682,000 in 2010 from $531,000 in 2009.  This increase was attributable to an increase of expenses related to preparing properties for sale and an increase of other real estate properties from the two bank acquisitions in 2010.  A portion of the expenses on the other real estate owned covered under the FDIC Loss Sharing Agreements are reimbursable from the FDIC, however, the remaining 20% of the expense is absorbed by us.  At December 31, 2010, there were eighteen properties that we have acquired either through acquisition or foreclosure of loans with a book value of $7.2 million.   In addition, loan workout expenses increased due to additional problem assets from the acquisitions of two failed banks in 2010 and a portion of the expenses incurred are reimbursable from the FDIC.

Other expenses increased 50.0% or $324,000 to $972,000 in 2010 from $648,000 in 2009.  This increase was primarily attributable to increases in appraisal expenses in connection with expansion costs, director fees, and other miscellaneous expenses.
 
INCOME TAXES
 
For the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010

The income tax provision was $1.8 million for the year ended December 31, 2011, compared to $4.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2010.  The decrease in income tax provision was primarily due to the decrease in net income before taxes of approximately $22.6 million.  In addition, the tax benefit from bank owned life insurance increased by approximately $423,000 due to the purchase of approximately $20.0 million of bank owned life insurance at the end of 2010.  For additional information regarding our income taxes, refer to “Note 13 –Income Taxes” in the consolidated financial statements included herein.

For the years ended December 31, 2010 and 2009

The income tax provision was $4.7 million for the year ended December 31, 2010, compared to zero for the year ended December 31, 2009.  The increase in the income tax provision is primarily due to the increase in net income before taxes of approximately $41.7 million. The income tax provision reflects a provision for approximately $11.3 million offset by a $6.6 million adjustment to reverse the deferred tax valuation allowance previously recorded on the net deferred tax asset through the second quarter of 2010. Due to the acquisitions of USA Bank and ISN Bank and the estimated taxable income to be generated over the life of the acquired assets, it is more likely than not that our net deferred tax asset will be realized.  Accordingly, the valuation allowances recorded in 2010 and in the previous years were reversed.  Income tax expense also increased due to the expansion into various jurisdictions.

FINANCIAL CONDITION

GENERAL

Our total assets were $2.08 billion at December 31, 2011.  This represents a 52.0% increase from $1.37 billion at December 31, 2010.  The main component of this change was a significant increase in loan volume.  Our total liabilities were $1.93 billion at December 31, 2011, up 52.0% from $1.27 billion at December 31, 2010.  The main component of this change was due to increased deposits and other borrowings.
 
 
 
 
 
- 50 -

 
 

 
On August 6, 2010, we purchased from Tammac Holding Corporation (“Tammac”) a $105.8 million manufactured housing loan portfolio for a purchase price of $105.8 million.  On September 30, 2011, we purchased from Tammac $19.3 million of manufactured housing loans and a 1.50% interest only strip security with an estimated value of $3 million secured by a pool of $70 million of loans originated by Tammac.  The total purchase price for these assets was $13 million.  These purchases and other similar portfolio purchases made by us in recent periods were opportunistic purchases and may not be indicative of future strategies or purchases.

On September 17, 2011, we completed our acquisition of Berkshire Bancorp, Inc. (“Berkshire Bancorp”) and its subsidiary, Berkshire Bank (collectively, “Berkshire”).  Berkshire Bank merged with and into the Bank immediately following the acquisition.   Berkshire Bancorp served Berks County, Pennsylvania through the five branches of its subsidiary, Berkshire Bank.  

On July 9, 2010 and September 17, 2010, we acquired the former USA Bank and ISN Bank in FDIC assisted transactions that resulted in two additional branches and expanded the our brand into New York and New Jersey to continue the growth into these markets.

The following table sets forth certain key condensed balance sheet data:
   
December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
   
(dollars in thousands)
 
Cash and cash equivalents
 
$
73,570
   
$
238,724
 
Loans held for sale
   
174,999
     
199,970
 
Investment securities, available for sale
   
79,137
     
205,828
 
Investment securities, held-to-maturity
   
319,547
     
-
 
Loans receivable not covered under FDIC Loss Sharing Agreements
   
1,216,265
     
514,087
 
Total loans receivable covered under FDIC Loss Sharing Agreements
   
126,276
     
164,885
 
Total loans receivable, net of the allowance for loan and lease losses
   
1,327,509
     
663,843
 
Total assets
   
2,077,532
     
1,374,407
 
Total deposits
   
1,583,189
     
1,245,690
 
Federal funds purchased
   
5,000
     
-
 
Total other borrowings
   
331,000
     
11,000
 
Subordinated debt
   
2,000
     
2,000
 
Total liabilities
   
1,929,784
     
1,269,267
 
Total shareholders’ equity
   
147,748
     
105,140
 

The following table sets forth a summary of assets acquired and liabilities assumed from the former USA Bank and ISN Bank at their respective acquisition dates (in thousands):

Total loans receivable, not covered under FDIC Loss Sharing Agreements
 
$
1,440
 
Total loans receivable, covered under FDIC Loss Sharing Agreements
   
174,660
 
FDIC loss sharing receivables
   
28,337
 
Other real estate owned covered under FDIC Loss Sharing Agreements
   
4,640
 
Total deposits
 
 
251,239
 
 
 
 
 
 
- 51 -

 
 

 
CASH AND DUE FROM BANKS

Cash and due from banks consists mainly of vault cash and cash items in the process of collection.  These balances totaled $7.8 million at December 31, 2011.  This represents a $1.4 million increase from $6.4 million at December 31, 2010.  These balances vary from day to day, primarily due to variations in customers’ deposits with us.

INTEREST-EARNING DEPOSITS WITH BANKS

Our interest earning deposits consist mainly of deposits at the Federal Home Loan Bank of Pittsburgh.  These deposits totaled $65.8 million at December 31, 2011, which is a $159.8 million decrease from $225.6 million at December 31, 2010.  The decline of interest earning deposits was primarily attributable to such deposits funding the organic loan growth, acquisitions of BBI and Tammac during the period ending December 31, 2011, as well as purchases of higher yielding investment securities.  This balance varies from day to day, depending on several factors, such as variations in customers’ deposits with us and the payment of checks drawn on customers’ accounts.  

FEDERAL FUNDS SOLD

Federal funds sold consist of overnight interbank lending through Atlantic Central Bankers Bank.  There were no funds sold at December 31, 2011, compared to $6.7 million at December 31, 2010.  This balance varies day-to-day, based upon the short-term fluctuations in our net cash position.
 
INVESTMENT SECURITIES

Our investment securities portfolio is an important source of interest income and liquidity.  It consists of U.S.  Treasury, government agency and mortgage-backed securities (guaranteed by an agency of the United States government and non-agency guaranteed), municipal securities, domestic corporate debt, and asset-backed securities.  In addition to generating revenue, we maintain the investment portfolio to manage interest rate risk, provide liquidity, provide collateral for other borrowings and diversify the credit risk of earning assets.  The portfolio is structured to maximize net interest income, given changes in the economic environment, liquidity position and balance sheet mix.

Management determines the appropriate classification of securities at the time of purchase.  In accordance with ASC 320 Investments—Debt and Equity Securities , investment securities are classified as:  (a) investment securities held to maturity (“HTM”), which are classified as such based on management’s intent and ability to hold the securities to maturity; (b) trading account securities, which are bought and held principally for the purpose of selling them in the near term; and (c) securities available for sale (“AFS”), which include those securities that may be sold in response to changes in interest rates, changes in pre-payment assumptions, the need to increase regulatory capital or other similar requirements.  We do not necessarily intend to sell our AFS securities, but have classified them as AFS to provide flexibility to respond to liquidity needs.

At December 31, 2011, $79.1 million of our investment securities were classified as AFS.  This represents a decrease of 61.6% from $205.8 million at December 31, 2010.  The decrease was largely due to the sales of investment securities to fund strong loan growth primarily due to warehouse and manufactured housing lending.  Unrealized gains and losses on AFS securities, although excluded from the results of operations, are reported as a separate component of shareholders’ equity, net of the related tax effect.  At December 31, 2011 we held $319.5 million of investment securities that were classified as HTM.  
 
 
 
 
- 52 -

 
 

 
The following table sets forth the amortized cost of the investment securities at its last three fiscal year ends:

   
December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
 Available for Sale:
 
(dollars in thousands)
 
 
 
U.S. Treasury and government agencies
  $ 1,002     $ 1,711     $ 435  
 Mortgage-backed securities
    55,818       204,182       39,314  
 Asset-backed securities
    622       719       843  
 Municipal securities
    2,071       2,088       4,048  
 Corporate bonds
    20,000       -       -  
    $ 79,513     $ 208,700     $ 44,640  
 Held to Maturity:
                       
 
Mortgage-backed securities
    319,547       -       -  
    $ 319,547     $ -     $ -  
 
For financial reporting purposes, available for sale securities are carried at fair value.

The following table sets forth information about the maturities and weighted average yield on our securities portfolio. Floating rate securities are included in the “Due in 1 Year or Less” bucket. Yields are not reported on a tax equivalent basis.

  December 31, 2011        
 
Amortized Cost
       
(dollars in thousands)
                     
No Specific
           
 
< 1yr
   
1 -5 yrs
   
5 -10 yrs
   
After 10 yrs
 
Maturity
 
Total
   
Fair Value
 
Available for Sale
                                   
U.S. Treasury and government agencies
$ 1,002     $ -     $ -     $ -   $ -   $ 1,002     $ 1,001  
Yield
  1.39 %     -       -             -     1.39
%
    -  
                                                   
Mortgage-backed securities
-     -     -     -   $ 55,818   55,818     56,292  
Yield
  -       -       -       -     2.01
%
  2.01
%
    -  
                                                   
Asset-backed securities
100     406     77     39   -   622     627  
Yield
  1.58 %     1.58 %     1.84 %     2.16
%
  -     1.65
%
    -  
                                                   
Municipal securities
-     2,071     -     -   -   2,071     2,000  
Yield
  -       4.15 %     -       -     -     4.15
%
    -  
                                                   
Corporate bonds
-     $ 20,000     -     -   -   20,000     19,217  
Yield
  -       3.87 %     -       -     -     3.87
%
    -  
Total
$ 1,102     $ 22,477     $ 77     $ 39   $ 55,818   $ 79,513     $ 79,137  
Yield
  1.41  
%
  3.85  
%
  1.84  
%
  2.16
%
  2.01
%
  2.52
%
       
 
 
 
 
- 53 -

 
 

 
   
December 31, 2011
Amortized Cost
 
   
< 1yr
   
1 -5 yrs
   
5 -10 yrs
   
After 10 yrs
   
No Specific Maturity
   
Total
   
Fair Value
 
(dollars in thousands)
     
Held to Maturity
                                         
Agency Residential Mortgage-Backed Debt Securities
    -       -       -       -     $ 319,547     $ 319,547     $ 330,809  
 Yield
    -       -       -       -       3.20 %     3.20 %     -  

At December 31, 2011, we held $2.4 million in securities that were impaired based on having a fair value lower than amortized cost for at least twelve consecutive months.  We consider these securities to be temporarily impaired primarily due to interest rate changes and a lack of liquidity in the market.  We do not intend to sell and, it is more likely than not, that we will not be required to sell the securities prior to maturity or market price recovery. Management believes that there is no other than temporary impairment of these securities as of December 31, 2011.  $311.4 million and $2.1 million of investment securities were pledged at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  Securities are pledged to the Federal Home Loan Bank of Pittsburgh to be used as collateral for borrowing purposes and to the Federal Reserve for contingency liquidity planning purposes.

LOANS

The composition of net loans receivable at December 31, 2011 and 2010 is as follows (dollars in thousands):
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
 Construction
  $ 37,926     $ 50,964     $ -     $ -     $ -  
 Commercial real estate
    51,619       72,281       -       -       -  
 Commercial and industrial
    10,254       13,156       -       -       -  
 Residential real estate
    22,465       23,822       -       -       -  
 Manufactured housing
    4,012       4,662       -       -       -  
      Total loan receivable covered under FDIC Loss Sharing Agreements (a)
    126,276       164,885       -       -       -  
 Construction
    15,271       13,387       21,742       -       -  
 Commercial real estate
    352,635       144,849       133,433       -       -  
 Commercial and industrial
    69,178       35,942       25,290       188,192       180,926  
 Mortgage warehouse
    619,318       186,113       16,435       -       -  
 Manufactured housing
    104,565       102,924       -       -       -  
 Residential real estate
    53,476       28,964       27,422       8,592       8,260  
 Consumer
    2,211       1,581       5,524       26,448       24,848  
 Unearned origination (fees) costs, net
    (389 )     327       452       520       535  
     Total loan receivable not covered under FDIC Loss Sharing Agreements
    1,216,265       514,087       230,298       223,752       214,569  
 Allowance for loan and lease losses
    (15,032 )     (15,129 )     (10,032 )     (2,876 )     (2,460 )
 Loans receivable, net
  $ 1,327,509     $ 663,843     $ 220,266     $ 220,876     $ 212,109  

(a)   Covered loans receivable acquired from the former USA Bank and ISN Bank are covered under the FDIC Loss Sharing Agreements over a five to ten year period, depending upon the type of loan.

Loans receivable, net increased $663.7 million from December 31, 2010 to December 31, 2011. An increase of $433.2 million in the mortgage-warehouse category, which we attribute to our successful strategy of expanding our warehouse lending platform and that funded balances as a percentage of commitments were unusually high in late 2011 , accounted for 65.3% of the total increase.   We expect that this short term market anomaly will dissipate in the first half of 2012.  Over the long-term, we expect continued growth in this business but expect a reduction in the warehouse mix of total assets due to faster growth in their loan portfolios.  We expect warehouse mix will make up about 25% of assets over time which is down from 38% at December 31, 2011.   In addition, we also focused on our multi-family and commercial real estate product line, and as a result, the outstanding balance is this category increased $207.8 million from December 31, 2010 to December 31, 2011. Finally, in September 2011, we acquired loans with a fair value of $98.4 million in the Berkshire Bancorp acquisition, which consisted primarily of $55.7 million in commercial real estate loans.
 
 
 
 
 
- 54 -

 

 

The following table sets forth certain categories of loans as of December 31, 2011, in terms of contractual maturity date:
 
 
  
Within
 one year
 
  
After one
 but
within
 five
years
 
  
After
five
 years
 
  
Total
 
 
  
(dollars in thousands)
 
Types of Loans:
  
     
  
     
  
     
  
     
Construction
  
$
36,569
   
$
11,925
   
$
4,703
   
$
53,197
  
Commercial real estate
  
 
53,788
     
136,026
     
214,440
     
404,254
  
Commercial and industrial
  
 
15,432
     
18,876
     
45,124
     
79,432
  
 
  
                             
Total
  
$
  105,789
   
$
166,827
   
$
264,267
   
$
536,883
  
 
  
                             
Amount of such loans with:
  
                             
Predetermined rates
  
$
  45,987
   
$
135,785
   
$
127,266
   
$
309,039
  
Floating or adjustable rates
  
 
  59,802
     
31,042
     
137,001
     
227,844
 
Total
  
$
  105,789
   
$
166,827
   
$
264,267
   
$
536,883
  
 
* Includes covered and non-covered loans.
 
 
 
 
 
 
- 55 -

 
 

 
 
CREDIT RISK

We manage credit risk by maintaining diversification in our loan portfolio, by establishing and enforcing rigorous underwriting standards, by intensive collection efforts, and by establishing and performing periodic loan classification reviews.  Management also attempts to anticipate and allow for credit risks by maintaining an adequate allowance for loan and lease losses, to which credit losses are charged as they are incurred, and to which provisions are added periodically as management and the board of directors deem appropriate.

The provision for loan losses was $9.5 million, $10.4 million, and $11.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010, and 2009, respectively.  The allowance for loan and lease losses was $15.0 million, or 1.24% of total non-covered loans, at December 31, 2011 and $15.1 million, or 2.94% of total non-covered loans, at December 31, 2010.  Net charge-offs were $9.5 million for the year ended December 31, 2011, an increase of $4.3 million compared to the $5.3 million for the year ending December 31, 2010.  In addition, we have approximately $126.3 million in loans that are covered under loss share arrangements with the FDIC as of December 31, 2011 compared to $164.9 million as of December 31, 2010.

 
The chart below depicts Customers Bancorp’s allowance for loan and lease losses for the periods indicated.

   
December 31,
 
     
2011
     
2010
     
2009
     
2008
     
2007
 
                                         
Balance of the allowance at the beginning of the year
  $
15,129
   
$
10,032
   
$
2,876
   
$
2,460
   
$
2,029
 
Loan charge-offs
                                       
Construction
   
1,179
     
1,214
     
920
     
100
     
-
 
Commercial real estate
   
5,775
     
964
     
2,597
     
79
     
-
 
Commercial and industrial
   
2,543
     
1,699
     
1,080
     
-
     
9
 
Residential real estate
   
109
     
1,366
     
-
     
1
     
-
 
Consumer and other
   
55
     
22
     
33
     
15
     
5
 
Total Charge-offs
   
9,661
     
5,265
     
4,630
     
195
     
14
 
Loan recoveries
                                       
Construction
   
2
     
-
     
-
     
-
     
-
 
Commercial real estate
   
94
     
-
     
-
     
-
     
-
 
Commercial and industrial
   
11
     
6
     
8
     
-
     
1
 
Residential real estate
   
-
     
9
     
-
     
-
     
-
 
Consumer and other
   
7
     
-
     
-
     
-
     
-
 
Total Recoveries
   
114
     
15
     
8
     
-
     
1
 
Total net charge-offs
   
9,547
     
5,250
     
4,622
     
195
     
13
 
Provision for loan losses
   
9,450
     
10,397
     
11,778
     
611
     
444
 
Transfer (1) 
   
 -
     
(50
)
   
 -
     
 -
     
 -
 
Balance of the allowance for loan and lease losses at the end of the year
 
$
15,032
   
$
15,129
   
$
10,032
   
$
2,876
   
$
2,460
 
Net charge-offs as a percentage of average non-covered loans
   
1.13%
     
1.00%
     
2.05%
     
0.09%
     
0.01%
 
 
(1)
In 2010, we had a reserve of $50,000 for unfunded commitments previously included in the allowance for loan and lease losses.  The reserve for unfunded loan commitments was reclassified to other liabilities.
 
The accrual of interest is generally discontinued when the contractual payment of principal or interest has become 90 days past due or when management has doubts about further collectability of principal or interest, even though the loan is currently performing.  A loan may remain on accrual status if it is in the process of collection and is well secured.  When a loan is placed on non-accrual status, unpaid interest credited to income is reversed. Interest received on non-accrual loans is applied against principal until all principal has been repaid.  Thereafter, interest payments are recognized as income until all unpaid interest has been received.  Generally, loans are restored to accrual status when the obligation is brought current and has performed in accordance with the contractual terms for a minimum of six months and the ultimate collectability of the total contractual principal and interest is no longer in doubt.
 
 
 
 
- 56 -

 
 
 
 
The allowance for loan and lease losses is based on a periodic evaluation of the loan portfolio and is maintained at a level that management considers adequate to absorb potential losses.  All loans are assigned risk ratings, based on an assessment of the borrower, the structure of the transaction and the available collateral and/or guarantees.  All loans are monitored regularly and the risk ratings are adjusted when appropriate.  This process allows us to take corrective actions on a timely basis.  Management considers a variety of factors, and recognizes the inherent risk of loss that always exists in the lending process.  Management uses a disciplined methodology to estimate the appropriate level of allowance for loan and lease losses.  Management reviewed various factors to develop an aggregate reserve under ASC 450-10 Contingencies (general reserve).The ALLL methodology determines the fair value on impaired loans and utilizes our historical loss experience to project losses in the foreseeable future for performing loans.  See “Asset Quality.”

This methodology includes an evaluation of loss potential from individual problem credits, as well as anticipated specific and general economic factors that may adversely affect collectability.  This assessment includes a review of changes in the composition and volume of the loan portfolio, overall portfolio quality and past loss experience, review of specific problem loans, current economic conditions that may affect borrowers’ ability to repay, and other factors that may warrant current recognition.  In addition, our internal and external auditors, loan review auditors and various regulatory agencies periodically review the adequacy of the allowance as an integral part of their examination process.  Such agencies may require us to recognize additions or reductions to the allowance based on their judgments of information available at the time of their examination.

Approximately 75-80% of our commercial real estate, commercial and residential construction, consumer residential and commercial and industrial loan types have real estate as collateral (collectively, “the real estate portfolio”).  Our lien position on the real estate collateral will vary on a loan by loan basis.  Current appraisals are received when our credit group determines that the facts and circumstances have significantly changed since the date of the last appraisal, including that real estate values have deteriorated.  The credit committee and loan officers review loans that are fifteen or more days delinquent and all nonaccrual loans on a periodic basis.  In addition, loans where the loan officers have identified a “borrower of interest” are discussed to determine if additional analysis is necessary to apply the risk rating criteria properly.  The risk ratings for the real estate loan portfolio are determined based upon the current information available, including but not limited to discussions with the borrower, updated financial information, economic conditions within the geographic area and other factors that may affect the cash flow of the loan.   On a quarterly basis, if necessary, the collateral values or discounted cash flow models are used to determine the estimated fair value of the underlying collateral for the quantification of a specific reserve for impaired loans.  Appraisals used within this evaluation process do not typically age more than two years before a new appraisal is obtained.  For loans where real estate is not the primary source of collateral, updated financial information is obtained, including accounts receivable and inventory aging reports and relevant supplemental financial data to determine the fair value of the underlying collateral.
 
An unallocated component is maintained to cover uncertainties that could affect management’s estimate of probable losses. The unallocated component of the allowance reflects the margin of imprecision inherent in the underlying assumptions used in the methodologies for estimating specific and general losses in the portfolio.
 
These evaluations, however, are inherently subjective as they require material estimates, including, among others, the amounts and timing of expected future cash flows on impaired loans, estimated losses in the loan portfolio, and general amounts for historical loss experience, economic conditions, uncertainties in estimating losses and inherent risks in the various credit portfolios, all of which may be susceptible to significant change.  Pursuant to ASC 450 Contingencies and ASC 310-40 Troubled Debt Restructurings by Creditors , impaired loans, consisting of non-accrual and restructured loans, are considered in the methodology for determining the allowance for credit losses.  Impaired loans are generally evaluated based on the expected future cash flows or the fair value of the underlying collateral if principal repayment is expected to come from the sale or operation of such collateral. 
 
 
 
 
- 57 -

 
 
 
The following table shows how the allowance for loan and lease losses is allocated among the various loan portfolios that we have outstanding. This allocation is based on management’s specific review of the credit risk of the outstanding loan portfolios in each category as well as historical trends.

   
December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
Amount
   
Percent
of Loans
in each
category
to total
loans (a)
   
Amount
   
Percent of
Loans in
each
category to
total
loans (a)
   
Amount
   
Percent of
Loans in
each
category
to total
loans
 
   
(dollars in thousands)
 
Construction
  $ 4,656       31.0 %   $ 2,126       7.7 %   $ 2,349       9.5 %
Commercial real estate
    7,030       47.1 %     6,280       32.7 %     4,874       58.0 %
Commercial and industrial
    1,441       9.6 %     1,663       8.7 %     1,350       11.0 %
Residential real estate
    844       5.6 %     3,988       7.8 %     1,284       19.1 %
Consumer and other
    77       0.5 %     11       0.1 %     75       2.4 %
Mortgage warehouse 
    929       6.2     465       27.7            
Manufactured housing 
    1       0.0           15.3            
Unallocated
    54             596             100        
    $ 15,032       100.0 %   $ 15,129       100.0 %   $ 10,032       100.0 %


   
December 31,
 
   
2008
   
2007
 
   
Amount
   
Percent of
Loans in
each
category to
total
loans
   
Amount
   
Percent of
Loans in
each
category to
total
loans
 
   
(dollars in thousands)
 
Construction
 
$
608
     
15.8
%
 
$
352
     
16.2
%
Commercial real estate
   
856
     
53.3
%
   
757
     
34.2
%
Commercial and industrial
   
532
     
15.1
%
   
551
     
20.1
%
Residential real estate
   
696
     
12.2
%
   
724
     
27.9
%
Consumer and other
   
32
     
3.6
%
   
44
     
1.6
%
Mortgage warehouse 
   
     
     
     
 
Manufactured housing 
   
 —
     
 —
     
     
 
Unallocated
   
152
     
     
32
     
 
   
$
2,876
     
100.0
%
 
$
2,460
     
100.0
%
 
(a) Total loans include covered and non-covered loans in 2011 and 2010.  No covered loans were held prior to 2010.

 
ASSET QUALITY

We had impaired loans totaling $57.8 million at December 31, 2011, compared to $44.6 million at December 31, 2010.  Non-accrual non-covered loans totaled $38.9 million at December 31, 2011, up from $22.2 million at December 31, 2010.  We had net charge-offs of $9.5 million in 2011, compared with $5.3 million in 2010.  We had recoveries of $114,000 in 2011, compared with $15,000 in 2010.  There was $7.3 million and $1.9 million of non-covered other real estate owned as a result of foreclosure or voluntary transfer to us at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  
 
 
 
 
 
- 58 -

 

 
To better understand our asset quality and related reserve adequacy, we break our loan portfolio into two categories; loans that we originated and loans that were acquired.  Management believes that this additional information will allow investors to better understand the risk in our portfolio and the various types of credit reserves that are available to support loan losses in the future.  Originated loans are supported with allowance for loan and lease loss reserves (“ALLL”).  Acquired loans are supported with ALLL, non-accretable difference fair value marks and cash reserves as described below.

Originated Loans

Loans that the Bank has originated totaled $1.19 billion as of December 31, 2011 or about 77% of total loans.  Of these, $141.4 million were loans originated prior to September 2009 (“Legacy Loans”), when the new management team lead by Jay Sidhu introduced new underwriting standards that management believes are more conservative.  The loans originated prior to September 2009 have $34.6 million of non-performing assets (“NPAs”) or 99% of total NPAs for originated loans.  Loans originated after September 2009 which total approximately $1.05 billion, have only $244,000 of NPAs.

The high level of non-performing loans (“NPLs”) in the Legacy Loan portfolio (22% NPL / Loans) are supported with $6.0 million of reserves or about 4.4% of total Legacy Loans.  The newly originated portfolio is comprised of $619.3 million of warehouse loans and $175.0 million of mortgages held for sale.  Held for sale loans are carried on our balance sheet at fair value so no ALLL is needed.  Losses in warehouse lending have historically been very low and therefore the ALLL / warehouse loans is 0.15%.  Commercial loans and multifamily loans totaled $237.2 million, which are supported with $2.0 million of ALLL.  Consumer and mortgage loans totaled $21.0 million, which are supported by $170,000 of ALLL.

Loan Type
 
Total Loan
   
Current
      30-90    
Non Accrual
   
Restructured
   
NPL's (1)
   
OREO
   
NPA
   
NPL / Loans
   
NPA / (Loans
 
               
(a)
   
(b)
   
(c)
         
(d)
   
(b) +( c)+(d)
         
+ OREO)
 
Originated Loans
                                                             
Legacy
  141,370     109,075     1,172     28,473     2,650     31,123     3,459     34,582       22.02 %     23.88 %
Manufactured Originated
    1,311       1,298       14       -       -       -       -       -       0.00 %     0.00 %
Warehouse - Repo
    619,318       619,318       -       -       -       -       -       -       0.00 %     0.00 %
Warehouse - HFS
    174,999       174,999       -       -       -       -       -       -       0.00 %     0.00 %
MultiFamily
    74,930       74,930       -       -       -       -       -       -       0.00 %     0.00 %
Commercial Originated Post 09/2009
    162,279       161,705       330       244       -       244       -       244       0.15 %     0.15 %
Consumer/ Mortgage Originated Post 09/2009
    19,734       19,734       -       -       -       -       -       -       0.00 %     0.00 %
Total Originated Loans
  1,193,941     1,161,057     1,516     28,717     2,650     31,367     3,459     $ 34,826       2.63 %     2.91 %
Acquired Loans
                                                                               
Berkshire
  96,801     85,531     1,124     10,146     -     10,146     3,811     $ 13,956       10.48 %     13.87 %
Total FDIC - Covered
    138,206       80,817       4,769       52,620       -       52,620       6,165       58,785       38.07 %     40.72 %
Total FDIC -  Non Covered
    41       30       7       4       -       4       -       4       10.60 %     10.60 %
Manufactured Housing 2010
    94,396       89,963       3,451       -       982       982       -       982       1.04 %     1.04 %
TAMMAC 2011
    17,673       8,867       1,765       7,040       -       7,040       48       7,088       39.84 %     40.00 %
Total Acquired Loans
  347,117     265,209     11,116     69,810     982     70,792     10,023     $ 80,815       20.39 %     22.63 %
Unallocated fees
  29     29      -      -      -      -      -     $  -                  
Sub Total Portfolio
  1,541,087     1,426,295     12,633     98,527     3,632     102,159     13,482     $ 115,641       6.63 %     7.44 %
                                                                   
Fair Value/Acquisition Credit Marks/Fasb & Deferred Fees/Expenses
 
 
23,547     8,957     143     14,447     -     14,447     -     $ 14,447    
Total Portfolio
  1,517,540     1,417,338     12,490     84,080     3,632     87,712     13,482     $ 101,194    
 
(1) Amount is gross of credit mark.

Acquired Loans

As of December 31, 2011, we carried $347.1 million of acquired loans which is 23% of total loans.  When loans are acquired, they are recorded on the balance sheet at fair value.  Acquired loans include purchased portfolios, FDIC failed bank acquisitions and unassisted acquisitions.  As of December 31, 2011, (i) 28% of acquired loans are from the Berkshire Bancorp acquisition, (ii) 40% of acquired loans are from FDIC assisted acquisitions, which have loss share protection and 80% of credit losses are covered by the FDIC, and (iii) 32% of acquired loans were purchased from Tammac which is a consumer finance company.  84% of the loans purchased from Tammac are supported by a $6.5 million cash reserve which is maintained in a demand deposit account at the Bank.  All losses and delinquent interest are covered with this reserve.  We estimate that this cash reserve will be adequate to cover future losses and delinquent interest over the life of the portfolio.
 
 
 
 
- 59 -

 

 
Most of the acquired loans were purchased at a discount.  The price paid factored in management’s judgment on the credit and interest rate risk inherent in the portfolio at the time of purchase.  Every quarter, management reassesses the risk and adjusts the fair value to incorporate changes in the credit outlook.  Total NPAs in the acquired portfolio were $80.8 million, or 70% of total NPAs.  Of this total, 73% have FDIC loss share protection (80% FDIC coverage of losses).  At December 31, 2011, the FDIC covered loans had $5.8 million of ALLL and $11.7 million of non-accretable difference fair value marks to support future credit losses.  17% of NPAs are from loans acquired from Berkshire, while 10% are from Tammac acquired loans.

Acquired loans have significantly higher non-performing assets than loans originated after September 2009.  Management acquired these loans with the expectation that losses will be elevated and therefore incorporated that expectation into the price paid.  Management also created a Special Assets group whose sole purpose is to workout these acquired non-performing assets.


Loan Type
 
Total Loans
         
Non-Accretable
   
Cash
         
Total Credit
   
Reserves
   
Reserves
 
(Dollars in 000's)
       
ALLL
   
Difference
   
Reserve
   
Other
   
Reserves
   
/ Loans
   
/ NPL
 
Originated Loans
                                               
Legacy
  136,897     6,018     -     -     -     6,018       4.40 %     19.34 %
Manufactured Originated
    1,311       1       -       -       -       1       0.10 %     0.00 %
Warehouse - Repo
    619,318       929       -       -       -       929       0.15 %     0.00 %
Warehouse - HFS
    174,999       -       -       -       -       -       0.00 %     0.00 %
MultiFamily
    74,930       674               -       -       674       0.90 %     0.00 %
Commercial Originated Post 09/2009
    166,752       1,343       -       -       -       1,343       0.81 %     550.28 %
Consumer/ Mortgage Originated Post 09/2009
    19,734       170       -       -       -       170       0.86 %     0.00 %
Total Originated Loans
  1,193,941     9,136     -     -     -     9,136       0.77 %     29.13 %
Acquired Loans
     -       -       -       -       -       -                  
Berkshire
  96,801     -     3,578     -     -     3,578       3.70 %     35.27 %
Total FDIC - Covered
    138,206       5,842       11,703       -       -       17,545       12.69 %     33.34 %
Total FDIC -  Non Covered
    41       -       -       -       -       -               0.00 %
Manufactured Housing 2010
    94,396       -       -       6,534       -       6,534       6.92 %     665.51 %
TAMMAC 2011
    17,673       -       8,251       -       -       8,251       46.69 %     117.19 %
Total Acquired Loans
  347,117     5,842     23,532     6,534     -     35,908       10.34 %     50.72 %
Un-allocated
   -     54      -        -      -     54       0.00 %     0.00 %
Total Portfolio
  1,541,087     15,032     23,532     6,534     -     45,098       2.93 %     44.14 %
 
Loans not covered under loss sharing arrangements

The tables below set forth non-covered non-performing loans and non-performing assets and asset quality ratios at December 31, 2011, 2010, 2009, 2008 and 2007:

   
December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
   
(dollars in thousands)
 
Non-accrual loans
 
$
38,868
   
$
22,274
   
$
10,341
   
$
4,387
   
$
2,058
 
Loans 90+ days delinquent still accruing
   
-
     
5
     
4,119
     
1,585
     
11
 
Restructured loans
   
6,269
     
4,776
     
4,690
     
1,203
     
-
 
Non-performing non-covered loans
   
45,137
     
27,055
     
19,150
     
7,175
     
2,069
 
OREO
   
7,316
     
1,906
     
1,155
     
1,519
     
-
 
Non-performing non-covered assets
 
$
52,453
   
$
28,961
   
$
20,305
   
$
8,694
   
$
2,069
 
 
 
 
 
- 60 -

 
 

 

   
December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
       
Non-accrual non-covered loans to total non-covered loans
    3.20 %     4.33 %     4.49 %     1.96 %     0.96 %
Non-performing non-covered loans to total non-covered loans
    3.71 %     5.26 %     8.32 %     3.21 %     1.63 %
Non-performing non-covered assets to total non-covered assets
    2.70 %     2.41 %     5.81 %     3.17 %     1.28 %
Non-accrual non-covered loans and 90+ days delinquent to total non-covered assets
    2.00 %     1.97 %     4.13 %     2.18 %     0.76 %
Allowance for loan and lease losses to:
                                       
Total non-covered loans
    1.24 %     2.94 %     4.36 %     1.29 %     1.15 %
Non-performing non-covered loans
    33.30 %     55.92 %     52.39 %     40.08 %     118.90 %
Non-performing non-covered assets
    28.66 %     52.24 %     49.41 %     33.08 %     118.90 %
 
 
The table below sets forth types of non-covered loans that were non-performing at December 31, 2011, 2010, 2009, 2008 and 2007.

   
December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
   
2008
   
2007
 
   
(dollars in thousands)
 
Construction
 
$
6,180
   
$
4,673
   
$
2,835
   
$
1,443
   
$
1,469
 
Residential real estate
   
3,559
     
1,793
     
672
     
350
     
-
 
Commercial real estate
   
31,486
     
15,879
     
14,786
     
5,232
     
411
 
Commercial and industrial
   
3,872
     
4,673
     
721
     
150
     
172
 
Consumer and other
   
40
     
5
     
136
     
-
     
17
 
Total non-performing loans
 
$
45,137
   
$
27,023
   
$
19,150
   
$
7,175
   
$
2,069
 

We seek to manage credit risk through the diversification of the loan portfolio and the application of policies and procedures designed to foster sound credit standards and monitoring practices.  While various degrees of credit risk are associated with substantially all investing activities, the lending function carries the greatest degree of potential loss.

Asset quality assurance activities include careful monitoring of borrower payment status and a review of borrower current financial information to ensure financial strength and viability.  We have established credit policies and procedures, seek the consistent application of those policies and procedures across the organization, and adjust policies as appropriate for changes in market conditions and applicable regulations.  The risk elements, which comprise asset quality, include loans past due, non-accrual loans, renegotiated loans, other real estate owned, and loan concentrations.

All loans are assigned risk ratings, based on an assessment of the borrower, the structure of the transaction and the available collateral and/or guarantees.  All loans are monitored regularly and the risk ratings are adjusted when appropriate.  This process allows us to take corrective actions on a timely basis.

A regular reporting and review process is in place to provide for proper portfolio oversight and control, and to monitor those loans identified as problem credits by management.  This process is designed to assess our progress in working toward a solution, and to assist in determining an appropriate specific allowance for possible losses.  All loan work out situations involve the active participation of management, and are reported regularly to the Board.
 
Loan charge-offs are determined on a case-by-case basis.  Loans are generally charged off when principal is likely to be unrecoverable and after appropriate collection steps have been taken.
 
 
 
 
 
- 61 -

 
 

 
Loan policies and procedures are reviewed internally for possible revisions and changes on a regular basis.  In addition, these policies and procedures, together with the loan portfolio, are reviewed on a periodic basis by various regulatory agencies and by our internal, external and loan review auditors, as part of their examination and audit procedures.
 
  Nonperforming loans and assets covered under FDIC Loss Sharing Agreements
 
The tables below set forth non-accrual covered loans and non-performing covered assets covered under FDIC Loss Sharing Agreements at December 31, 2011 and 2010 (in thousands).
 
   
December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
Non-accrual covered loans
  $ 45,213     $ 43,454  
Covered other real estate owned
    6,166       5,342  
Total nonperforming covered assets
  $ 51,379     $ 48,796  

The table below sets forth the types of covered loans that were non-performing at December 31, 2011 and 2010 (in thousands).

   
December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
Construction
  $ 21,480     $ 21,781  
Residential real estate
    5,534       4,017  
Commercial real estate
    17,666       15,675  
Commercial and industrial
    378       1,790  
Manufactured housing
    155       191  
Total non-performing covered loans
  $ 45,213     $ 43,454  
 
FDIC LOSS SHARING RECEIVABLE
 
As of December 31, 2011, 9.41% of the outstanding principal balance of loans receivable and 45.74% of our other real estate assets were covered under loss share agreements with the FDIC in which the FDIC has agreed to reimburse us for 80% of all losses incurred in connection with those assets.  We estimated the FDIC reimbursement that will result from losses or expenses incurred as we dispose of covered loans and other real estate assets, and we recorded the estimate as a receivable from the FDIC.  The FDIC loss sharing receivable was approximately $13.1 and $16.7 million as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  Realized losses in excess of acquisition date estimates will result in an increase in the FDIC receivable for loss share agreements.  Conversely, if realized losses are less than acquisition date estimates, the FDIC loss sharing receivable will be reduced.  The discount on the FDIC receivable is accreted into noninterest income using the level yield method over the estimated life of the receivable, including estimates of the timing of cash flow receipts and the disposition of non-performing assets. 
 
PREMISES AND EQUIPMENT AND OTHER ASSETS

Our premises and equipment, net of accumulated depreciation, was $9.4 million and $4.7 million at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.

Our restricted stock holdings at December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010 were $21.8 million and $4.2 million, respectively.  These consist of stock of the Federal Reserve Bank, Federal Home Loan Bank and Atlantic Central Bankers Bank, and are required as part of our relationship with these banks.
 
 
 
 
 
- 62 -

 

 
We owned BOLI of $29.3 million and $25.6 million at December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  Cash flow from these policies will occur over an extended period of time and flow through non-interest income.  We periodically review the creditworthiness of the insurance companies that have underwritten the policies.  The cash surrender values of the policies appear on our balance sheet and are subject to full regulatory capital requirements.

Other assets increased to $14.1 million at December 31, 2011 from $7.6 million at December 31, 2010.  This increase primarily was the result of an increase in accrued interest receivable as a result of the loans acquired from Berkshire Bancorp and a $4.1 million in deferred tax asset related to the Berkshire Bancorp acquisition.
  
DEPOSITS

We offer a variety of deposit accounts, including checking, savings, money market and time deposits.  Deposits are obtained primarily from our service area.  Total deposits grew to $1.58 billion at December 31, 2011, an increase of $337.5 million, or 27%, from $1.25 billion at December 31, 2010, primarily from deposits acquired from the Berkshire Bancorp acquisition and strong money market deposit initiation in the second half of 2011.  We introduced many new initiatives to increase our deposits that continued through 2011.  Sales management practices were introduced along with new marketing and pricing strategies.  

The components of deposits were as follows at the dates indicated:

   
December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Demand, non-interest bearing
 
$
114,044
   
$
72,268
 
Demand, interest bearing
   
739,463
     
387,013
 
Savings
   
16,922
     
17,649
 
Time, $100,000 and over
   
408,853
     
434,453
 
Time, other
   
303,907
     
334,307
 
Total deposits
 
$
1,583,189
   
$
1,245,690
 

Total time deposits decreased $56.0 million, or 7.3%, to $712.8 million at December 31, 2011 compared to $768.8 million at December 31, 2010.  Time deposits of $100,000 or more were $408.9 million at December 31, 2011 compared to $434.5 million at December 31, 2010, a decrease of $25.6 million or 5.9%.  We had no brokered deposits at December 31, 2011 compared to $46.0 million at December 31, 2010.  During this period, non-interest bearing demand deposits increased $41.7 million, or 57.8%, to $114.0 million from $72.3 million.  Interest bearing demand deposits increased $352.5 million, or 91.1%, to $739.5 million from $387.0 million.  The majority of this increase was in money market accounts that increased to $702.4 million at December 31, 2011 from $373.6 million at December 31, 2010.  Savings deposit accounts decreased $727,000, or 4.2%, to $16.9 million at December 31, 2011 from $17.6 million.  

At December 31, 2011, the scheduled maturities of time deposits greater than $100,000 are as follows (in thousands):

       
       
3 months or less
 
$
62,743
 
Over 3 through 6 months
   
56,604
 
Over 6 through 12 months
   
144,765
 
Over 12 months
   
144,741
 
   
$
408,853
 
 
 
 
 
 
- 63 -

 
 
 
OTHER BORROWINGS

Borrowed funds from various sources are generally used to supplement deposit growth.  There were $5 million and $0 of Federal funds purchased as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  Federal funds typically mature in one day.  An increase in mortgage warehouse funding has increased the need for us to borrow overnight funds.  FHLB overnight advances totaled $320.0 million and $0 as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  We also had contractual maturities of fixed rate long-term advances as noted below as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 (in thousands):


   
2011
   
2010
 
   
Amount
   
Rate
   
Amount
   
Rate
 
2013
  $ 1,000       3.73 %   $ 1,000       3.73 %
2017
    5,000       3.08       5,000       3.08  
2018
    5,000       3.31       5,000       3.31  
    $ 11,000             $ 11,000          


SUBORDINATED DEBT

In June 2004, we issued $2.0 million in floating rate subordinated debt that matures on July 23, 2014.  The quarterly interest rate at December 31, 2011 was 3.17%.  Currently, 40% of this subordinated debt is included in Customers Bank and Customers Bancorp’s Tier II regulatory capital requirement.

We issued a subordinated term note during the fourth quarter of 2008.  The note was issued for $1.0 million at a fixed interest rate of 7.50% per annum.  Quarterly interest payments are made on this note in January, April, July and October.  The note was converted to common stock in the third quarter of 2009 due to a significant change in our board of directors, which triggered a change in control event.

PREFERRED STOCK

As part of the Berkshire Bancorp acquisition in September 2011, we exchanged outstanding Berkshire Bancorp TARP Shares Series A and Series B preferred shares for 2,892 shares of the Series A Shares of Customers Bancorp, having a liquidation preference of $1,000 per share, and 145 shares of the Series B Shares of Customers Bancorp, also having a liquidation preference of $1,000 per shares. On December 28, 2011, we repurchased these preferred shares from the U.S. Treasury for $3.0 million.

SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

Shareholders’ equity increased to $147.7 million at December 31, 2011 from $105.1 million at December 31, 2010.  The increase primarily was due to capital raises totaling $28.5 million in 2011, the net effect of the Berkshire Bancorp acquisition of $11.3 million, offset by the repurchase of $3.0 million in TARP-related preferred stock.  For additional details relating to changes in our shareholders’ equity, refer to the Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity and Note 10 – Shareholders’ Equity to the consolidated financial statements included herein.

PRIVATE OFFERINGS OF COMMON STOCK

Since January 1, 2009, we raised approximately $106.3 million of capital, net of offering costs, through several private offerings of our securities.  In the aggregate, we issued 6,644,047 shares of Voting Common Stock and 3,090,076 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock pursuant to these private offerings.  Several of the investors in these offering were deemed “lead investors,” which entitled them to certain registration rights, pre-emptive rights and anti-dilution rights. In addition, as part of the private offerings, the lead investors, along with certain other investors received anti-dilution agreements providing them with protection from dilution until March 31, 2011.  Except as noted below with respect to the September, 30, 2011 private placement, all of these contractual rights acquired by these investors have expired or we have performed our required obligations, and these rights are no longer in force or effect. In addition, some of these purchasers also received warrants in connection with their investment in us.
 
 
 
 
- 64 -

 
 

 
In connection with a private placement sale of 419,000 shares of Voting Common Stock and 565,848 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock to an accredited investor on September 30, 2011, we granted this investor with piggyback registration rights entitling such investor to register all of his registrable securities as part of any public offering of common stock by Customers Bancorp.  Pursuant to this investor’s stock purchase agreement, we must give the investor written notice of our intention to file a registration statement with the SEC.  If after giving this notice we determine that none of the registrable securities will be registered, we may give written notice of this determination to the investor if the investor has requested registration and we will be relieved of our obligation to register any registrable securities in connection with the abandoned registration.  If we determine to delay registration of the registrable securities, we may delay the registration of the investor’s registrable securities for the same period as the delay in registering our registrable securities.  Additionally, the managing underwriters may, under certain circumstances, limit the number of registrable securities to be sold on account of the investor, if the managing underwriters determine that the amount of registrable securities to be registered on behalf of the investor is greater than the amount that can be offered without adversely affecting the success of the offering.

We have also changed our capital structure since 2009 pursuant to certain private exchange transactions.  In addition to the exchange described above under “Preferred Stock,”  in conjunction with our 2009 private offering, in July 2009 all shares of 10% Series A Non-Cumulative Perpetual Convertible Preferred Stock issued in the 2009 private offering were exchanged for 59,388 shares of our Voting Common Stock at an average per share price of $16.50 per share, and 8,167 warrants to purchase our Voting Common Stock at an exercise price of $16.50 per share.  We also anticipate that from time to time we may offer to convert the Class B Non-Voting Stock into Voting Common Stock on a one-to-one basis; provided, however, this conversion would be only be to the extent the holder would not own greater than 4.9% of our outstanding Voting Common Stock after conversion.

LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES

Liquidity for a financial institution is a measure of that institution’s ability to meet depositors’ needs for funds, to satisfy or fund loan commitments, and for other operating purposes.  Ensuring adequate liquidity is an objective of the Asset/Liability Management process.  We coordinate our management of liquidity with our interest rate sensitivity and capital position.  We strive to maintain a strong liquidity position.

Our investment portfolio provides periodic cash flows through regular maturities and amortization, and can be used as collateral to secure additional liquidity funding.  Our principal sources of funds are proceeds from stock issuance, deposits, principal and interest payments on loans, and other funds from operations.  We also maintain borrowing arrangements with the Federal Home Loan Bank and the Federal Reserve Bank of Philadelphia to meet short-term liquidity needs.  As of December 31, 2011, our borrowing capacity with the Federal Home Loan Bank was $571.3 million of which $320 million was used in short-term borrowings.  As of December 31, 2011, our borrowing capacity with the Federal Reserve Bank of Philadelphia was $72 million.

Our operating activities provided $29.9 million and used $221.5 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  

Investing activities used $760.5 million and $348.8 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  This increase was primarily due to the higher volume of investment securities transactions and an increase in loan activity, primarily mortgage warehouse loans, in 2011 compared to 2010.

Financing activities provided $565.4 million and $740.2 million for the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.  The decrease was primarily due to increased growth of deposits of $215.2 million in addition to an increase in short-term borrowed funds of $325.0 million in 2011.

Overall, based on our core deposit base and available sources of borrowed funds, management believes that we have adequate resources to meet our short-term and long-term cash requirements within the foreseeable future.
 
CAPITAL ADEQUACY

The Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System has adopted risk-based capital and leverage ratio requirements for bank holding companies like Customers Bancorp and banks like Customers Bank that are members of the Federal Reserve System.  The Pennsylvania Department of Banking also sets minimum capital requirements.  At December 31, 2011 and 2010, Customers Bancorp met each of its minimum capital requirements.  Management believes that we would be deemed “well capitalized” for regulatory purposes as of December 31, 2011 and 2010.  Banking regulators have discretion to establish an institution’s classification based on other factors, in addition to the institution’s numeric capital levels.
 
 
 
 
- 65 -

 
 

 
Management is not aware of any developments that have occurred and that could, or would be reasonably likely to, cause our classification to be reduced below a level of “well capitalized” for regulatory purposes.  Our capital classification is determined pursuant to “prompt corrective action” regulations, and to determine levels of deposit insurance assessments, and may not constitute an accurate representation of our overall financial condition or prospects.  The following table summarizes the required capital ratios and the corresponding regulatory capital positions of Customers Bancorp and Customers Bank for the periods or dates indicated:

 
Actual
 
For Capital Adequacy Purposes
 
To Be Well Capitalized Under
 Prompt Corrective Action
 Provisions
 
 
Amount
   
Ratio
 
Amount
     
Ratio
 
Amount
     
Ratio
 
     
As of December 31, 2011:
                         
Total capital (to risk weighted assets)
                                   
                                         
Customers Bancorp
  $ 162,228       11.43 %   $ 113,504  
>
    8.0 %     N/A         N/A  
Customers Bank
  $ 157,228       11.08 %   $ 113,504  
>
    8.0 %   $ 141,880  
>
    10.0 %
                                               
Tier 1 capital (to risk weighted assets)
                                             
Customers Bancorp
  $ 146,395       10.32 %   $ 56,752  
>
    4.0 %     N/A         N/A  
Customers Bank
  $ 141,395       9.97 %   $ 56,752  
>
    4.0 %   $ 85,128  
>
    6.0 %
                                               
Tier 1 capital (to average assets)
                                             
 
Customers Bancorp
  $ 146,395       7.59 %   $ 77,166  
 
>
    4.0 %     N/A          N/A  
Customers Bank
  $ 141,395       7.33 %   $ 77,166  
>
    4.0 %   $ 96,457  
>
    5.0 %
                                     
As of December 31, 2010:
                                   
Total capital (to risk weighted assets)
  $ 115,147       21.1 %   $ 43,571  
>
    8.0 %   $ 53,464  
>
    10.0 %
                                                     
Tier 1 capital (to risk weighted assets)
  $ 107,036       19.7 %   $ 21,557  
>
    4.0 %   $ 32,335  
>
    6.0 %
Tier 1 capital (to average assets)
  $ 107,036       8.7 %   $ 49,397  
>
    4.0 %   $ 61,747  
>
    5.0 %

As our assets grow, our capital ratios decrease.  In general, in the past few years, balance sheet growth has been offset by earnings and increases in capital from sales of common stock and growth of the allowance for loan and lease losses.  

We do not presently have any commitments for significant capital expenditures.  We are unaware of any current recommendations by the regulatory authorities which, if they were to be implemented, would have a material effect on our liquidity, capital resources, or operations.

The maintenance of appropriate levels of capital is an important objective of our Asset and Liability Management process.  Through our initial capitalization and our subsequent offerings, we believe we have continued to maintain a strong capital position.  Management also believes that, under current requirements and regulations, we will meet our minimum capital requirements for the foreseeable future.
 
 
 
 
 
- 66 -

 
 

OFF-BALANCE SHEET ARRANGEMENTS

We are a party to financial instruments and other commitments with off-balance sheet risks.  Financial instruments with off-balance sheet risks are incurred in the normal course of business to meet the financing needs of our customers.  These financial instruments include commitments to extend credit, including unused portions of lines of credit, and standby letters of credit.  Those instruments involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit risk in excess of the amount recognized on the balance sheets.

With commitments to extend credit, our exposure to credit loss in the event of non-performance by the other party to the financial instrument is represented by the contractual amount of those instruments.  We use the same credit policies in making commitments and conditional obligations as for on-balance sheet instruments.  Since they involve credit risk similar to extending a loan, they are subject to our Credit Policy and other underwriting standards.

As of December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, the following off-balance sheet commitments, financial instruments and other arrangements were outstanding:

   
December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
   
(in thousands)
 
Commitments to fund loans
 
$
106,227
   
$
23,446
 
Unfunded commitments to fund mortgage warehouse loans
   
294,681
     
221,706
 
Unfunded commitments under lines of credit
   
66,936
     
42,840
 
Letters of credit
   
1,374
     
1,085
 

Commitments to fund loans, unfunded commitments to fund mortgage warehouse loans, unfunded commitments under lines of credit and letters of credit are agreements to extend credit to or for the benefit of a customer in the ordinary course of our business.

Commitments to fund loans and unfunded commitments under lines of credit may be obligations of ours as long as there is no violation of any condition established in the contract.  Since many of the commitments are expected to expire without being drawn upon, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements.  Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee.  We evaluate each customer’s creditworthiness on a case-by-case basis.  The amount of collateral obtained, if we deem it necessary upon extension of credit, is based on management’s credit evaluation.  Collateral held varies but may include personal or commercial real estate, accounts receivable, inventory and equipment.

Mortgage warehouse loan commitments are agreements to purchase mortgage loans from mortgage bankers that agree to purchase the loans back in a short period of time or to sell to third party mortgage originators.  These commitments generally fluctuate monthly as existing loans are repurchased by the mortgage bankers and new loans are purchased by us.

Outstanding letters of credit written are conditional commitments issued by us to guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party.  Letters of credit may obligate us to fund draws under those letters of credit whether or not a customer continues to meet the conditions of the extension of credit.  The credit risk involved in issuing letters of credit is essentially the same as that involved in extending loan facilities to customers.
 
CONTRACTUAL OBLIGATIONS
 
The following table sets forth contractual obligations and other commitments representing required and potential cash outflows as of December 31, 2011.  Interest on subordinated debentures and long-term borrowed funds is calculated based on current contractual interest rates.
 
 
 
 
- 67 -

 
 
( in thousands )
               
After one
   
After three
       
               
but within
   
but within
       
   
Total
   
Within one year
   
three years
   
five years
   
More than 5 years
 
                               
Operating leases
 
$
10,568
   
$
1,859
   
$
3,289
   
$
1,985
   
$
3,435
 
Benefit plan commitments
   
  4,500
     
-
     
  -
     
300
     
4,200
 
Contractual maturities on time deposits
   
712,760
     
495,444
     
98,049
     
119,065
     
202
 
Subordinated notes and the interest expense (1)
   
2,174
     
63
     
2,111
     
  -
     
  -
 
Loan commitments
   
467,844
     
456,701
     
1,181
     
695
     
9,267
 
Long term debt
   
  11,000
     
-
     
  1,000
     
 -
     
10,000
 
Interest on long term debt
   
2,030
     
357
     
656
     
639
     
378
 
Standby letters of credit
   
1,374
     
1,374
     
  -
     
-
     
  -
 
Total
 
$
  1,212,250
   
 $
955,798
   
$
106,286
   
$
122,684
   
$
27,482
 
 
(1) Includes interest on long-term debt and subordinated debentures at a weighted rate of 3.24% and 3.17%, respectively.
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
- 68 -

 
 
 
NEW ACCOUNTING PRONOUNCEMENTS


For information about the impact that recently adopted or issued accounting guidance will have on us, refer to Note 3 – Significant Accounting Policies to the consolidated financial statements included herein.

 
QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURE ABOUT MARKET RISK

Interest Rate Sensitivity

The largest component of our net income is net interest income, and the majority of our financial instruments are interest rate sensitive assets and liabilities with various terms and maturities.  One of the primary objectives of management is to maximize net interest income while minimizing interest rate risk.  Interest rate risk is derived from timing differences in the repricing of assets and liabilities, loan prepayments, deposit withdrawals, and differences in lending and funding rates.  Our Asset/Liability Committee actively seeks to monitor and control the mix of interest rate sensitive assets and interest rate sensitive liabilities.

We use two complementary methods to analyze and measure interest rate sensitivity as part of the overall management of interest rate risk.  They are income simulation modeling and estimates of economic value of equity.  The combination of these two methods provides a reasonably comprehensive summary of the levels of interest rate risk of our exposure to time factors and changes in interest rate environments.

Income simulation modeling is used to measure our interest rate sensitivity and manage our interest rate risk.  Income simulation considers not only the impact of changing market interest rates upon forecasted net interest income, but also other factors such as yield curve relationships, the volume and mix of assets and liabilities, customer preferences and general market conditions.

Through the use of income simulation modeling, we have estimated the net interest income for the year ending December 31, 2011, based upon the assets, liabilities and off-balance sheet financial instruments in existence at December 31, 2011.  We have also estimated changes to that estimated net interest income based upon interest rates rising or falling immediately (“rate shocks”).  Rate shocks assume that all interest rates increase or decrease immediately.  The following table reflects the estimated percentage change in estimated net interest income for the year ending December 31, 2011, resulting from changes in interest rates.

Net change in net interest income
     
Rate Shocks
 
%
Change
 
Up 3%
   
  4.4
%
Up 2%
   
5.2
%
Up 1%
   
3.3
%
Down 1%
   
(4.9
) %
Down 2%
   
(9.7
) %
Down 3%
   
(13.51
) %

The net changes in net interest income in all scenarios are within Customers Bank’s interest rate risk policy guidelines.  

Economic Value of Equity (“EVE”) estimates the discounted present value of asset and liability cash flows.  Discount rates are based upon market prices for comparable assets and liabilities.  Upward and downward rate shocks are used to measure volatility of EVE in relation to a constant rate environment.  This method of measurement primarily evaluates the longer term repricing risks and options in Customers Bank’s balance sheet.  The following table reflects the estimated EVE at risk and the ratio of EVE to EVE adjusted assets at December 31, 2011, resulting from shocks to interest rates.
   
 
 
 
- 69 -

 
 
 
Percent Change Economic Value of Equity
 
 
Rate Shocks
 
From
base
 
EVE
assets capital (a)
 
           
Up 3%
   
  (18.5
)%
   
  (16.5
)%
Up 2%
   
  (5.4
)%
   
  (4.8
)%
Up 1%
   
  (2.6
)%
   
2.3
%
Down 1%
   
(13.9
)%
   
(12.5
)%
Down 2%
   
(17.9
)%
   
(16.1
)%
Down 3%
   
  (15.4
)%
   
 (13.8
)%
 
(a) Capital defined as Tier 1 plus Tier 2 Capital as calculated under regulatory guidelines.
 
The percent changes of EVE with the exception of the “down 1%” and “down 2%” rate shocks are all within our interest risk policy guidelines.  While the percent changes of EVE in the “down 1%” and “down 2%” rate shock scenarios are slightly outside our guidelines, management does not believe these scenarios are likely given the current interest rate environment.

The matching of assets and liabilities may also be analyzed by examining the extent to which such assets and liabilities are interest rate sensitive and by monitoring a bank’s interest rate sensitivity “gap.”  An asset or liability is said to be interest rate sensitive within a specific time period if it will mature or reprice within that time period.  The interest rate sensitivity gap is defined as the difference between the amount of interest earning assets maturing or repricing within a specific time period and the amount of interest bearing liabilities maturing or repricing within that time period.

The following table sets forth the amounts of interest earning assets and interest bearing liabilities outstanding at December 31, 2011, that are anticipated, based upon certain assumptions, to reprice or mature in each of the future time periods shown.  Except as stated below, the amount of assets and liabilities shown that reprice or mature during a particular period were determined in accordance with the earlier of term to repricing or the contractual maturity of the asset or liability.  The table sets forth an approximation of the projected repricing of assets and liabilities at December 31, 2011, on the basis of contractual maturities, anticipated prepayments, and scheduled rate adjustments within a three-month period and subsequent selected time intervals.  The loan amounts in the table reflect principal balances expected to be repaid and/or repriced as a result of contractual amortization and anticipated prepayments of adjustable and fixed rate loans, and as a result of contractual rate adjustments on adjustable rate loans.
  
 
 
- 70 -

 
 
 
   
At December 31, 2011
   
3 months
or less
   
3 to 6
months
   
6 to 12
months
   
1 to 3
years
   
3 to 5
years
   
over 5
years
   
Total
 
   
(dollars in thousands)
Interest earning deposits and federal funds sold
 
$
  65,805
   
$
  -
   
$
-
   
$
-
   
$
  -
   
$
5,400
   
71,205
 
Investment securities
   
26,037
     
25,356
     
54,621
     
97,087
     
157,339
     
56,903
     
417,343
 
Loans receivable (a)
   
986,072
     
35,904
     
61,315
     
93,464
     
169,266
     
183,786
     
 1,529,807
 
Total interest
     earning assets
   
1,077,914
     
61,260
     
115,936
     
190,551
     
326,605
     
246,089
     
2,018,355
 
Non interest earning assets
   
  -
     
  -
     
  -
     
  -
     
  -
     
60,724
     
60,724
 
Total assets
 
$
1,077,914
   
$
61,260
   
$
115,936
   
$
190,551
   
$
326,605
   
$
306,813
   
$
2,079,079
 
Other interest bearing deposits
 
$
702,419
   
$
  -
   
$
  -
   
$
  -
   
$
  -
   
$
53,967
   
$
756,386
 
Time deposits
   
125,615
     
108,573
     
271,213
     
74,806
     
132,084
     
608
     
712,899
 
Other borrowings
   
325,000
     
  -
     
  -
     
  1,000
     
  -
     
  10,000
     
336,000
 
Subordinated debt
   
  2,000
     
-
     
  -
     
  -
     
  -
     
  -
     
  2,000
 
Total interest bearing liabilities
   
1,155,034
     
108,573
     
271,213
     
75,806
     
132,084
     
64,575
     
1,807,285
 
Non interest bearing liabilities
   
  -
     
  -
     
  -
     
  -
     
  -
     
125,659
     
125,659
 
Shareholders’ equity
   
  -
     
  -
     
  -
     
  -
     
  -
     
146,135
     
146,135
 
Total liabilities and equity
 
$
1,155,034
   
$
108,573
   
$
271,213
   
$
75,806
   
$
132,084
   
$
336,369
   
$
2,079,079
 
Interest sensitivity gap
 
$
  (77,120
)
 
$
  (47,313
)
 
$
  (155,277
)
 
$
114,745
   
$
194,521
   
$
  (29,556
)
       
Cumulative interest sensitivity gap
 
$
-
   
$
(124,433
 
$
(279,710
)
 
$
  (164,965
 )
 
$
29,556
     
-
         
Cumulative interest sensitivity gap
to total assets
   
(3.7
)% 
   
  (6.0
)%
   
  (13.5
)%
   
(7.9
)%
   
1.4
%
   
0.0
%
       
Cumulative interest earning assets
     to cumulative
     interest bearing liabilities
   
93.3
%
   
90.2
%
   
81.8
%
   
89.8
%
   
101.7
%
   
100
%
       
 
(a) Including loans held for sale

As shown above, we have a negative cumulative gap (cumulative interest sensitive assets are lower than cumulative interest sensitive liabilities) within the next year, which generally indicates that an increase in rates may lead to a decrease in net interest income and a decrease in rates may lead to an increase in net interest income.  Interest rate sensitivity gap analysis measures whether assets or liabilities may reprice but does not capture the ability to reprice or the range of potential repricing on assets or liabilities.  Thus indications based on a negative or positive gap position needs to be analyzed in conjunction with other interest rate risk management tools.

Management believes that the assumptions and combination of methods utilized in evaluating estimated net interest income are reasonable.  However, the interest rate sensitivity of our assets, liabilities and off-balance sheet financial instruments, as well as the estimated effect of changes in interest rates on estimated net interest income, could vary substantially if different assumptions are used or actual experience differs from the assumptions used in the model.
 
 
 
 
 
 
- 71 -

 
 
 
 
BUSINESS
 
Business Summary
 
Customers Bancorp, through its wholly-owned subsidiary Customers Bank, provides financial products and services to small businesses, not-for-profits and consumers through its fourteen branches in Southeastern Pennsylvania (Bucks, Berks, Chester and Delaware Counties), Rye, New York (Westchester County) and Hamilton, New Jersey (Mercer County).  Customers Bank also provides liquidity to the mortgage market nationwide through the operation of its mortgage warehouse business.  At December 31, 2011, Customers Bancorp had total assets of $2.08 billion, including net loans (including held for sale loans) of $1.50 billion, total deposits of $1.58 billion and shareholders’ equity of $147.8 million.

Our strategic plan is to become a leading regional bank holding company through organic growth and value-added acquisitions.  We differentiate ourselves from our competitors through our focus on and understanding of the banking needs of small businesses, not-for-profits and consumers. We will also focus on certain low-cost, low-risk specialty lending segments such as warehouse lending.  Our lending is funded by our branch model, which seeks higher deposit levels than a typical branch, combined with lower branch operating expenses, without sacrificing exceptional customer service.  We also create franchise value through our disciplined approach to acquisitions, both in terms of identifying targets and structuring transactions, including FDIC-assisted transactions of troubled financial institutions.  Risk management practices are also an important part of the strategies we initiate.

Our management team consists of experienced banking executives.  The team is led by our Chairman and Chief Executive Officer Jay Sidhu, who joined Customers Bank in June 2009. Mr. Sidhu brings 36 years of banking experience, including 20 years as the Chief Executive Officer of Sovereign Bank and 17 years as the Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of Sovereign Bancorp.  In addition to Mr. Sidhu, most of the members of our current management team joined us following Mr. Sidhu’s arrival in 2009 and have extensive experience working together at Sovereign with Mr. Sidhu. This team has significant experience in building a banking organization, in completing and integrating mergers and acquisitions, as well as developing existing valuable community and business relationships in our core markets.

Background and History

Customers Bancorp was incorporated in Pennsylvania in April 2010 to facilitate the Reorganization.  Pursuant to the Reorganization, all of the issued and outstanding shares of Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock of Customers Bank were exchanged on a three-to-one basis for shares of Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock, respectively, of Customers Bancorp ( i.e., each three shares of Customers Bank being exchanged for one share of Customers Bancorp).  Customers Bancorp’s corporate headquarters are located at 1015 Penn Avenue, Wyomissing, Pennsylvania 19610.  The main telephone number is (610) 933-2000.

In December 2010, Customers Bank changed its name from New Century Bank.  New Century Bank was incorporated in 1994 and is a Pennsylvania state chartered bank and a member of the Federal Reserve System. New Century Bank (each three shares of Customers Bank exchanged for one share of Customers Bancorp) commenced operations in 1997. Customers Bank’s deposits are insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation. Customers Bank’s corporate headquarters are located at 99 Bridge Street, Phoenixville, Pennsylvania 19460. The main telephone number is (610) 933-2000.

Our Markets

Market Criteria

We look to grow organically as well as through selective acquisitions in our current and prospective markets.  We believe there is significant opportunity to both enhance our presence in our current markets and enter new complementary markets that meet our objectives.

We focus on markets that we believe are characterized by some or all of the following:
·  
Population density
·  
Concentration of business activity
·  
Attractive deposit bases; large market share held by large banks
·  
Advantageous competitive landscape that provides opportunity to achieve meaningful market presence
·  
Lack of consolidation in the banking sector and corresponding opportunities for add-on transactions
 
 
 
 
 
- 72 -

 
 
 
·  
Potential for economic growth over time
·  
Management experience in the applicable markets

Current Markets

Our current markets are broadly defined as the greater Philadelphia region and Berks County in Pennsylvania, Mercer County, New Jersey and Southeastern New York.  The table below describes certain key statistics regarding our presence in these markets as of June 30, 2011:
 
Market
 
Deposit Market Share Rank
 
Offices
 
Deposits
(in millions)
 
Deposit
Market Share
                 
Philadelphia-Camden-Wilmington, PA, NJ, DE, MSA
 
27
 
8
 
$947.6
 
0.23%
                 
Berks County, PA (1)
 
9
 
6
 
271.9
 
3.07
                 
Mercer County, NJ
 
19
 
1
 
141.7
 
1.17
                 
Westchester County, NY
 
26
 
1
 
170.7
 
0.37
_________________
(1)  
Includes deposits and offices of Berkshire Bank.  See “Berkshire Bank Acquisition.”

Source:  FDIC Website as of June 30, 2011
 
 
 
 
 
 
- 73 -

 
 

 
We believe that these markets have highly attractive demographic, economic and competitive dynamics that are consistent with our objectives and favorable to executing our organic growth and acquisition strategy. The table below describes certain key demographic statistics regarding these markets.



Market Environment
Market
Deposits ($bn)
# of Businesses (thousands)
Market Population (millions)
Population Density Current (#/sq. mi.)
Population Growth (%) (2000 to 2011)
Median Household Income ($) 2011
Household Income Growth (%) (2000 to 2011)
Top 3 Competitor Combined Deposit Market Share (%)
Philadelphia – Camden – Wilmington, PA-NJ-DE-MD
417.2
219
6.0
1,228.9
5.2
58,051
20.4
53
Berks, PA
8.8
14
0.4
482.0
10.5
54,769
22.5
59
Mercer, NJ
12.1
16
0.4
1,638.2
4.9
71,646
26.0
49
Westchester, NY
46.5
41
0.9
2,203.0
2.7
81,147
27.5
53
U.S.
     
88.0
10.4
50,227
19.1
33

Source: SNL Financial; Deposit data as of June 30, 2011
 
 
 
 
 
 
- 74 -

 
 

 
Prospective Markets

Our organic growth strategy focuses on expanding market share in our existing and contiguous markets by generating deposits through personalized service and taking advantage of technology and through our commercial, consumer and specialized lending products.  Our acquisition strategy primarily focuses on undervalued and troubled community banks in Pennsylvania, New Jersey, New York, Maryland, Connecticut and Delaware, where such acquisitions further our objectives and meet our critical success factors.  As we evaluate potential acquisition opportunities, we believe there are many banking institutions that continue to face credit challenges, capital constraints and liquidity issues and that lack the scale and management expertise to manage the increasing regulatory burden.

Our Competitive Strengths
 
· 
Experienced and respected management team. An integral element of our business strategy is to capitalize on and leverage the prior experience of our executive management team. The management team is led by our Chairman and Chief Executive Officer, Jay Sidhu, who is the former Chief Executive Officer and Chairman of Sovereign Bancorp. In addition to Mr. Sidhu, most of the members of our current management team have extensive experience working together at Sovereign with Mr. Sidhu, including Richard Ehst, President and Chief Operating Officer of Customers Bancorp, Warren Taylor, President of Community Banking for Customers Bank, and Thomas Brugger, Chief Financial Officer of Customers Bancorp. During their tenure at Sovereign, the team established a track record of producing strong financial results, integrating acquisitions, managing risk, working with regulators and achieving organic growth and expense control. In addition, our warehouse lending group is led by Glenn Hedde, who brings more than 23 years of experience in this sector. This team has significant experience in successfully building a banking organization as well as existing valuable community and business relationships in our core markets.
 
·  
Unique Asset Generation Strategy. We focus on local market lending combined with relatively low-risk specialty lending segments.  Our local market asset generation provides consumer lending products, such as mortgage loans and home equity loans.  We have also established a multi-family and commercial real estate product line that is focused on the Mid-Atlantic region.  The strategy is to focus on refinancing existing loans with conservative underwriting and to keep costs low.  Through the multi-family and commercial real estate product, we earn interest income, fee income and generate commercial deposits.  We also maintain a specialty lending business, warehousing lending, which is a national business where we provide liquidity to non-depository mortgage companies to fund their mortgage pipelines. Through the warehouse lending business, we earn interest income and generate fees.
 
·  
Attractive risk profile.   We have sought to maintain high asset quality and moderate credit risk by using conservative underwriting standards and early identification of potential problem assets.  We have also formed a special assets department to both manage our covered assets portfolio and to review our other classified and non-performing assets.  As shown below, a significant portion of our loan portfolio has been subjected to acquisition accounting adjustments and, in some cases, is also subject to loss sharing agreements with the FDIC (“Loss Sharing Agreements”):

·  
as of December 31, 2011, approximately 22.87% of our loans (by dollar amount) were acquired loans and all of those loans were adjusted to their estimated fair values at the time of acquisition; and
·  
as of December 31, 2011, 8.32% of our loans and 45.74% of our other real estate owned (“OREO”) (each by dollar amount) were covered by a loss sharing arrangement with the FDIC in which the FDIC will reimburse us for 80% of our losses on these assets.

Please refer to the Asset Quality disclosure and tables regarding legacy and acquired loans beginning on page 58 in the “Management’s Discussion and Analysis” section.

·  
Superior Community Banking Model.   We expect to drive organic growth by employing our “concierge banking” strategy, which provides specific relationship managers for all customers, delivering an appointment banking approach available 12 hours a day, seven days a week. This allows us to provide services in a personalized, convenient and expeditious manner.  This approach, coupled with superior technology, including remote account opening, remote deposit capture and mobile banking, results in a competitive advantage over larger institutions, which we believe contributes to the profitability of our franchise and allows us to generate core deposits.  Our “high tech, high touch,” model requires less staff and smaller branch locations to operate, thereby significantly reducing our operating costs.
 
 
 
 
- 75 -

 
 
 
 
·  
Acquisition Expertise.   The depth of our management team and their experience working together and successfully completing acquisitions provides us with unique insight in identifying and analyzing potential markets and acquisition targets. Our team’s experience, which includes the acquisition and integration of over 30 institutions, as well as numerous branch acquisitions, provides us a substantial advantage in pursuing and consummating future acquisitions.  Additionally, we believe our strengths in structuring transactions to limit our risk, our experience in the financial reporting and regulatory process related to troubled bank acquisitions, and our ongoing risk management expertise, particularly in problem loan workouts, collectively enable us to capitalize on the potential of the franchises we acquire. With our depth of operational experience in connection with completing merger and acquisition transactions, we expect to be able to integrate and reposition acquired franchises cost-efficiently and with a minimum disruption to customer relationships.

We believe our ability to operate efficiently is enhanced by our centralized management structure, our access to attractive labor and real estate costs in our markets, and an infrastructure that is unencumbered by legacy systems. Furthermore, we anticipate additional expense synergies from the integration of our recent acquisitions, which we believe will enhance our financial performance.

Our Objectives and Strategies

Our strategic plan is to become a leading regional bank holding company through organic growth and value-added acquisitions. A key aspect of our current business strategy is to foster a community-oriented culture where our customers and employees establish long-standing and mutually beneficial relationships. We believe we can differentiate ourselves through our focus on and understanding of the banking needs of small businesses, not-for-profits, and consumers.

A central part of this strategy is generating core deposit customers to support growth of a strong and stable loan portfolio. We believe we can achieve this through exceptional convenience and pricing flexibility for deposits while remaining more responsive to our customers’ needs and providing a high level of personal and specialized service.  We will strive for flexibility and responsiveness in operating and growing our franchise, while maintaining tight internal controls and adhering to the following “Critical Success Factors:”

·  
Talent - Attract, retain and develop a seasoned and innovative executive management team, experienced high-producing relationship managers to accelerate organic growth and experienced business development officers;
·  
Profitability - Create a culture that focuses on profitability and delivering services in a cost-effective, efficient manner with the goal of increasing our revenues significantly faster than our expenses;
·  
Superior Asset Quality - Develop and adhere to conservative underwriting policies while maintaining diversified portfolios of earning assets and a conservative level of loan loss reserves;
·  
Risk Management - Manage other enterprise-wide risks, including minimizing interest rate risk through positioning the balance sheet so as to not place directional speculation on interest rate movements; and
·  
Capital - Maintain an adequate capital cushion that insulates us from adverse economic climates.

We intend to achieve our objectives under these guidelines by adhering to a combination of the following strategies:

·  
Organic growth through “High Touch, High Tech” Strategy.   We focus our customer service efforts on relationship banking, personalized service and the ability to quickly make credit and other business decisions. Relationship managers, available 12 hours a day, seven days a week, are assigned for all customers, establishing a single point of contact for all issues and products. This “concierge banking” approach allows Customers Bank to provide services in a convenient and expeditious manner, delivered by experienced bankers, and enhances the overall customer experience, offering pricing flexibility, speed and convenience.  This approach is supplemented with sophisticated high technology services, such as remote deposit capture and mobile banking, collectively creating “virtual branch banks.”  We can open accounts at the location of the customer and remote account opening is also available via our web site.  To ensure functionality across the customer base, Customers Bank will not only provide the technology, but also set up and train customers on how to benefit from this technology.  We believe that the combination of our “concierge banking” approach and creation of a more inexpensive network of “virtual” branches, which require less staff and smaller branch locations, provides greater convenience and cost savings.  We believe this allows us to capture market share from and have a competitive advantage over larger institutions, which we expect will continue to contribute to the profitability of our franchise and allows us to generate core deposits.
 
 
 
 
 
 
- 76 -

 

 
·  
Value-Added Acquisitions . We plan to take advantage of acquisition opportunities that will add immediate value to our core franchise. The recent U.S. recession and the related crisis in the financial services industry present a unique opportunity for us to execute our acquisition strategy.  Many banks are trading at historically low multiples and are in need of capital at a time when traditional sources of capital have diminished.  The current weakness in the banking sector and the potential duration of any recovery provide us with an opportunity to successfully execute our strategy.  Our management team has a long history of identifying targets, assessing and pricing risk and executing acquisitions. We believe our acquisition strategy will deliver transactions that add substantial value while minimizing potential risks.

Our acquisition strategy focuses on community banks, primarily in Pennsylvania, New Jersey, New York, Maryland, Connecticut and Delaware. We seek to achieve sufficient scale in each market that we enter by acquiring healthy, distressed, undercapitalized and weakened banking institutions that have stable core deposit franchises, local market share, quantifiable risks or that are acquired from the FDIC with federal assistance, and that offer synergies through add-on acquisitions, expense reduction and organic growth opportunities. We also seek to purchase assets and banking platforms, as well as assumptions of deposits from the FDIC and possibly enter into loss mitigation arrangements with the FDIC in connection with such purchases.

·  
Creative and Efficient Integration . We will seek to integrate acquired banks into our existing model, where our operational strategies and systems will have already proven themselves in our core banking franchise.  Our strategy includes maximizing customer retention, improving on the products and services offered to new customers, and a seamless integration and conversion focusing on achieving appropriate cost savings. As we grow our franchise, we will seek to capitalize on the existing goodwill, customer loyalty and brand values. We intend to actively manage banks we acquire, integrate and reposition existing management to maximize the use of their talents and evaluate the competitive models of our acquired franchises to determine how best our overall company can profit from the strongest features of each business.

·  
Lending initiatives focused on small business and specialty lending.   We maintain a specialty lending line, warehouse lending, that is relatively low risk and low cost.  Warehouse lending is a national business where we provide liquidity to non-depository mortgage companies to fund their mortgage pipelines.  We have also established a multi-family and commercial real estate segment that is focused in the Mid-Atlantic region, which targets the refinancing of existing loans utilizing conservative underwriting standards.

·  
Expand fee-based services and products.   We will provide fee-based services for core retail and small business customers, including cash management, deposit services, merchant services and asset management.  We are working with vendors to expand our suite of fee-based services.  Our management team has significant experience in building these capabilities and creating sales processes to increase fee revenue.

·  
Maintain strong risk management culture .  We are very focused on maintaining a strong risk management culture.  We employ conservative underwriting in our lending, with a loan committee chaired by our Chief Credit Officer.  The Bank’s Risk Management Committee performs an independent review of all risks at Customers Bank, and the Bank’s Management Risk Committee, chaired by the Head of Enterprise Risk Management, reviews all risks.  We intend to maintain strong capital levels and utilize our investment portfolio to primarily manage liquidity and interest rate risk.

Acquisitions

Since July 2010, we have completed three acquisitions, two of which were FDIC-assisted transactions.  We believe we have structured acquisitions that limit our credit risk, which has positioned us for attractive risk-adjusted returns. A summary of these acquisitions appears below.

Berkshire Bancorp Acquisition

On September 17, 2011, Customers Bancorp acquired Berkshire Bancorp, Inc. and its subsidiary Berkshire Bank.  Berkshire Bancorp served Berks County, Pennsylvania through five branches. On the closing date, Berkshire Bancorp had total assets of approximately $132.5 million, including total loans of $98.4 million, and total liabilities of approximately $122.8 million, including total deposits of $121.9 million.  Under the terms of the merger agreement, each outstanding share of Berkshire Bancorp common stock was exchanged for 0.1534 shares of Customers Bancorp’s Voting Common Stock, resulting in the issuance of 623,686 shares of Customers Bancorp’s Voting Common Stock.  The total purchase price was approximately $11.3 million, representing a price to tangible book value of Berkshire Bancorp common stock of 1.25%. This transaction was immediately accretive to earnings.
 
 
 
 
 
 
- 77 -

 
 

 
In addition, as part of the transaction, Customers Bancorp exchanged shares of its preferred stock for the preferred stock that was issued by Berkshire Bancorp as part of the U.S. Treasury’s Troubled Asset Relief Program.  Those shares were subsequently redeemed.  In addition, warrants to purchase shares of Berkshire Bancorp common stock were converted into warrants to purchase shares of Customers Bancorp’s Voting Common Stock.

Berkshire Bancorp’s operating results are included in our financial results from the date of acquisition, September 17, 2011, through December 31, 2011.

FDIC-Assisted Transactions

Acquisition of USA Bank

On July 9, 2010, Customers Bank acquired substantially all of the assets and assumed all of the non-brokered deposits and substantially all other liabilities of USA Bank from the FDIC, as receiver.  The transaction consisted of assets with a fair value of
$221.1 million, including $124.7 million of loans (with a corresponding unpaid principal balance (“UPB”), of $153.6 million), a $22.7 million FDIC loss sharing receivable and $3.4 million of foreclosed assets. Liabilities with a fair value of $202.1 million were also assumed, including $179.3 million of non-brokered deposits.  Customers Bank also received cash consideration from the FDIC of $25.6 million.  Furthermore, Customers Bank recognized a bargain purchase gain before taxes of $28.2 million, which represented 12.2% of the fair value of the total assets acquired.

Concurrently with the acquisition of USA Bank, the FDIC agreed to absorb a portion of all future credit losses and workout expenses through Loss Sharing Agreements that cover certain legacy assets, including the entire loan portfolio and OREO.  At July 9, 2010, the covered assets consisted of assets with a book value of $126.7 million. The total UPB of the   covered assets at July 9, 2010 was $159.2 million. Customers Bank acquired other USA Bank assets that are not covered by the Loss Sharing Agreements with the FDIC, including cash and certain investment securities purchased at fair market value. The Loss Sharing Agreements do not apply to subsequently acquired, purchased or originated assets.  Customers Bank entered into this transaction to expand its franchise into a lucrative new market, accrete its book value per share and add significant capital.

Pursuant to the terms of the Loss Sharing Agreements, the FDIC will reimburse Customers Bank for 80% of losses, calculated, in each case, based on UPB plus certain interest and expenses.  Customers Bank will reimburse the FDIC for its share of recoveries with respect to losses for which the FDIC has paid Customers Bank in reimbursement under the Loss Sharing Agreements.

Customers Bank has received an aggregate of $14.4 million from the FDIC in reimbursements under the Loss Sharing Agreements for claims filed for losses incurred through December 31, 2011.

Acquisition of ISN Bank

On September 17, 2010, Customers Bank acquired substantially all of the assets and assumed all of the non-brokered deposits and substantially all other liabilities of ISN Bank from the FDIC, as receiver.  The transaction consisted of assets with a fair value of $83.9 million, including $51.3 million of loans (with a corresponding UPB of $58.2 million), a $5.6 million FDIC loss sharing receivable and $1.2 million of foreclosed assets. Liabilities with a fair value of $75.8 million were also assumed, including $71.9 million of non-brokered deposits.  Customers Bank received cash consideration from the FDIC of $5.9 million.  Furthermore, Customers Bank recognized a bargain purchase gain before taxes of $12.1 million, which represented 14.4% of the fair value of the total assets acquired.

Concurrently with the acquisition of ISN Bank, the FDIC agreed to absorb a portion of all future credit losses and workout expenses through Loss Sharing Agreements that cover certain legacy assets, including the entire loan portfolio and OREO.  At September 17, 2010, the covered assets consisted of assets with a book value of $52.6 million. The total UPB of the covered assets at September 17, 2010 was $58.2 million. Customers Bank acquired other ISN Bank assets that are not covered by the Loss Sharing Agreements with the FDIC including cash, certain investment securities purchased at fair market value and other tangible assets. The Loss Sharing Agreements do not apply to subsequently acquired, purchased or originated assets. Customers Bank entered into this transaction to enhance book value per share, add capital and enter the New Jersey market in a more efficient manner than de novo expansion.  Pursuant to the terms of the Loss Sharing Agreements, the FDIC will reimburse Customers Bank for 80% of losses, calculated, in each case, based on UPB plus certain interest and expenses. Customers Bank will reimburse the FDIC for its share of recoveries with respect to losses for which the FDIC has paid Customers Bank in reimbursement under the Loss Sharing Agreements.
 
 
 
 
 
- 78 -

 
 

 
Customers Bank has received an aggregate of $4.2 million from the FDIC in reimbursements under the ISN Loss Sharing Agreements for claims filed for losses incurred through December 31, 2011.

In accordance with the guidance provided in SEC Staff Accounting Bulletin Topic 1.K, Financial Statements of Acquired Troubled Financial Institutions (“SAB 1: K”) and a request for relief granted by the SEC, historical financial information of USA Bank and ISN Bank has been omitted from this prospectus.   Relief is provided under certain circumstances, including transactions such as the acquisitions of USA Bank and ISN Bank in which an institution engages in an acquisition of a troubled financial institution for which audited financial statements are not reasonably available and in which federal assistance is an essential and significant part of the transaction.

Acquisition of Loan Portfolios

On August 6, 2010, we purchased from Tammac Holding Corporation (“Tammac”) a $105.8 million manufactured housing loan portfolio for a purchase price of $105.8 million.  On September 30, 2011, we purchased from Tammac $19.3 million of manufactured housing loans and a 1.50% interest only strip security with an estimated value of $3 million secured by a pool of $70 million of loans originated by Tammac.  The total purchase price for these assets was $13 million.  These purchases and other similar portfolio purchases made by us in recent periods were opportunistic purchases and may not be indicative of future strategies or purchases.

Products

We offer a broad range of traditional banking products and financial services to our commercial and consumer customers in Suburban Philadelphia, Pennsylvania, Central New Jersey and Southeastern New York. We offer an array of lending products to cater to our customers’ needs, including small business loans, mortgage warehouse loans, multi-family and commercial real estate loans, residential mortgage loans and consumer loans. We also offer traditional depository products, including commercial and consumer checking accounts, non-interest-bearing demand accounts, money market deposit accounts, savings accounts and time deposit accounts and cash management services.

Lending Activities

We focus our lending efforts to the following lending areas:
·  
Commercial Lending – includes business, small business and multi-family and commercial real estate lending
·  
Specialty Lending – Warehouse lending
·  
Consumer Lending – Local market mortgage lending and home equity lending

Our existing lending relationships are primarily with small businesses, not-for-profits and consumers in Berks, Chester and Delaware Counties in Pennsylvania, Westchester County in New York, Fairfield County in Connecticut, Bergen County in New Jersey and to a lesser extent in surrounding markets. We also provide warehouse financing nationwide and multi-family lending in the Mid-Atlantic states.  Our lending strategies focus on the following key segments:

Commercial Lending

The Bank’s commercial lending is segmented into three distinct groups: multi-family and commercial real estate, business banking and small business banking. This segmentation is designed to allow for greater resource deployment, higher standards of risk management, strong asset quality, lower interest rate risk and higher productivity levels.

The business banking lending group focuses on companies with annual revenues ranging from $5.0 million to $20.0 million, which typically have credit requirements between $500,000 and $2.0 million.

The small business banking platform originates loans, including Small Business Administration loans, through the branch network sales force and a team of dedicated small business relationship managers. The support administration of the platform for this segment is centralized, including risk management, product management, marketing, performance tracking and overall strategy. Credit and sales training has been established for our sales force, ensuring we have small business experts in place providing appropriate financial solutions to the small business owners in our communities. A segmentation approach focuses on industries that offer us high asset quality and are deposit rich to drive profitability.
 
 
 
 
 
- 79 -

 
 

 
The goal of our multi-family lending group is to build a portfolio of high quality multi-family and commercial real estate loans within our covered markets, while cross selling our other products and services.  This business line primarily focuses on refinancing existing loans, using conservative underwriting.  The primary collateral for these loans is a first lien mortgage on the multi-family property, plus an assignment of all leases related to such property.  During the year ended December 31, 2011, we originated and closed $121.5 million of multi-family loans commitments.

As of December 31, 2011, we had $536.9 million in commercial loans outstanding, comprising approximately 35.3% of our total loan portfolio (which includes loans held for sale).  During the year ended December 31, 2011, we originated and closed $167.7 million of commercial loans and commitments.

Specialty Lending

In 2009, we established a warehouse lending business, which provides financing to mortgage bankers for residential mortgage originations from loan closing until sale in the secondary market.    Many providers of liquidity in this segment exited the business in 2007-2008 during the period of excessive market turmoil. There is an opportunity to provide liquidity to this segment at attractive spreads. There is also opportunity to attract escrow deposits and to generate fee income in this business.  To date, there have been no losses in warehouse lending.

The goal of the warehouse group is to provide liquidity to mortgage companies.  These facilities are used by mortgage companies to fund their pipelines from closing of individual mortgage loans until their sale into the secondary market.  Most of the loans are insured or guaranteed by the U.S. government through one of their programs such as FHA, VA, or are conventional loans eligible for sale to Fannie Mae and Freddie Mac.  The strategy is to stay focused on providing the financing in the lowest risk segments in this business.  Most of the revenue is derived from the interest income earned on the mortgage warehouse loans, but the business also generates fee income and deposits.  We expect moderate growth in commitments in this business in 2012.

As of December 31, 2011, loans in our warehouse lending portfolio as well as loans held for sale totaled $794.3 million outstanding, comprising approximately 52.3% of our total loan portfolio (which includes loans held for sale).  During the year ended December 31, 2011, we funded $7.7 billion of mortgage loans under warehouse facilities.

Management will assess other lending businesses in the future but will make sure that they are aligned with the Bank’s critical success factors and strategic objectives.

Consumer Lending

We plan to expand our product offerings in real estate secured consumer lending. We will not offer indirect automobile loans, unsecured loans or credit cards. Initially, we will provide home equity and residential mortgage loans to customers. Underwriting standards for home equity lending will be conservative, focusing on FICO scores 720 and higher, and lending will be offered to solidify customer relationships and grow relationship revenues in the long term. This lending is important in our efforts to grow total relationship revenues for our consumer households.

As of December 31, 2011, we had $186.7 million in consumer loans outstanding, comprising 13.9% of our total loan portfolio (which includes loans held for sale).  During the year ended December 31, 2011, we originated and closed $10.1 million of consumer loans.

Deposit Products and Other Funding Sources

We offer a variety of deposit products to our customers, including checking accounts, savings accounts, money market accounts and other deposit accounts, including fixed-rate, fixed-maturity retail time deposits ranging in terms from 30 days to five years, individual retirement accounts, and non-retail time deposits consisting of jumbo certificates greater than or equal to $100,000. As of December 31, 2011, our deposit portfolio was comprised of 54.9% of core deposits.

We intend to continue our efforts to attract deposits from our business lending relationships to maintain our low cost of funds and improve our net interest margin.
 
 
 
 
 
- 80 -

 
 

 
Deposit flows are significantly influenced by general and local economic conditions, changes in prevailing interest rates, internal pricing decisions and competition. Our deposits are primarily obtained from areas surrounding our banking centers.  To attract and retain deposits, we rely on providing quality service and introducing new products and services that meet our customers’ needs.

Financial Products and Services

In addition to traditional banking activities, we provide other financial services to our customers, including: internet banking, wire transfers, electronic bill payment, lock box services, remote deposit capture services, courier services, merchant processing services, cash vault, controlled disbursements, positive pay and cash management services (including account reconciliation, collections and sweep accounts).

Competition

Customers Bank competes with other financial institutions for deposit and loan business. Competitors include other commercial banks, savings banks, savings and loan associations, insurance companies, securities brokerage firms, credit unions, finance companies, mutual funds, money market funds, and certain government agencies. Financial institutions compete principally on the quality of the services rendered, interest rates offered on deposit products, interest rates charged on loans, fees and service charges, the convenience of banking office locations and hours of operation, and in the consideration of larger commercial borrowers, lending limits.

Many competitors are significantly larger than Customers Bank, and have significantly greater financial resources, personnel and locations from which to conduct business. In addition, Customers Bank is subject to regulation, while certain of its competitors are not. Non-regulated companies face relatively few barriers to entry into the financial services industry. Customers Bank’s larger competitors enjoy greater name recognition and greater resources to finance wide ranging advertising campaigns. Customers Bank competes for business principally on the basis of high quality, personal service to customers, customer access to Customers Bank’s decision makers, and competitive interest and fee structure. Customers Bank also strives to provide maximum convenience of access to services by employing innovative delivery vehicles such as internet banking, and convenience of availability of banking representatives.

Customers Bank’s current market is primarily served by large national and regional banks, with a few larger institutions capturing more than 50% of the deposit market share. Customers Bank’s large competitors utilize expensive, branch-based models to sell products to consumers and small businesses, which requires our larger competitors to price their products with wider margins and charge more fees to justify their higher expense base. While maintaining physical branch locations remains an important component of Customers Bank’s strategy, Customers Bank utilizes an operating model with fewer and less expensive locations, thereby lowering overhead costs and allowing for greater pricing flexibility.

Employees

As of December 31, 2011, Customers Bank had 205 full-time and 8 part-time employees.


SUPERVISION AND REGULATION

General

We are subject to extensive regulation, examination and supervision by the Pennsylvania Banking Department and, as a member of the Federal Reserve System, by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the “Federal Reserve Board”).  Federal and state banking laws and regulations govern, among other things, the scope of a bank’s business, the investments a bank may make, the reserves against deposits a bank must maintain, terms of deposit accounts, loans a bank makes, the interest rates a bank charges and collateral a bank takes, the activities of a bank with respect to mergers and consolidations and the establishment of branches.

Pennsylvania Banking Laws

Pennsylvania banks that are Federal Reserve members may establish new offices only after approval by the Pennsylvania Banking Department and the Federal Reserve Board.  Approval by these regulators can be subject to a variety of factors, including the convenience and needs of the community, whether the institution is sufficiently capitalized and well managed, issues of safety and soundness, the institution’s record of meeting the credit needs of its community, whether there are significant supervisory concerns with respect to the institution or affiliated organizations, and whether any financial or other business arrangement, direct or indirect, involving the proposed branch and bank “insiders” (directors, officers, employees and 10%-or-greater shareholders) involves terms and conditions more favorable to the insiders than would be available in a comparable transaction with unrelated parties.
 
 
 
 
- 81 -

 
 

 
Under the Pennsylvania Banking Code, we are permitted to branch throughout Pennsylvania.  Pennsylvania law also provides Pennsylvania state chartered institutions elective parity with the power of national banks, federal thrifts, and state-chartered institutions in other states as authorized by the FDIC, subject to a required notice to the Pennsylvania Banking Department.  The Pennsylvania Banking Code also imposes restrictions on payment of dividends, as well as minimum capital requirements.

Interstate Branching .  Federal law allows the Federal Reserve and FDIC, and the Pennsylvania Banking Code allows the Pennsylvania Banking Department, to approve an application by a state banking institution to acquire interstate branches.  For more information on federal law, see the discussion under “Federal Banking Laws – Interstate Branching” that follows.

Pennsylvania banking laws authorize banks in Pennsylvania to acquire existing branches or branch de novo in other states, and also permits out-of-state banks to acquire existing branches or branch de novo in Pennsylvania.

In April 2008, Banking Regulators in the States of New Jersey, New York, and Pennsylvania entered into a Memorandum of Understanding (the “Interstate MOU”) to clarify their respective roles, as home and host state regulators, regarding interstate branching activity on a regional basis pursuant to the Riegle-Neal Amendments Act of 1997. The Interstate MOU establishes the regulatory responsibilities of the respective state banking regulators regarding bank regulatory examinations and is intended to reduce the regulatory burden on state chartered banks branching within the region by eliminating duplicative host state compliance exams.

Under the Interstate MOU, the activities of branches we established in New Jersey or New York would be governed by Pennsylvania state law to the same extent that federal law governs the activities of the branch of an out-of-state national bank in such host states. Issues regarding whether a particular host state law is preempted are to be determined in the first instance by the Pennsylvania Banking Department. In the event that the Pennsylvania Banking Department and the applicable host state regulator disagree regarding whether a particular host state law is pre-empted, the Pennsylvania Banking Department and the applicable host state regulator would use their reasonable best efforts to consider all points of view and to resolve the disagreement.

Federal Banking Laws

Interstate Branching.   The Riegle-Neal Interstate Banking and Branching Efficiency Act of 1994 (the “Interstate Act”), among other things, permits bank holding companies to acquire banks in any state. A bank may also merge with a bank in another state.  Interstate acquisitions and mergers are subject, in general, to certain concentration limits and state entry rules relating to the age of the bank.  Under the Interstate Act, the responsible federal regulatory agency is permitted to approve the acquisition of less than all of the branches of an insured bank by an out-of-state bank or bank holding company without the acquisition of an entire bank, only if the law of the state in which the branch is located permits such an acquisition.  Under the Interstate Act, branches of state-chartered banks that operate in other states are covered by the laws of the chartering state, rather than the host state.  The Dodd-Frank Act created a more permissive interstate branching regime by permitting banks to establish branches de novo in any state if a bank chartered by such state would have been permitted to establish the branch.  For more information on interstate branching under Pennsylvania law, see “Pennsylvania Banking Laws – Interstate Branching” above.   

Prompt Corrective Action .  Federal banking law mandates certain “prompt corrective actions,” which Federal banking agencies are required to take, and certain actions which they have discretion to take, based upon the capital category into which a Federally regulated depository institution falls.  Regulations have been adopted by the Federal bank regulatory agencies setting forth detailed procedures and criteria for implementing prompt corrective action in the case of any institution that is not adequately capitalized.  Under the rules, an institution will be deemed to be “adequately capitalized” or better if it exceeds the minimum Federal regulatory capital requirements.  However, it will be deemed “undercapitalized” if it fails to meet the minimum capital requirements, “significantly undercapitalized” if it has a total risk-based capital ratio that is less than 6.0%, a Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio that is less than 3.0%, or a leverage ratio that is less than 3.0%, and “critically undercapitalized” if the institution has a ratio of tangible equity to total assets that is equal to or less than 2.0%.  The rules require an undercapitalized institution to file a written capital restoration plan, along with a performance guaranty by its holding company or a third party.  In addition, an undercapitalized institution becomes subject to certain automatic restrictions including a prohibition on the payment of dividends, a limitation on asset growth and expansion, and in certain cases, a limitation on the payment of bonuses or raises to senior executive officers and a prohibition on the payment of certain “management fees” to any “controlling person.”  Institutions that are classified as undercapitalized are also subject to certain additional supervisory actions, including increased reporting burdens and regulatory monitoring, a limitation on the institution’s ability to make acquisitions, open new branch offices, or engage in new lines of business, obligations to raise additional capital, restrictions on transactions with affiliates, and restrictions on interest rates paid by the institution on deposits.  In certain cases, bank regulatory agencies may require replacement of senior executive officers or directors, or sale of the institution to a willing purchaser.  If an institution is deemed to be “critically undercapitalized” and continues in that category for four quarters, the statute requires, with certain narrowly limited exceptions, that the institution be placed in receivership.
 
 
 
 

 
 
- 82 -

 
 
 
Safety and Soundness; Regulation of Bank Management .  The Federal Reserve Board possesses the power to prohibit us from engaging in any activity that would be an unsafe and unsound banking practice and in violation of the law.  Moreover, Federal law enactments have expanded the circumstances under which officers or directors of a bank may be removed by the institution’s Federal supervisory agency; restricted and further regulated lending by a bank to its executive officers, directors, principal shareholders or related interests thereof; restricted management personnel of a bank from serving as directors or in other management positions with certain depository institutions whose assets exceed a specified amount or which have an office within a specified geographic area; and restricted management personnel from borrowing from another institution that has a correspondent relationship with the bank for which they work.

Capital Rules .  Federal banking agencies have issued certain “risk-based capital” guidelines, which supplemented existing capital requirements.  In addition, the Federal Reserve Board imposes certain “leverage” requirements on member banks such as us.  Banking regulators have authority to require higher minimum capital ratios for an individual bank or bank holding company in view of its circumstances.

The risk-based guidelines require all banks and bank holding companies to maintain two “risk-weighted assets” ratios.  The first is a minimum ratio of total capital (Tier 1 and Tier 2 capital) to risk-weighted assets equal to 8.0%; the second is a minimum ratio of Tier 1 capital to risk-weighted assets equal to 4.0%.  Assets are assigned to five risk categories, with higher levels of capital being required for the categories perceived as representing greater risk.  In making the calculation, certain intangible assets must be deducted from the capital base.  The risk-based capital rules are designed to make regulatory capital requirements more sensitive to differences in risk profiles among banks and bank holding companies and to minimize disincentives for holding liquid assets.

The risk-based capital rules also account for interest rate risk.  Institutions with interest rate risk exposure above a normal level would be required to hold extra capital in proportion to that risk.  A bank’s exposure to declines in the economic value of its capital due to changes in interest rates is a factor that banking agencies will consider in evaluating a bank’s capital adequacy.  The rule does not codify an explicit minimum capital charge for interest rate risk.  We currently monitor and manage our assets and liabilities for interest rate risk, and management believes that the interest rate risk rules which have been implemented and proposed will not materially adversely affect our operations.

The Federal Reserve Board’s “leverage” ratio rules require member banks which are rated the highest in the composite areas of capital, asset quality, management, earnings and liquidity to maintain a ratio of Tier 1 capital to “adjusted total assets” of not less than 3.0%.  For banks which are not the most highly rated, the minimum “leverage” ratio will range from 4.0% to 5.0%, or higher at the discretion of the Federal Reserve Board, and is required to be at a level commensurate with the nature of the level of risk of a bank’s condition and activities.

For purposes of the capital requirements, “Tier 1” or “core” capital is defined to include common shareholders’ equity and certain noncumulative perpetual preferred stock and related surplus.  “Tier 2” or “qualifying supplementary” capital is defined to include a bank’s allowance for loan and lease losses up to 1.25% of risk-weighted assets, plus certain types of preferred stock and related surplus, certain “hybrid capital instruments” and certain term subordinated debt instruments.

The Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (the “Basel Committee”) released a comprehensive list of proposals for changes to capital, leverage, and liquidity requirements for banks in December 2009 (commonly referred to as “Basel III”). In July 2010, the Basel Committee announced the design for its capital and liquidity reform proposals.
 
In September 2010, the oversight body of the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision announced minimum capital ratios and transition periods providing: (i) the minimum requirement for the Tier 1 common equity ratio will be increased from the current 2.0% level to 4.5% (to be phased in by January 1, 2015); (ii) the minimum requirement for the Tier 1 capital ratio will be increased from the current 4.0% to 6.0% (to be phased in by January 1, 2015); (iii) an additional 2.5% of Tier 1 common equity to total risk-weighted assets (to be phased in between January 1, 2016 and January 1, 2019); and (iv) a minimum leverage ratio of 3.0% (to be tested starting January 1, 2013). The proposals also narrow the definition of capital, excluding instruments that no longer qualify as Tier 1 common equity as of January 1, 2013, and phasing out other instruments over several years.   It is unclear how U.S. banking regulators will define “well-capitalized” in their implementation of Basel III.
 
 
 
 
 
- 83 -

 
 

 
The liquidity proposals under Basel III include: (i) a liquidity coverage ratio (to become effective January 1, 2015); (ii) a net stable funding ratio (to become effective January 1, 2018); and (iii) a set of monitoring tools for banks to report minimum types of information to their regulatory supervisors.

Many of the details of the new framework related to minimum capital levels and minimum liquidity requirements in the Basel Committee’s proposals will remain uncertain until the final release is issued. Implementation of the final provisions of Basel III will require implementing regulations and guidelines by U.S. banking regulators. Implementation of these new capital and liquidity requirements has created significant uncertainty with respect to the future liquidity and capital requirements for financial institutions. Therefore, we are not able to predict at this time the content of liquidity and capital guidelines or regulations that may be adopted by regulatory agencies or the impact that any changes in regulation may have on us.

Deposit Insurance Assessments .  Our deposits are insured by the FDIC up to the limits set forth under applicable law and are subject to deposit insurance premium assessments.  The FDIC imposes a risk-based deposit premium assessment system, which was amended pursuant to the Federal Deposit Insurance Reform Act of 2005.  Under this system, the amount of FDIC assessments paid by an individual insured depository institution, like us, is based on the level of risk incurred in its activities.  The FDIC places a depository institution in one of four risk categories determined by reference to its capital levels and supervisory ratings.  In addition, in the case of those institutions in the lowest risk category, the FDIC further determines its assessment rates based on certain specified financial ratios.

On May 22, 2009, the FDIC adopted a final rule imposing a 5 basis point special assessment on each insured depository   institution’s assets minus Tier 1 capital as of September 30, 2009.  The amount of the special assessment for any institution will not exceed 10 basis points times the institution’s assessment base for the second quarter 2009.  The special assessment was collected on September 30, 2009.

On October 12, 2009, the FDIC adopted a final rule to require insured institutions to prepay their estimated quarterly risk-based assessments for the fourth quarter of 2009 and for all of 2010, 2011 and 2012.  The prepaid assessment was collected on December 30, 2009.  For purposes of calculating the prepaid assessment, each institution’s assessment rate was its total base assessment rate in effect on September 30, 2009.  The prepayment attributable to 2011 and thereafter was calculated using the September 29, 2009 increase in 2011 base assessment rates.  In addition, future deposit growth was reflected in the prepayment by assuming that an institution’s third quarter 2009 assessment base increased quarterly at a 5 percent annual growth rate through the end of 2012.  The Dodd-Frank Act changed the federal deposit insurance regime that will affect the deposit insurance assessments the Bank will be obligated to pay in the future.  For example:

·  
The law permanently raises the federal deposit insurance limit to $250,000 per account ownership.
 
·  
The law makes deposit insurance coverage unlimited in amount for non-interest bearing transaction accounts until December 31, 2012.
 
·  
The law increases the insurance fund’s minimum designated reserve ratio from 1.15 to 1.35, and removed the current 1.50 cap on the reserve ratio, leaving it, instead, to the discretion of the FDIC.  The FDIC has recently exercised that discretion by establishing a long range fund ratio of 2%.
 
Each of these changes may increase the rate of FDIC insurance assessments to maintain or replenish the FDIC’s deposit insurance fund.  This could, in turn, raise our future deposit insurance assessment costs.  On the other hand, the law changes the deposit insurance assessment base so that it will generally be equal to consolidated assets less tangible equity.  This change of the assessment base from an emphasis on deposits to an emphasis on assets is generally considered likely to cause larger banking organizations to pay a disproportionately higher portion of future deposit insurance assessments, which may, correspondingly, lower the level of deposit insurance assessments that community banks like Customers Bank may otherwise have to pay in the future.  While it is likely that the new law will increase our future deposit insurance assessment costs, the specific amount by which the new law’s combined changes will affect our deposit insurance assessment costs is difficult to predict, particularly because the Dodd Frank Act gives the FDIC enhanced discretion to set assessment rate levels.

On February 7, 2011, the FDIC adopted a final rule modifying the risk-based assessment system and setting initial base assessment rates ranging from 2.5 to 45 basis points of Tier I capital.
 
 
 
 
 
- 84 -

 
 

 
As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, our initial base assessment rate was 9.00 and 14.10 basis points, respectively.

In addition to deposit insurance assessments, banks are subject to assessments to pay the interest on Financing Corporation bonds.  The Financing Corporation was created by Congress to issue bonds to finance the resolution of failed thrift institutions.  The FDIC sets the Financing Corporation assessment rate every quarter.  The Financing Corporation assessment for the fourth quarter of 2011 was an annual rate of 1 basis point.

Community Reinvestment Act .  Under the CRA, the record of a bank holding company and its subsidiary banks must be considered by the appropriate Federal banking agencies, including the Federal Reserve Board, in reviewing and approving or disapproving a variety of regulatory applications including approval of a branch or other deposit facility, office relocation, a merger and certain acquisitions of bank shares.  Federal banking agencies have recently demonstrated an increased readiness to deny applications based on unsatisfactory CRA performance. The Federal Reserve Board is required to assess our record to determine if we are meeting the credit needs of the community (including low and moderate neighborhoods) that we serve.  The Financial Institutions Reform, Recovery, and Enforcement Act of 1989 amended the CRA to require, among other things, that the Federal Reserve Board make publicly available an evaluation of our record of meeting the credit needs of our entire community including low- and moderate-income neighborhoods.  This evaluation includes a descriptive rating (outstanding, satisfactory, needs to improve, or substantial noncompliance) and a statement describing the basis for the rating.

Consumer Protection Laws .  We are subject to a variety of consumer protection laws, including the Truth in Lending Act, the Truth in Savings Act adopted as part of the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991 (“FDICIA”), the Equal Credit Opportunity Act, the Home Mortgage Disclosure Act, the Electronic Funds Transfer Act, the Real Estate Settlement Procedures Act and the regulations adopted thereunder.  In the aggregate, compliance with these consumer protection laws and regulations involves substantial expense and administrative time on our part.
  
Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act.      The Dodd-Frank Act was enacted by Congress on July 15, 2010, and was signed into law by President Obama on July 21, 2010.  Among many other provisions, the legislation: 

·  
established the Financial Stability Oversight Council, a federal agency acting as the financial system’s systemic risk regulator with the authority to review the activities of significant bank holding companies and non-bank financial firms, to make recommendations and impose standards regarding capital, leverage, conflicts and other requirements for financial firms and to impose regulatory standards on certain financial firms deemed to pose a systemic threat to the financial health of the U.S. economy;

·  
created a new Consumer Financial Protection Bureau within the Federal Reserve, which will have substantive rule-making authority over a wide variety of consumer financial services and products, including the power to regulate unfair, deceptive, or abusive acts or practices;

·  
provides state attorney generals and other state enforcement authorities broader power to enforce consumer protection laws against banks;

·  
authorizes federal regulatory agencies to ban compensation arrangements at financial institutions that give employees incentives to engage in conduct that could pose risks to the nation’s financial system;

·  
grants the U.S. government resolution authority to liquidate or take emergency measures with regard to troubled financial institutions, such as bank holding companies, that fall outside the existing resolution authority of the FDIC;

·  
gives the FDIC substantial new authority and flexibility in assessing deposit insurance premiums, which may result in increased deposit insurance premiums for us in the future;

·  
increased the deposit insurance coverage limit for insurable deposits to $250,000 generally, and removes, until December 31, 2012, the limit entirely for transaction accounts;

·  
permits banks to pay interest on business demand deposit accounts;
 
 
 
 
 
- 85 -

 
 

 
·  
extends the national bank lending (or loans-to-one-borrower) limits to other institutions like us;

·  
prohibits banks subject to enforcement action (such as a memorandum of understanding) from changing their charter without the approval of both their existing charter regulator and their proposed new charter regulator; and

·  
imposes new limits on asset purchase and sale transactions between banks and their insiders.

Many of these provisions are subject to further rule making and to the discretion of regulatory bodies, including our primary federal banking regulator, the Federal Reserve.  It is not possible to predict at this time the extent to which regulations authorized or mandated by the Dodd-Frank Act will impose requirements or restrictions on us in addition to or different from the provisions summarized above.

Memorandum Of Understanding
 
As a result of a March 31, 2009 regulatory examination prior to the arrival of new management, we entered into an August 24, 2009 Memorandum of Understanding (“MOU”) with our regulators that called for a back-up Bank Secrecy Act officer and employee training, and precluded us from declaring or paying dividends that would cause our capital ratios to fall below the higher of the minimum levels for a “well capitalized” classification under Prompt Corrective Action standards or the internal ratios set in our capital plan, or redeeming our stock or issuing debt with maturity greater than one year without prior regulatory approval.  The MOU required us to update plans relating to earnings and capital improvement, management and board oversight, credit risk management and liquidity risk, to enhance pre-purchase analysis of investment securities, and to revise to our allowance for loan and lease losses (“ALLL”) methodology by November 15, 2009. Management believes that we are in substantial compliance with all terms of the MOU at this time.
 
Bank Holding Company Regulation
 
As a bank holding company, we are also subject to additional regulation.  The Bank Holding Company Act requires us to secure the prior approval of the Federal Reserve Board before we own or control, directly or indirectly, more than five percent (5%) of the voting shares or substantially all of the assets of any bank.  It also prohibits acquisition by the Company of more than five percent (5%) of the voting shares of, or interest in, or all or substantially all of the assets of, any bank located outside of the state in which a current bank subsidiary is located unless such acquisition is specifically authorized by laws of the state in which such bank is located.  A bank holding company is prohibited from engaging in or acquiring direct or indirect control of more than five percent (5%) of the voting shares of any company engaged in non-banking activities unless the Federal Reserve Board, by order or regulation, has found such activities to be so closely related to banking or managing or controlling banks as to be a proper incident thereto.  In making this determination, the Federal Reserve Board considers whether the performance of these activities by a bank holding company would offer benefits to the public that outweigh possible adverse effects.  Applications under the Bank Holding Company Act and the Change in Control Act are subject to review, based upon the record of compliance of the applicant with the CRA.
 
We are required to file an annual report with the Federal Reserve Board and any additional information that the Federal Reserve Board may require pursuant to the Bank Holding Company Act.  Further, under Section 106 of the 1970 amendments to the Bank Holding Company Act and the Federal Reserve Board’s regulations, a bank holding company and its subsidiaries are prohibited from engaging in certain tie-in arrangements in connection with any extension of credit or provision of credit or provision of any property or services.  The so-called “anti-tie-in” provisions state generally that we may not extend credit, lease, sell property or furnish any service to a customer on the condition that the customer provide additional credit or service to us, to Customers Bank or to any of our other subsidiaries or on the condition that the customer not obtain other credit or service from a competitor of us, Customers Bank, or any other subsidiary.
 
The Federal Reserve Board permits bank holding companies to engage in non-banking activities so closely related to banking or managing or controlling banks as to be a proper incident thereto.  A number of activities are authorized by Federal Reserve Board regulations, while other activities require prior Federal Reserve Board approval.  The types of permissible activities are subject to change by the Federal Reserve Board.

 
 
 
- 86 -

 
 
 
 
 
Properties
 
The table below summarizes our leases of branch and office properties, by county, as of December 31, 2011.  We do not currently own any real property.

County
     
State
   
Number
 
Bank Branches
             
Berks
(1)
   
PA
   
4
 
Bucks
     
PA
   
3
 
Chester
(2)
   
PA
   
4
 
Delaware
     
PA
   
1
 
Mercer
     
NJ
   
1
 
Westchester
     
NY
   
1
 
             
14
 
                 
Administrative Office Locations
           
Berks
(3)
   
PA
   
4
 
Chester
(2)
   
PA
   
2
 
Mercer
(4)
   
NJ
   
1
 
Westchester
(5)
   
NY
   
1
 
             
8
 
 
(1) Includes the full service branch at 1001 Penn Avenue, Wyomissing, PA as well as three branches acquired through the Berkshire Bancorp, Inc. acquisition.
 
(2) Includes the corporate headquarters of Customers Bank and a full service branch located in a freestanding building at 99 Bridge Street, Phoenixville, PA 19460, wherein we lease approximately 15,298 square feet on 2 floors.  The lease on this location expires in 2022.  Also includes the lease of 5,500 square feet of property at 513 Kimberton Road in Phoenixville, Pennsylvania where we maintain a full service commercial bank branch and corporate offices. The lease on this location expires in 2013.
 
(3) Includes the corporate headquarters of Customers Bancorp, which is located at 1015 Penn Avenue, Wyomissing, PA.  The leased space covers a total of 8,000 square feet.  This lease expires in 2015.  Also, includes the administrative offices for the corporate lending group which is housed within the Exeter branch location and two other administrative offices for Company personnel.  The leases on these locations expire in 2013 and 2014.
 
(4) We lease 5,059 square feet of space in Hamilton, New Jersey from which we conduct our mortgage warehouse and retail lending activities. The lease on this location expires in 2015.
 
(5) Represents the former Port Chester branch location which is currently being utilized as space for administrative offices.
 
The bank branch locations, which range in size from approximately 2,300 to 3,300 square feet have leases on these locations which expire between 2013 and 2021.
 
The total minimum cash lease payments for our current branches, administrative offices and mortgage warehouse lending locations amount to approximately $157,000 per month.
 
Legal Proceedings

Although from time to time we are involved in various legal proceedings in the normal course of business, other than as described below, there are no material legal proceedings to which we are a party or to which our property is subject.

On November 15, 2010, Customers Bank filed suit against Open Solutions, Inc. (“OSI”) in the United States District Court for the Eastern District of Pennsylvania, seeking damages for failure to assist in the conversion of system and customer information associated with the former USA Bank and requesting injunctive relief to compel OSI to assist with the deconversion of the former USA Bank’s systems. OSI filed counterclaims against Customers Bank on November 24, 2010, asserting claims for breach of contract and breach of settlement agreement. In support of its breach of contract claim, OSI alleged that Customers Bank “assumed” the former-USA Bank agreements and is bound by those agreements. OSI claimed that it has sustained damages in excess of $1 million. Customers Bank disputed that it has any liability to OSI. Prior to trial, OSI dismissed with prejudice its settlement agreement claim.  Trial was held on February 24, 2011.  On March 7, 2011, the Court ruled against Customers Bank and in favor of OSI as follows: judgment was entered against Customers Bank on OSI’s claim that the agreements between OSI and USA Bank were assumed by Customers Bank and judgment was entered against Customers Bank on its claims against OSI; judgment was entered for OSI on its breach of contract claim under one agreement, in the amount of $104,000; the Court found there was no breach of the second agreement by Customers Bank and no proof of damages.  OSI has filed a motion for payment of legal fees and costs associated with the litigation, which are estimated to be approximately $205,000.  Customers Bank has filed a motion with the Court to vacate the judgment and to enter judgment in favor of Customers Bank on OSI’s counterclaim.  In addition, the FDIC has filed a motion to intervene in the litigation, and has also sought dismissal of OSI’s counterclaims on jurisdictional grounds.  On May 3, 2011, the Court granted the FDIC’s motion to intervene, and directed that OSI respond to the motion to dismiss the counterclaim.  On August 9, 2011, the Court granted the FDIC’s motion to dismiss and vacated the judgment entered against Customers Bank.  The Court denied the Bank’s post-trial motion as moot because of the Court’s vacatur of the judgment.   On September 2, 2011, OSI filed a notice of appeal to the United States Court of Appeals for the Third Circuit, in which OSI appeals from the Court’s August 9, 2011 Order granting the FDIC’s motion to dismiss.  The Third Circuit has not yet set a schedule for briefing or argument.   
 
 
 
- 87 -

 
 
 
 
 
The names, ages, positions and business backgrounds of each of the directors and executive officers of Customers Bancorp are provided below.
 
OUR BOARD OF DIRECTORS AND MANAGEMENT
The board members of Customers Bancorp are:
Name
 
Director Since*
 
Position
 
Age
 
Term Expires:
John R. Miller
 
2010
 
Director
 
65
 
2013
Daniel K. Rothermel
 
2009
 
Director, Lead Independent Director
 
73
 
2013
Jay S. Sidhu
 
2009
 
Director, Chairman and Chief Executive Officer
 
60
 
2012
T. Lawrence Way
 
2005
 
Director
 
63
 
2014
Steven J. Zuckerman
 
2009
 
Director
 
47
 
2014

*Includes services as a director of Customers Bank prior to the Reorganization.

Below are the biographies of our directors, as well as information on their experience, qualifications and skills that support their service as a director of Customers Bancorp:

Jay S. Sidhu, Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of Customers Bancorp and Customers Bank

Mr. Sidhu has served as Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of Customers Bank since the second quarter of 2009 and of Customers Bancorp since its inception in April 2010.  Before joining Customers Bank, Mr. Sidhu was the Chief Executive Officer of Sovereign Bank from 1989 until his resignation and retirement in October 2006, and its Chairman from 2002 until December 2006.  He was the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of SIDHU Advisors, LLC, a Florida based private equity and financial services consulting firm, from 2007 to the first quarter of 2009.  He has received Financial World’s CEO of the year award and was named Turnaround Entrepreneur of the Year.  He has received many other awards and honors, including a Hero of Liberty Award from the National Liberty Museum.  Since 2010, Mr. Sidhu has been a director of Atlantic Coast Bank Financial Corp., the holding company for Atlantic Coast Bank, a federal savings bank with branches in Florida and Georgia, and has served as its Non-Executive Chairman of the board of directors since May 2011.  Mr. Sidhu has also served on the boards of numerous businesses and not-for-profits, including as a member of the board of Grupo Santander.  He obtained an MBA from Wilkes University and is a graduate of Harvard Business School’s Leadership Course.  Mr. Sidhu also helped establish the Jay Sidhu School of Business and Leadership at Wilkes University.

Mr. Sidhu’s demonstration of day-to-day leadership combined with his extensive banking sector experience provide the board with intimate knowledge of our direction and strategic opportunities.

Daniel K. Rothermel, Director

Mr. Rothermel has been the President and Chief Executive Officer of Cumru Associates, Inc., a private holding company located in Reading, Pennsylvania since 1989, and served over twenty years on the board of directors of Sovereign Bancorp and Sovereign Bank.  At Sovereign, he was lead independent Director and served on the Audit, Governance, and Risk Management Committee and was chairman of the Executive Committee.  He is a graduate of The Pennsylvania State University with a B.S. in Business Administration (finance and accounting) and of American University with a Juris Doctor.

Mr. Rothermel’s background as an attorney and general counsel, plus his extensive service as a director of Sovereign Bank provide unique and valuable perspective to the board.
 
 
 
- 88 -

 
 

 
John R. Miller, Director

Mr. Miller has been a member of the Board of Trustees of Wilkes University since 1996, including as Chairman of the Board of Trustees from 2005 to 2008. Mr. Miller is presently in a second term as Chairman of the Board of Trustees of Wilkes University commencing June 2011.  He has also been the Chairman of the Board of Trustees of the Osborn Retirement Community since 2006.  Mr. Miller served in various capacities as an accountant at KPMG, LLP from 1968 to January 2005, including a tenure as Vice Chairman from 1999 to 2004, as a member of the Board of Directors from 1993 to 1997, and as a member of the Management Committee from 1997 to 2004.  He was the Chairman of the United States Comptroller General’s Governmental Auditing Standards Advisory Council from 2001 to 2008.  He has received the Ellis Island Medal of Honor, recognizing distinguished Americans who have made significant contributions to the nation’s heritage.  Mr. Miller is a graduate of Wilkes University with a B.S. in Commerce and Finance and is registered as a certified public accountant in both Pennsylvania and New York.

Mr. Miller’s 36 years of experience at KPMG, LLP and 7 years as Chairman of the US Comptroller’s General Auditing Standards Advisory Council have given him valuable experience and insight into auditing, accounting and financial reporting, making him a valuable asset to Customers Bancorp’s board.

Our board of directors has determined that Mr. Miller is an “audit committee financial expert” within the meaning of the rules of the Securities and Exchange Commission.

T. Lawrence Way, Director

Mr. Way is the retired President, CEO and Chairman of the Board of Directors of Alco Industries, Inc., an employee-owned diversified manufacturing company.  Over his 34-year career with Alco, Mr. Way has held various positions at Alco, including serving as the President and CEO from October 2000 to September 2008, CEO from October 2008 to September 2010 and Chairman of the Board from 2004 to 2011.  He continued as a member of the Board of Directors of Alco and chaired its Audit Committee until February 9, 2012.  Mr. Way is a Certified Public Accountant, received a Master’s in Business Administration from Mount St. Mary’s College, a Juris Doctor degree from Rutgers-Camden School of Law, and graduated from Tufts University.  He has experience in varied management, finance, operations and mergers and acquisitions.

Mr. Way’s background as an attorney and certified public accountant, as well as his experience leading a company through the current economic, social and governance issues as Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of Alco Industries, Inc., make him well-suited to serve on the board.

Steven J. Zuckerman, Director

Mr. Zuckerman, President and CEO of Clipper Magazine, graduated from Franklin & Marshall College with a B.A. in Business Management in 1985.  While in college, he co-founded the Campus Coupon Clipper, a predecessor to Clipper Magazine, now, a full-service media company, with numerous subsidiaries, including Loyal Customer Club, Spencer Advertising & Marketing, Clipper Web Development, The Menu Company, Total Loyalty Solutions, Clipper Graphics and Clipper TV.  Clipper Magazine has over 550 individual market editions in over 31 states with 1,200 employees around the country, including approximately 500 in Lancaster County, Pennsylvania.  He is a partner in Opening Day Partners, owner and operator of the Atlantic League of Professional Baseball Teams and Stadiums in New Jersey, Maryland and South Central Pennsylvania.

Mr. Zuckerman’s experience in the advertising industry make him uniquely situated to provide the board with insight in the key areas of marketing and customer strategies.

Executive Officers

Richard Ehst, President and Chief Operating Officer of Customers Bancorp and Customers Bank - Age 66

Mr. Ehst has served as President and Chief Operating Officer of Customers Bank since August 2009 and of Customers Bancorp since its inception in April 2010.  Mr. Ehst served as Regional President for Berks County of Sovereign Bank from May 2004 until January 2007, and as Executive Vice President, Commercial Middle Market, Mid-Atlantic Division, of Sovereign Bank from January 2007 until August 2009.  Mr. Ehst also served as the Managing Director of Corporate Communications for Sovereign Bank from 2000 until 2004 where his responsibilities included reputation risk management and marketing services support systems.  Before joining Sovereign Bank in 2000, Mr. Ehst was an independent consultant to more than 70 financial institutions in the mid-Atlantic region, including Sovereign Bank, where he provided guidance on regulatory matters, mergers and acquisitions, and risk management.  Mr. Ehst also began serving as a Trustee of Albright College in 2010.  Mr. Ehst has also served as a director of Customers Bank since August 2009.
 
 
 
 
- 89 -

 

 
Thomas Brugger, Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer of Customers Bancorp and Chief Financial Officer of Customers Bank - Age 45

Mr. Brugger has served as Chief Financial Officer of Customers Bank since September 2009 and as Chief Financial Officer and Treasurer of Customers Bancorp since its inception in April 2010.  Prior to joining Customers Bank, Mr. Brugger was employed by Sovereign Bank for 15 years in the roles of Corporate Treasurer, Chief Investment Officer and Portfolio Manager.  At Sovereign Bank, Mr. Brugger was responsible for investment portfolio management, wholesale funding, liquidity, regulatory and economic capital, securitization, interest rate risk, business unit profitability, budgeting, and treasury operations.  He was Chairman of the Asset/Liability committee and all pricing committees.  In addition, he participated in 19 acquisitions while at Sovereign Bank.  Before Sovereign Bank, he worked in the treasury department and internal audit at Independence Bancorp.

Warren Taylor, President and Director of Community Banking for Customers Bank - Age 54

Mr. Taylor is the President and Director of Community Banking for Customers Bank.  He joined Customers Bank in July 2009.  Prior to Customers Bank, Mr. Taylor was employed by Sovereign Bank for 20 years in the role of Division President.  At Sovereign Bank, Mr. Taylor was responsible for retail banking in various markets in southeastern Pennsylvania and central and southern New Jersey.  Mr. Taylor was actively involved with team member selection from the branch manager role and higher.

Glenn A. Hedde, President of Mortgage Warehouse Lending for Customers Bank  - Age 51
 
Mr. Hedde is the President of Customers Bank Mortgage Warehouse Lending.  He joined Customers Bank in August 2009, and immediately prior to that he provided consulting services in the banking, mortgage banking and multi-family lending industries from August 2008 to July 2009.  Mr. Hedde was the President of Commercial Operations at Popular Financial Holdings, LLC from 2000 to 2008.  During his time at Popular Financial, Mr. Hedde was a member of a senior leadership team with direct responsibility for management of more than $300 million in mortgage warehouse lending assets.  Additionally, Mr. Hedde was responsible for business development, risk management, collateral operations and compliance at Popular Financial.  Mr. Hedde also previously worked in mortgage banking, business development, and credit quality management for various companies including GE Capital Mortgage Services, Inc. and PNC Bank.
 
BOARD GOVERNANCE
 
Director Independence

Of the directors of Customers Bancorp who have served since January 1, 2011, each of Messrs. Miller, Rothermel, Way and Zuckerman (who remain as current directors of Customers Bancorp) is considered independent, as independence for board members is defined under Nasdaq Rules.  Bhanu Choudrie, a director of Customers Bancorp in 2011 until September 14, 2011, was also deemed independent.  For the period in 2011 prior to the Reorganization, each of the following directors of Customers Bank were also considered independent under Nasdaq Rules: Bhanu Choudrie, Daniel Rothermel, T. Lawrence Way, Steven Zuckerman and John R. Miller.  Jay Sidhu, Richard Ehst and Kenneth Mumma also served as directors of Customers Bank in 2011 prior to the Reorganization but were not considered independent.  In determining these directors met the definition of an independent director, the board of directors considered routine banking transactions between Customers Bank or its affiliates and certain of the directors, their family members and businesses with whom they are associated, such as loans, deposit accounts, routine purchases of insurance or securities brokerage products, any overdrafts that may have occurred on deposit accounts, any contributions we made to non-profit organizations with whom any of the directors are associated, and any transactions that are discussed under “Transactions With Related Parties.”  In addition, when determining Mr. Zuckerman’s independence, the board considered and deemed immaterial certain advertising arrangements we have with Clipper Magazine and its affiliates, for which Mr. Zuckerman is the Chief Executive Officer.  See “Transactions With Related Parties” below for more detail on these relationships.

Information about Board Committees

The table below highlights the current membership composition of our directors on our board committees for Customers Bancorp:

Name
 
Executive
 
Audit
   
Compensation
 
Nominating and Corporate Governance
Daniel Rothermel
 
X
 
X
   
X
 
  X*
Jay Sidhu
 
X
             
T. Lawrence Way
 
X
 
  X*
       
X
Steven Zuckerman
           
X*
 
X
John R. Miller
     
X
       
X

* Committee Chair

 
 
- 90 -

 
 
In addition, for the period in 2011 prior to the Reorganization, Bhanu Choudhrie served as a member of the Customers Bank Audit Committee and Compensation Committee, Kenneth Mumma served as a member of the Customers Bank Executive Committee Daniel Rothermel served as a member of the Customers Bank Executive Committee, Audit Committee, Compensation Committee and Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee, John R. Miller served as a Member of the Customers Bank Audit Committee and Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee, Jay Sidhu served as a member of the Customers Bank Executive Committee, T. Lawrence Way served as a member of the Customers Bank Executive Committee, Audit Committee and Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee and Steven Zuckerman served as a member of the Customers Bank Compensation Committee and Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee.
 
Compensation Committee Interlocks and Insider Participation
 
Except for the relationships of  Mr. Zuckerman described below, none of the members of our Compensation Committee had any relationship requiring disclosure pursuant to Item 404 of Regulation S-K under the Securities Act nor any other interlocking relationships as defined by the SEC.  For the year ended December 31, 2011, Customers Bank paid, for advertising and marketing services, approximately $295,339 to Clipper Magazine and its division, Spencer Advertising Marketing.  Additionally, for the year ended December 31, 2011, Customers Bank paid, for promotional items, approximately $48,486 to Jaxxon Promotions, Inc.  Steven Zuckerman, a director of Customers Bancorp is the President and Chief Executive Officer of Clipper Magazine, an affiliate of Gannett Co., Inc., and holds 25% of the issued and outstanding capital stock of Jaxxon Promotions, Inc.
 
Risk Assessment of Compensation Policies and Practices
 
Our management team, with the assistance of compensation consultant Vistra Partners, LLC, conducted an assessment of the risks related to or arising from our compensation policies and practices. The Compensation Committee reviewed and discussed this risk assessment with management and Vistra Partners.  Based on this assessment, the Compensation Committee determined that any risks arising from our compensation policies and practices for our employees are not reasonably likely to have a material adverse effect on the Company.
 
Federal Reserve Board Application to Appoint Director
 
We submitted an application to the Federal Reserve Board (“FRB”) in 2011 requesting approval for Bhanu Choudhrie to serve as a director of Customers Bancorp, but have not yet received a determination from the FRB.  If approved by the FRB, we intend to appoint Mr. Choudhrie to be a director of Customers Bancorp, subject to his consent to serve as a director at such time.  If approved, his appointment may be subject to the board of directors increasing the size of the board or appointing Mr. Choudhrie to a vacancy (if one existed at the time).  Alternatively, the Board may seek to nominate Mr. Choudhrie as a director for election by the shareholders at the next annual meeting of shareholders.
 
Mr. Choudhrie, age 33, served as a director of Customers Bank since July 2009.  Mr. Choudhrie has been Executive Director of C&C Alpha Group Limited, a London based family private equity group, since November 2006, and was the Executive Director of C&C Business Solutions Ltd. from June 2003 to November 2006.  In July 2010, Mr. Choudhrie became a director of Atlantic Coast Financial Corporation, the holding company for Atlantic Coast Bank, a federal savings bank with branches in Florida and Georgia.   Mr. Choudhrie is a private equity investor with investments in the United States, United Kingdom, Europe and Asia.  C&C Alpha Group was founded in 2002.  The company, with global headquarters in London, has established offices in several countries.  Its team is comprised of entrepreneurs, financial analysts, project developers, project managers and strategy consultants.
 
Director Nominations
 
Our bylaws contain provisions that address the process by which a shareholder may nominate a director to stand for election to the board of directors at our Annual Meeting of Shareholders.
 
In evaluating director nominees, the Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee (the “Committee”) considers the following factors:
 
• The appropriate size of our board of directors and its committees;
 
• The perceived needs of the board for particular skills, background, and business experience;
 
• The skills, background, reputation, and business experience of nominees compared to the skills, background, reputation, and business experience already possessed by other members of the board; and
 
• The nominees’ independence.
 
There are no stated minimum criteria for director nominees, and the Committee may also consider such other factors as it may deem are in our best interests and the interests of our shareholders. The Committee does, however, believe it appropriate for at least one member of the board to meet the criteria for an “audit committee financial expert,” that a majority of the members of the board meet the definition of “independent director” under Nasdaq Rules, and that one or more key members of management participate as members of the board.
 
 
 
 
- 91 -

 
 
While we have no formal policy with respect to diversity on the board, in order to enhance the overall quality of the board’s deliberations and decisions, the Committee seeks candidates with diverse professional backgrounds and experiences, representing a mix of industries and professions with varied skill
sets and expertise.
 
The Committee identifies nominees by first evaluating the current members of the expiring class of directors willing to continue in service. Current members of the expiring class with skills and experience that are relevant to our business and who are willing to continue in service are considered for re-nomination, balancing the value of continuity of service by members of the expiring class with that of obtaining a new perspective.  If any member of the expiring class does not wish to continue in service or if the Committee or the board decides not to re-nominate a member for reelection, the Committee identifies the desired skills and experience of a new nominee, and discusses with the board suggestions as to individuals that meet the criteria. The Committee has not in the past engaged third parties to identify, evaluate, or assist in identifying potential nominees, but relies on community and business contacts it has established through its directors, officers and professional advisors to help it identify potential director candidates when a specific need is identified.
 
The Committee will evaluate any recommendation for a director nominee proposed by a shareholder. In order to be evaluated in connection with the Committee’s procedures for evaluating potential director nominees, any recommendation for director nominee must be submitted in accordance with our procedures for shareholder nominees described below. In particular, all nominations made by a shareholder must be made in writing, delivered or mailed by registered or certified mail, postage prepaid, return receipt requested, to the Secretary of the Company (at our corporate headquarters in Wyomissing, Pennsylvania) and received by the Secretary not less than ninety (90) days nor more than one hundred and twenty (120) days prior to any meeting of the shareholders called for the election of directors. If less than ninety seven (97) days’ notice of the meeting is given to the shareholders (which notice may be provided by press release reported by a national news service or an SEC filing pursuant to Section 13, 14 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (“Exchange Act”)), the nomination shall be delivered or mailed to the Secretary and received by the Secretary not later than the close of business on the seventh (7th) day following the day on which notice of the meeting was given to shareholders (whether by mailing the notice of meeting or such other means described above). Every nomination must include: (a) the consent of the person nominated to serve as a director if elected; (b) the name, age, business address and residence address of the nominee; (c) the principal occupation or employment of the nominee; (d) the number of shares of the Company beneficially owned by the nominee; (e) the name and address of the notifying shareholder; (f) the number of shares of the Company owned by the notifying shareholder; and (g) all other information relating to the nominee and the notifying shareholder that is required to be disclosed in solicitations of proxies for election of directors in an election contest, or is otherwise required, in each case pursuant to Regulation 14A under the Exchange Act and Rule 14a-11 there under (including such person’s written consent to being named in the proxy statement as a nominee).
 
Code of Conduct
 
Each of our directors, officers and employees are required to comply with the Customers Bancorp, Inc. Code of Conduct adopted by us.  The Code of Conduct sets forth policies covering a broad range of subjects and requires compliance with laws and regulations applicable to our business.  The Code of Conduct is available on our website at www.customersbank.com , under the “About Us-Corporate Governance-Code of Conduct” captions.  We will post to our website any amendments to the Code of Conduct, or waiver from the provisions thereof for executive officers or directors, under the “About Us-Corporate Governance-Code of Conduct” caption. 
 
EXECUTIVE COMPENSATION
 
COMPENSATION DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS
 
This Compensation Discussion and Analysis describes our executive compensation program and addresses how we made executive compensation decisions for our senior executive officers during fiscal year 2011.  The senior executive officers covered by this Compensation Discussion and Analysis are the “named executive officers” set forth in the Summary Compensation Table beginning on page 97 of this prospectus (“Summary Compensation Table”).
 
Compensation Objectives and the Focus of Compensation Rewards
 
Our compensation program is designed to attract highly qualified individuals, retain those individuals in a competitive marketplace for executive talent and motivate performance in a manner that maximizes corporate performance while ensuring that these programs do not encourage unnecessary or excessive risks that threaten the value of the Company. We seek to align individual performance with long-term strategic business objectives and shareholder value, and believe that the combination of executive compensation provided fulfills these objectives.
 
Currently, our executive compensation program has three key elements: (1) salary, (2) bonus, and (3) long-term equity incentives.  The mix of short term performance incentives versus long term incentives are reviewed annually by the Compensation Committee with the intention of achieving a reasonable balance of those incentives.  However, we do not have set percentages of short term versus long term incentives.  We also do not have a policy with respect to the mix between the cash and equity components of executive compensation, although as noted below certain portions of the annual bonus are paid in stock and subject to a long-term vesting period before payout.
 
 
 
- 92 -

 
 
 
Compensation philosophy is ultimately determined by the Board of Directors, based upon the recommendations of the Compensation Committee, which is comprised solely of independent directors as defined by the rules of Nasdaq.  Our Chief Executive Officer makes recommendations to the Compensation Committee concerning the compensation of other executive officers, but does not participate in establishing his own compensation.  As part of this process, the Compensation Committee reviews a report provided by its compensation consultant, Vistra Partners, LLC (“Consultant”), that compares each named executive officer’s compensation to peer group executive compensation (“Report”).  The Compensation Committee generally seeks to provide salary and bonus compensation to the named executive officers at approximately the median of its competitors in the banking industry as reported by a compensation survey.  In 2011, the Compensation Committee used the Towers Watson compensation survey for banks with assets below $2 billion, although the Compensation Committee (as ratified by the Board of Directors) generally paid salary and bonus levels for the named executive officers that were below the median due to the start-up nature of the Company at the time.  As the Company matured and experienced significant growth in 2011, the Compensation Committee determined to increase salaries in February 2012 and used the SNL Financial Survey for banks as the relevant peer group, which decision was ratified by our Board of Directors and are described below under “Salary.”  The Compensation Committee also reviewed the median salary and bonuses under the L.R. Webber survey as a market check on local compensation market practices.  The Compensation Committee retains the flexibility to consider, in its sole discretion, various subjective factors when making compensation decisions.
 
The guiding principle of our compensation philosophy is that the compensation of executive officers should be based primarily on the financial performance of the Company, and partially on individual performance.  While this “pay-for-performance” philosophy requires the Compensation Committee to first consider our profitability, the Compensation Committee does not intend to reward unnecessary or excessive risk taking.  These principles are reflected in the specific elements of the compensation program, particularly the bonus and long-term equity income programs, as described below.
 
Role of the Compensation and Corporate Governance Committee
 
The Compensation Committee assists the Board of Directors in discharging its responsibilities regarding our compensation and benefit plans and practices.  Authority granted to the Compensation Committee is established by the board of directors and also set forth in the charter of the Compensation Committee.  In 2011, the Compensation Committee strongly considered the recommendations of the Chief Executive Officer regarding the other named executive officers.  The recommendations of the Compensation Committee were presented for discussion and final approval at meetings of the full Board of Directors.
 
Specific Elements of the Compensation Program
 
Described below are the key elements of our compensation program for the named executive officers.
 
Salary
 
We believe that a key objective of the salary structure is to maintain reasonable “fixed” compensation costs, while taking into account the performance of the named executive officers.  Base salaries are reviewed annually by the Compensation Committee to determine if any base pay changes should be made for the named executive officers.  Base pay changes, if any, are normally determined after considering the executive’s current base pay position relative to the peer group as reflected in the Report, our performance and the individual’s contribution to that performance for the prior year and the national and regional economic conditions, their effect upon us and how the executive has dealt with them within his or her area of responsibility.  All of the named executive officers joined us in 2009 and did not receive any increase in salary for 2010.  In February 2011, the Compensation Committee reviewed the Report and, based on the recommendation of the Consultant, determined to increase the salary of the named executive officers, which decision was ratified by the Board of Directors and is disclosed in the Summary Compensation Table for 2011.  These salaries were generally set below the median salary for the peer group for their position with the Company.  In making this decision to increase salaries for 2011, the Compensation Committee also considered the strong performance of Customers Bank in 2010, including strong growth in assets, loans, customer base and return on equity, along with the Chief Executive Officer’s leadership in driving this performance.  With regard to the named executive officers other than the Chief Executive Officer, the Compensation Committee considered their contributions to the performance of Customers  Bank (overall and in their functional area) in 2010 as reported by the Chief Executive Officer and his recommendation to increase their salary.
 
Given our significant growth and evolution as a bank since 2009, including raising more than $100 million in equity, increasing assets to over $2 billion and significantly increasing our equity base, in February 2012 the Compensation Committee reviewed the existing salaries against the peer group as reflected in the Report and determined to increase the salaries for 2012, which decision was ratified by the Board.  The new salaries were generally set below the median for the peer group for their position, which 2012 salaries are disclosed in footnote 2 to the Summary Compensation Table.
 
 
 
- 93 -

 
 
 
Bonuses
 
Bonuses are designed to motivate executives by rewarding performance.  For all of the named executive officers other than Mr. Hedde, bonuses for 2011 were determined at the discretion of the Compensation Committee, which considered our financial performance, including strong growth in assets, loans, customer base and return on equity, along with the recommendations of the Chief Executive Officer with regard to the other named executive officers.  The decision of the Compensation Committee for 2011 bonuses was ratified by our Board of Directors.  Based on these considerations, in February 2012 the Compensation Committee reviewed the Report and determined to pay a bonus to these named executive officers that was below the median bonus of the peer group for their position, which decision was ratified by the Board.  The Chief Executive Officer also recommended these bonuses for the other executive officers, which was based on their respective contributions to the performance of the areas for which they are responsible. The amount of these cash bonuses for 2011 are disclosed in the footnotes to the “Bonus” column of the Summary Compensation Table for each of the named executive officers.
 
The 2011 bonus for Mr. Hedde is based on a bonus pool of 10% of the net profit of the mortgage warehouse division, which bonus pool is to be allocated among the employees of this division.  Mr. Hedde’s share of this bonus pool was determined by discussion between Mr. Hedde and the Chief Executive Officer in 2012 following the determination of the amount of the bonus pool, which amount was presented to the Compensation Committee as a recommendation from the Chief Executive Officer, and was also ratified by the Board.  Mr. Hedde was awarded a total bonus of $679,090, which constituted 58% of the total bonus pool for the mortgage warehouse division.  This bonus was paid 60% in cash and 40% in restricted stock units that vest on the third anniversary of the date of the award.  The restricted stock portion was implemented to encourage a long-term view for the operation of this division.
 
The named executive officers, including Mr. Hedde, were also given the opportunity to participate in our Bonus Recognition and Retention Plan, and each deferred the receipt of a portion of their cash bonus to receive restricted stock in lieu of cash, which restricted stock will vest if the executive officer continues to be employed for five years after the date of the bonus award.  See “Bonus Recognition and Retention Plan” for a description of this plan, along with the footnotes to the Summary Compensation Table for a description of the deferrals made by the named executive officers under this plan for their 2011 bonuses.  These awards of stock are subject to forfeiture if the executive does not remain employed over the five year vesting period, which services to incentivize and retain executives.
 
Long-Term Equity Incentive Compensation
 
Long-term incentive compensation is intended to motivate and retain executives and reward them based on long-term company performance.  The Compensation Committee believes that equity-based incentive arrangements are among the most effective means available to the Company of aligning the interests of executives with the objectives of shareholders generally, and of building their long term commitment to the organization.  Our shareholders have approved the Management Stock Purchase Plan, the 2010 Stock Option Plan, the Amended and Restated 2004 Incentive Equity and Deferred Compensation Plan, and the Bonus Recognition and Retention Program (referred to collectively as “equity compensation programs”).
 
Our equity compensation programs permit the Compensation Committee to grant stock options, restricted stock, and other types of awards on a discretionary basis, subject to ratification by the board of directors. Upon determination of our performance for the prior fiscal year, in February of each year the Compensation Committee assesses if it will grant long-term equity awards, although it may grant awards at any time of the year in its discretion for new hires, outstanding performance or otherwise.  In February 2011, the Compensation Committee granted Messrs. Taylor and Hedde options to purchase 16,666 and 8,333 shares of our Voting Common Stock, which award was ratified by our Board of Directors.  The Chief Executive Officer made the recommendation to pay these awards based on the strong performance of their respective business units.  In addition, pursuant to the terms of the employment agreement of each of Messrs. Sidhu, Ehst and Brugger, during 2011 they were each granted options to purchase common stock as a result of our successful capital raising activities and the acquisition of another bank.  Each of these options rewarded the executive for transactions to increase the value of the Company, and the structure of these options also serve to retain and incentivize the executive due to the five year vesting of these options and the further vesting condition that the fair value of the common stock increase by 50% before they become exercisable.  The options granted to Messrs. Taylor and Hedde have the same vesting provisions.
 
Given our significant growth and evolution as a bank since 2009, including raising more than $100 million in equity, increasing assets to over $2 billion and significantly increasing our equity base, in February 2012 the Compensation Committee determined to implement a restricted stock reward program that provided for the grant of restricted stock units to certain directors and senior executives of Customers and Customers Bank, which included awards to each of the named executive officers as set forth in the “Grant of Plan-Based Awards” table.  This decision of the Compensation Committee was ratified by the Board.  These awards create retention and value creation incentives as the restricted stock units vest if both (i) the holder remains employed through December 31, 2016 (subject to accelerated vesting upon a change of control), and (ii) our Voting Common Stock trades at greater than $18.90 per share, all as described in more detail under “2012 Restricted Stock Awards Program”.
 
Perquisites, Post-Retirement and Other Elements of Compensation for Executive Officers
 
In order to attract and retain qualified executives, we provides executives with a variety of benefits and perquisites, consisting primarily of retirement benefits through a 401(k) plan, executive life insurance, and the use of automobiles.  Details of the values of these benefits and perquisites that were paid to the named executive officers in 2011 may be found in the footnotes and narratives to the Summary Compensation Table.
 
 
 
- 94 -

 
 
 
Employment and Other Agreements
 
The Compensation Committee believes that it is in the best interest of the Company to promote stability and continuity of senior management.  The Compensation Committee seeks to obtain this goal by providing reasonable assurance to certain of its senior executives so they are not distracted from their duties, especially in light of the uncertainty caused by adverse market conditions and the continued consolidation in the banking industry.  Accordingly, we entered into employment agreements with Mr. Sidhu in 2009 and Messrs. Ehst and Brugger in 2011, the material elements of which are described in “Employee Benefits - Officer Employment Agreements.”  These employment agreements provide for severance to be paid to the executives in connection with a termination of employment, including severance following a change of control.  A summary of the estimated payments to be made as a result of these severance and change of control provisions are described under “Potential Payments Upon a Change of Control.”  All of these agreements that provide for severance payments following termination in connection with a change in control are structured as “double triggers” based on the Compensation Committee’s determination that such payments should only be made if we terminate the employee in connection with a change in control.  For the foregoing reasons, we also adopted a Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan for Mr. Sidhu.  See “Employee Benefits – Supplemental Executive Retirement  Plan for Chairman and Chief Executive Officer” and the “Pension Benefits” table for more information on this plan for Mr. Sidhu.
 
Consideration of Risk
 
Our compensation methods are discretionary and balance short and long-term goals for our executive officers.  The Compensation Committee strives to provide strong incentives to manage us for the long-term, while avoiding excessive risk taking in the short term.  Goals and objectives reflect a fair mix of quantitative and qualitative factors to avoid excessive reliance on a single performance measure.  As a matter of best practice, beginning in 2010, the Compensation Committee began to annually review the relationship between the risk management practices and the incentive compensation provided to the named executive officers to confirm that the incentive compensation does not encourage unnecessary and excessive risks.
 
Risk Management Checks and Balances
 
The Compensation Committee believes that the design and governance of our executive compensation program are consistent with best practices in risk management.  The design of the executive compensation program supports our risk management goals through an interlocking set of checks and balances.
 
 
· 
Rather than determining incentive compensation awards based on a single metric, the Committee applies its informed judgment taking into account factors such as quality and sustainability of earnings, successful implementation of strategic initiatives and adherence to risk and compliance policies and our other core values.
 
 
· 
To further ensure that executive officers are focused on long-term performance, a significant portion of our incentive awards (including bonuses paid in stock) are provided as long-term equity awards that do not become earned and paid until three to five years after the grant date.
 
 
· 
Use of equity awards aligns executive officers’ interests with the interests of shareholders, and their significant stock ownership further enhances this alignment.

Together, these features of the executive compensation program are intended to:
 
 
· 
Ensure that compensation opportunities do not encourage excessive risk taking;
 
 
· 
Focus executive officers on managing the Company towards creating long-term, sustainable value for shareholders; and
 
 
· 
Provide appropriate levels of realized rewards over time.

Compliance with Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code
 
The executive compensation arrangements are intended to be maintained in conformity with the requirements of Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code, which imposes certain restrictions on deferred compensation arrangements and tax penalties on the affected employees if their deferred compensation arrangements do not comply with those restrictions.
 
Compensation Committee Report
 
The Compensation Committee of the board of directors has reviewed and discussed with management the Compensation Discussion and Analysis required by Item 402(b) of Regulation S-K and, based upon this review and discussion, the Compensation Committee recommended to the board of directors that the  Compensation Discussion and Analysis be included in this prospectus.
 
 
 
- 95 -

 
 
Compensation Committee:
 
Steven Zuckerman, Chair
 
Daniel Rothermel
 
 
 
 

 
 
- 96 -

 
 
SUMMARY COMPENSATION TABLE
 
The table below sets forth the following information for each of the named executive officers for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2011: dollar value of (1) base salary and bonus earned; (2) stock awards and option awards; (3) all other compensation; and (4) total compensation.
 
Name & Principal
Position
Salary
($) (1)
 
Bonus
($)
 
Stock Awards
($) (7)
Option
Awards
($) (8)
All Other
Compensation
($) (9)
Total ($)
 
Jay S. Sidhu
  Chairman & CEO
300,000
150,000
(2)
300,000
 
976,212
13,454
1,739,666
 
Richard A. Ehst
  President & COO
225,000
84,375
(3)
56,250
 
146,433
14,250
526,308
 
Thomas R. Brugger
  EVP & Chief Financial Officer
225,000
56,250
(4)
112,500
 
146,433
16,704
556,887
 
Warren Taylor
  President and Director of
  Community Banking
190,000
37,500
(5)
75,000
 
55,230
--
357,730
 
Glenn A. Hedde
  President of Customers Bank
  Mortgage Warehouse Lending
190,000 164,400 (6)  624,290 (6)  27,615 5,662 1,011,967  

 
(1)
Represents annual salary for 2011.  The annual salary for each of the named executive officers was increased for 2012 to the following: Mr. Sidhu - $500,000; Mr. Ehst - $320,000 Mr. Brugger - $300,000; Mr. Taylor - $200,000; and Mr. Hedde - $200,000.
(2)
Mr. Sidhu earned a cash bonus of $300,000 for 2011; however, he elected to receive 50% in cash ($150,000) and to defer 50% of this bonus under the Bonus Recognition and Retention Program (“BRRP”) pursuant to which after a 5 year vesting period he will receive his deferred bonus, along with a Company match of $150,000 ($300,000 in total), in the form of 23,809 shares of Voting Common Stock plus any shares resulting from the deemed reinvestment of dividends on those 23,809 shares.  If Mr. Sidhu does not remain employed during this 5 year vesting period, he will forfeit the right to receive these shares.  See “Bonus Recognition and Retention Program” for more details regarding this deferral.
(3)
Mr. Ehst earned a cash bonus of $112,500 for 2011; however, he elected to receive 75% in cash ($84,375) and to defer 25% of this bonus under the BRRP pursuant to which after a 5 year vesting period he will receive his deferred bonus, along with a Company match of $28,125 ($56,250 in total), in the form of 4,464 shares of Voting Common Stock plus any of the shares resulting from the deemed reinvestment of dividends on those 4,464 shares.  If Mr. Ehst does not remain employed during this 5 year vesting period, he will forfeit the right to receive these shares.  See “Bonus Recognition and Retention Program” for more details regarding this deferral.
(4)
Mr. Brugger earned a cash bonus of $112,500 for 2011; however, he elected to receive 50% in cash ($56,250) and to defer 50% of this bonus under the BRRP pursuant to which after a 5 year vesting period he will receive his deferred bonus, along with a Company match of $56,250 ($112,500 in total), in the form of 8,928 shares of Voting Common Stock plus any of the shares resulting from the deemed reinvestment of dividends on those 8,928 shares.  If Mr. Brugger does not remain employed during this 5 year vesting period, he will forfeit the right to receive these shares.  See “Bonus Recognition and Retention Program” for more details regarding this deferral.
(5)
Mr. Taylor earned a cash bonus of $75,000 for 2011; however, he elected to receive 50% in cash ($37,500) and to defer 50% of this bonus under the BRRP pursuant to which after a 5 year vesting period he will receive his deferred bonus, along with a Company match of $37,500 ($75,000 in total), in the form of 5,952 shares of Voting Common Stock plus any of the shares resulting from the deemed reinvestment of dividends on those 5,952 shares.  If Mr. Taylor does not remain employed during this 5 year vesting period, he will forfeit the right to receive these shares.  See “Bonus Recognition and Retention Program” for more details regarding this deferral.
(6)
Mr. Hedde earned a cash bonus of $679,090 for 2011; however, pursuant to the terms of his bonus arrangement he is required to have a portion (60%) of his aggregate bonus for 2011 paid through the issuance of 32,150 restricted stock units.  These restricted stock units were granted in February 2012 under the Amended and Restated 2004 Incentive Equity and Deferred Compensation Plan (the “2004 Plan”), and they will become 100% vested on the third anniversary of the date of grant. With regard to the remaining 40% cash portion of the bonus ($274,000), Mr. Hedde elected to receive 60% of this amount in cash ($164,400) and to defer 40% of this amount under the BRRP pursuant to which after a 5 year vesting period this 40% ($109,600) of his 2011 bonus, along with an equal Company match of $109,600 ($219,200 in total)), will be paid through the issuance of 17,396 shares of Voting Common Stock under the 2004 Plan, plus any of the shares resulting from the deemed reinvestment of dividends on those 17,396 shares.  If Mr. Hedde does not remain employed during this 5 year vesting period, he will forfeit the right to receive these shares.  See “Bonus Recognition and Retention Program” for more details regarding this deferral.
 
 
 
 
- 97 -

 
 
 
(7)
Represents the aggregate grant date fair value calculated in accordance with FASB ASC Topic 718 of the stock awards described in footnotes 2-6 above.  The grant date fair values have been determined based on the assumptions and methodologies set forth in our 2011 financial statements included herein (Note 12-Stock Based Compensation Plans).
(8)
Represents the grant date fair value, as calculated in accordance with FASB ASC Topic 718 of option awards granted in 2011 under our 2010 Stock Option Plan (“2010 Stock Option Plan”).  See footnote 1 to the “Grant of Plan-Based Awards” table for more information on these options.  The grant date fair values have been determined based on the assumptions and methodologies set forth in our 2011 financial statements included herein (Note 12-Stock Based Compensation Plans).
(9)
The amounts listed in this column include matching 401(k) contributions paid under our 401(k) Retirement Savings and Profit Sharing Plan for each of Messrs. Sidhu, Brugger and Hedde, car allowance payments for each of Messrs. Ehst and Brugger, and a golf club membership for Mr. Ehst.  The Company provides Mr. Sidhu with an automobile which he primarily uses for business purposes.  All Other Compensation for Mr. Sidhu also includes the value attributable to Mr. Sidhu’s personal use of this automobile in 2011.

GRANTS OF PLAN-BASED AWARDS
 
The following table sets forth certain information regarding awards granted to each of our named executive officers with respect to 2011:
 
Name
Grant date
All other stock
awards: Number of
shares of Common Stock
(#) (1)
All other option
awards: Number of
shares of Common
Stock underlying options
(#) (2)
Exercise or base price of
option awards
($/Sh) (3)
Grant date fair value of
stock and
option awards ($) (4)
Jay S. Sidhu
1/31/2011
 
76,458
12.00
264,722
 
2/28/2011
 
33,516
12.00
108,604
 
3/7/2011
 
26,830
12.00
72,371
 
9/17/2011
 
62,399
13.20
205,761
 
9/30/2011
 
98,485
13.20
324,754
 
2/16/12
23,809
   
300,000
Richard A. Ehst
1/31/2011
 
11,468
12.00
39,708
 
2/28/2011
 
5,027
12.00
16,291
 
3/7/2011
 
4,024
12.00
10,856
 
9/17/2011
 
9,360
13.20
30,865
 
9/30/2011
 
14,773
13.20
48,714
 
2/16/12
4,464
   
56,250
Thomas R. Brugger
1/31/2011
 
11,468
12.00
39,708
 
2/28/2011
 
5,027
12.00
16,291
 
3/7/2011
 
4,024
12.00
10,856
 
9/17/2011
 
9,360
13.20
30,865
 
9/30/2011
 
14,773
13.20
48,714
 
2/16/2012
8,928
   
112,500
Warren Taylor
2/17/2011
 
16,666
12.00
55,230
 
2/16/2012
5,952
   
75,000
Glenn A. Hedde
2/17/2011
 
8,333
12.00
27,615
 
2/16/2012
17,396
   
219,200
 
2/16/2012
32,150
   
405,090


(1)
Represents restricted stock units received in lieu of cash bonuses earned for 2011 under the 2004 Plan as described in footnotes 2-6 to the “Summary Compensation Table.”  All restricted stock units are for shares of Voting Common Stock.  Excludes 24,479 restricted stock units issued to Mr. Hedde on February 17, 2011 under the 2004 Plan as they were issued in lieu of a portion of Mr. Hedde’s cash bonus earned for 2010.  See footnote 13 to the “Outstanding Equity Awards at Fiscal Year End Table” for more details on this award.
 
(2)
Includes options awarded on January 31, 2011, February 28, 2011, March 7, 2011, September 17, 2011 and September 30, 2011 to Messrs. Sidhu, Ehst and Brugger, which were awarded under the 2010 Stock Option Plan pursuant to the terms of their employment agreements.  See “Stock Option Grants in Connection with Recent Transactions” and “Officer Employment Agreements” for more details on these awards.  Also includes options awarded on February 17, 2011 to Messrs. Taylor and Hedde under our 2010 Stock Option Plan.  All of these awards vest on the fifth anniversary of the date of grant, subject to a condition that the value of our Voting Common Stock increase by 50% during the life of the option and subject to accelerated vesting in certain circumstances.  All of these options are non-qualified stock options and entitle the holder to purchase shares of Voting Common Stock.  However, the September 17, 2011 and the September 30, 2011 options awards to Mr. Sidhu were cancelled on March 6, 2012, and new options to purchase the same number of shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock upon the same terms (including the same exercise price and expiration date) were issued.  The cancellation and grant were done to correct an inadvertent mistake of originally awarding these as options to purchase shares of Voting Common Stock.
 
 
 
- 98 -

 
 
 
 
(3)
Exercise price for stock options is based on the sale price of the Voting Common Stock in the most recent private offering prior to the date the award is granted.
 
(4)
Represents the grant date fair value, as calculated in accordance with FASB ASC Topic 718 of these option or stock awards.  The grant date fair value has been determined based on the assumptions and methodologies set forth in the consolidated financial statements included herein (Note 12-Stock Based Compensation Plans).
 
Amended and Restated 2004 Incentive Equity and Deferred Compensation Plan
 
During 2004, our shareholders approved the 2004 Plan, which was amended and restated in September 2011 by approval of our shareholders.  Our board of directors amended and restated the 2004 Plan in March 2012 primarily to reflect changes effectuated by the Reorganization.  The purpose of the 2004 Plan is to promote the success and enhance our value by linking the personal interests of the members of the board of directors and our employees, officers and executives to those of our shareholders and by providing such individuals with an incentive for outstanding performance in order to generate superior returns to our shareholders. The 2004 Plan is further intended to provide us flexibility to motivate, attract and retain the services of members of our board of directors, employees, officers and executives.
 
The 2004 Plan is administered by the Compensation Committee of the board of directors or, in certain cases, by the full board of directors.  It provides for the grant of options, some or all of which may be structured to qualify as incentive stock options under Section 422 of the Code (“ISOs”) if granted to employees, and for the grant of stock appreciation rights, restricted stock and unrestricted stock up to a total of 500,000 shares of common stock.  Unless sooner terminated by the board, the 2004 Plan will expire ten (10) years from the date the 2004 Plan was approved by our shareholders, which was September 6, 2011.
 
Management Stock Purchase Plan
 
In December 2010, our shareholders approved our Management Stock Purchase Plan (the “Management Stock Purchase Plan”), which consisted of a pool of 233,334 shares of our Voting Common Stock that may be offered for purchase by senior management personnel at a deeply-discounted purchase price of $1.00 per share during a short election period.  As of March 6, 2012, no shares were available for grant under the Management Stock Purchase Plan, and the Management Stock Purchase Plan was terminated on March 6, 2012 by our board of directors.  The Management Stock Purchase Plan provided us with a flexible way to motivate, attract and retain the services of employees, officers and executives upon whose judgment, interest and special effort the successful conduct of our operations largely depend.  The Management Stock Purchase Plan was intended to promote our success and enhance our value by linking the personal interests of our executive and senior management-level employees to those of our shareholders, and by providing those individuals with an incentive for outstanding performance in order to generate superior returns to shareholders.
 
2010 Stock Option Plan
 
In December 2010, our shareholders approved the 2010 Stock Option Plan, which was amended and restated in March 2012 by our board of directors primarily to reflect changes effectuated by the Reorganization.  The 2010 Stock Option Plan provides for the grant of stock options to our management personnel, other employees and non-employee members of the board of directors.  The purpose of the 2010 Stock Option Plan is to promote our success and enhance our value by linking the personal interest of our employees, officers, executives and non-employee directors to those of our shareholders and by providing those individuals with an incentive for outstanding performance in order to generate superior returns to shareholders.  The 2010 Stock Option Plan provides flexibility for us to motivate, attract, and retain the services of our employees, officers, executives and non-employee directors upon whose judgment, interest and special effort the successful conduct of our operations largely depend.  The options can take the form of either tax-qualified ISOs or non-qualified stock options (“NQOs”), although only NQOs may be granted to non-employee directors.
 
The 2010 Stock Option Plan consists of a pool of the lesser of 3,333,334 shares of our Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock, or fifteen percent (15%) of the number of shares of Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock issued by us after December 31, 2009.  The 2010 Stock Option Plan is administered by the Compensation Committee of the board of directors or, in certain cases, by the full board of directors.  The maximum number of shares underlying options granted to any single participant during a fiscal year shall be 2,222,223 shares of common stock.  All employees are potentially eligible to receive options under the 2010 Stock Option Plan.  In making determinations regarding the potential eligibility of any employee, the Compensation Committee may take into account the nature of the services rendered by the employee, his or her present and potential contributions to our success and such other factors as the Compensation Committee in its discretion deems relevant.
 
 
 
- 99 -

 
 
 
The Compensation Committee is authorized to grant stock options to participants subject to the following terms and conditions: (1) the exercise price per share of an option must not be less than the fair market value of one share at the time the option is granted, and the term of an option must not be longer than ten (10) years from the date of grant; and (2) in the case of a participant who owns stock representing more than 10% of the total combined voting power of us at the time of the grant of an option to that participant, the option cannot qualify as an ISO unless the exercise price is at least 110% of the fair market value of the stock at the time of grant and the term is no longer than five years from the date of grant.
 
Unless sooner terminated by the board, the 2010 Stock Option Plan will expire ten (10) years from the date the 2010 Stock Option Plan was approved by our shareholders, which was December 9, 2010.  The termination of the 2010 Stock Option Plan must not affect any option that is outstanding on the termination date without the consent of the participant.  Offers granted under the 2010 Stock Option Plan are, by their terms, not transferable other than by will or laws of descent and distribution.  No right or interest of a participant in any offer may be pledged, encumbered, or hypothecated to or in favor of any party other than us, or be subject to any lien, obligation, or liability of that participant to any other party other than us; provided, however, that the foregoing must not be deemed to imply any obligation of ours to lend against or accept a lien or pledge of any offer for any reason.
 
Bonus Recognition And Retention Program
 
In December 2010, our shareholders approved the BRRP, which was amended and restated in March 2012 by our board of directors primarily to reflect changes effectuated by the Reorganization.  The BRRP provides specified benefits to a select group of management and highly compensated employees who contribute materially to our continued growth, development and future business success that are eligible under the BRRP.  Participation in the BRRP is limited to a select group of management and highly compensated employees, as determined by the Compensation Committee in its sole discretion.  From that group, the Committee selects, in its sole discretion, the employees who are eligible to participate in the BRRP, which always includes our Chief Executive Officer.
 
As a condition of participation, each selected employee must annually complete and return to the Committee (or its designee) the forms the Committee may prescribe, including an annual deferral election form.  Each election made by a participant to defer receipt of a portion of his or her bonus for a given calendar year must be filed no later than December 31 prior to the calendar year with respect to which the relevant bonus may be earned; provided, however, in the event an employee is hired during a plan year and is designated as being eligible to participate for that year, the employee may commence participation for that year by filing a deferral election within 30 days of employment.  Each eligible employee must file a new deferral election for each year with respect to which he or she desires to defer receipt of a portion of a bonus.
 
A participant may elect to defer receipt of not less than 25%, nor more than 50%, of his or her bonus payable with respect to each year of participation.  Shares of Voting Common Stock having a value equal to the portion of the bonus deferred by a participant will be allocated to an annual deferral account (the “Annual Deferral Account”) established by us for the year of deferral.  On the same day that the shares of common stock attributable to a deferred bonus are allocated to the Annual Deferral Account, a matching amount equal to an identical number of shares of common stock shall be allocated to the Annual Deferral Account.  The Annual Deferral Account shall be increased by that number of shares of common stock having a value equal to the amount of any cash dividend payable with respect to the number of shares of common stock allocated to the Annual Deferral Account. The BRRP is a formula based plan that does not provide for a maximum number of shares to be issued, but it is limited by the amount of the cash bonuses awarded annually to those persons selected to participate.
 
In the event a participant files a deferral election and subsequently terminates as an employee prior to the date bonuses are paid, if (a) he or she is entitled to a bonus notwithstanding termination and (b) the termination of employment is related to death, disability, or is involuntary or related to a change in control, then the bonus and the related matching amount shall be distributed to the individual or his or her beneficiary in cash or invested and so distributed in common stock, at the Compensation Committee’s election, within 60 days following the date that year’s bonuses are paid.
 
A participant becomes 100% vested in an Annual Deferral Account on the fifth anniversary date of the initial funding of the account, provided he or she remains continuously employed by us from the date of funding to the anniversary date.  Vesting is accelerated in the vent of involuntary termination other than for cause, retirement at or after age 65, death, termination on account of disability, or a change in control of the Company.
 
As of March 15, 2012, we have issued restricted stock units for 63,326 shares of Voting Common Stock under BRRP.
 
Stock Option Grants in Connection with Recent Transactions
 
In connection with recent private placement offerings of our stock, on each of January 31, February 28, March 7 and September 30, 2011 we granted 7-year nonqualified stock options to members of our senior management team under our 2010 Stock Option Plan for shares up to 15% of the offered shares.  Also, in connection with our recent acquisition of Berkshire Bancorp, on September 17, 2011, we granted 7-year nonqualified stock options to members of our senior management team for 15% of the shares issued in the acquisition.  Of the total 15% for each award, 10% were granted to Mr. Sidhu and 1.5% were granted to each of Messrs. Ehst and Brugger pursuant to the terms of their employment agreements, with the remaining 2% being granted to other employees (including Messrs. Hedde and Taylor).
 
 
 
 
- 100 -

 
 
As long as an individual to whom these options are granted remains an employee or director of ours, the options will vest 5 years from the date of grant, subject to earlier vesting upon a change in control of us or a termination without cause of the executive’s employment (but not, in the case of employees other than Mr. Sidhu, Mr. Ehst and Mr. Brugger, termination of employment upon voluntary resignation).  In the case of Mr. Sidhu, Mr. Ehst and Mr. Brugger, the options will vest upon his resignation for “Good Reason” in accordance with the provisions of his employment agreement but not upon any other voluntary resignation.  Even if vested, an award may not be exercised unless and until, at any time during the option life, the value of our Voting Common Stock appreciates by 50% above the value of the Voting Common Stock at the time the option was granted.
 
2012 Restricted Stock Rewards Program
 
Due to our significant growth and evolution as a bank since 2009, including raising more than $100 million in equity, increasing assets to over $2 billion and significantly increasing our equity base, in February 2012 the Compensation Committee recommended and the board of directors approved a restricted stock reward program that provided for the grant of restricted stock units to certain directors and senior executives of Customers Bancorp and Customers Bank.  Pursuant to the program, restricted stock units for 185,189 shares of our Voting Common Stock and 211,640 shares of our Class B Non-Voting Common Stock were granted on February 16, 2012 pursuant to the 2004 Plan.  Of this amount, our named executive officers received restricted stock units for 126,988 shares of Voting Common Stock and 211,640 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock in the aggregate and our non-employee directors received 15,876 shares of Voting Common Stock in the aggregate.  One requirement for vesting is that the recipient of the restricted stock units remains an employee or director of ours, through December 31, 2016, subject to earlier vesting upon a change in control of us resulting in any one shareholder owning more than 24.9% of the outstanding stock of Customers Bancorp. The second vesting requirement for each award (both must be met to vest) is that our Voting Common Stock trades at a price greater than $18.90 per share (adjusted for any stock splits or stock dividends) for at least 5 consecutive trading days during the five year period ending December 31, 2016.  If the restricted stock units vest, the recipient will receive shares of our common stock on December 31, 2016.
 
Officer Employment Agreements
 
On June 17, 2009, we entered into a three-year employment agreement with Jay Sidhu as Chairman and CEO of Customers Bank.  Under the terms of the agreement Mr. Sidhu will receive a minimum base salary of $225,000 per year plus a performance-based incentive bonus and a car allowance of $1,000 per month.  As of each one year anniversary of June 17, 2009, the term of the agreement is to extend another year unless Mr. Sidhu or we give notice to the contrary.  Mr. Sidhu will also be entitled to cash or equity incentive compensation up to the amount of his base salary under an executive incentive plan to be approved by the board of directors.  Mr. Sidhu’s employment agreement also provides that, for every issuance of shares made by us in connection with an acquisition or a raise of capital, we must grant to Mr. Sidhu options or warrants to purchase up to 10% of the shares issued in such issuance.  Our board of directors and Mr. Sidhu intend that future equity compensation plans that provide for grants to management will be submitted for shareholder approval.  Our board of directors and Mr. Sidhu also intend that, to the extent of future capital raises up to $200 million, the 2004 Plan or the Stock Option Plan, or both, each as more fully described above in this prospectus, will be used to fulfill the provisions of Mr. Sidhu’s employment agreement requiring us to issue to Mr. Sidhu options or warrants to acquire up to 10% of the shares issued in connection with acquisitions or raises of capital.
 
Under the employment agreement, we also agreed that our board of directors will develop and implement a nonqualified retirement income plan designed to provide Mr. Sidhu with a retirement benefit, targeted at $200,000 per year (depending on performance of the investments in the informal funding vehicle) for 15 years commencing upon his retirement at or after age 65, subject to his ability to qualify for a variable life insurance policy to be owned by us to fund the plan.  The board of directors is to review the plan at the end of the fourth year of his employment and determine whether it is appropriate to increase the target benefit amount in light of his compensation at that time.  Under the employment agreement, Mr. Sidhu was to become vested in this retirement benefit after seven years of continuous service with us, or upon his termination of employment under circumstances that would result in our obligation to pay him severance compensation.  Ultimately, the plan (which was developed and approved by the board of directors) provided for funding towards a target benefit of $300,000 per year, and for immediate vesting upon the effective date of the plan.  See discussion of the “Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan for Chairman and Chief Executive Officer” on page 108 of this prospectus.
 
As of February 17, 2011, we also entered into a three-year employment agreement with Mr. Ehst, and a two-year employment agreement with Mr. Brugger, each of which replaced previous employment agreements that Messrs. Ehst and Brugger entered into with us on April 12, 2010.  As of each one year anniversary of February 17, 2011, the term of the agreement is to extend another year unless the executive or we give notice to the contrary.  Under the terms of these agreements, Messrs. Ehst and Brugger will receive minimum base salaries, plus incentive compensation in cash or equity or both and in such amounts as determined by the board of directors in accordance with incentive programs developed for them.  Each of Messrs. Ehst and Brugger’s employment agreements provide that, for every issuance of shares made by us in connection with an acquisition or a raise of capital, we must grant to such individual options to purchase up to 1.5% of the same type of security as was issued in such issuance.
 
 
 
 
- 101 -

 
 

 
In February and March 2012, the Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors recommended, and the Board approved certain amendments to the employment agreements of Messrs. Sidhu, Ehst and Brugger.  Based on this approval, we  entered into amended and restated employment agreements with each of Messrs. Sidhu, Ehst and Brugger on March 26, 2012 reflecting these amendments.  The amendments include changes resulting from the Reorganization, including  Customers Bancorp being the party to the agreement and the services of the executive being rendered principally in Wyomissing, Pennsylvania.  The amendments also amended the executives’ options to purchase a percentage of the shares issued in connection with an acquisition or capital raise.  However, the amendments to the options are subject to obtaining shareholder approval of a new plan or an amendment to the 2010 Stock Option Plan or the 2004 Plan to issue these awards.   Under the amendment to the options, beyond a threshold of $400 million of equity raised the amendment would reduce the percentages used to calculate the number of shares for the option to purchase and also remove the vesting requirement of achieving an appreciation in value of 50%.  In particular, for total equity issued by us since 2009 of up to $400 million (whether pursuant to an acquisition or capital raise) the terms of the options would remain the same as currently in effect, but from (i) $401 million to $749 million of equity the percentages for Messrs. Sidhu, Ehst and Brugger would decrease to 6.7%, 1% and 1%, respectively, and (ii) $750 million of equity and above the percentages for Messrs. Sidhu, Ehst and Brugger would decrease to 3.4%, 0.5% and 0.5%, respectively.  As of February 29, 2012, approximately $115 million of equity has been issued since 2009 pursuant to acquisitions or capital raises.
 
Each of Messrs. Sidhu, Ehst and Brugger will be entitled to severance compensation under the agreement if he terminates his employment for “Good Reason” (as defined in their respective employment agreements), if his employment is terminated by us other than for “Cause” (as defined in their respective employment agreements) during the employment term or on expiration of the employment term.  If a “Change in Control” (as defined in their respective employment agreements) has not occurred within twelve months before termination of employment, then:  (1) he will receive the sum of his then current base salary plus the average of his last three years’ annual cash bonuses, for the greater of (a) one year in the case of Mr. Sidhu and two years in the cases of Messrs. Ehst and Brugger, or (b) the period of time remaining in his employment term, generally payable in equal installments on his normal pay dates, subject to normal tax deductions and withholding; (2) any unvested equity awards he has received will vest in full; (3) he will be entitled to an allocable fraction of any cash bonus that would have been payable to him for the current year had he remained employed through the date of payment; and (4) we will continue to provide health insurance (including dental if applicable) and any life or disability insurance benefits (“health benefits”) for the shorter of the period on which his cash severance compensation is measured or the maximum period we are then permitted to extend his benefit under the applicable plan or policy or applicable law.  If a Change in Control shall have occurred within twelve months before termination of his employment, then:  (1) he will receive cash equal to three times the sum of his then current base salary plus the average of his annual cash bonuses for the immediately preceding three years, payable in a lump sum; (2) any unvested equity awards he has received will vest in full; (3) he will be entitled to an allocable fraction of any cash bonus that would have been payable to him for the current year had he remained employed through the date of payment; (4) we shall continue to provide health benefits for the shorter of three years or the maximum period we are then permitted to extend his benefit under the applicable plan or policy or applicable law; and (5) if applicable, reimbursement of any “parachute payment” excise tax under Section 4999 of the Code, grossed up to include any additional taxes payable on that benefit.
 
 
 
- 102 -

 
 

 
OUTSTANDING EQUITY AWARDS AT FISCAL YEAR END TABLE (1)

The following table sets forth information on outstanding warrants and options awards and stock awards held by the named executive officers at December 31, 2011, including the number of shares underlying each stock option and warrant, the exercise price and the expiration date of each outstanding option and warrant, and the number of shares and market value of stock awards.

 
 Option Awards
 
 Stock Awards
 
Name & Principal Position
Number of Securities
Underlying
Unexercised Warrants or Options
(#)
Exercisable
Number of Securities
Underlying
Unexercised Warrants or Options
(#)
Unexercisable
Warrant or Option
Exercise
Price
($)
Warrant or Option
Expiration Date
 
 Number of shares or units of stock that have not vested
(#)
 Market value of shares or units of stock that have not vested
(#)(15)
Jay S. Sidhu
195,596 (2)
-   
 
10.50
6/30/2016
 
-
-
 
  Chairman & CEO
21,891 (2)
-   
 
10.50
9/30/2016
 
-
-
 
 
60,632 (2)
-   
 
10.50
11/13/2016
 
-
-
 
 
-
448,753
(3)
9.75
4/6/2017
 
-
-
 
 
-
11,666
(4)
10.50
7/14/2017
 
-
-
 
 
-
74,420
(5)
12.00
12/28/2017
 
-
-
 
 
-
76,458
(6)
12.00
1/31/2018
 
-
-
 
 
-
33,516
(7)
12.00
2/28/2018
 
-
-
 
 
-
26,830
(8)
12.00
3/7/2018
 
-
-
 
 
-
62,399
(9)
13.20
9/17/2018
 
-
-
 
 
-
98,485
(10)
13.20
9/30/2018
 
-
-
 
 
-
-   
 
-
-
 
23,809(11)
299,993
 
Richard A. Ehst
-
67,313
(3)
9.75
4/6/2017
 
-
-
 
  President & COO
-
1,750
(4)
10.50
7/14/2017
 
-
-
 
 
-
11,163
(5)
12.00
12/28/2017
 
-
-
 
 
-
11,468
(6)
12.00
1/31/2018
 
-
-
 
 
-
5,027
(7)
12.00
2/28/2018
 
-
-
 
 
-
4,024
(8)
12.00
3/7/2018
       
 
-
9,360
(9)
13.20
9/17/2018
       
 
-
14,773
(10)
13.20
9/30/2018
       
 
-
-   
 
-
-
 
4,464(11)
56,246
 
Thomas R. Brugger
-
67,313
(3)
9.75
4/6/2017
 
-
-
 
  EVP & Chief Financial Officer
-
1,750
(4)
10.50
7/14/2017
 
-
-
 
 
-
11,163
(5)
12.00
12/28/2017
 
-
-
 
 
-
11,468
(6)
12.00
1/31/2018
 
-
-
 
 
-
5,027
(7)
12.00
2/28/2018
 
-
-
 
 
-
4,024
(8)
12.00
3/7/2018
 
-
-
 
 
-
9,360
(9)
13.20
9/17/2018
 
-
-
 
 
-
14,773
(10)
13.20
9/30/2018
       
 
-
-   
 
-
-
 
8,928(11)
112,493
 
Warren Taylor
-
16,666
(3)
9.75
4/6/2017
 
-
-
 
  President and Director of
-
16,666
(12)
12.00
2/17/2018
 
-
-
 
  Community Banking
-
-   
 
-
-
 
5,952(11)
74,995
 
Glenn A. Hedde
-
3,333
(3)
9.75
4/6/2017
       
  President of Customers Bank
-
8,333
(12)
12.00
2/17/2018
       
  Mortgage Warehouse Lending
-
-
 
-
-
 
24,479(13)
308,435
 
 
-
-
 
-
-
 
17,396(11)
219,190
 
 
-
-
 
-
-
 
32,150(14)
405,090
 

(1)
Except as otherwise noted in a footnote, all awards relate to shares of Voting Common Stock. Includes 92,699 restricted stock units held by the named executive officers that were awarded on February 16, 2012 in lieu of a cash bonus for 2011.  See footnote 1 to the “Grants of Plan-Based Awards” table.  Excludes 338,624 restricted stock units held by the named executive officers that were awarded on February 16, 2012 pursuant to a restricted stock reward program.  See “2012 Restricted Stock Rewards Program” for more details on these awards.
 
(2)
Represents immediately exercisable warrants to purchase our Voting Common Stock granted to Mr. Sidhu in connection with an agreement between Customers Bancorp and Mr. Sidhu relating to the 2009 private offerings.
 
 
 
- 103 -

 
 
 
 
(3)
This stock option vests on the fifth anniversary of the date of grant (April 6, 2015), subject to a condition that the value of our Voting Common Stock increase by 50% during the life of the option and subject to accelerated vesting in certain circumstances.
 
(4)
This stock option vests on the fifth anniversary of the date of grant (July 14, 2015), subject to a condition that the value of our Voting Common Stock increase by 50% during the life of the option and subject to accelerated vesting in certain circumstances.
 
(5)
This stock option vests on the fifth anniversary of the date of grant (December 28, 2015), subject to a condition that the value of our Voting Common Stock increase by 50% during the life of the option and subject to accelerated vesting in certain circumstances.
 
(6)
This stock option vests on the fifth anniversary of the date of grant (January 31, 2016), subject to a condition that the value of our Voting Common Stock increase by 50% during the life of the option and subject to accelerated vesting in certain circumstances.  See “Stock Option Grants in Connection with Recent Transactions” and “Officer Employment Agreements” for more details on these awards.
 
(7)
This stock option vests on the fifth anniversary of the date of grant (February 28, 2016), subject to a condition that the value of our Voting Common Stock increase by 50% during the life of the option and subject to accelerated vesting in certain circumstances.  See “Stock Option Grants in Connection with Recent Transactions” and “Officer Employment Agreements” for more details on these awards.
 
(8)
This stock option vests on the fifth anniversary of the date of grant (March 7, 2016), subject to a condition that the value of our Voting Common Stock increase by 50% during the life of the option and subject to accelerated vesting in certain circumstances.  See “Stock Option Grants in Connection with Recent Transactions” and “Officer Employment Agreements” for more details on these awards.
 
(9)
This stock option vests on the fifth anniversary of the date of grant (September 17, 2016), subject to a condition that the value of our Voting Common Stock increase by 50% during the life of the option and subject to accelerated vesting in certain circumstances.  While this option entitled Mr. Sidhu to purchase 62,399 shares of Voting Common Stock, his option was cancelled on March 6, 2012 and a new option to purchase the same number of shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock upon the same terms (including the same exercise price and expiration date) was issued.  The cancellation and grant were done to correct an inadvertent mistake of originally issuing these as options to buy shares of Voting Common Stock.
 
(10)
This stock option vests on the fifth anniversary of the date of grant (September 30, 2016), subject to a condition that the value of our Voting Common Stock increase by 50% during the life of the option and subject to accelerated vesting in certain circumstances.  See “Stock Option Grants in Connection with Recent Transactions” and “Officer Employment Agreements” for more details on these awards.  While this option entitled Mr. Sidhu to purchase 98,485 shares of Voting Common Stock, his option was cancelled on March 6, 2012 and a new option to purchase the same number of shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock upon the same terms (including the same exercise price and expiration date) was issued.  The cancellation and grant were done to correct an inadvertent mistake of originally issuing these as options to buy shares of Voting Common Stock.
 
(11)
The restricted stock units vest on the fifth anniversary of their grant date (February 16, 2017).
 
(12)
This stock option vests on the fifth anniversary of the date of grant (February 17, 2016), subject to a condition that the value of our Voting Common Stock increase by 50% during the life of the option and subject to accelerated vesting in certain circumstances.  See “Stock Option Grants in Connection with Recent Transactions” for more details on these awards.
 
(13)
The restricted stock units vest on the third anniversary of their grant date (February 17, 2014).
 
(14)
The restricted stock units vest on the third anniversary of their grant date (February 16, 2015).
 
(15)
Market value was determined using the tangible common book value ($12.60 per share) as of December 31, 2011.
 
 
 
 
- 104 -

 
 

 
The following Nonqualified Deferred Compensation table summarizes activity during 2011 and the account balance as of December 31, 2011 for our non-qualified defined contribution plans that provide for the deferral of compensation.
 
NONQUALIFIED DEFERRED COMPENSATION
 
Name
 
 
 
 
Executive Contributions in Last FY
($)
 
Registrant
Contributions
in Last FY
($)
 
Aggregate Earnings
in Last FY
($)
 
Aggregate
Withdrawals/
Distributions
($)
 
Aggregate
Balance
at Last FY
($)
 
Jay S. Sidhu (1)
-
-
103,322
-
2,485,492
           

(1)
Represents the supplemental executive retirement plan (“SERP”) for Mr. Sidhu.   As a result of the acquisition of USA Bank on July 9, 2010, Mr. Sidhu’s SERP became effective and Mr. Sidhu is entitled to receive the balance of the SERP account payable over 15 years commencing upon the later of his separation from service or his 65th birthday. If Mr. Sidhu dies prior to his payment commencement date, his beneficiary receives a lump sum payment equal to $3,000,000. If Mr. Sidhu dies after reaching age 65, his beneficiary receives the remainder of his scheduled retirement benefits. If Customers Bank terminates Mr. Sidhu’s employment for cause, he forfeits the benefits provided under the SERP.  See “Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan for Chairman and Chief Executive Officer” for more details on Mr. Sidhu’s SERP.
 
Potential Payments upon Termination or Change in Control
 
The tables below show the value of estimated payments pursuant to the employment agreements, equity plans and other plans described above upon a termination of employment, including gross-up payments for any excise tax on the parachute payments upon a change of control, for each of Messrs. Sidhu, Ehst and Brugger.  All termination events are assumed to occur on December 31, 2011. The payments represent the maximum possible payments under interpretations and assumptions most favorable to the executive officer, including assuming that the salary increases awarded in February 2012 were effective as of December 31, 2011. The amounts shown in the tables include estimates of amounts that would be paid to the executive upon the occurrence of the specified event. The actual amounts to be paid to the named executive officers can only be determined at the time of their termination and may be more or less than the amounts contained in the tables and the various agreements and plans.  See “Officer Employment Agreements” for more details.
 
Jay S. Sidhu
 
Assuming one of the following events had occurred on December 31, 2011, Mr. Sidhu’s payments and benefits had an estimated value as follows:
 
 
Termination Without Cause
or Good Reason(6)
 
Termination in Connection with
Change in Control(6)
 
 
Death
Base Salary(1)
$1,230,000
 
$1,500,000
 
$-
Bonus(2)
609,877
 
914,816
 
-
Value of Health and Welfare Benefits(3)
43,262
 
52,757
 
-
Death Benefit (4)
-
 
-
 
3,000,000
Tax Gross Up(5)
-
 
-
 
-
TOTAL
$1,883,139
 
$2,467,573
 
$3,000,000
 
 
 
 
- 105 -

 
 

 
Richard A. Ehst
 
Assuming one of the following events had occurred on December 31, 2011, Mr. Ehst’s payments and benefits had an estimated value as follows:
 
 
Termination Without Cause or Good Reason(6)
 
Termination in Connection with Change in Control(6)
 
Death
Base Salary(1)
$681,600
 
$960,000
 
$-
Bonus(2)
199,380
 
280,817
 
-
Value of Health and Welfare Benefits(3)
26,947
 
37,953
 
-
Death Benefit(4)
-
 
-
 
500,000
Tax Gross Up(5)
-
 
533,068
 
-
TOTAL
$907,927
 
$1,811,838
 
$500,000


Thomas R. Brugger
 
Assuming one of the following events had occurred on December 31, 2011, Mr. Brugger’s payments and benefits had an estimated value as follows:
 
 
Termination Without Cause or Good Reason(6)
 
Termination in Connection with Change in Control (6)
 
 
Death
Base Salary(1)
$600,000
 
$900,000
 
$-
Bonus(2)
151,390
 
227,085
 
-
Value of Health and Welfare Benefits(3)
19,454
 
29,181
 
-
Death Benefit(4)
-
 
-
 
200,000
Tax Gross Up(5)
-
 
453,682
 
-
TOTAL
$770,844
 
$1,609,948
 
$200,000

(1)
Represents continuation of salary payments for the payout period provided under each named executive officer’s applicable employment agreement.
 
(2)
Represents payment of an amount representing the average of the executive’s cash bonuses for the two fiscal years preceding the fiscal year of termination (2010 and 2009) over the payout period provided under each named executive officer’s applicable employment agreement.  Reflects no bonus for 2011 because the assumed termination date was December 31, 2011; assumes no discretionary bonuses would be awarded in the first quarter of 2012 for 2011 performance of the former employee.
 
(3)
Represents payment of premiums for continued health and other welfare benefit insurance over the payout period provided under each named executive officer’s applicable employment agreement.
 
(4)
In Mr. Sidhu’s case, represents an uninsured death benefit payable under his Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan.  In the cases of Mr. Ehst and Mr. Brugger, represents the proceeds of group term life insurance, the premiums for which are paid by us.
 
(5)
Represents estimated cash payment to reimburse the executives for their “golden parachute” excise tax liability under Section 4999 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986 attributable to payments contingent upon a change in control, plus the regular taxes and additional excise tax on the reimbursement.  The calculation of the reimbursement assumes that each executive’s total marginal rate of Federal, State and Local taxes is 40%.  Mr. Sidhu would not receive any reimbursement because the amounts payable to him in connection with a change in control are not sufficient to trigger the golden parachute excise tax in his case.
 
(6)
While the employment agreements of these named executive officers provide for the time-based vesting requirements of equity-based awards to be met upon these terminations, no amounts are shown as these awards also require a 50% increase in the value of the common stock which did not occur as of the assumed termination date of December 31, 2011.
 

The other two named executive officers, Messrs. Hedde and Taylor, do not have an employment agreement with us providing for compensation in connection with severance or a change of control.  However, under the terms of certain plans and award agreements, the vesting of certain outstanding restricted stock units held by Glenn A. Hedde, President of Customers Bank Warehouse Lending, will accelerate as described in this paragraph below.  Mr. Hedde was awarded 24,479 restricted stock units in February 2011.  These restricted stock units will vest on the third anniversary of the date of the award, but the vesting is accelerated in the event of death, disability or a change in control.  The value of these restricted stock units is $308,453.40, which is based on a fair market value of  $12.60 per share as of December 31, 2011.  As also noted in footnote 2 to the tables above, this disclosure for Messrs. Hedde and Taylor also assumes no bonus for 2011 (and accordingly no shares issued pursuant to BRRP) because the assumed termination date was December 31, 2011.
 
 
 
- 106 -

 
 
 
DIRECTOR COMPENSATION
 
DIRECTOR COMPENSATION TABLE (1)
 
We have compensated our directors for their services and expect to continue this practice.  Information relating to the compensation of our non-employee directors during 2011 is set forth below.
 
Name & Principal
Position
 
Fees Earned or Paid in Cash
 
Stock Awards(2)
 
Total
Daniel K. Rothermel
 
$18,000
 
$6,000
 
 $24,000
T. Lawrence Way
 
 18,000
 
 6,000
 
 24,000
Steven J. Zuckerman
 
 18,000
 
 6,000
 
 24,000
John R. Miller
 
 18,000
 
 6,000
 
 24,000
Bhanu Choudhrie (1)
 
 18,000
 
 6,000
 
 24,000
Kenneth Mumma (1)
 
 18,000
 
 6,000
 
 24,000

 
(1)
Except as noted below for Messrs. Choudrie and Mumma, represents compensation to the directors for their service to Customers Bank prior to the Reorganization and for their services to Customers Bancorp after the Reorganization.  Messrs. Choudrie and Mumma only served as directors of Customers Bank for 2011 and not Customers Bancorp; represents disclosure of compensation for all of 2011 for Messrs. Choudrie and Mumma from Customers Bank.
 
(2)
Represents the grant date fair value, as calculated in accordance with FASB ASC Topic 718, of shares of Voting Common Stock granted to each board member worth $500 per month based upon the tangible common book value as of the end of the preceding month.  While all directors are entitled to receive 476 shares for 2011 under our 2004 Plan, these shares have not been issued by the Company yet but are expected to be issued in the second quarter of 2012. The grant date fair value has been determined based on the assumptions and methodologies set forth in our 2011 financial statements included herein (Note 12-Stock Based Compensation Plans).
 
 
In 2011, each non-employee director received $1,500 in cash for each month he served as a director, and an award of Voting Common Stock equal to $500, calculated based on the tangible common book value of such shares on the date of grant (in the event the stock becomes listed on a national securities exchange, award will be calculated based on the closing trading price as reported by such exchange on the date of grant).  In the event an individual ceases to be a member of the board of directors other than on the last day of a given month, the individual will be entitled to his monthly director fee only if he has attended a meeting of the board of directors in that month.
 
For 2012, compensation for non-employee directors was amended to provide a cash fee of $20,000 per year, which is payable quarterly.  In addition, each non-employee director will also receive 1,588 shares of our Voting Common Stock per annum under the 2004 Plan, payable quarterly.  Commencing for 2013, each director may also make an annual election prior to the beginning of each year to have all of their director fees paid in Voting Common Stock, in which event they would receive 3,176 shares per year.  Also for 2012, the following directors will receive an annual award of restricted stock.
 
·  
1,000 shares for the Chairman of each of the Audit Committee and the Compensation Committee.
 
·  
2,000 shares for the Chairman of the Nominating and Corporate Governance Committee who shall also be the Lead Independent Director.
 
·  
500 shares for the Audit Committee Financial Expert.
 
Each of the non-employee directors received an award of restricted stock units for 2,646 shares of Voting Common Stock in February 2012 as described in “2012 Restricted Stock Rewards Program.”

EMPLOYEE BENEFITS
 
We provide health, life, vision and dental insurance to the named executive officers on terms similar to those provided to other employees generally.  See “Employee Benefits - Insurance.”  We also provide car allowances to each of Messrs. Ehst and Brugger, and we provide Mr. Sidhu with an automobile which he primarily uses for business purposes.
 
401(k) Retirement Savings and Profit Sharing Plan
 
Customers Bank has a 401(k) profit sharing plan whereby eligible employees may contribute up to 15% of their salary to such plan.  Customers Bank provides a matching contribution equal to 50% of the first 6% of the contribution made by the employee.  Employer contributions for the year ended December 31, 2011 were approximately $223,000.
 
 
 
 
 
- 107 -

 
 
Insurance
 
All eligible full-time employees of Customers Bank are covered as a group by basic hospitalization, major medical, long-term disability, term life and prescription drug plans.  Customers Bank pays the total cost of such plans for employees with the exception of the major medical and the prescription drug plan, in which cost sharing and co-payments are required by the employees.
 
Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan for Chairman and Chief Executive Officer
 
Pursuant to Mr. Sidhu’s employment agreement, we have established a supplemental executive retirement plan (“SERP”) for Mr. Sidhu.  As a result of our acquisition of USA Bank on July 9, 2010, the SERP became effective and the present value of the payments was recorded in the third quarter of 2010.
 
The SERP is a deferred compensation plan whereby we created a reserve account on our books for Mr. Sidhu.  During the third quarter of 2010, we credited an amount to this account that was sufficient to create a hypothetical fund that would provide payments of $300,000 per year for fifteen years commencing on Mr. Sidhu’s sixty-fifth birthday, assuming a rate of return of 7% per year, compounded annually.  Additionally, we will credit the account with any gains or losses as if we had deposited the amounts in certain investment funds selected by Mr. Sidhu.  Mr. Sidhu’s is now fully vested in the SERP.
 
Mr. Sidhu’s entire interest in the account will be paid to him in fifteen annual installments generally upon the later of (a) his separation from service with us, or (b) his sixty-fifth birthday.  Any portion of Mr. Sidhu’s interest in the account remaining upon his death will be paid to his beneficiary in a single lump sum.
 
In the event of Mr. Sidhu’s death prior to the later of (a) his separation from service with us, or (b) his sixty-fifth birthday, $3.0 million will be paid to his beneficiary in a single lump sum in lieu of the installment payments described above.
 
These obligations under the SERP will be general unsecured obligations by us to pay money in the future.  Mr. Sidhu will have no rights to any assets or investments held by us to meet our obligations under the SERP, except as a general creditor of us.
 
 
 
 
- 108 -

 

 
SECURITY OWNERSHIP OF CERTAIN BENEFICIAL OWNERS AND MANAGEMENT
 
The following table sets forth information, as of February 29, 2012, with respect to the beneficial ownership of each director, each beneficial owner known to us of more than five percent (5%) of the outstanding Voting Common Stock, the named executive officers and all directors and executive officers as a group.
 

           
   
Beneficial Ownership Before this Offering
 
Beneficial Ownership After this Offering (1)
 
                       
                       
                       
           
Percent of
Shares of
     
Percent of
       
Percent of
 
Class of
Voting
 
Percent of
 
Class of
       
Class of
Class B
Class B
Common
 
Class of
Class B
Class B
   
Voting
 
Voting
Non-Voting
Non-Voting
Stock
Voting
Voting
Non-Voting
Non-Voting
Name and Address
 
Common
 
Common
Common
Common
Being
Common
Common
Common
Common
of
 
Stock(1)(2)(4)
 
Stock(2)
Stock(1)(2)
Stock(2)
Offered
Stock
Stock
Stock
Stock
Beneficial Owner (3)
                     
                       
Directors and Officers
                     
                       
Daniel K. Rothermel
 
19,799
 
*
             
T. Lawrence Way
 
137,319
 
1.61%
             
Steven J. Zuckerman
 
205,657
 
2.42%
             
John R. Miller
 
9,177
 
*
             
Jay S. Sidhu
 
516,691
 
5.88%
20,833
*
         
Richard A. Ehst
 
1,666
 
*
             
Thomas R. Brugger
 
16,666
 
*
             
Warren Taylor
 
25,000
 
*
             
Glenn Hedde
 
21,209
 
*
             
All directors and executive officers as a group (9 persons)
 
953,184
 
10.84%
20,833
*
         
                       
Greater than 5% Stockholders
                     
                       
Bhanu Choudhrie (5)
 
721,063
 
8.45%
139,632
4.91%
         
Rodella Assets Inc. (6)
                     
50 Raffles Place
                     
Singapore
 
567,729
 
6.65%
102,489
3.60%
         
Amberland Properties LLC (7)
54/58 Athold Street
Douglas, Isle of Man UK
 
 
 
567,729
 
 
 
6.65%
 
 
102,489
 
 
3.60%
         
Commerce Street Financial Partners, LP (8)
                     
1700 Pacific Ave
                     
Dallas, TX 75210
                     
New York, NY 10065
 
600,568
 
7.04%
169,429
5.96%
         

*Less than 1%
 
(1)
Based on information furnished by the respective individual and our share records.  Shares are deemed to be beneficially owned by a person if he or she directly or indirectly has or shares the power to vote or dispose of the shares, whether or not he or she has any economic interest in the shares.  Unless otherwise indicated, the named beneficial owner has sole voting and dispositive power with respect to the shares.
 
 
 
 
- 109 -

 
 
 
 
(2)
Beneficial ownership for each listed person as of February 29, 2012 includes shares issuable pursuant to warrants or options to purchase stock held by such person which are exercisable within 60 days after February 29, 2012.  Shares subject to warrants or options exercisable within 60 days of February 29, 2012 are deemed outstanding for purposes of computing the percentage of the person or group holding such option or warrants, but are not deemed outstanding for purposes of computing the percentage of any other person or group.
(3)
Unless otherwise indicated, the address for each beneficial owner is c/o Customers Bancorp, 1015 Penn Ave., Wyomissing, Pennsylvania 19610.
(4)
Includes shares issuable upon the exercise of warrants in the following amounts: Mr. Choudhrie – 32,377;  Mr. Way – 2,270; Mr. Zuckerman – 6,195; Mr. Sidhu – 278,119; Rodella Assets, Inc. – 32,377; Commerce Street Financial Partners – 23,918.
(5)
Mr. Choudhrie has an indirect beneficial ownership interest in these securities through his company, Lewisberg LLC.
(6)
Sumant Kapur may be deemed to have voting and dispositive power over the securities owned by Rodella Assets Inc.
(7)
Thomas P. Cherian may be deemed to have voting and dispositive power over the securities owned by Amberland Properties LLC.
(8)
440,094 shares of Voting Common Stock and 169,429 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock is held by Commerce Street Financial Partners, LP, 54,103 shares of Voting Common Stock is held by Service Equity Partners, LP, an affiliate of Commerce Street Financial Partners, LP, 82,453 shares of Voting Common Stock is held by Service Equity Partners (QP), LP, an affiliate of Commerce Street Financial Partners, LP, and 23,918 shares of Voting Common Stock underlying warrants is held by Commerce Street Financial Partners, LP.  Dorey Wiley, Manager of Commerce Street Financial Partners, GP, LLC may be deemed to have voting and dispositive power over the securities owned by Commerce Street Capital.

 
EQUITY COMPENSATION PLANS
 
 
The following table provides certain summary information as of December 31, 2011 concerning our compensation plans (including individual compensation arrangements) under which shares of our common stock may be issued.
 
 
Plan Category
Number Of Securities To Be Issued Upon Exercise Of Outstanding Options, Warrants And Rights(#)
Weighted-Average Exercise Price Of Outstanding Options, Warrants And Rights($)
Number Of Securities Remaining Available For Future Issuance Under Equity Compensation Plans (Excluding Securities Reflected In  The First Column)(#)
Equity Compensation Plans Approved By Security Holders (1)
 1,131,832(1)
  $10.98(2)
2,603,350(3)(4)
       
Equity Compensation Plans Not Approved By Security Holders
N/A
  N/A
N/A



(1)
Includes shares of our common stock that may be issued upon the exercise of awards granted under the 2004 Plan, the 2010 Stock Option Plan and the BRRP. Excludes shares issued in 2012 under these plans.
(2)
Calculation does not include restricted stock units for which there exists no exercise price.
(3)
Includes shares of our common stock underlying awards that are authorized under the 2004 Plan and the 2010 Stock Option Plan.  However, due to the limitation of only issuing 15% of any stock issuances by us under the 2010 Stock Option Plan, no shares can be issued as of December 31, 2011 under the 2010 Stock Option Plan (instead of the 2,145,231 shares included in the table above which is based on the maximum authorization under the 2010 Stock Option Plan).  See “Executive Compensation – Amended and Restated 2010 Stock Option Plan” for more details on this 15% limitation.
(4)
This amount does not include securities available for future issuance under the BRRP as there is no specific number of shares reserved under this plan.  By its terms, the award of restricted stock units is limited by the amount of the cash bonuses paid to the participants in the BRRP.  See the description of the BRRP under the heading “Executive Compensation - Bonus Recognition and Retention Program.”

TRANSACTIONS WITH RELATED PARTIES
 
Customers Bank makes loans to executive officers and directors of Customers Bancorp and Customers Bank in the ordinary course of its business.  These loans are currently made on substantially the same terms, including interest rates and collateral, as those prevailing at the time the transaction is originated for comparable transactions with nonaffiliated persons, and do not involve more than the normal risk of collectability or present any other unfavorable features.  Federal regulations prohibit Customers Bank from making loans to executive officers and directors at terms more favorable than could be obtained by persons not affiliated with Customers Bank.  Our policy towards loans to executive officers and directors currently complies with this limitation.
 
 
 
 
- 110 -

 
 
 
Some current directors and executive officers of Customers Bancorp and Customers Bank and entities or organizations in which they were executive officers or the equivalent or owners of more than 10% of the equity were customers of and had banking transactions with or involving Customers Bank in the ordinary course of business during the fiscal years ended December 31, 2009, 2010 and  2011.  None of these transactions involved amounts in excess of 5% of our consolidated gross revenues during 2011 or $200,000, nor was Customers Bank indebted to any of the foregoing persons or entities in an aggregate amount in excess of 5% of our total consolidated assets at December 31, 2011.  Additional transactions with such persons and entities may be expected to take place in the ordinary course of business in the future.  
 
On June 17, 2009, Customers Bank entered into a Consulting Agreement with Kenneth B. Mumma, its former Chairman and CEO, pursuant to which Customers Bank agreed to engage Mr. Mumma as a consultant until December 31, 2011.  During the period of his engagement, Mr. Mumma agreed to provide from 20 to 40 hours of consulting services per month, for a consulting fee of $13,500 per month plus reimbursement of expenses incurred by him in performing the services.  The agreement also provides non-compete covenants for a period ending one year after the term of the consulting agreement.  During both 2011, Customers Bank paid $162,000 in consulting fees to Mr. Mumma under the agreement, and also paid him $67,500 under the agreement in 2009.
 
On June 30, 2010, Customers Bank extended a term loan in the principal amount of $5,000,000 to Atlantic Coast Federal Corporation, which is the former holding company for Atlantic Coast Bank, a federal savings bank with branches in Georgia and Florida.  Mr. Sidhu is the non-executive Chairman of the Board, and Mr. Choudhrie is a director, of Atlantic Coast Financial Corporation, the successor to Atlantic Coast Federal Corporation.  This lending transaction was in the ordinary course of our business, made on substantially the same terms, including interest rates and collateral, as those prevailing at the time for comparable transactions with other non-affiliated customers, and did not involve more than the normal risk of collectability or present other unfavorable features.  Customers Bank participated the full amount of the term loan to accredited investors in August 2010.  Two of the directors of Customers Bank had material interests in this participation transaction:  $500,000 of the loan was participated to Mr. Zuckerman, and $2,000,000 of the loan was participated to Emblem Investors LLC, a company for which Mr. Choudhrie is a managing member.  This loan was paid off in December 2010.
 
On August 13, 2010, Customers Bank executed a loan participation agreement in the principal amount of up to $25,000,000 to Atlantic Coast Bank.   Mr. Sidhu  is the non-executive Chairman of the Board, and Mr. Choudrie is a director, of Atlantic Coast Financial Corporation, which is the holding company owning Atlantic Coast Bank.   This participating interest is based upon the loan activity by certain mortgage warehouse customer activity and will be repaid upon the release of the underlying mortgage collateral. This lending transaction was in the ordinary course of our business, made on substantially the same terms, including interest rates and collateral, as those prevailing at the time for comparable transactions with other non-affiliated customers, and did not involve more than the normal risk of collectability or present other unfavorable features. This agreement was terminated on December 30, 2010.
 
On December 30, 2010, Customers Bank executed a loan participation agreement with Atlantic Coast Bank for a principal amount up to $6,250,000.  This participating interest is based upon specified Atlantic Coast Bank customers activity and was to be repaid to Customers Bank upon the release of the underlying mortgage collateral. This lending transaction was in the ordinary course of our business, made on substantially the same terms, including interest rates and collateral, as those prevailing at the time for comparable transactions with other non-affiliated customers, and did not involve more than the normal risk of collectability or present other unfavorable features.  This loan was paid off in March 2011.
 
For the years ended December 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011, Customers Bank paid, for advertising and marketing services, approximately $80,808, $284,532, and $295,339, respectively, to Clipper Magazine and its division, Spencer Advertising Marketing.  Additionally, for the years ended December 31, 2009, 2010 and 2011, Customers Bank paid, for promotional items, approximately $1,429, $16,088 and $48,486, respectively, to Jaxxon Promotions, Inc.  Steven Zuckerman, a director of Customers Bancorp is the President and Chief Executive Officer of Clipper Magazine, an affiliate of Gannett Co., Inc., and holds 25% of the issued and outstanding capital stock of Jaxxon Promotions, Inc.
 
Commerce Street Financial Partners, LP is a beneficial holder of more than 5% of our outstanding Voting Common Stock.  In or around December 2010 through February 2011, Commerce Street Capital, LLC, an affiliate of Commerce Street Financial Partners, LP, provided placement agent services in connection with a private placement of the common stock of Customers Bank.  Customers Bank paid Commerce Street Capital, LLC a placement fee in the amount of $231,750.
 
Certain of our executive officers and directors purchased securities in private offerings of our securities during since January 1, 2009.  The chart below indicates the number and types of securities purchased as well as the amount paid for such securities.  The figures for common stock and warrants to purchase common stock set forth in the chart and accompanying footnotes reflect all adjustments that have been made to date in connection with anti-dilution repricing and the Reorganization.  See “Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management” for the current security ownership of each of the individuals listed below.
 
 
 
- 111 -

 
 
 
Name
 
Number and Type of Securities
 
Aggregate
Purchase Price
 
Jay Sidhu, Chairman and CEO
 
95,238 shares of Voting Common Stock
 
$
1,000,005
 
 
 
20,833 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock
 
 
  250,000
 
Bhanu Choudhrie, Director (1)
 
238,095 shares of Voting Common Stock (2)
 
 
2,500,003
 
 
 
297,257 shares of Voting Common Stock and 102,489 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock (3)
 
 
4,197,332
 
 
 
153,333 shares of Voting Common Stock and
37,143 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock
 
 
 2,000,002
 
Lawrence Way, Director
 
3,457 shares of Voting Common Stock (4)
 
 
36,300
 
 
 
4,076 shares of Voting Common Stock
 
 
42,800
 
 
 
8 shares of 10% Series A Preferred Stock (6)
 
 
250,000
 
 
 
74,666 shares of Voting Common Stock
 
 
  896,000
 
 
 
14,000 shares of Voting Common Stock
 
 
 168,000
 
Steven Zuckerman, Director
 
119,048 shares of Voting Common Stock (5)
 
 
1,250,002
 
 
 
79,365 shares of Voting Common Stock
 
 
833,333
 
Daniel Rothermel, Director
 
18,750 shares of Voting Common Stock
 
 
196,880
 
Glenn Hedde
 
11,209 shares of Voting Common Stock
 
 
117,700
 
John R. Miller
 
8,481 shares of Voting Common Stock
 
 
 99,999
 
 
(1)
Mr. Choudhrie  has an indirect beneficial ownership interest in these securities through his company, Lewisberg LLC (successor-in-interest to Lewisburg Capital Limited).
 
(2)
In connection with this purchase, Lewisberg LLC also received immediately exercisable warrants to purchase 12,389 shares of our Voting Common Stock at an exercise price of $10.50 per share. Such warrants expire on June 30, 2016.
 
(3)
In connection with this purchase, Lewisberg LLC also received immediately exercisable warrants to purchase 19,988 shares of our Voting Common Stock at an exercise price of $10.50 per share. Such warrants expire on February 17, 2017.
 
(4)
In connection with this purchase, Mr. Way also received immediately exercisable warrants to purchase 186 shares of our Voting Common Stock at an exercise price of $10.50 per share. Such warrants expire on June 30, 2016.
 
(5)
In connection with this purchase, Mr. Zuckerman also received immediately exercisable warrants to purchase 6,195 shares of our Voting Common Stock at an exercise price of $10.50 per share. Such warrants expire on June 30, 2016.
 
(6)
In June 2009, all outstanding shares of 10% Series A Preferred Stock were redeemed for shares of our Voting Common Stock and warrants to purchase our Voting Common Stock.
 
Certain of our holders of 5% or more of our Voting Common Stock (who are not executive officers or directors) purchased securities in private offerings since January 1, 2009, including transactions that would have made them a 5% holder.  The chart below indicates the number and types of securities purchased as well as the amount paid for such securities.  The figures for common stock and warrants to purchase common stock set forth in the chart and accompanying footnotes reflect all adjustments that have been made to date in connection with anti-dilution repricing and the Reorganization.  These investors were deemed “lead investors” as part of some of these transactions.  See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Private Offerings of Common Stock” for more details on the rights of lead investors.  Also see “Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management” for the current security ownership of each of the individuals listed below.
 
Name
 
Number and Type of Securities (1)
 
Aggregate
Purchase Price
 
Amberland Properties (2)
 
535,352  shares of Voting Common Stock
 
$
5,621,201
 
 
 
102,489 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock
 
 
1,076,138
 
Commerce Street Financial Partners, LP (3)
 
395,813 shares of Voting Common Stock
 
 
4,156,043
 
 
 
84,450 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock
 
 
886,725
 
Rodella Assets, Inc. (4)
 
535,352 shares of Voting Common Stock
 
 
5,621,201
 
 
 
102,489 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock
 
 
1,076,138
 
 
(1)
Amberland Properties, Commerce Street Financial Partners, LP and Rodella Assets, Inc. invested in Customers Bank multiple times on various dates and at various prices.  Warrants were allocated in connection with certain purchases, but were not allocated at every purchase.

(2)
Amberland Properties received immediately exercisable warrants to purchase 12,389 shares and 19,988 shares of our Voting Common Stock at an exercise price of $10.50 per share.  Such warrants expire on June 30, 2016 and February 17, 2017, respectively.

(3)
Commerce Street Financial Partners, LP received immediately exercisable warrants to purchase 18,981 shares of our Voting Common Stock at an exercise price of $10.50 per share.  Such warrants expire on February 17, 2017.

(4)
Rodella Assets, Inc. received immediately exercisable warrants to purchase 12,389 shares and 19,988 shares of our Voting Common Stock at an exercise price of $10.50 per share.  Such warrants expire on June 30, 2016 and February 17, 2017, respectively.
 
 
 
- 112 -

 
 
We have a Code of Conduct applicable to our directors, officers and employees, including our Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer and all of our other executives pursuant to which all directors, officers and employees must promptly disclose to us, any material transactions or relationships that reasonably could be expected to give rise to an actual or apparent conflict of interest with Customers Bank. In approving or rejecting the proposed agreement, the board of directors must consider the relevant facts and circumstances available and deemed relevant, including, but not limited to the risks, costs and benefits to us, the terms of the transaction, the availability of other sources for comparable services or products, and, if applicable, the impact on a director’s independence. The board of directors may only approve those agreements that, in light of known circumstances, are in, or are not inconsistent with, our best interests, as the board of directors determines in the good faith exercise of its discretion.
 
The Company’s Board of Directors has also adopted the Affiliate and Related Party Transaction Policy and Compliance Plan (the “Transaction Policy”).  The Transaction Policy is a written policy and set of procedures for the review and approval or ratification of transactions involving Affiliates and Related Parties (as such terms are defined in the Transaction Policy).
 
Related Parties are defined in the Transaction Policy as owners of more than 5% of any class of voting securities of the Company, directors or executive officers of the Company, or nominees to become directors, since the beginning of the last fiscal year, and “related persons” and others as provided in Item 404 of Regulation S-K under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, immediate family members if involved in Company transactions and organizations, including charitable, where the foregoing have a material relationship or interest to such organization.  Affiliates are defined in the Transaction Policy as “affiliates” as provided in Sections 23A and 23B of the Federal Reserve Act and Regulation W issued by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System, and can include anyone that controls, that is under common control with, or that is controlled by the Company, investment funds where an affiliate is a fund investment advisor, and “executive officers”, “directors”, “principal shareholders”, “related interests” of a person, “insider”, “immediate family” and “Subsidiary” as defined in Regulation O issued by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System.
 
The Transaction Policy is administered through the Company’s Audit Committee with appropriate involvement and input from the Company’s Audit, Legal and Compliance Departments (collectively, the “Committee”).  The Audit Committee (i) has the responsibility to interpret and enforce the Transaction Policy, (ii) may amend the Transaction Policy from time to time and (iii) may delegate administrative responsibilities within the Company or to third parties as the Audit Committee deems appropriate to accomplish the objectives of the Transaction Policy.  All transactions covered by the Transaction Policy are prohibited unless approved or ratified by the Audit Committee and, when determined necessary by the Audit Committee pursuant to the Related Transaction Policy, the Company’s Board of Directors.
 
Transactions involving Affiliates that are subject to the Transaction Policy include extensions of credit, purchase or sale of loans, referrals or brokerage of loans, indebtedness to another “member bank” or correspondent bank, purchases of or investments in securities, purchase or sale of services, goods and other assets, issuance of guarantees, acceptances or letters of credit and third party transactions where an Affiliate benefits from transaction proceeds.
 
Transactions involving Related Parties that are subject to the Transaction Policy include transactions where there is a direct or indirect interest by the Related Party and the amount involved is over $120,000.
 
Transactions covered by the Transaction Policy are required to be referred to the Committee.  The Compliance Department is responsible for coordinating the performance of appropriate legal research and obtaining opinions regarding the disposition of the transaction, and communicating such information to the Committee with recommendations, including if any regulatory application needs to be prepared to report or obtain authorization of the transaction.  The Audit Committee will approve, ratify, recommend change to or deny the transaction, or schedule the referral for follow up reporting or presentations.  Material transactions and transactions covered by Regulation O are required to be referred by the Audit Committee to the Company’s Board of Directors for disposition.  

MARKET PRICE OF COMMON STOCK AND DIVIDENDS
 
Trading Market for Voting Common Stock

There is no established public trading market for our Voting Common Stock or Class B Non-Voting Common Stock.  Neither our Voting Common Stock nor our Class B Non-Voting Common Stock is actively traded nor listed for trading on any securities exchange and an active market may not develop as further described in “Risk Factors – There is currently no public market for our Voting Common Stock and an active, liquid market for our Voting Common Stock may not develop” beginning at page 27 of this prospectus.  We do not make a market in our securities, nor do we attempt to negotiate prices for trades of such securities.

Market Price of Voting Common Stock
 
As of February 29, 2012, there were:  (1) approximately 910 shareholders of record of our Voting Common Stock and approximately 12 shareholders of record of our Class B Non-Voting Common Stock; and (2) 8,503,541 outstanding shares of our Voting Common Stock and 2,844,142 outstanding shares of our Class B Non-Voting Common Stock.
 

 
- 113 -

 
 
The chart below shows the high and low sale prices of our Voting Common Stock known by management to have occurred, or bid quotations on the Pink Sheets, for the periods from January 1, 2010 through December 31, 2011.  These quotations reflect interdealer prices, without retail mark-up, mark downs or commission and may not represent actual transactions.  Prices have been restated to reflect the Reorganization, including that each three shares of Customers Bank were exchanged for one share of Customers Bancorp in the Reorganization.
 

Quarter ended
   
High (1)
   
Low (1)
December 31, 2011
 
$
13.50
 
$
13.50
September 30, 2011
 
 
-
 
 
-
June 30, 2011
 
 
15.00
 
 
13.20
March 31, 2011
 
 
16.50
 
 
14.40
December 31, 2010
 
 
16.50
 
 
14.40
September 30, 2010
 
 
15.45
 
 
15.00
June 30, 2010
 
 
21.00
 
 
14.25
March 31, 2010
 
 
16.50
 
 
16.50
 
(1)  
There are no brokerage firms that are active market makers in our Voting Common Stock or Class B Non-Voting Common Stock. Consequently, information on current stock trading prices is not readily available. There may have been additional transactions of which management is unaware, and such transactions could have occurred at higher or lower prices.  The current trading symbol of our Voting Common Stock on the Pink Sheets is “CUUU”.  The last reported sale on the Pink Sheets of our Voting Common Stock on February 29, 2012 was $10.25 per share.
 
Dividends on Voting Common Stock
 
Neither Customers Bancorp nor Customers Bank has paid any cash dividends on its shares of common stock.  We intend to follow a policy of retaining earnings, if any, to increase our net worth and reserves over the next few years. We have not historically declared or paid dividends on our Voting Common Stock and we do not expect to do so in the near future. Any future determination relating to our dividend policy will be made at the discretion of our board of directors and will depend on a number of factors, including our earnings and financial condition, liquidity and capital requirements, the general economic and regulatory climate, our ability to service any equity or debt obligations senior to Voting Common Stock, and other factors deemed relevant by our board of directors.  Presently, for the reasons described below, Customers Bank is not authorized to pay cash dividends on its shares.
 
Dividend payments made by Customers Bank to its shareholders are subject to the Pennsylvania Banking Code, the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, and the regulations of the Federal Reserve Board.
 
The Pennsylvania Banking Code provides that cash dividends may be declared and paid only out of accumulated net earnings and that, prior to the declaration of any dividend, if the surplus of a bank is less than the amount of its capital, the bank shall, until surplus is equal to such amount, transfer to surplus an amount which is at least ten percent of the net earnings of such bank for the period since the end of the last fiscal year or for any shorter period since the declaration of a dividend. If the surplus of a bank is less than fifty percent of the amount of capital, no dividend may be declared or paid without the prior approval of the Pennsylvania Banking Department until such surplus is equal to fifty percent of such bank’s capital.
 
Under the Federal Reserve Act, if losses have at any time been sustained by a bank equal to or in excess of its undivided profits then on hand, no dividend is permitted; no dividends can be paid in an amount greater than a bank’s net profit less losses and bad debts. Cash dividends must be approved by the Federal Reserve Board if the total of all cash dividends declared by a bank in any calendar year, including the proposed cash dividend, exceeds the total of such bank’s net profits for that year plus its retained net profits from the preceding two years less any required transfers to surplus or a fund for the retirement of preferred stock, if any. The Federal Reserve Board and the Pennsylvania Banking Department each has the authority under the Federal Reserve Act to prohibit the payment of cash dividends by a bank when it determines such payment to be an “unsafe or unsound banking practice” under the then existing circumstances.
 
The Federal Deposit Insurance Act generally prohibits all payments of dividends by any bank that is in default of any assessment of the FDIC.
 
The Federal Reserve Board and the FDIC have formal and informal policies, which provide that insured banks and bank holding companies should generally pay dividends only out of current operating earnings, with some exceptions. The Federal banking laws further limit the ability of banks to pay dividends if they are not classified as well capitalized or adequately capitalized.
 
Customers Bank does not have any accumulated net earnings, and so, under the foregoing restrictions, Customers Bank is not presently permitted to pay dividends.
 
Further, under the MOU, Customers Bank may not declare or pay any dividends that would cause its capital ratios to fall below the higher of the minimum levels for a “well capitalized” classification under Prompt Corrective Action standards pursuant to the Federal Deposit Insurance Act, or the internal ratios set in our capital plan without the prior written approval of the Pennsylvania Department of Banking.

 
 
- 114 -

 
 
 
SHARES ELIGIBLE FOR FUTURE SALE
 
All of our _______ shares of Voting Common Stock sold in this offering (or the _____ shares of Voting Common Stock sold if the underwriters exercise in full their option to purchase additional shares from us) will be freely tradable without restriction or further registration under the Securities Act, unless such shares are purchased by “affiliates” (as described below).
 
Prior to this offering, the issuance of 8,132,160 shares of our Voting Common Stock and 2,278,294 Class B Non-Voting Common Stock to Customers Bank’s shareholders and Berkshire Bancorp’s shareholders in connection with our reorganization into a bank holding company and the acquisition of Berkshire Bancorp and Berkshire Bank, was registered on a Form S-1 registration statement (the “Reorganization S-1 Registration Statement”) under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended (the “Securities Act”).  The shares of our Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock issued to Customers Bank’s shareholders and Berkshire Bancorp’s shareholders in connection with such reorganization are freely tradable, except any shareholders who are currently our “affiliates” (or were our “affiliates” within 90 days prior to any sale) would be permitted to resell our shares only in the manner permitted by Rule 144.
 
Persons who may be deemed to be our “affiliates” for these purposes generally include individuals or entities that control, are controlled by, or are under common control with us, and would generally not include shareholders who are not executive officers, directors or significant shareholders of us.
 
The 419,000 shares of our Voting Common Stock and 565,848 shares of our Class B Non-Voting Common Stock which were issued by us after the Reorganization and any shares of  Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock issued upon vesting of restricted stock units or exercise of our options and warrants are “restricted” securities, and such shares may be resold in the public market if and when such shares qualify for an exemption from registration under Rule 144 or any other applicable exemption under the Securities Act or such shares are registered for resale under the Securities Act.   Subject to the lock-up agreements described below and the provisions of Rule 144 and other applicable exemptions, additional shares will be available for sale as set forth below.
 
Lock-Up Agreements
 
See the section entitled “Underwriting” for a description of lock-up agreements in connection with this offering.
 
Stock Options and Restricted Stock
 
As of March 15, 2012, we have granted (i) 340,835 shares of restricted stock units for Voting Common Stock and 211,640 shares of restricted stock units for Class B Non-Voting Common Stock, and (ii) options to purchase 1,065,479 shares of Voting Common Stock and options to purchase 160,884 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock, under our 2010 Stock Option Plan, the 2004 Plan and the BRRP, subject to vesting requirements.  As of March 15, 2012, an additional 2,117,822 shares of common stock (subject to the 15% limitation under the 2010 Stock Option Plan) are available for future issuance under the 2004 Plan and 2010 Stock Option Plan.  See the section entitled “Executive Compensation” for a description of these plans.  Of this amount, our directors are entitled to receive 6,736 shares of Voting Common Stock related to their accrued director fees under our 2004 Plan; these shares have not been issued by us yet but are expected to be issued in the second quarter of 2012.
 
Warrants
 
As of  February 29, 2012, we have issued warrants to purchase 589,005 shares of Voting Common Stock and 81,036 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock.  See the section entitled “Warrants to Purchase Additional Stock” for a description of our outstanding warrants.
 
 
 
- 115 -

 
 
 
Form S-8 Registration Statement
 
We intend to file a registration statement under the Securities Act to register an aggregate of _______ shares of Voting Common Stock and _________ shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock reserved for issuance or issuable under restricted stock units and outstanding options granted under our 2010 Stock Option Plan, 2004 Plan and BRRP, or covering the resale of shares issued under our Management Stock Purchase Plan.  Such registration statement on Form S-8 will become effective upon filing, and shares of Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock covered by such registration statement would be eligible for sale in the public market immediately after the effectiveness of such registration statement (unless held by affiliates) subject to vesting restrictions with us and the lock-up agreements referred to above.
 
Registration Rights
 
Concurrently with the consummation of our September 2011 private offering, we provided the investor in such offering with piggy back registration rights that would require us to register such investor’s shares in any public offering of our shares.  See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations – Private Offerings of Common Stock” for more detail on these registration rights.  The investor did not seek to have his shares registered in this offering.
 
 
 
 
- 116 -

 
 

DESCRIPTION OF CAPITAL STOCK

The following description of our capital stock is a summary. This summary is not complete and is subject to the complete text of our articles of incorporation, as amended, and bylaws, copies of which are incorporated by reference as exhibits to the registration statement of which this prospectus forms a part. Except where otherwise indicated, the description below reflects Customers Bancorp’s articles of incorporation and bylaws. We encourage you to read those documents carefully.
 
General
 
We are authorized to issue up to an aggregate amount of 300,000,000 shares of stock, which is divided into three equal classes, namely (i) 100,000,000 shares of Voting Common Stock with a par value of $1.00 per share, (ii) 100,000,000 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock, with a par value of $1.00 per share and (iii) 100,000,000 shares of preferred stock.  The board of directors has the authority to establish and divide the authorized and unissued shares of Voting Common Stock and of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock into series or classes and to fix and determine, to the extent not already determined in our articles of incorporation, the designations, preferences, and other special rights, including conversion rights, and the qualifications, limitations, or restrictions on those rights attributable to the shares in a series or class.  The board of directors also has the power to specify whether shares of any series of the Class B Non-Voting Common Stock have a par value and can establish the par value. As of the date of this prospectus, there are 8,503,541 shares of Voting Common Stock and 2,844,142 shar es of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock outstanding.
 
The board of directors has the authority to establish and divide the authorized and unissued shares of preferred stock into series or classes (“Blank Check Preferred”), and to determine whether or not shares in any series or class of preferred stock have par value and, if so, the par value, whether or not the shares in a series or class have voting rights and if so whether those voting rights are full, limited, multiple or fractional, and for each series or class of preferred stock, the designations, preferences, and other special rights including dividends rights, conversion rights, redemption rights and liquidation preferences, if any, and the qualifications, limitations, or restriction on those rights, and the number of shares of each series or class.  There are no shares of preferred stock currently outstanding.
 
The board of directors created two series of preferred stock, Fixed Rate Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A (the “Series A Preferred”) and Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series B (the “Series B Preferred”), pursuant to the authority granted to the board of directors of Customers Bancorp in its articles of incorporation as described above.  All of the shares designated as Series A Preferred and all of the shares designated as Series B Preferred in their respective Certificates of Designations were issued on September 17, 2011 and all of these shares of Series A Preferred and Series B Preferred were subsequently repurchased by Customers Bancorp on December 28, 2011 and are no longer outstanding.  Pursuant to their respective Certificates of Designation, shares of Series A Preferred and shares of Series B Preferred that are redeemed, repurchased or otherwise acquired by Customers Bancorp revert to authorized but unissued shares of preferred stock (provided that any such cancelled shares of Series A Preferred Stock may be reissued only as shares of any series of preferred stock other than Series A Preferred and any such shares of Series B Preferred may be reissued only as shares of any series of preferred stock other than Series B Preferred). 

The board of directors, in its sole discretion, has authority to sell any treasury stock and/or unissued securities, options, warrants, or other rights to purchase any security of Customers Bancorp, upon such terms as it deems advisable. Our board of directors could issue preferred stock, or additional shares of Voting Common Stock or Class B Non-Voting Common Stock, with terms different from those of our existing common or preferred stock, at any time.
 
Voting rights
 
The holders of shares of Voting Common Stock have the right to elect our board of directors and to act on such other matters as are required to be presented to them.  Each holder of Voting Common Stock is entitled to one vote per share.  The holders of Voting Common Stock do not have the right to vote their shares cumulatively in the election of directors. This means that, for each director position to be elected, a shareholder may only cast a number of votes equal to the number of shares held by the shareholder.
 
Any action that would significantly and adversely affect the rights of the Class B Non-Voting Common Stock with respect to the modification of the terms of those securities or dissolution requires the approval of the holders of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock voting separately as a class. Otherwise, the holders of the Class B Non-Voting Common Stock have no voting power, and do not have the right to participate in or have notice of any meeting of shareholders.
 
Because the articles of incorporation permit Customers Bancorp’s board of directors to set the voting rights of preferred stock, it is possible that holders of one or more series of preferred stock issued in the future could have voting rights of any sort, which could limit the effect of the voting rights of holders of Voting Common Stock.
 
 
 
 
- 117 -

 
 
Dividend rights
 
The holders of Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock are entitled to receive an equal amount of dividends per share if, as and when declared from time to time by our board of directors. In no event shall any stock dividends or stock splits or combinations of stock be declared or made on Voting Common Stock or Class B Non-Voting Common Stock unless the shares of Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock at the time outstanding are treated equally and identically, provided that, in the event of a dividend of common stock, shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock shall only be entitled to receive shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock and shares of Voting Common Stock shall only be entitled to receive shares of Voting Common Stock.
 
Because the articles of incorporation permit our board of directors to set the dividend rights of preferred shares, it is possible that holders of one or more series of preferred shares issued in the future could have dividend rights that differ from those of the holders of Voting Common Stock or Class B Non-Voting Common Stock, or could have no right to the payment of dividends.  If the holders of a class or series of preferred stock is given dividend rights, the right of holders of preferred shares to receive dividends could have priority over the right of holders of Voting Common Stock or Class B Non-Voting Common Stock to receive dividends.
 
Authority Under Pennsylvania Business Corporation Law .  Our board of directors has the authority to declare dividends on its common and preferred stock, subject to statutory and regulatory requirements.
 
Pennsylvania Business Corporation Law .  Pennsylvania law permits a business corporation such as us to pay dividends if, after giving effect to the dividend, it is able to pay its debts as they come due in the usual course of business and its assets exceed its liabilities.  However, Customers Bancorp’s ability to pay dividends will be restricted by banking laws and Customers Bank’s ability to pay dividends to Customers Bancorp.
 
Federal Bank Holding Company Act Policies Applicable to Cash Dividends .  The Federal Reserve Board, which is the federal banking regulator, considers adequate capital to be critical to the health of individual banking organizations and to the safety and stability of the banking system. A major determinant of a bank’s or bank holding company’s capital adequacy is the strength of its earnings and the extent to which its earnings are retained and added to capital or paid out to shareholders in the form of cash dividends.
 
The Federal Reserve believes that a bank or bank holding company generally should not maintain its existing rate of cash dividends on Voting Common Stock unless (1) the organization’s net income available to common shareholders over the past year has been sufficient to fully fund the dividends and (2) the prospective rate of earnings retention appears consistent with the organization’s capital needs, asset quality, and overall financial condition. The Federal Reserve may strongly encourage, or require, a banking organization whose cash dividends are inconsistent with either of these criteria to cut or eliminate its dividends.
 
The Federal Reserve Board also believes it is inappropriate for a banking organization that is experiencing serious financial problems or that has inadequate capital to borrow in order to pay dividends since this can result in increased leverage at the very time the organization needs to reduce its debt or increase its capital. Similarly, the payment of dividends based solely or largely upon gains resulting from unusual or nonrecurring events, such as the sale of the organization’s building or the disposition of other assets, may not be prudent or warranted, especially if the funds derived from such transactions could be better employed to strengthen the organization’s financial resources. Furthermore, a fundamental principle underlying the Federal Reserve’s supervision and regulation of bank holding companies is that bank holding companies should serve as a source of managerial and financial strength to their subsidiary banks. The Federal Reserve believes, therefore, that a bank holding company should not maintain a level of cash dividends to its shareholders that places undue pressure on the capital of bank subsidiaries, or that can be funded only through additional borrowings or other arrangements that may undermine the bank holding company’s ability to serve as a source of strength. Thus, for example, if a major subsidiary bank is unable to pay dividends to its parent company—as a consequence of statutory limitations, intervention by the primary supervisor, or noncompliance with regulatory capital requirements—the Federal Reserve may encourage or require a bank holding company to reduce or eliminate its dividends in order to conserve its capital base and provide capital assistance to the subsidiary bank.
 
The Federal Reserve Board has further stated that a bank holding company should pay cash dividends only out of income over the past year and only if prospective earnings retention is consistent with the organization’s expected future needs and financial condition, and only if, after paying the dividend, the bank holding company is not in danger of falling below its required regulatory capital adequacy ratios. It has also indicated that a “small bank holding company,” such as Customers Bancorp, is not expected to pay corporate dividends until such time as its debt to equity ratio (determined separately and not on a consolidated basis with its bank subsidiary) is 1:1 or less and its bank subsidiaries are otherwise well-managed, well-capitalized, and not under any supervisory order.
 
Pennsylvania Banking Code Requirements Applicable to Cash Dividends .  Because Customers Bank is currently the primary source of cash for payment of dividends by Customers Bancorp for the foreseeable future, requirements of the Pennsylvania Banking Code setting conditions on payments of dividends by banks will constrain Customer Bank’s ability to provide funds to us to pay dividends to our shareholders. The Pennsylvania Banking Code permits a bank to pay cash dividends only out of accumulated net earnings. Furthermore, if any transfer of net earnings to surplus is required by the Pennsylvania Banking Code to cause our surplus to meet minimum statutory requirements at the time the dividend is to be declared or paid, the transfer must be made prior to the declaration of the dividend, and our surplus cannot be reduced by the payment of the dividend.
 
 
 
- 118 -

 
 
 
For the foregoing reasons, and because a decision by our board of directors to declare and pay cash dividends will depend upon the future financial performance and condition of Customers Bank and Customers Bancorp, no assurances can be given that any dividends will in fact be paid on any class of stock, or that, if dividends are paid, they will not be reduced or discounted in the future.
 
Redemption, Preemptive Rights and Repurchase Provisions
 
Our Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock have no preemptive, redemption or repurchase provisions. The shares are non-assessable and require no sinking fund. Voting Common Stock repurchases are subject to Federal Reserve Board regulations and policy, which generally require that no more than ten percent of the outstanding shares of a bank holding company’s Voting Common Stock may be repurchased in any 12-month period unless the bank holding company is deemed “well-managed” and “well-capitalized” under applicable regulations. Repurchases of our stock will also be constrained by federal and state bank regulatory capital requirements. Repurchases of stock by bank holding companies may also be subject to prior notice to and approval by the Federal Reserve in some cases.
 
Liquidation Rights
 
In the event of a liquidation, dissolution or winding up of Customers Bancorp, the holders of Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock will be entitled to share ratably in all of our assets remaining after payment of all liabilities, subject, however, to any preferential liquidation rights of holders of preferred stock. If our only asset is our ownership of Customers Bank, it is likely that, if Customers Bank is then in liquidation or receivership, our shareholders will not receive anything on account of their shares.
 
Anti-Takeover Effect of Governing Documents and Applicable Law
 
Provisions of Governing Documents .  Customers Bancorp’s articles of incorporation and bylaws contain certain provisions which may have the effect of deterring or discouraging, among other things, a nonnegotiated tender or exchange offer for Customers Bancorp Voting Common Stock, a proxy contest for control of Customers Bancorp, the assumption of control of Customers Bancorp by a holder of a large block of Customers Bancorp Voting Common Stock and the removal of Customers Bancorp’s management. These provisions:
 
·  
Empower Customers Bancorp’s board of directors, without shareholder approval, to issue Customers Bancorp preferred stock, the terms of which, including voting power, are set by Customers Bancorp’s board of directors;
 
·  
Divide Customers Bancorp’s board of directors into three classes serving staggered three-year terms;
 
·  
Restrict the ability of shareholders to remove directors;
 
·  
Require that shares with at least 80% of total voting power approve mergers and other similar transactions with a person or entity holding stock with more than 5% of our voting power, if a reorganization is not approved, in advance, by our board of directors;
 
·  
Prohibit shareholders’ actions without a meeting;
 
·  
Require that shares with at least 80%, or in certain instances a majority, of total voting power approve the repeal or amendment of Customers Bancorp’s articles of incorporation;
 
·  
Require any person who acquires stock of Customers Bancorp with voting power of 25% or more to offer to purchase for cash all remaining shares of Customers Bancorp voting stock at the highest price paid by such person for shares of Customers Bancorp voting stock during the preceding year;
 
·  
Eliminate cumulative voting in elections of directors;
 
·  
Require an affirmative vote of at least two-thirds of Customers Bancorp’s total voting power in order for shareholders to repeal or amend Customers Bancorp’s bylaws;
 
·  
Require advance notice of nominations for the election of directors and the presentation of shareholder proposals at meetings of shareholders; and
 
 
 
 
- 119 -

 
 
 
·  
Provide that officers, directors, employees, agents and persons who own 5% or more of the voting securities of any other corporation or other entity that owns 66 2/3% or more of Customers Bancorp’s outstanding voting stock cannot constitute a majority of the members of Customers Bancorp’s board of directors.
 
Provisions of Applicable Law .   The Pennsylvania Business Corporation Law also contains certain provisions applicable to Customers Bancorp which may have the effect of impeding a change in control of Customers Bancorp. These provisions, among other things:
 
·  
Generally prohibit (under Subchapter 25G) a person or group who or which acquires voting power in an election of directors in excess of certain thresholds (20%, 33 1/3% and 50%) for the first time from voting the “control shares” (i.e., the shares acquired which result in the person exceeding the applicable threshold, plus all voting shares acquired in the preceding 180 days and any other voting shares acquired with the intent of making a “control-share acquisition”) unless voting rights are restored at a shareholders meeting requested by the shareholder by the affirmative vote of a majority of the voting power in the election of directors of both (1) the disinterested shareholders and (2) all voting shares;
 
·  
Prohibit (under Subchapter 25F) for five years, subject to certain exceptions, a “business combination,” which includes a merger or consolidation of the corporation or a sale, lease or exchange of assets with a shareholder or group of shareholders beneficially owning 20% or more of the corporation’s voting power in an election of directors;
 
·  
Requires (under Subchapter 25I) the payment of minimum severance benefits to certain employees whose employment is terminated within two years of the approval of a control-share acquisition under Subchapter 25G; and
 
·  
Prohibits (under Subchapter 25J) the cancellation of certain labor contracts in connection with a control-share acquisition under Subchapter 25G.
 
In 1990, Pennsylvania adopted legislation amending the Pennsylvania Business Corporation Law.  The 1990 amendments:
 
·  
Expand the factors and groups (including shareholders) which a corporation’s board of directors can consider in determining whether a certain action is in the best interests of the corporation;
 
·  
Provide that a corporation’s board of directors need not consider the interests of any particular group as dominant or controlling;
 
·  
Provide that a corporation’s directors, in order to satisfy the presumption that they have acted in the best interests of the corporation, need not satisfy any greater obligation or higher burden of proof for actions relating to an acquisition or potential acquisition of control;
 
·  
Provide that actions relating to acquisitions of control that are approved by a majority of “disinterested directors” are presumed to satisfy the directors’ standard of care, unless it is proven by clear and convincing evidence that the directors did not assent to such action in good faith after reasonable investigation; and
 
·  
Provide that the fiduciary duty of a corporation’s directors is solely to the corporation and may be enforced by the corporation or by a shareholder in a derivative action, but not by a shareholder directly.
 
The 1990 amendments provide that the fiduciary duty of directors does not require directors to:
 
·  
Redeem any rights under, or to modify or render inapplicable, any shareholder rights plan;
 
·  
Render inapplicable, or make determinations under, provisions of the  Pennsylvania Business Corporation Law , relating to control transactions, business combinations, control-share acquisitions or disgorgement by certain controlling shareholders following attempts to acquire control; or
 
·  
Take action as the board of directors, a committee of the board or an individual director solely because of the effect such action might have on an acquisition or potential or proposed acquisition of control of Customers Bancorp or the consideration that might be offered or paid to shareholders in such an acquisition.
 
One of the effects of the 1990 amendments may be to make it more difficult for a shareholder to successfully challenge the actions of Customers Bancorp’s board of directors in a potential change in control context. Pennsylvania case law appears to provide that the fiduciary duty standard under the 1990 amendments grants directors the statutory authority to reject or refuse to consider any potential or proposed acquisition of Customers Bancorp.
 
 
 
- 120 -

 
 
 
Pursuant to provisions of its articles of incorporation, Customers Bancorp has opted out of coverage by the “disgorgement” and “control transactions” statutes included in the 1990 amendments. As a result of Customers Bancorp’s opt-out from coverage by these statutes, neither the “disgorgement” nor the “control transactions” statute would apply to a nonnegotiated attempt to acquire control of Customers Bancorp, although such an attempt would still be subject to the special provisions of Customers Bancorp’s governing documents described in the paragraphs above.
 
The overall effect of these provisions may be to deter a future offer or other merger or acquisition proposals that a majority of the shareholders might view to be in their best interests as the offer might include a substantial premium over the market price of Customers Bancorp Voting Common Stock at that time. In addition, these provisions may have the effect of assisting Customers Bancorp’s management in retaining its position and placing it in a better position to resist changes that the shareholders may want to make if dissatisfied with the conduct of Customers Bancorp’s business.
 
 
 
 
- 121 -

 
 
 
WARRANTS TO PURCHASE ADDITIONAL STOCK
 
The below table indicates the types and amounts of stock underlying warrants that were issued by us in (i) various private offerings, (ii) an exchange offer exchanging shares of our preferred stock into Voting Common Stock in 2009, and (iii) the acquisition of Berkshire Bancorp (“Berkshire Warrants”), as well as the original exercise prices for these warrants (as adjusted for the Reorganization).  The chart also indicates the exercise price and amounts of warrants outstanding following the anti-dilution adjustments described in the paragraphs following the chart below.  All of the warrants listed in the chart were immediately exercisable upon issuance.
 
Transaction
Type of Stock Underlying Warrants
 
Original Number of Shares Underlying Warrants
 
 
Original Exercise Price
 
 
Number of Shares Underlying Warrants upon Anti-Dilution Adjustment
 
 
Exercise Price upon Anti-Dilution Adjustment
 
June 30, 2009 Preferred Stock Exchange
Voting Common Stock
 
 
8,166
 
 
$16.50
 
 
 
--
 
 
 
--
 
July 31, 2009 Voting Common Stock Issuance
Voting Common Stock
 
 
227,776
 
 
$16.50
 
 
 
357,940
 
 
 
$10.50
 
February 17, 2010 Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock Issuance
Voting Common Stock
 
 
68,593
 
 
$12.84
 
 
 
83,881
 
 
 
$10.50
 
 
Class B Non-Voting Common Stock
 
 
52,177
 
 
$12.84
 
 
 
63,807
 
 
 
$10.50
 
March 29, 2010 Voting Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock Issuance
Voting Common Stock
 
 
16,034
 
 
$11.28
 
 
 
17,226
 
 
 
$10.50
 
 
Class B Non-Voting Common Stock
 
 
16,035
 
 
$11.28
 
 
 
17,227
 
 
 
$10.50
 
September 17, 2011 Berkshire Warrants
Voting Common Stock
    118,745     $44.09 (1)       --       --  
 
(1)
Represents an average exercise price of $44.09 per share based on exercise prices ranging from $21.38 to $73.01 per share.
 
Customers Bancorp Warrants
 
The following summary description applies to all warrants other than the Berkshire Warrants, which are separately described below.  The number of shares of Voting Common Stock and Non-Voting Common Stock issuable upon exercise of each warrant and the exercise price per share shall be proportionately adjusted:
 
·  
In the event of any change in the number of shares of Voting Common Stock outstanding by reason of any stock proportionally adjusted dividend or split, recapitalization, merger, consolidation, combination or exchange of shares or similar corporate change; and
 
·  
Subject to any required action by our shareholders, in the event of any increase or decrease in the number of issued shares of Voting Common Stock resulting from a subdivision or consolidation of shares of Voting Common Stock or the payment of a stock dividend on Voting Common Stock, or any other increase or decrease in the number of shares of Voting Common Stock outstanding effected without receipt or payment of consideration by us.
 
Subject to any required action by our shareholders, in the event that we are the surviving corporation in any merger or consolidation (except a merger or consolidation as a result of which the holders of shares of Voting Common Stock receive securities of another corporation), the number of shares issuable under each warrant immediately prior to the date of such merger or consolidation shall be converted into the securities which a holder of that number of shares would have received in such merger or consolidation.
 
In the event of (1) a dissolution or liquidation of us, (2) a sale of all or substantially all of our assets, (3) a merger or consolidation involving us in which we are not the surviving corporation, or (4) a merger or consolidation involving us, or any other reorganization transaction (including without limitation the formation of a holding company for the Bank) in which we are the surviving corporation but the holders of shares of Voting Common Stock receive securities of another corporation and/or other property, including cash, our board of directors shall provide for the exchange of each warrant for a warrant with respect to, as appropriate, some or all of the property for which each warrant is exchanged and, incident thereto, make an equitable adjustment as determined by our board of directors in its absolute discretion in the exercise price under each warrant or, if appropriate, provide for a cash payment to the warrant holder in partial consideration for the exchange of the warrant, or any combination thereof.
 
In the event of any other change in the capitalization of Customers Bancorp or corporate change other than those specifically referred to above, our board of directors may, in its absolute discretion, make such adjustments in the number and class of shares issuable upon exercise of each warrant on the date on which such change occurs, and in the exercise price of each warrant, as our board of directors may reasonably consider appropriate to prevent dilution or enlargement of rights.
 
 
 
- 122 -

 
 
 
On April 12, 2010, our board of directors approved adjustments to the terms of warrants held by those shareholders benefitting from anti-dilution agreements, to adjust the exercise price and make a corresponding adjustment to the number of shares for which each warrant is exercisable.  Warrant exercise prices were adjusted from either $16.50 per share, $12.84 per share or $11.28 per share to $10.50 per share.  The number of shares for which each warrant is exercisable were increased in proportion to the decrease in exercise price.  After the adjustment, each adjusted warrant is exercisable for the type or types of shares (Voting Common Stock or Class B Non-Voting Common Stock) for which the warrant was previously exercisable.  The number of shares of Voting Common Stock for which a warrant is exercisable is limited so that no warrant holder, after the adjustment, will have the right to purchase, nor be deemed to have the right to purchase, an amount of Voting Common Stock which, together with any other shares of our Voting Common Stock the warrant holder owns or controls or is deemed to own or control (as determined under the federal Change in Bank Control Act, as amended), comprises more than 9.9% of the aggregate outstanding shares of our Voting Common Stock (including, in calculating both the number of shares owned or controlled by the warrant holder and the number of shares outstanding, those shares of Voting Common Stock for which any warrants or options owned or controlled or deemed owned or controlled by the warrant holder are exercisable, and any shares of Voting Common Stock into which any other securities owned or controlled or deemed owned or controlled by the warrant holder are convertible).
 
Except as expressly provided in each warrant, warrant holders shall not have any rights by reason of any subdivision or consolidation of shares of stock of any class, the payment of any dividend, any increase or decrease in the number of shares of stock of any class or any dissolution, liquidation, merger, or consolidation of us or any other corporation.  Except as expressly provided in each warrant, no issuance by us of shares of stock of any class, or securities convertible into shares of stock of any class, shall affect, and no adjustment by reason thereof shall be made with respect to, the number of shares issuable upon exercise of each warrant.
 
Berkshire Warrants
 
In connection with the acquisition of Berkshire Bancorp and the Reorganization, we assumed the outstanding Berkshire Warrants which now represent warrants to purchase the Voting Common Stock of Customers Bancorp.
 
The following is a summary description of certain of the terms of the Berkshire Warrants.  The number of shares of Voting Common Stock issuable upon exercise of each warrant and the exercise price per share shall be proportionately adjusted:
 
·  
In the event of any change in the number of shares of Voting Common Stock outstanding resulting from (i) a split, division or consolidation of, or any other capital adjustment, (ii) the payment of any stock dividend with respect to shares of stock, or (iii) any other issuance of stock by transactions effected without the receipt of consideration.
 
Additionally, for certain warrant holders, the number of shares of Voting Common Stock issuable upon exercise of each warrant and the exercise price per share shall be proportionately adjusted:
 
·  
(i) if there is any public or private sale of stock, whether or not as part of an offering, or (ii) if there is an issuance of stock as a result of any stock option plan, or the sale or contribution of stock to any employee stock ownership plan, profit sharing or pension plan, other than in any case of an issuance of stock pursuant to an exercise of a warrant to the same class of warrant holders.
 
In the case of any merger into any other entity or sale or conveyance of all or substantially all of Customers Bancorp’s assets outside of the ordinary course of business then, as a condition of such change, lawful and adequate provisions shall be made whereby the holders shall thereafter have the right to receive upon payment of the purchase price in effect immediately prior to such change, upon the basis and upon the terms and conditions specified in such warrant and in lieu of the shares of common stock purchasable upon the exercise of those certain warrants, such shares of stock, securities, cash or assets which such holder would have been entitled to receive after the happening of such change had such warrant been exercised immediately prior to such change.
 
Additionally, with respect to certain of the warrants, in the event of liquidation, dissolution or winding up of the affairs of Customers Bancorp (other than in connection with a merger or sale or conveyance of all or substantially all of its assets outside of the ordinary course of business), the right to exercise each warrant shall terminate and expire at the close of business on the last full business day before the earliest date fixed for the payment of any distributable amount on the Voting Common Stock.
 
While certain of the Berkshire Warrants are transferable, others are non-transferable.
 
MATERIAL U.S. FEDERAL TAX CONSIDERATIONS
 
This discussion is not intended to be a complete analysis or description of all potential United States federal income tax considerations relating to the purchase, ownership and disposition of shares of the Voting Common Stock. In addition this discussion does not address tax consequences that may vary with, or are contingent on, individual circumstances. It also does not address any U.S. federal non-income, state, local or foreign tax consequences, estate or gift tax consequences, or alternative minimum tax consequences. Accordingly, we strongly urge you to consult with a tax advisor to determine the particular tax consequences to you of the purchase, holding and disposition of the Voting Common Stock .

The following is a summary of the material U.S. federal income tax considerations relating to the purchase, ownership and disposition of shares of the Voting Common Stock by initial beneficial owners thereof.  This summary is based upon the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the “Code”), Treasury regulations promulgated under the Code (the “Treasury Regulations”), administrative rulings and pronouncements and judicial decisions, in each case as of the date hereof. These authorities are subject to differing interpretations and are subject to change, possibly with retroactive effect , resulting in U.S. federal income tax consequences different from those discussed below.  No rulings have been sought from the Internal Revenue Service (the “IRS”) with respect to the statements made and the conclusions reached in the following summary, and there can be no assurance that the IRS will agree with such statements and conclusions or that a court will not sustain any challenge by the IRS in the event of litigation.

This summary assumes that a beneficial owner will hold shares of the Voting Common Stock as capital assets within the meaning of section 1221 of the Code.  This summary does not address the tax consequences arising under the laws of any state or local jurisdiction or Non-U.S. jurisdiction or any other U.S. federal tax consequences, such as estate and gift tax consequences or the alternative minimum tax. In addition, this summary does not address all tax considerations that might be applicable to your particular circumstances (such as the alternative minimum tax provisions of the Code), or to certain types of holders subject to special tax rules, including, without limitation, partnerships, banks, financial institutions or other “financial services” entities, broker-dealers, insurance companies, tax-exempt organizations, regulated investment companies, real estate investment trusts, retirement plans, individual retirement accounts or other tax-deferred accounts, persons who use or are required to use mark-to-market accounting for federal income tax purposes, persons that hold shares of the Voting Common Stock as part of a “straddle,” a “hedge,” a “conversion transaction” or other arrangement involving more than one position, U.S. holders (as defined below) that have a functional currency other than the U.S. dollar, certain former citizens or permanent residents of the United States or Customers Bancorp directors, officers and employees that hold or receive options to acquire the Voting Common Stock or otherwise acquire the Voting Common Stock as compensation.

If a partnership holds shares of the Voting Common Stock , the tax treatment of a partner in the partnership will generally depend upon the status of the partner and the activities of the partnership.  If you are a partner of a partnership holding shares of the Voting Common Stock , you should consult your tax advisor.
 
 
 
- 123 -

 
 
 
If you are considering the purchase of shares of the Voting Common Stock , you should consult your own tax advisors concerning the U.S. federal income tax consequences to you in light of your particular facts and circumstances and any consequences arising under the laws of any state, local, foreign or other taxing jurisdiction.
 
As used in this discussion, a “U.S. Holder” is a beneficial owner of shares of the Voting Common Stock  that is:
 
·   
an individual who is a citizen or resident of the United States;
 
·  
a corporation (or other entity treated as a corporation for U.S. federal income tax purposes) created or organized in or under the laws of the United States, any state thereof or the District of Columbia;
 
·  
an estate, the income of which is subject to U.S. federal income taxation regardless of its source; or
 
·   
a trust (i) if a court within the United States is able to exercise primary supervision over its administration and one or more U.S. persons have authority to control all substantial decisions of the trust or (ii) that has a valid election in effect under applicable Treasury Regulations to be treated as a U.S. person.
 
As used in this discussion, a “Non-U.S. Holder” is a beneficial owner of shares of the Voting Common Stock  that is neither a U.S. Holder nor a partnership or other entity treated as a partnership for U.S. federal income tax purposes.

Consequences to U.S. Holders
 
Distributions on the Voting Common Stock .  Distributions made to U.S. Holders out of our current or accumulated earnings and profits, as determined for U.S. federal income tax purposes, will be included in the income of a U.S. Holder as dividend income and will be subject to tax as ordinary income.  Dividends received by an individual U.S. Holder in taxable years beginning before January 1, 2013 that constitute “qualified dividend income” are generally subject to tax at a maximum rate of 15% applicable to net long-term capital gains, provided that certain holding period and other requirements are met.  In order for you to treat a dividend in respect of a share of Voting Common Stock  as qualified dividend income, you must hold the Voting Common Stock  for at least 61 days during the 121-day period beginning 60 days before the ex-dividend date.

Dividends received by a corporate U.S. Holder generally will be eligible for the 70% dividends-received deduction, provided that certain holding period and other requirements are met.   To be eligible for the corporate dividends-received deduction in respect of a dividend on a share of the Voting Common Stock, you must hold the Voting Common Stock for at least 46 days during the 90 day period beginning 45 days before the ex-dividend date.  The Code reduces the dividends received deduction allowed with respect to “debt-financed portfolio stock.”  Special rules under the Code also apply to any dividend on the Voting Common Stock treated as an “extraordinary dividend.” Corporate U.S. Holders should consult with their own tax advisors with respect to the possible application of these and other requirements under the Code that apply to the ownership or disposition of the Voting Common Stock in their particular circumstances.
 
Distributions in excess of our current and accumulated earnings and profits will not be taxable to a U.S. Holder to the extent that the distributions do not exceed the U.S. Holder’s adjusted tax basis in the stock to which such distribution relates, but rather will reduce the adjusted tax basis of such shares. To the extent that distributions in excess of our current and accumulated earnings and profits exceed the U.S. Holder’s adjusted tax basis in the shares of stock to which the distribution relates, such distributions will be included in income as capital gain. In addition, a corporate U.S. Holder will not be entitled to the dividends-received deduction on such portion of a distribution.
 
We will notify holders of our Voting Common Stock  after the close of our taxable year as to the portions of the distributions attributable to that year that constitute ordinary income, qualified dividend income and non-dividend distributions, if any.
 
Sale, Exchange, or other Taxable Disposition.   Upon the sale, exchange, or other taxable disposition of our Voting Common Stock , a U.S. Holder generally will recognize gain or loss equal to the difference between the amount realized upon the sale, exchange, or other taxable disposition and the U.S. Holder’s adjusted tax basis in such shares.  The amount realized by the U.S. Holder will include the amount of any cash and the fair market value of any other property received upon the sale, exchange, or other taxable disposition of such shares.  A U.S. Holder’s tax basis in a share generally will be equal to the cost of the share to such U.S. Holder, which may be adjusted for certain subsequent events (for example, if the U.S. Holder receives a non-dividend distribution, as described above).  Gain or loss realized on the sale, exchange, or other taxable disposition of our Voting Common Stock  generally will be capital gain or loss and will be long-term capital gain or loss if the shares have been held for more than one year.  Net long-term capital gain recognized by an individual U.S. Holder before January 1, 2013 generally is subject to tax at a maximum rate of 15%.  The ability of U.S. Holders to deduct capital losses is subject to limitations under the Code.
 
 
 
- 124 -

 
 
 
Information Reporting and Backup Withholding.    Generally, the amount of the payments of dividends on or the proceeds of the sale or other disposition of shares of our Voting Common Stock, the name and address of the recipient and the amount, if any, of tax withheld must be reported to the IRS. These information reporting requirements apply even if no tax was required to be withheld, but they do not apply with respect to U.S. Holders that are exempt from the information reporting rules, such as corporations. A similar report is sent to the recipient.
   
In general, backup withholding (currently at the rate of 28%, but scheduled to increase to 31% for payments made after December 31, 2012) will apply to payments received by a U.S. Holder with respect to shares of our Voting Common Stock  unless the U.S. Holder is (i) a corporation or other exempt recipient and, when required, establishes this exemption or (ii) provides its correct taxpayer identification number, certifies that it is not currently subject to backup withholding tax and otherwise complies with applicable requirements of the backup withholding tax rules. A U.S. Holder that does not provide us with its correct taxpayer identification number might be subject to penalties imposed by the IRS.
 
Backup withholding is not an additional tax. Any amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules from a payment to a U.S. Holder may be refunded or credited against the U.S. Holder’s U.S. federal income tax liability, if any, provided that the required information is furnished to the IRS in a timely manner.
 
Medicare Tax on Investment Income .  The recently enacted Patient Protection and Affordable Care Act of 2010, as amended by the Health Care and Education Affordability Reconciliation Act of 2010, will impose a 3.8% Medicare surtax on “net investment income” including, among other things, dividends and gain on sale in respect of securities like shares of our Voting Common Stock , subject to certain exceptions, for taxable years beginning after December 31, 2012.  In the case of an individual, the tax will be imposed on the lesser of (1) the shareholder’s net investment income or (2) the amount by which the shareholder’s modified adjusted gross income exceeds $250,000 (if the shareholder is married and filing jointly or a surviving spouse), $125,000 (if the shareholder is married and filing separately) or $200,000 (in any other case).  Prospective purchasers of shares of our Voting Common Stock  should consult their own tax advisors regarding the effect, if any, of the legislation on their ownership and disposition of shares of our Voting Common Stock .
 
Consequences to Non-U.S. Holders
 
Distributions on Voting Common Stock .   Distributions made to Non-U.S. Holders out of our current or accumulated earnings and profits, as determined for U.S. federal income tax purposes, and that are not effectively connected with the conduct by the Non-U.S. Holder of a trade or business within the United States, or attributable to a permanent establishment maintained in the United States if certain tax treaties apply, generally will be subject to U.S. federal income and withholding tax at a rate of 30% (or lower rate under an applicable treaty, if any).  Payments subject to withholding of U.S. federal income tax may nevertheless be exempt from withholding (or subject to withholding at a reduced rate) if the Non-U.S. Holder provides us with a properly executed IRS Form W-8BEN (or successor form) claiming an exemption from, or reduction in, withholding under the benefit of a tax treaty, or IRS Form W-8ECI (or other applicable form) stating that a dividend paid on our shares is not subject to withholding tax because it is effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business within the United States, as discussed below. 
 
To claim benefits under an income tax treaty, a Non-U.S. Holder must certify to us or our agent, under penalties of perjury, that it is a non-United States person and provide its name and address (which certification may generally be made on an IRS Form W-8BEN, or a successor form), obtain and provide a taxpayer identification number, and certify as to its eligibility under the appropriate treaty’s limitations on benefits article.  In addition, special rules may apply to claims for treaty benefits made by Non-U.S. Holders that are entities rather than individuals.  A Non-U.S. Holder that is eligible for a reduced rate of U.S. federal withholding tax under an income tax treaty may obtain a refund of any excess amounts withheld by filing an appropriate claim for refund with the IRS.
 
Sale, Exchange, or other Taxable Disposition.    A Non-U.S. Holder generally will not be subject to U.S. federal income or withholding tax on any capital gain realized on the sale, exchange, or other taxable disposition of our Voting Common Stock  provided that: (a) the gain is not effectively connected with the conduct of a trade or business within the United States, or attributable to a permanent establishment maintained in the United States if certain tax treaties apply, (b) in the case of a Non-U.S. Holder that is an individual, the Non-U.S. Holder is not present in the United States for 183 days or more in the taxable year of the sale, exchange, or other disposition of the shares, (c) the Non-U.S. Holder is not subject to tax pursuant to certain provisions of U.S. federal income tax law applicable to certain expatriates, and (d) we are not nor have we been a “United States real property holding corporation” for U.S. federal income tax purposes.  If certain other conditions are met, an individual Non-U.S. Holder who is present in the United States for 183 days or more in the taxable year of sale, exchange or other disposition of our Voting Common Stock will be subject to U.S. federal income tax at a rate of 30% on the gains realized on the sale, exchange, or other disposition of such shares.
 
We would not be treated as a “United States real property holding corporation” if less than 50% of our assets throughout a prescribed testing period consist of interests in real property located within the United States, excluding, for this purpose, interests in real property solely in a capacity as a creditor.  Even if we are treated as a “United States real property holding corporation,” a Non-U.S. Holder’s sale of our Voting Common nonetheless generally will not be subject to U.S. federal income or withholding tax, provided that (a) our stock owned is of a class that is “regularly traded,” as defined by applicable Treasury Regulations, on an established securities market, and (b) the selling Non-U.S. Holder held, actually or constructively, 5% or less of our outstanding stock of that class at all times during the five-year period ending on the date of disposition.
 
 
 
- 125 -

 
 
 
To the extent we are or have been a “United States real property holding corporation” for U.S. federal income tax purposes and a Non-U.S. Holder held, directly or indirectly, at any time during the five-year period ending on the date of disposition, more than 5% of the class of stock and the non-U.S. Holder was not eligible for any treaty exemption, any gain on the sale of our Voting Common Stock  or Non-Voting Voting Common Stock  would be treated as effectively connected with a trade or business within the United States, the treatment of which is described below, and the purchaser of the stock could be required to withhold 10% of the purchase price and remit such amount to the IRS.
 
We believe that we are not currently, and do not anticipate becoming, a “United States real property holding corporation” for U.S. federal income tax purposes.
 
Income Effectively Connected with a Trade or Business within the United States .  If a Non-U.S. Holder of our Voting Common Stock  is engaged in the conduct of a trade or business within the United States and if dividends on the shares, or gain realized on the sale, exchange, or other disposition of the shares, are effectively connected with the conduct of such trade or business (and, if certain tax treaties apply, is attributable to a permanent establishment maintained by the Non-U.S. Holder in the United States), the Non-U.S. Holder, although exempt from U.S. federal withholding tax (provided that the certification requirements discussed above are satisfied), generally will be subject to U.S. federal income tax on such dividends or gain on a net income basis in the same manner as if it were a U.S. Holder.  Non-U.S. Holders should read the material under the heading “—Consequences to U.S. Holders” above for a description of the U.S. federal income tax consequences of acquiring, owning, and disposing of our Voting Common Stock.  In addition, if such Non-U.S. Holder is a foreign corporation, it may also be subject to a branch profits tax equal to 30% (or such lower rate provided by an applicable U.S. income tax treaty) of a portion of its earnings and profits for the taxable year that are effectively connected with its conduct of a trade or business in the United States, subject to certain adjustments. 
 
Information Reporting and Backup Withholding .    We will, when required, report to the IRS and to each Non-U.S. Holder the amount of any dividends paid to, and the tax withheld, if any, with respect to such Non-U.S. Holder. Copies of these information returns might also be made available to the tax authorities of the country in which the Non-U.S. Holder resides under the provisions of a specific treaty or agreement. Backup withholding will not apply to payments of dividends on shares of our Voting Common Stock by us or our agent to a Non-U.S. Holder if the Non-U.S. Holder certifies as to its Non-U.S. Holder status under penalties of perjury. Sales or exchanges of shares of our Voting Common Stock by a Non-U.S. Holder might be subject to information reporting, and might be subject to backup withholding at the applicable rate, currently 28% (but scheduled to increase to 31% for payments made after December 31, 2012), unless the seller certifies its non-U.S. status (and certain other conditions are met) or otherwise establishes an exemption.
 
Backup withholding is not an additional tax. A Non-U.S. Holder might obtain a refund or a credit against such Non-U.S. Holder’s U.S. federal income tax liability of any amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules provided the required information is timely furnished to the IRS.
 
Non-U.S. Holders should consult their own tax advisors regarding the application of the information reporting and backup withholding rules in their particular situations, the availability of an exemption therefrom, and the procedure for obtaining such an exemption, if available.
 
Foreign Financial Institutions .   Under the Foreign Account Tax Compliance Act, the relevant withholding agent may be required to withhold 30% of:  (a) dividends paid after December 31, 2013 and (b) the proceeds of a sale of shares paid after December 31, 2014 to (i) a foreign financial institution unless such foreign financial institution agrees to verify, report and disclose certain of its U.S. account holders and meets certain other specified requirements or (ii) a non-financial foreign entity that is the beneficial owner of the payment unless such entity certifies that it does not have any substantial U.S. owners or provides the name, address and taxpayer identification number of each substantial U.S. owner and such entity meets certain other specified requirements. These requirements are different from, and in addition to, the U.S. tax certification rules described above. Prospective purchasers of shares of our Voting Common Stock should consult their tax advisors regarding these rules and the potential implications of these rules on their particular circumstances.
 
 
 
- 126 -

 
 
 
U.S. Estate Tax .  An individual who, at the time of death, is a Non-U.S. Holder will nevertheless be subject to U.S. federal estate tax with respect to shares at the graduated rates applicable to U.S. citizens and residents, unless a treaty exemption applies. If a treaty exemption is available, a decedent’s estate may nonetheless need to file a U.S. estate tax return to claim the exemption in order to obtain a U.S. federal transfer certificate. The transfer certificate will identify the property (i.e., Voting Common Stock) as to which the U.S. federal estate tax lien has been released. In the absence of a treaty, there is a $13,000 statutory estate tax credit (equivalent to an estate with assets of $60,000). Prospective purchasers of shares of our Voting Common Stock should consult their tax advisors regarding the applicability of U.S. estate tax.

Net Operating Loss Carryovers

The Code contains provisions that may limit our net operating loss carryovers available to be used to offset income in any given year upon the occurrence of certain events, including changes in the ownership interests of significant shareholders.  In the event of a cumulative change in ownership in excess of 50% over a three-year period, the amount of the net operating loss carryovers that Customers Bancorp may utilize in any one year may be limited.  Customers Bancorp undertakes no obligation to avoid or prevent an ownership change, which, when combined with the issuance of Voting Common Stock in connection with this offering, could occur in the normal course of shareholder purchases and sales of our Voting Common Stock or as a result of future financings or other transactions. At December 31, 2011, Customer Bancorp had approximately $9.2 million of federal net operating loss carryovers that expire beginning in 2029 through 2031.
 

We are offering the shares of our Voting Common Stock described in this prospectus through the several underwriters (the “Underwriters”) for whom Keefe, Bruyette & Woods, Inc. and Macquarie Capital (USA) Inc. are acting as representatives.  We have entered into an underwriting agreement with Keefe, Bruyette & Woods and Macquarie Capital, as representatives of the Underwriters, dated [●], 2012 (the “Underwriting Agreement”). Subject to the terms and conditions of the Underwriting Agreement, each of the Underwriters has severally agreed to purchase the number of shares of Voting Common Stock listed next to its name in the following table:
 
Underwriter of Shares
Number
Macquarie Capital (USA) Inc.
[●]
Keefe, Bruyette & Woods, Inc. 
[●]
      Total                                                                                
[●]
 

Our Voting Common Stock is offered subject to a number of conditions, including receipt and acceptance of the Voting Common Stock by the Underwriters. 
 
In connection with this offering, the Underwriters or securities dealers may distribute offering documents to investors electronically.
 
Commissions and discounts
 
Shares of Voting Common Stock sold by the Underwriters to the public will initially be offered at the public offering price set forth on the cover of this prospectus.  Any shares of Voting Common Stock sold by the Underwriters to securities dealers may be sold at a discount of up to $ [●] per share from the public offering price. Any of these securities dealers may resell any shares of Voting Common Stock purchased from the Underwriters to other brokers or dealers at a discount of up to $ [●] per share from the public offering price. If all of the shares of Voting Common Stock are not sold at the public offering price, the representatives may change the offering price and the other selling terms. Sales of shares of Voting Common Stock made outside of the United States may be made by affiliates of the Underwriters.
 
 
 
- 127 -

 
 
 
The following table shows the per share and total underwriting discounts and commissions we will pay to the Underwriters, assuming both no exercise and full exercise of the Underwriters’ over-allotment option to purchase an additional [●] shares of Voting Common Stock:
 
 
No Exercise
Full Exercise
Per Share                                             
$ [●]
$ [●]
Total                                             
$ [●]
$ [●]

We estimate that the total expenses of this offering payable by us, not including the underwriting discounts and commissions but including our reimbursement of certain expenses of the Underwriters, will be approximately $ [●] .

Over-allotment option

We have granted the Underwriters an option to buy up to [●] additional shares of our Voting Common Stock, at the public offering price less underwriting discounts and commissions. The Underwriters may exercise this option, in whole or from time to time in part, solely for the purpose of covering over-allotments, if any, made in connection with this offering. The Underwriters have 30 days from the date of this prospectus to exercise this option. If the Underwriters exercise this option, each Underwriter will be obligated, subject to the conditions in the Underwriting Agreement, to purchase a number of additional shares of our Voting Common Stock proportionate to such Underwriter’s initial amount relative to the total amount reflected in the table above.

No sales of similar securities

The executive officers and directors of Customers Bancorp and certain directors of Customers Bank have entered into lock-up agreements with the Underwriters. Under these agreements, we and each of these persons may not, without the prior written approval of the representatives, subject to limited exceptions, (i) offer, pledge, sell, contract to sell, sell any option or contract to purchase, purchase any option or contract to sell, grant any option, right or warrant for the sale of, or otherwise dispose of or transfer any shares of our Voting Common Stock or any securities convertible into or exchangeable or exercisable for our Voting Common Stock, whether now owned or hereafter acquired or with respect to which such person has or hereafter acquires the power of disposition, or file any registration statement under the Securities Act, as amended, with respect to any of the foregoing or (ii) enter into any swap, hedge or any other agreement or any transaction that transfers, in whole or in part, directly or indirectly, the economic consequence of ownership of the shares of our Voting Common Stock, whether any such swap, hedge or transaction is to be settled by delivery of shares of our Voting Common Stock or such other securities, in cash or otherwise. These restrictions will be in effect for a period of 90 days after the date of the Underwriting Agreement. At any time and without public notice, the representatives, may, in their sole discretion, release all or some of the securities from these lock-up agreements.

The 90-day restricted period described above is subject to extension under limited circumstances. In the event that either (1) during the period that begins on the date that is 15 calendar days plus 3 business days before the last day of the 90-day restricted period and ends on the last day of the 90-day restricted period, we issue an earnings release or material news or a material event relating to us occur; or (2) prior to the expiration of the 90-day restricted period, we announce that we will release earnings results during the 16-day period beginning on the last day of the 90-day restricted period, then the restricted period will continue to apply until the expiration of the date that is 15 calendar days plus 3 business days after the date on which the earnings release is issued or the material news or material event relating to us occurs.

Pricing of the offering

Prior to this offering, there has been no public market for our shares of Voting Common Stock.  The initial public offering price will be negotiated among us and the representatives.  Among the factors to be considered in determining the initial public offering price of the Voting Common Stock, in addition to prevailing market conditions, will be our historical performance, estimates of our business potential and our earnings prospects, an assessment of our management and the consideration of the above factors in relation to market valuation of companies in related businesses.

Indemnification and contribution

We have agreed to indemnify the Underwriters and their affiliates, selling agents and controlling persons against certain liabilities. If we are unable to provide this indemnification, we will contribute to the payments the Underwriters and their affiliates, selling agents and controlling persons may be required to make in respect of those liabilities.

Nasdaq listing

We intend to list our Voting Common Stock on the Nasdaq Global Market under the symbol “CUBI.”
 
 
 
- 128 -

 
 

 
Price stabilization and short positions

In connection with this offering, the Underwriters may engage in activities that stabilize, maintain or otherwise affect the price of our Voting C ommon Stock, including:

·  
stabilizing transactions;
 
·  
short sales; and
 
·  
purchases to cover positions created by short sales.
 
Stabilizing transactions consist of bids or purchases made for the purpose of preventing or retarding a decline in the market price of our Voting Common Stock while this offering is in progress. These transactions may also include making short sales of our Voting Common Stock, which involve the sale by the Underwriters of a greater number of shares of Voting Common Stock than they are required to purchase in this offering. Short sales may be “covered short sales,” which are short positions in an amount not greater than the Underwriters’ over-allotment option referred to above, or may be “naked short sales,” which are short positions in excess of that amount.
 
The Underwriters may close out any covered short position either by exercising their over-allotment option, in whole or in part, or by purchasing shares in the open market. In making this determination, the Underwriters will consider, among other things, the price of shares available for purchase in the open market compared to the price at which they may purchase shares through the over-allotment option. The Underwriters must close out any naked short position by purchasing shares in the open market. A naked short position is more likely to be created if the Underwriters are concerned that there may be downward pressure on the price of the Voting Common Stock in the open market that could adversely affect investors who purchased in this offering.
 
As a result of these activities, the price of our Voting Common Stock may be higher than the price that otherwise might exist in the open market. If these activities are commenced, they may be discontinued by the Underwriters at any time without notice. The Underwriters may carry out these transactions on Nasdaq, in the over-the-counter market or otherwise.
 
Affiliations
 
The Underwriters and their affiliates have provided certain commercial banking, financial advisory and investment banking services for us for which they receive fees.
 
The Underwriters and their affiliates may from time to time in the future perform services for us and engage in other transactions with us.
 
Selling restrictions
 
European Economic Area
 
In relation to each Member State of the European Economic Area which has implemented the Prospectus Directive (each, a “Relevant Member State”), each Underwriter has represented and agreed that with effect from and including the date on which the Prospectus Directive is implemented in that Relevant Member State (the “Relevant Implementation Date”) it has not made and will not make an offer of shares to the public in that Relevant Member State prior to the publication of a prospectus in relation to the shares of Voting Common Stock offered hereby which has been approved by the competent authority in that Relevant Member State or, where appropriate, approved in another Relevant Member State and notified to the competent authority in that Relevant Member State, all in accordance with the Prospectus Directive, except that it may, with effect from and including the Relevant Implementation Date, make an offer of shares to the public in that Relevant Member State at any time:
 
(a)           to legal entities which are authorized or regulated to operate in the financial markets or, if not so authorized or regulated, whose corporate purpose is solely to invest in securities;
 
(b)           to any legal entity which has two or more of (1) an average of at least 250 employees during the last financial year, (2) a total balance sheet of more than €43,000,000 and (3) an annual net turnover of more than €50,000,000, as shown in its last annual or consolidated accounts;
 
(c)           to fewer than 100 natural or legal persons (other than qualified investors, as defined in the Prospectus Directive) subject to obtaining the prior consent of Keefe, Bruyette & Woods, Inc. for any such offer; or
 
(d)           in any other circumstances which do not require the publication by us of a prospectus pursuant to Article 3 of the Prospectus Directive.
 
 
 
 
- 129 -

 
 
 
For the purposes of this provision, the expression “an offer of shares to the public” in relation to any shares in any Relevant Member State means the communication in any form and by any means of sufficient information on the terms of the offer and the shares to be offered so as to enable an investor to decide to purchase or subscribe for the shares, as the same may be varied in that Relevant Member State by any measure implementing the Prospectus Directive in that Relevant Member State, and the expression “Prospectus Directive” means Directive 2003/71/EC and includes any relevant implementing measure in each Relevant Member State.
 
United Kingdom
 
Each Underwriter has represented and agreed that:
 
(a)           it has only communicated or caused to be communicated and will only communicate or cause to be communicated an invitation or inducement to engage in investment activity (within the meaning of Section 21 of the Financial Services and Markets Act 2000, as amended (the “FSMA”)) received by it in connection with the issue or sale of the shares of Voting Common Stock offered hereby in circumstances in which Section 21(1) of the FSMA does not apply to us; and
 
(b)           it has complied and will comply with all applicable provisions of the FSMA with respect to anything done by it in relation to the shares of Voting Common Stock offered hereby in, from or otherwise involving the United Kingdom.
 
LEGAL MATTERS
 
Certain legal matters in connection with the offering have been passed upon for us by Stradley Ronon Stevens & Young, LLP, 2005 Market Street, Suite 2600, Philadelphia, PA  19103.  Certain legal matters in connection with the offering have been passed upon for the underwriters by Kilpatrick Townsend & Stockton LLP, Suite 900, 607 14th Street, NW, Washington, DC 20005-2018.
 
 
Our audited consolidated financial statements including the balance sheets as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the related statements of operations, changes in shareholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2011 have been attached to this prospectus in reliance upon the report of ParenteBeard LLC, 1869 Charter Lane, Lancaster, Pennsylvania, 17601, independent registered public accounting firm, and upon the authority of said firm as experts in accounting and auditing.

WHERE YOU CAN FIND MORE INFORMATION
 
We have filed with the SEC a registration statement on Form S-l under the Securities Act with respect to the Voting Common Stock offered hereby. This prospectus does not contain all of the information set forth in the registration statement and the exhibits and schedules thereto. For further information with respect to us and our Voting Common Stock, reference is made to the registration statement and the exhibits and any schedules filed therewith. Statements contained in this prospectus as to the contents of any contract or other document referred to are not necessarily complete and in each instance, if such contract or document is filed as an exhibit, reference is made to the copy of such contract or other document filed as an exhibit to the registration statement, each statement being qualified in all respects by such reference. A copy of the registration statement, including the exhibits and schedules thereto, may be read and copied at the SEC's Public Reference Room at 100 F Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549. Information on the operation of the Public Reference Room may be obtained by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. In addition, the SEC maintains an Internet website that contains reports and other information about issuers, like us, that file electronically with the SEC. The address of that site is http://www.sec.gov .
 
We also currently file periodic reports (e.g., annual, quarterly and current reports) with the SEC pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Exchange Act. You may read and copy any document we file at the SEC's Public Reference Room at 100 F Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549.  In addition, as a result of the offering, we will become subject to the full informational requirements of the Exchange Act, which will require us to file periodic reports, proxy statements, beneficial ownership reports and other information with the SEC. We also intend to furnish our stockholders with annual reports containing consolidated financial statements certified by an independent public accounting firm. We also maintain an Internet site at www.customersbank.com . Information on, or accessible through, our website is not part of this prospectus nor a part of any of our other filings made under the Exchange Act.
 






 
- 130 -

 






 
 

Financial Statements for the three years ended
December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009




INDEX TO CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2011 and 2010
Statements of Operations for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
Statements of Changes In Shareholders’ Equity for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
Notes to Financial Statements for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
 
 
 
F-1

 

 
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
 
 
To the Board of Directors and
Shareholders of Customers Bancorp, Inc.
 
 
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Customers Bancorp, Inc. and subsidiary (the “Bancorp”) as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 and the related consolidated statements of operations, changes in shareholders’ equity, and cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2011. These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audits.
 
 
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. The Bancorp is not required to have, nor were we engaged to perform, an audit of its internal control over financial reporting. Our audit included consideration of internal control over financial reporting as a basis for designing audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the Bancorp’s internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion. An audit also includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.
 
 
In our opinion, the financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of Customers Bancorp, Inc. and subsidiary as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, and the results of their operations and their cash flows for each of the years in the three-year period ended December 31, 2011 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.
 
 
/s/ ParenteBeard LLC
 
 
 
Lancaster, Pennsylvania
March 20, 2012
 
 
 
 
F-2

 
 

 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
CONSOLIDATED BALANCE SHEETS
(Dollar amounts in thousands, except per share data)
 
December 31, 
    2011       2010  
ASSETS
               
Cash and due from banks
 
$
7,765
   
$
6,396
 
Interest earning deposits
   
65,805
     
225,635
 
Federal funds sold
   
     
6,693
 
 Cash and cash equivalents
   
73,570
     
238,724
 
Investment securities available for sale, at fair value
   
79,137
     
205,828
 
Investment securities, held-to-maturity (fair value 2011 $330,809; 2010 $0)
   
319,547
     
 
Loans held for sale
   
174,999
     
199,970
 
Loans receivable not covered by Loss Sharing Agreements with the FDIC
   
1,216,265
     
514,087
 
Loans receivable covered under Loss Sharing Agreements with the FDIC
   
126,276
     
164,885
 
Less: Allowance for loan and lease losses
   
(15,032)
     
(15,129)
 
Total loans receivable, net
   
1,327,509
 
   
663,843
 
FDIC loss sharing receivable
   
13,077
     
16,702
 
Bank premises and equipment, net
   
9,420
 
   
4,700
 
Bank owned life insurance
   
29,268
     
25,649
 
Other real estate owned (2011 $6,166; 2010 $5,342 covered under Loss Sharing Agreements with the FDIC)
   
13,482
 
   
7,248
 
Goodwill
   
1,598
     
 
Restricted stock
   
21,818
     
4,169
 
Accrued interest receivable and other assets
   
14,107
     
7,574
 
Total assets
 
$
2,077,532
   
$
1,374,407
 
LIABILITIES AND SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
               
Liabilities:
               
Deposits:
               
Demand, non-interest bearing
 
$
114,044
   
$
72,268
 
Interest bearing
   
1,469,145
     
1,173,422
 
 Total deposits
   
1,583,189
     
1,245,690
 
Federal funds purchased
   
5,000
     
 
Other borrowings
   
331,000
     
11,000
 
Subordinated debt
   
2,000
     
2,000
 
Accrued interest payable and other liabilities
   
8,595
     
10,577
 
Total liabilities
   
1,929,784
     
1,269,267
 
                 
Commitments and contingencies (Notes 15 and 19)
               
                 
Shareholders’ equity:
               
Preferred stock, par value $1,000 per share; 100,000,000 shares  authorized; none issued
   
     
 
Common stock, par value $1.00 per share;  200,000,000 shares  authorized; shares issued 11,395,302 and 11,347,683  outstanding at December 31, 2011, and 8,398,015 issued and  outstanding at December 31, 2010
   
11,395
     
8,398
 
Additional paid in capital
   
122,602
     
88,132
 
Retained earnings
   
14,496
     
10,506
 
Accumulated other comprehensive loss
   
(245)
     
    (1,896)
 
Less: cost of treasury stock, 47,619 and 0 shares at December 31,  2011 and 2010
   
(500)
 
   
 
Total shareholders’ equity
   
147,748
     
105,140
 
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
 
$
2,077,532
   
$
1,374,407
 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.
 
 
 
 
F-3

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF OPERATIONS
(Dollar amounts in thousands, except per share data)
 
Years Ended December 31,
               
       

Interest income:
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Loans receivable, including fees
 
$
46,682
   
$
29,021
    $
12,142
 
Investment securities, taxable
   
14,064
     
1,382
     
1,140
 
Investment securities, non-taxable
   
86
     
110
     
191
 
Other
   
607
     
394
     
13
 
Total interest income
   
61,439
     
30,907
     
13,486
 
                         
Interest expense:
                       
Deposits
   
21,861
     
11,112
     
5,729
 
Borrowed funds
   
536
     
366
     
461
 
Subordinated debt
   
66
     
68
     
146
 
Total interest expense
   
22,463
     
11,546
     
6,336
 
Net interest income
   
38,976
     
19,361
     
7,150
 
Provision for loan losses
   
9,450
     
10,397
     
11,778
 
Net interest income (loss) after provision for loan losses
   
 
29,526
     
 
8,964
     
          (4,628)
 
Non-interest income:
                       
Service fees
   
698
     
643
     
458
 
Mortgage warehouse transactional fees
   
5,581
     
2,631
     
70
 
Bank owned life insurance
   
1,404
     
228
     
229
 
Gains on sales of investment securities
   
2,731
     
1,114
     
236
 
Gains on sales of SBA loans
   
329
     
98
     
 
Impairment charges on investment securities
   
     
     
   (15)
 
Bargain purchase gains on bank acquisitions
   
     
40,254
     
 
Accretion of FDIC loss sharing receivable
   
1,955
     
     
 
Gain (loss) on sale of OREO
   
367
     
(67)
     
(31)
 
Other
   
587
     
702
     
96
 
Total non-interest income
   
13,652
     
45,603
     
1,043
 
                         
Non-interest expense:
                       
Salaries and employee benefits
   
16,718
     
14,031
     
4,267
 
Occupancy
   
3,242
     
1,897
     
1,261
 
Technology, communication and bank operations
   
3,169
     
2,431
     
1,000
 
Advertising and promotion
   
994
     
1,007
     
191
 
Professional services
   
4,837
     
2,833
     
510
 
FDIC assessments, taxes, and regulatory fees
   
2,366
     
1,613
     
892
 
Loan workout and other real estate owned
   
1,988
     
682
     
531
 
Impairment and losses on other real estate owned
   
576
     
635
     
350
 
Merger related expenses
   
531
     
     
 
Other
   
2,888
     
972
     
648
 
Total non-interest expense
   
37,309
     
26,101
     
9,650
 
Income (loss) before tax expense
   
5,869
     
28,466
     
  (13,235)
 
Income tax expense
   
1,835
     
4,731
     
 
Net income (loss)
   
4,034
     
23,735
     
 (13,235)
 
Dividends on preferred stock
   
44
     
     
 
Net income (loss) available to common shareholders
 
 
$
 
3,990
   
 
$
 
23,735
    $
 (13,235)
 
 
Basic income (loss) per share
 
 
$
 
0.40
   
 
$
 
3.78
    $
 (10.98)
 
Diluted income (loss) per share
 
$
0.39
   
$
3.69
    $
(10.98)
 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.
 
 
 
F-4

 
 

 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CHANGES IN SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY
For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009
(Dollar amounts in thousands, except share and per share data)

   
Shares of
preferred stock
   
Shares of
common stock
   
Preferred Stock
   
Common Stock
   
Additional
Paid in
Capital
   
Retained
Earnings (Accumulated deficit)
   
Accumulated
other
comprehensive
income (loss)
   
Treasury Stock
   
Total
 
Balance, January 1, 2009
          673,694     $ 980     $ 674     $ 15,440     $ 10     $ (255 )         $ 16,849  
Comprehensive loss:
                                                                       
Net loss
                                  (13,235 )                 (13,235 )
Change in net unrealized losses on investment securities available for sale, net of taxes and reclassification adjustments
                                        222             222  
Total comprehensive loss
                                                    (13,013 )
Dividends paid on preferred stock Series A
                                  (4 )                 (4 )
Preferred stock Series A exchanged for common stock
          59,388       (980 )     59       921                          
Subordinated debt converted to common stock
          71,073             71       929                         1,000  
Common stock shares issued
          1,036,748             1,037       15,634                         16,671  
                                                                         
Balance, December 31, 2009
          1,840,903             1,841       32,924       (13,229 )     (33 )             21,503  
Comprehensive income:
                                                                       
Net income
                                  23,735                   23,735  
Change in net unrealized losses on investment securities available for sale, net of taxes and reclassification adjustments
                                        (1,863 )           (1,863 )
Total comprehensive income
                                                    21,872  
Stock-based compensation expense
                            2,041                         2,041  
Common stock issued, net of costs
          6,323,779             6,324       52,700                         59,024  
Shares issued under the management stock purchase plan
          233,333             233       467                         700  
                                                                         
Balance, December 31, 2010
          8,398,015             8,398       88,132       10,506       (1,896 )           105,140  
Comprehensive income:
                                                                       
Net income
                                  4,034                   4,034  
Change in net unrealized losses on investment securities available for sale, net of taxes and reclassification adjustments
                                        1,651             1,651  
Total comprehensive income
                                                    5,685  
Stock-based compensation expense
                            704                         704  
Common stock issued, net of costs
          2,373,601             2,374       26,152                         28,526  
Shares issued in the acquisition of Berkshire Bancorp, Inc.
    3,037       623,686       3,037       623       7,614                         11,274  
                                                                         
Repurchase of preferred stock
    (3,037 )           (3,037 )                                   (3,037 )
Repurchase of 47,619 shares at a cost of $10.50 per share
          (47,619 )                                   (500 )     (500 )
Dividends preferred stock
                                  (44 )                 (44 )
                                                                         
Balance, December 31, 2011
          11,347,683     $     $ 11,395     $ 122,602     $ 14,496     $ (245 )   $ (500 )   $ 147,748  

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.
 
 
 
F-5

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS
(Dollar amounts in thousands)
 
For Years Ended December 31,
 
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Cash Flows from Operating Activities
     
Net income (loss)
 
$
4,034
   
$
23,735
   
$
(13,235)
 
Adjustments to reconcile net income (loss) to net cash provided by (used in) operating activities:
                       
Provision for loan losses
   
9,450
     
10,397
     
11,778
 
Provision for depreciation and amortization
   
1,375
     
840
     
726
 
Stock based compensation
   
704
     
2,041
     
-
 
Bargain purchase gain on bank acquisitions
   
-
     
(40,254)
     
-
 
Deferred income tax expense (benefit)
   
(2,728)
     
1,817
     
(394)
 
Net amortization of investment securities premiums and discounts
   
(143)
     
(133)
     
184
 
Gain on sale of investment securities
   
(2,731)
     
(1,114)
     
(236)
 
Gain on sale of loans
   
(329)
     
(98)
     
-
 
Origination of loans held for sale
   
(2,243,122)
     
(199,970)
     
-
 
Proceeds from the sale of loans held for sale
   
2,268,340
     
-
     
-
 
Impairment charges on investment securities
   
-
     
-
     
15
 
Increase in FDIC loss sharing receivable
   
(3,920)
     
(520)
     
-
 
Amortization (accretion) of fair value discounts
   
280
     
(417)
     
-
 
(Gain) loss on sales of other real estate owned
   
(367)
     
67
     
31
 
Impairment charges on other real estate owned
   
576
     
635
     
350
 
Earnings on investment in bank owned life insurance
   
(1,404)
     
(228)
     
(229)
 
Decrease (increase) in accrued interest receivable and other assets
   
2,257
     
(11,417)
     
(1,868)
 
Increase (decrease) in accrued interest payable and other liabilities
   
(2,369)
     
(6,927)
     
450
 
Net Cash Provided by (Used in) Operating Activities
   
29,903
     
(221,546)
     
(2,428)
 
Cash Flows from Investing Activities
                       
Purchases of investment securities available for sale
   
(72,932)
     
(303,681)
     
(34,489)
 
Purchases of investment securities held to maturity
   
(397,482)
     
-
     
-
 
Proceeds from maturities, calls and principal repayments on investment securities available for sale
   
 
22,137
     
 
8,175
     
 
8,425
 
Proceeds from maturities and principal repayments on investment securities held to maturity
   
 
78,049
     
 
-
     
 
39
 
Proceeds from sales of investment securities available for sale
   
182,743
     
154,287
     
11,816
 
Sales of investment securities held to maturity
   
-
     
-
     
2,263
 
Net increase in loans
   
(581,339)
     
(175,183)
     
(14,507)
 
Purchase of loan portfolio
   
(10,000)
     
(94,632)
     
-
 
Proceeds on sale of SBA loans
   
5,172
     
1,465
     
-
 
Proceeds from (purchases of) bank owned life insurance
   
273
     
(20,466)
     
-
 
Purchase of restricted stock
   
(16,702)
     
(2,143)
     
-
 
Proceeds and acquired cash in FDIC assisted transactions
   
-
     
72,931
     
-
 
Reimbursements from the FDIC on Loss Sharing Agreements
   
7,545
     
11,115
     
-
 
Purchases of bank premises and equipment
   
(2,721)
     
(3,287)
     
(430)
 
Cash proceeds from acquisitions
   
19,207
     
-
     
-
 
Proceeds from sales of other real estate owned
   
5,572
     
2,633
     
3,071
 
Net Cash Used in Investing Activities
   
(760,478)
     
(348,786)
     
(23,812)
 
Cash Flows from Financing Activities
                       
Net increase in deposits
   
215,495
     
680,525
     
76,085
 
Net increase (decrease) in short-term borrowed funds
   
325,000
     
-
     
(4,000)
 
Payment of TARP preferred stock dividends
   
(44)
     
-
     
-
 
Purchase of treasury stock
   
(500)
     
-
     
-
 
Repayment of TARP
   
(3,056)
     
-
     
-
 
Proceeds from issuance of common stock
   
28,526
     
59,724
     
16,671
 
Dividends on preferred stock
   
-
     
-
     
(4)
 
Net Cash Provided by Financing Activities
   
565,421
     
740,249
     
88,752
 
Net Increase (Decrease) in Cash and Cash Equivalents
   
(165,154)
     
169,917
     
62,512
 
Cash and Cash Equivalents — Beginning
   
238,724
     
68,807
     
6,295
 
Cash and Cash Equivalents — Ending
 
$
73,570
   
$
238,724
   
$
68,807
 
 
See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.                                                                                                                                                         
 
 
 
 
 
 
F-6

 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS OF CASH FLOWS (continued)
(Dollar amounts in thousands, except per share data)




For Years Ended December 31,
 
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 

Supplementary Cash Flows Information
                 
Interest paid
  $ 22,642     $ 10,241     $ 5,030  
Income taxes (refund) paid
    2,816       -       (165 )
                         
Non cash items:
                       
Transfer of loans to other real estate owned
  $ 8,630       4,786       3,088  
Issuance of common stock related to the merger
    624       -       -  
Exchange of preferred shares to common stock
    -       -       980  
Conversion of subordinated term note to common stock
    -       -       1,000  
                         
                         
Acquisitions:
                       
     Assets acquired
  $ 132,512     $ 285,605     $ -  
     Liabilities assumed
    122,836       264,842       -  
                         

 

See accompanying notes to the consolidated financial statements.
 
 
 
F-7

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 1 – DESCRIPTION OF THE BUSINESS AND BASIS OF PRESENTATION

Customers Bancorp, Inc. (the “Bancorp”) is a Pennsylvania corporation formed on April 7, 2010 to facilitate the reorganization of Customers Bank (the “Bank”) into a bank holding company structure.  The reorganization was completed on September 17, 2011.   Any financial information for periods prior to September 17, 2011 contained herein reflects those of Customers Bank as the predecessor entity. The consolidated financial statements have been prepared in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States (“U.S. GAAP”) and pursuant to the rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”).  

Customers Bancorp, Inc., and its wholly-owned subsidiary, Customers Bank, serve residences and businesses in Southeastern Pennsylvania (Bucks, Berks, Chester, and Delaware Counties), Rye, New York (Westchester County) and Hamilton, New Jersey (Mercer County). On September 17, 2011, Customers Bancorp, Inc. purchased Berkshire Bancorp, Inc.  In 2010, Customers Bank acquired two banks, USA Bank and ISN Bank (the Acquired Banks), in FDIC assisted transactions that expanded its footprint into central New Jersey and southeast New York.  Customers Bancorp, Inc. has 14 branches and provides commercial banking products, primarily loans and deposits.  The Bancorp also provides liquidity to mortgage market originators nationwide through its mortgage warehouse division.  Customers Bank is subject to regulation of the Pennsylvania Department of Banking and the Federal Reserve Bank and is periodically examined by those regulatory authorities.  Customers Bank changed its name from New Century Bank in 2010.

Certain amounts reported in the 2010 and 2009 financial statements have been reclassified to conform to the 2011 presentation.  These reclassifications did not significantly impact Bancorp’s financial position or results of operations.
 

NOTE 2 – REORGANIZATION AND ACQUISITION ACTIVITY

Reorganization into Customers Bancorp, Inc.

The Bancorp and the Bank entered into a Plan of Merger and Reorganization effective September 17, 2011 pursuant to which all of the issued and outstanding common stock of the Bank was exchanged on a three to one basis for shares of common stock and Class B Non-Voting common stock of the Company. The Bank became a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Bancorp (the “Reorganization”).  The Bancorp is authorized to issue up to 100,000,000 shares of common stock, 100,000,000 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock and 100,000,000 shares of preferred stock.  All share and per share information has been retrospectively restated to reflect the Reorganization, including the three-for-one consideration used in the Reorganization.

In the Reorganization, the Bank’s issued and outstanding shares of common stock of 22,525,825 shares and Class B Non-Voting common stock of 6,834,895 shares converted into 7,508,473 shares of the Bancorp’s common stock and 2,278,294 shares of the Bancorp’s Class B Non-Voting common stock.  Cash was paid in lieu of fractional shares.  Outstanding warrants to purchase 1,410,732 shares of the Bank’s common stock with a weighted-average exercise price of $3.55 per share and 243,102 shares of the Bank’s Class B Non-Voting common stock with a weighted-average exercise price of $3.50 per share were converted into warrants to purchase 470,260 shares of the Bancorp’s common stock with a weighted-average exercise price of $10.64 per share and warrants to purchase 81,036 shares of the Bancorp’s Class B Non-Voting common stock with a weighted-average exercise price of $10.50 per share.  Outstanding stock options to purchase 2,572,404 shares of the Bank’s common stock with a weighted- average exercise price of $3.50 per share and stock options to purchase 231,500 shares of the Bank’s Class B Non-Voting common stock with a weighted-average exercise price of $4.00 per share were converted into stock options to purchase 855,774 shares of the Bancorp’s common stock with a weighted-average exercise price of $10.49 per share and stock options to purchase 77,166 shares of the Bancorp’s Class B Non-Voting common stock with a weighted-average exercise price of $12.00 per share.

Berkshire Bancorp Acquisition

On September 17, 2011, the Bancorp completed its acquisition of Berkshire Bancorp, Inc. (“BBI”) and its subsidiary, Berkshire Bank (collectively, “Berkshire”).  Berkshire Bank merged with and into the Bank immediately following the acquisition.   BBI served Berks County, Pennsylvania through the five branches of its subsidiary, Berkshire Bank.  Under the terms of the merger agreement, each outstanding share of BBI common stock (a total of 4,067,729) was exchanged for 0.1534 shares of the Bancorp’s common stock, resulting in the issuance of 623,686 shares of the Bancorp’s common stock.  Cash was paid in lieu of fractional shares.  The most recent price for the sale of Customers Bancorp, Inc. common stock, $13.20, was used to determine the fair value of the Bancorp stock issued.  The total purchase price was approximately $11,274.
 
 
 
F-8

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

The table below illustrates the calculation of the consideration effectively transferred.
     
       
Reconcilement of Pro Forma Shares Outstanding
     
Berkshire shares outstanding
   
4,067,729
 
Exchange ratio
   
0.1534
 
Bancorp shares to be issued to Berkshire
   
623,686
 
Customers shares outstanding
   
9,786,765
 
Pro Forma Customers shares outstanding
   
 10,410,755
 
Percentage ownership for Customers
   
94.01
%
Percentage ownership for Berkshire
   
5.99
%
 
In addition, Bancorp exchanged each share of BBI’s shares of Series A Preferred Securities and Series B Preferred Shares to the U.S. Treasury for one share of the Bancorp’s Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock for the total issuance of 2,892 shares of Series A Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock (“Series A Preferred Stock”) and 145 shares of Series B Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock (“Series B Preferred Stock”) with a par value of $1.00 per share and a liquidation value of $1,000 per share.  Cumulative dividends on the Series A Preferred Stock are 5% per year and Series B Preferred Stock are 9%. Upon the exchange of the Series A and B preferred shares, the Bancorp paid to the Treasury $218 of cumulative dividends which were previously unpaid.   

As a result of the Berkshire Merger, the Bancorp recognized assets acquired and liabilities assumed at the acquisition date (September 17, 2011) fair values presented below.
 
 
             
Total purchase price
       
$
11,274
 
               
Net Assets Acquired:
             
Cash
   
19,207
         
Restricted investments
   
947
         
Loans
   
98,387
         
Accrued interest receivable
   
276
         
Premises and equipment, net
   
3,374
         
Deferred tax assets
   
4,111
         
Other assets
   
6,210
         
Time deposits
   
(45,721
)
       
Deposits other than time deposits
   
(76,145
)
       
Accrued interest payable
   
(48
)
       
Other liabilities
   
(922
)
       
             
9,676
 
Goodwill resulting from Berkshire Merger
         
$
1,598
 

In addition, 774,571 warrants to purchase shares of BBI common stock were converted into warrants to purchase 118,853 shares of the Bancorp’s common stock with an exercise price ranging from $21.38 to $68.82 per share.  The warrants were extended for a five year period and will expire on September 17, 2016.  

BBI’s operating results are included in the Bancorp’s financial results from the date of acquisition, September 17, 2011 through December 31, 2011.   BBI had total assets of approximately $134,110 including total loans of $98,387 and goodwill of $1,598, with total liabilities of approximately $122,836, including total deposits of $121,866 on September 17, 2011.  The assets acquired and liabilities assumed from Berkshire are recorded at their fair value.  The fair value adjustments made to the assets and liabilities are preliminary estimates and are subject to change as further data is analyzed to complete the valuation based upon information available at the closing date.  As of December 31, 2011, there were no adjustments to fair value.

 
 
 
 
F-9

 

 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 2 – ACQUISITION ACTIVITY (continued)

FDIC Assisted Acquisitions
 
On July 9, 2010, Customers Bank acquired certain assets and assumed certain liabilities of USA Bank from the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (“FDIC”) in an FDIC-assisted transaction (the “USA Bank acquisition”). USA Bank was headquartered in Port Chester, New York and operated one branch.   On September 17, 2010, Customers Bank acquired certain assets and assumed certain liabilities of ISN Bank from the FDIC in an FDIC-assisted transaction (the “ISN Bank acquisition”). ISN Bank was headquartered in Cherry Hill, New Jersey and operated one branch.   The acquisitions were accounted for under the acquisition method of accounting in accordance with ASC Topic 805 Business Combinations . The purchased assets and assumed liabilities were recorded at their acquisition date fair values.
 
As part of the Purchase and Assumption Agreement entered into by Customers Bank with the FDIC (the “Agreement”) in connection with the USA Bank and ISN Bank acquisitions, Customers Bank entered into Loss Sharing Agreements, pursuant to which the FDIC will cover a substantial portion of any future losses on the acquired loans.  Excluding certain consumer loans, the loans and other real estate owned acquired are covered by a loss share agreement between Customers Bank and the FDIC which affords Customers Bank protection against future losses. Under the Agreement, the FDIC will cover 80% of losses on the disposition of the loans and OREO covered under the Agreements (collectively, the Covered Assets). The term for loss sharing and Customers Bank reimbursement to the FDIC is five years for non-single family loans and ten years for single family loans. The reimbursable losses from the FDIC are based on the book value of the relevant loans as determined by the FDIC at the date of the transaction. New loans made after that date are not covered by the provisions of the loss share agreement. Customers Bank has recorded an aggregate receivable from the FDIC of $28,337 for the USA Bank and ISN Bank acquisitions which represents the estimated fair value of the FDIC’s portion of the losses that are expected to be incurred and reimbursed to Customers Bank.
 
The Agreement with the FDIC for each acquisition provided Customers Bank with an option to purchase at appraised value the premises, furniture, fixtures, and equipment of each bank and assume the leases associated with these offices. Customers Bank exercised the option to purchase the assets of USA Bank during the third quarter of 2010.  Customers Bank did not exercise the option to purchase the assets of ISN Bank.  Customers Bank received approval from the FDIC and moved the deposit relationships to its Hamilton, New Jersey branch on January 18, 2011.
 
The acquired assets and liabilities, as well as the adjustments to record the assets and liabilities at fair value, are presented in the following table. Cash received from the FDIC was included in the fair value adjustments to arrive at the total assets acquired. Because the consideration paid to the FDIC was less than the net fair value of the acquired assets and assumed liabilities, the Bank recorded bargain purchase gains as part of the acquisitions.
 
A summary of the net assets acquired and the fair value adjustments for USA Bank as of July 9, 2010 and ISN Bank as of September 17, 2010 resulting in a bargain purchase gain as follows:
 
Cost basis of assets acquired in excess of liabilities assumed
 
$
20,586
 
Cash payments received from the FDIC
   
31,519
 
Net assets acquired before fair value adjustments
   
52,105
 
Fair value adjustments:
       
Loans receivable
   
(35,733
)
FDIC loss share receivable
   
28,337
 
Other real estate owned
   
(4,261
)
Bank premises and equipment and repossessed assets
   
(194
)
 Total fair value adjustments
   
(11,851
)
         
Pre-tax gain on the acquisition
   
40,254
 
Income taxes
   
(13,109
)
         
Gain on the acquisition of the Acquired Banks, net of taxes
 
$
27,145
 
 
 
 
 
F-10

 
 

 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)


NOTE 2 – ACQUISITION ACTIVITY (continued)

The net after-tax gain represents the excess of the estimated fair value of the assets acquired (including cash payments received from the FDIC) over the estimated fair value of the liabilities assumed, and is influenced significantly by the FDIC-assisted transaction process.  As indicated in the preceding table, net assets of $20,586 (i.e., the cost basis) were transferred to Customers Bank in the USA Bank and ISN Bank acquisitions and the FDIC made cash payments to the Bank totaling $31,519.
 
In many cases, the determination of the fair value of the assets acquired and liabilities assumed required management to make estimates about discount rates, future expected cash flows, market conditions, and other future events that are highly subjective in nature and subject to change.

The following table sets forth the assets acquired and liabilities assumed, at the estimated fair value, in the USA Bank and ISN Bank acquisitions:
 
   
USA Bank
July 9, 2010
   
ISN Bank
September 17, 2010
Assets Acquired
       
Cash and cash equivalents, including federal funds sold
 
$
54,140
 
$
18,791
Investment securities
   
15,330
   
6,181
Loans receivable – covered under FDIC loss sharing
   
123,312
   
51,348
Loans receivable – not covered under FDIC loss sharing
   
1,414
   
26
Total loans receivable
   
124,726
   
51,374
Other real estate owned
   
3,406
   
1,234
FDIC loss sharing receivable
   
22,728
   
5,609
Other assets
   
785
   
713
             
Total assets acquired
   
221,115
   
83,902
Liabilities Assumed
           
Deposits
           
Non-interest bearing
   
7,584
   
972
Interest bearing
   
171,764
   
70,919
Total deposits
   
179,348
   
71,891
Deferred income tax liability
   
9,390
   
3,719
Other liabilities
   
13,370
   
154
Total liabilities assumed
   
202,108
   
75,764
Net Assets Acquired
 
$
19,007
 
$
8,138
 

In accordance with the guidance provided in SEC Staff Accounting Bulletin Topic 1.K, Financial Statements of Acquired Troubled Financial Institutions (“SAB 1: K”) and a request for relief granted by the SEC, historical financial information of USA Bank and ISN Bank has been omitted from the financial statements. Relief is provided for acquisitions of troubled institutions, including transactions such as the acquisitions of USA Bank and ISN Bank in which an institution engages in an acquisition of a troubled financial institution for which audited financial statements are not reasonably available and in which federal assistance is an essential and significant part of the transaction.


 
F-11

 

CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 2 – REORGANIZATION AND ACQUISITION ACTIVITY (continued)

Loan Portfolio Acquisition

On September 30, 2011, the Bancorp purchased from Tammac Holding Corporation (“Tammac”) $19,273 of loans and a 1.50% interest only strip security with an estimated value of $3,000 secured by a pool of $70,000 of loans originated by Tammac.  The total purchase price for these assets was $13,000.

NOTE 3 – SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

Basis of Presentation

The accounting policies and reporting policies of the Bancorp are in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America and predominant practices of the banking industry.  The preparation of financial statements requires management to make estimates and assumptions that affect the reported balances of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingent assets and liabilities at the date of the financial statements and the reported balances of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ from those estimates.  Material estimates that are particularly susceptible to significant change in the near term relate to the determination of the allowance for loan and lease losses, the valuation of deferred tax assets, determination of other-than-temporary impairment losses on securities, determination of the FDIC loss sharing receivables and the fair value of financial instruments.
 
Cash and Cash Equivalents

Cash and cash equivalents include cash on hand, amounts due from banks, interest-bearing deposits with banks with a maturity date of three months or less, and federal funds sold.  Generally, federal funds are sold for one day periods.

Restrictions on Cash and Amounts due from Banks
 
Customers Bank is required to maintain average balances on hand or with the Federal Reserve Bank.  At December 31, 2011 and 2010, these reserve balances amounted to $10,228 and $3,070, respectively.

Investment Securities
 
Investments securities classified as available for sale are those securities that Bancorp intends to hold for an indefinite period of time but not necessarily to maturity. Investment securities available for sale are carried at fair value. Unrealized gains or losses are reported as increases or decreases in other comprehensive income, net of the related deferred tax effect.  Realized gains or losses, determined on the basis of the cost of the specific securities sold, are included in earnings and recorded at the trade date.  Premiums and discounts are recognized in interest income using the interest method over the terms of the securities.   
 
Investment securities classified as held to maturity are those debt securities Bancorp has both the intent and ability to hold to maturity regardless of changes in market conditions, liquidity needs or changes in general economic conditions.  These securities are carried at cost, adjusted for the amortization of premium and accretion of discount, computed by the interest method over the terms of the securities.   As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Bancorp had $319,547 and $0 in investment securities designated as held to maturity.
 
Other-than-temporary impairment means management believes the security’s impairment is due to factors that could include its inability to pay interest or dividends, its potential for default, and/or other factors. When a held to maturity or available for sale debt security is assessed for other-than-temporary impairment, management has to first consider (a) whether the Bancorp intends to sell the security, and (b) whether it is more likely than not that the Bancorp will be required to sell the security prior to recovery of its amortized cost basis.
 
 
 
 
F-12

 

 

CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 3 – SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)

If one of these circumstances applies to a security, an other-than-temporary impairment loss is recognized in the statement of operations equal to the full amount of the decline in fair value below amortized cost. If neither of these circumstances applies to a security, but the Bancorp does not expect to recover the entire amortized cost basis, an other-than-temporary impairment has occurred that must be separated into two categories: (a) the amount related to credit loss, and (b) the amount related to other factors. In assessing the level of other-than-temporary impairment attributable to credit loss, management compares the present value of cash flows expected to be collected with the amortized cost basis of the security. The portion of the total other-than-temporary impairment related to credit loss is recognized in earnings (as the difference between the fair value and the present value of the estimated cash flows), while the amount related to other factors is recognized in other comprehensive income. The total other-than-temporary impairment loss is presented in the statement of operations, less the portion recognized in other comprehensive income. When a debt security becomes other-than-temporarily impaired, its amortized cost basis is reduced to reflect the portion of the total impairment related to credit loss.
 
Loans Held for Sale
 
Loans originated with the intent to sell in the secondary market are carried at the lower of cost or fair value, determined in the aggregate. These loans are sold on a non-recourse basis with servicing released. Gains and losses on the sale of loans recognized in earnings are measured based on the difference between proceeds received and the carrying amount of the loans, inclusive of deferred origination fees and costs, if any. As a result of changes in events and circumstances or developments regarding management’s view of the foreseeable future, loans not originated or acquired with the intent to sell may subsequently be designated as held for sale. These loans are transferred to the held for sale portfolio at the lower of amortized cost or fair value.
 
Loans Receivable
 
Loans receivable that management has the intent and ability to hold for the foreseeable future or until maturity or payoff are stated at their outstanding unpaid principal balances, net of an allowance for loan and lease losses and any deferred fees.  Interest income is accrued on the unpaid principal balance.  Loan origination fees, net of certain direct origination costs, are deferred and recognized as an adjustment of the yield (interest income) of the related loans using the level-yield method without anticipating prepayments.  Customers Bank is generally amortizing these amounts over the contractual life of the loans. Loans acquired in a FDIC-assisted acquisition, that are subject to a loss share agreement, are referred to as “covered loans” and are reported separately in the balance sheet.
 
The accrual of interest is generally discontinued when the contractual payment of principal or interest has become 90 days past due or when management has doubts about further collectability of principal or interest, even though the loan is currently performing.  A loan may remain on accrual status if it is in the process of collection and is well secured.  When a loan is placed on nonaccrual status, unpaid interest credited to income is reversed. Interest received on nonaccrual loans is applied against principal until all principal has been repaid.  Thereafter, interest payments are recognized as income until all unpaid interest has been received.  Generally, loans are restored to accrual status when the obligation is brought current and has performed in accordance with the contractual terms for a minimum of six months and the ultimate collectability of the total contractual principal and interest is no longer in doubt.
 
Transfers of financial assets, including loan participations sold, are accounted for as sales, when control over the assets has been surrendered.  Control over transferred assets is deemed to be surrendered when (1) the assets have been isolated from Customers Bank, (2) the transferee obtains the right (free of conditions that constrain it from taking advantage of that right) to pledge or exchange the transferred assets, and (3) Customers Bank does not maintain effective control over the transferred assets through an agreement to repurchase them before their maturity.

Customers Bank segregates its loan portfolio into seven segments in the evaluation of the allowance for loan and lease losses.  Customers Bank loan segments are: commercial and industrial, construction, commercial real estate, residential real estate, mortgage warehouse, manufactured housing and consumer loans.  Customers Bank also breaks the residential real estate loan segment into two classes:  the first mortgage and home equity loan classes to further monitor credit risk.  The inherent credit risks within the loan portfolio varies depending upon the loan type.

Commercial and industrial loans are underwritten after evaluating historical and projected profitability and cash flow to determine the borrower’s ability to repay their obligation as agreed. Commercial and industrial loans are made primarily based on the identified cash flow of the borrower and secondarily on the underlying collateral supporting the loan facility. Accordingly, the repayment of a commercial and industrial loan depends primarily on the creditworthiness of the borrower (and any guarantors), while liquidation of collateral is a secondary and often insufficient source of repayment.
 
 
 
F-13

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 3 – SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)

Construction loans are underwritten based upon a financial analysis of the developers and property owners and construction cost estimates, in addition to independent appraisal valuations. These loans will rely on the value associated with the project upon completion. These cost and valuation estimates may be inaccurate. Construction loans generally involve the disbursement of substantial funds over a short period of time with repayment substantially dependent upon the success of the completed project. Sources of repayment of these loans would be permanent financing upon completion or sales of developed property. These loans are closely monitored by onsite inspections and are considered to be of a higher risk than other real estate loans due to their ultimate repayment being sensitive to general economic conditions, availability of long-term financing, interest rate sensitivity, and governmental regulation of real property.
 
Commercial real estate loans are subject to the underwriting standards and processes similar to commercial and industrial loans, in addition to those underwriting standards for real estate loans. These loans are viewed primarily as cash flow dependent and secondarily as loans secured by real estate.  Repayment of these loans is generally dependent upon the successful operation of the property securing the loan or the principal business conducted on the property securing the loan. Commercial real estate loans may be adversely affected by conditions in the real estate markets or the economy in general. Management monitors and evaluates commercial real estate loans based on collateral and risk-rating criteria. The Bank also utilizes third-party experts to provide environmental and market valuations. The nature of commercial real estate loans makes them more difficult to monitor and evaluate.
 
Residential real estate loans are secured by one to four dwelling units.  This segment is further divided into first mortgage and home equity loans.  First mortgages have limited risk as they are originated at a loan to value ratio of 80% or less.  Home equity loans have additional risks as a result of being in a second position in the event collateral is liquidated.
 
Mortgage warehous e loans represent loans to third-party mortgage originators during the period of financing their loan inventory until the loans are sold to investors.   Mortgage warehouse lending has a lower risk profile than other real estate loans because the loans are conforming one to four family real estate loans that are subject to purchase commitments from approved investors.
 
Manufactured housing loans represent loans that are secured by the personal property where the borrower may or may not own the underlying real estate and therefore have a higher risk than a residential real estate loan.
 
Consumer loans consist of loans to individuals originated through the Bank’s retail network and are typically unsecured or secured by personal property.  Consumer loans have a greater credit risk than residential loans because of the difference in the underlying collateral, if any.  The application of various federal and state bankruptcy and insolvency laws and may limit the amount that can be recovered on such loans.
 
Loans covered under loss sharing arrangements, including loans acquired with credit deterioration, consist of the same portfolio segments as the non-covered loans with the additional component of the loss sharing arrangements.  Covered loans with credit deterioration are presented as a separate class within the applicable portfolio segment.

On August 6, 2010, the Bank purchased a $105.8 million manufactured housing loan portfolio from Tammac for a purchase price of $105.8 million, where $94.6 million was funded on the purchase date and the remainder was held back under the provisions of the agreement and recorded in non-interest bearing deposit accounts.  The Agreement of Sale of Loans (the Agreement) includes a hold-back for 10% of the purchase price for the fulfillment of the provisions of the Agreement, including the payment of past due amounts for principal and interest of the purchased loans during the hold-back period and servicing and indemnification obligations, should these events occur through the repayment of the loan portfolio.  The loans purchased were originated on or before 2008 and were current with their payments as of August 6, 2010; accordingly, no loans were identified with credit deterioration on the purchase date.

On September 30, 2011, the Bancorp purchased from Tammac $19,273 of loans and a 1.50% interest only strip security with an estimated value of $3,000 secured by a pool of $70,000 of loans originated by Tammac.  The total purchase price for these assets was $13,000. The Bancorp recorded a discount on these loans at acquisition to record them at their realizable cash flows.  The Bancorp aggregated these loans that have common risk characteristics into a pool within the loan category of manufactured housing.
 
 
 
F-14

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 3 – SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)

Acquired Loans Receivable

Loans acquired in a business combination are recorded at fair value.  No allowance for loan and lease losses related to the acquired loans is recorded on the acquisition date because the fair value of the loans acquired incorporates assumptions regarding credit risk. The fair value estimate associated with the loans include estimates related to expected prepayments and the amount and timing of undiscounted expected principal, interest and other cash flows.
 
Loans acquired in business combinations with evidence of credit deterioration since origination and for which it is probable that all contractually required payments will not be collected are considered to be credit impaired.  Evidence of credit quality deterioration as of purchase dates may include information such as past-due and nonaccrual status, borrower credit scores and recent loan to value percentages. Acquired credit-impaired loans are initially measured at fair value, which includes estimated future credit losses expected to be incurred over the life of the loans.  The Bancorp considers expected prepayments and estimates the amount and timing of undiscounted expected principal, interest and other cash flows for each loan or pool of loans meeting the criteria above, and determines the excess of the loan’s scheduled contractual principal and contractual interest payments over all cash flows expected at acquisition as an amount that should not be accreted (nonaccretable difference). The remaining amount, representing the excess of the loan’s or pool’s cash flows expected to be collected over the amount deemed paid for the loan or pool of loans, is accreted into interest income over the remaining life of the loan or pool (accretable yield).  The Bancorp records a discount on these loans at acquisition to record them at their estimated realizable cash flows.  The Bancorp aggregates loans that have common risk characteristics into pools within the following loan categories: real estate loan pool (Berkshire acquisition) and the manufactured housing loan pool (Tammac loan purchase).

Loans acquired through business combinations that do not meet the specific criteria of FASB ASC Topic 310-30, but for which a discount is attributable at least in part to credit quality, are also accounted for under this guidance.  As a result, related discounts are recognized subsequently through accretion related to credit quality discounts is subsequently recognized based on changes in the expected cash flow of the acquired loans.  Pursuant to an AICPA letter dated December 18, 2009, the AICPA summarized the view of the SEC regarding the accounting in subsequent periods for discount accretion associated with loan receivables acquired in a business combination or asset purchase.  Regarding the accounting for such loan receivables, that in the absence of further standard setting, the AICPA understands that the SEC would not object to an accounting policy based on contractual cash flows or an accounting policy based on expected cash flows. Management believes the approach using expected cash flows is a more appropriate option to follow in accounting for the fair value discount.
 
Subsequent to the acquisition date, increases in cash flows expected to be received in excess of the Bancorp’s initial investment in the loans are accreted into interest income on a level-yield basis over the life of the loan.  Decreases in cash flows expected to be collected should be recognized as impairment through the provision for loan losses. 

Allowance for loan and lease Losses (“ALLL”)
 
The allowance for loan and lease losses is established as losses are estimated to have occurred through provisions for loan losses charged against income.  Loans deemed to be uncollectible are charged against the allowance for loan and lease losses, and subsequent recoveries, if any, are credited to the allowance. The allowance for loan and lease losses is maintained at a level considered appropriate to meet probable loan losses.  
 
Customers Bank disaggregates its loan portfolio into segments for purposes of determining the allowance for loan and lease losses. Customers Bank’s portfolio segments include commercial and industrial, commercial real estate, construction, residential real estate, mortgage warehouse, manufactured housing and consumer. The Bank further disaggregates its residential real estate portfolio segment into two classes based upon certain risk characteristics; first mortgages and home equity.  The remaining portfolio segments are also considered classes for purposes of monitoring and assessing credit quality based on certain risk characteristics.  The allowance consists of specific, general, and unallocated components.  The allowance for loan and lease losses is maintained at a level considered adequate to provide for losses that can be reasonably anticipated.  Management performs a quarterly evaluation of the adequacy of the allowance, which is based on the Company’s past loan loss experience, known and inherent risks in the portfolio, adverse situations that may affect the borrower’s ability to repay, the estimated value of any underlying collateral, composition of the loan portfolio, current economic conditions and other relevant factors.  This evaluation is inherently subjective as it requires material estimates that may be susceptible to significant revision as more information becomes available.  Customers Bank’s current methodology for determining the ALLL is based on historical loss rates, risk ratings, specific allocation on loans identified as impaired above specified thresholds and other qualitative adjustments.


 
F-15

 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 3 – SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)

The specific component relates to loans that are classified as impaired.  For such loans, an allowance is established when the (i) discounted cash flows, or (ii) collateral value, or (iii) observable of the impaired loan is lower than the carrying value of the loan.  The general component covers pools of loans by loan class including commercial loans not considered impaired, as well as smaller balance homogeneous loans, such as residential real estate, home equity loans, home equity lines of credit and other consumer loans.  These pools of loans are evaluated for loss exposure based upon loan risk ratings and historical loss rates for each of these categories of loans, adjusted for relevant qualitative factors.  Separate qualitative adjustments are made for higher-risk criticized loans that are not impaired.  These qualitative risk factors include:

1.  
Lending policies and procedures, including underwriting standards and historical-based loss/collection, charge-off, and recovery practices.
2.  
National, regional, and local economic and business conditions as well as the condition of various market segments, including the value of underlying collateral for collateral dependent loans.
3.  
Nature and volume of the portfolio and terms of loans.
4.  
Experience, ability, and depth of lending management and staff.
5.  
Volume and severity of past due, classified and nonaccrual loans as well as trends and other loan modifications.
6.  
Existence and effect of any concentrations of credit and changes in the level of such concentrations.

Each factor is assigned a value to reflect improving, stable or declining conditions based on management’s best judgment using relevant information available at the time of the evaluation.

An unallocated component is maintained to cover uncertainties that could affect management’s estimate of probable losses.  The unallocated component of the allowance reflects the margin of imprecision inherent in the underlying assumptions used in the methodologies for estimating specific and general losses in the portfolio.

Delinquency monitoring is used to identify credit risks and the general reserves are established based on the expected net charge-offs, adjusted for qualitative factors. Loss rates are based on the average net charge-off history by portfolio segment. Historical loss rates may be adjusted for significant factors that, in management’s judgment, are necessary to reflect losses inherent in the portfolio. Factors that management considers in the analysis include the effects of the national and local economies; trends in the nature and volume of delinquencies, charge-offs and trends in nonaccrual loans; changes in loan mix; risk management and loan administration; changes in the internal lending policies and credit standards; collection practices and the Bank’s regulatory examiners.
 
Charge-offs on the commercial and industrial, construction and commercial real estate loan segments are recorded when management estimates that there are insufficient cash flows to repay the loan contractual obligation based upon financial information available and valuation of the underlying collateral.  Additionally, the Bank takes into account the strength of any guarantees and the ability of the borrower to provide value related to those guarantees in determining the ultimate charge-off or reserve associated with any impaired loans. Accordingly, the Bank may charge-off a loan to a value below the net appraised value if it believes that an expeditious liquidation is desirable in the circumstance and it has legitimate offers or other indications of interest to support a value that is less than the net appraised value. Alternatively, the Bank may carry a loan at a value that is in excess of the appraised value if the Bank has a guarantee from a borrower that the Bank believes has realizable value. In evaluating the strength of any guarantee, the Bank evaluates the financial wherewithal of the guarantor, the guarantor’s reputation, and the guarantor’s willingness and desire to work with the Bank. The Bank then conducts a review of the strength of a guarantee on a frequency established as the circumstances and conditions of the borrower warrant.

Customers Bank records a loan charge-off for the residential real estate, consumer, manufactured housing and mortgage warehouse portfolio segments after 120 days of delinquency or sooner when cash flows are determined to be insufficient for repayment. The Bank may also charge-off these loan types below the net appraised valuation if the Bank holds a junior mortgage position in a piece of collateral whereby the risk to acquiring control of the property through the purchase of the senior mortgage position is deemed to potentially increase the risk of loss upon liquidation due to the amount of time to ultimately market the property and the volatile market conditions. In such cases, the Bank may abandon its junior mortgage and charge-off the loan balance in full.  
 
 
 
 
F-16

 

 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 3 – SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)

Credit Quality Factors
 
To facilitate the monitoring of credit quality within the commercial and industrial, commercial real estate, construction portfolio and residential real estate segments, and for purposes of analyzing historical loss rates used in the determination of the ALLL for the respective portfolio segment, the Bank utilizes the following categories of risk ratings: pass, special mention, substandard, doubtful or loss. The risk rating categories, which are derived from standard regulatory rating definitions, are assigned upon initial approval of credit to borrowers and updated periodically thereafter. Pass ratings, which are assigned to those borrowers that do not have identified potential or well defined weaknesses and for which there is a high likelihood of orderly repayment, are updated periodically based on the size and credit characteristics of the borrower. All other categories are updated on a quarterly basis during the month preceding the end of the calendar quarter.  While assigning risk ratings involves judgment, the risk rating process allows management to identify riskier credits in a timely manner and allocate the appropriate resources to managing the loans.
 
The Bank assigns a special mention rating to loans that have potential weaknesses that deserve management’s close attention. If left uncorrected, these potential weaknesses may, at some future date, result in the deterioration of the repayment prospects for the loan and the Bank’s credit position.
 
The Bank assigns a substandard rating to loans that are inadequately protected by the current sound worth and paying capacity of the borrower or of the collateral pledged. Substandard loans have well defined weaknesses or weaknesses that could jeopardize the orderly repayment of the debt. Loans in this category also are characterized by the distinct possibility that the Bank will sustain some loss if the deficiencies noted are not addressed and corrected.
 
The Bank assigns a doubtful rating to loans that have all the attributes of a substandard rating with the added characteristic that the weaknesses make collection or liquidation in full, on the basis of currently existing facts, conditions, and values, highly questionable and improbable. The possibility of loss is extremely high, but because of certain important and reasonable specific pending factors that may work to the advantage of and strengthen the credit quality of the loan, its classification as an estimated


 
F-17

 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 3 – SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)

loss is deferred until its more exact status may be determined. Pending factors may include a proposed merger or acquisition, liquidation proceeding, capital injection, perfecting liens on additional collateral or refinancing plans. Loans classified as loss are considered uncollectible and are charged off in the period in which they are determined uncollectible.
 
Risk ratings are not established for home equity loans, consumer loans, and installment loans, mainly because these portfolios consist of a larger number of homogenous loans with smaller balances. Instead, these portfolios are evaluated for risk mainly based on aggregate payment history, through the monitoring of delinquency levels and trends.
 
Impaired loans
 
A loan is considered impaired when, based on current information and events, it is probable that Customers Bank will be unable to collect the scheduled payments of principal or interest when due according to the contractual terms of the loan agreement.  Factors considered by management in determining impairment include payment status, collateral value and the probability of collecting scheduled principal and interest payments when due.  Loans that experience insignificant payment delays and payment shortfalls generally are not classified as impaired.  Management determines the significance of payment delays and payment shortfalls on a case-by-case basis, taking into consideration all of the circumstances surrounding the loan and the borrower, including the length of the delay, the reasons for the delay, the borrower’s prior payment record and the amount of the shortfall in relation to the principal and interest owed.  
 
Impairment is measured on a loan by loan basis for commercial and construction loans by either the present value of expected future cash flows discounted at the loan’s effective interest rate, the loan’s obtainable market price or the fair value of the collateral if the loan is collateral dependent.  Fair value is measured based on the value of the collateral securing the loans, less cost to sell. Collateral may be in the form of real estate or business assets including equipment, inventory, and accounts receivable. The vast majority of the collateral is real estate. The value of real estate collateral is determined utilizing an income or market valuation approach based on an appraisal conducted by an independent, licensed appraiser outside of the Bank using observable market data. The value of business equipment is based upon an outside appraisal if deemed significant, or the net book value on the applicable business’ financial statements if not considered significant using observable market data. Likewise, values for inventory and accounts receivables collateral are based on financial statement balances or aging reports.

Covered loans are and will continue to be subject to the Bank’s internal and external credit review and monitoring that is applied to the non-covered loan portfolio. If credit deterioration is experienced subsequent to the initial acquisition fair value amount, such deterioration will be measured, and a provision for loan losses will be charged to earnings. These provisions will be offset by an increase to the FDIC loss sharing receivable for the estimated portion anticipated to be received from the FDIC, and is recognized in non-interest income.

Loans Receivable Covered Under Loss Sharing Agreements
 
Loans acquired in the two FDIC assisted transactions are recorded at fair value at the acquisition date and are subject to Loss Sharing Agreements with the FDIC.  In the acquisitions of the Acquired Banks, the fair value was determined based on expected future cash flows and the fair value of the collateral. Factors considered in determining the fair value (Level 3) of the acquired loans include projected cash flows, type of loan and related collateral, classification status, contractual interest rate, term of loan, amortization status, current market conditions and discount rates.  Loans were evaluated individually when applying valuation techniques for the majority of the loans of the Acquired Banks. The present values of projected cash flows are measured using discount rates that are based on current market rates for new originations of comparable loans. The discount rates do not include adjustments for credit losses that are included in the estimated cash flows.
 
At the date of the acquisitions, Customers Bank analyzed the delinquent and nonaccrual loans, the eighteen month history of delinquency and reviewed the financial information available for each loan with in the Acquired Banks’ loan portfolios.   The loans acquired from USA Bank that met the definition under ASC 310-30 as a loan with credit deterioration were individually reviewed and no loan pools were created.  The loans acquired from ISN Bank that met the definition under ASC 310-30 were further evaluated and separated into loans to be individually reviewed and loans to be pooled based upon risk characteristics.  Acquired loans with a fair market value of $101,622 did not appear to have characteristics of credit deterioration and $74,478 appeared to have characteristics of credit deterioration on their acquisition dates.
 
 
 
F-18

 

 

CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 3 – SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)

Acquired loans that were not individually reviewed but had characteristics of credit deterioration are aggregated into pools, based on individually evaluated common risk characteristics, and aggregate expected cash flows were estimated for each pool. Loans acquired from USA Bank were individually reviewed.  A pool is accounted for as a single asset with a single interest rate, cumulative loss rate and cash flow expectation. The Bank aggregated three pools of acquired loans in the ISN Bank acquisition totaling $6,211 at the acquisition date that were determined to have credit deterioration characteristics primarily based onnon-accrual or significant delinquency status. A loan will be removed from a pool of loans only if the loan is sold, foreclosed, assets are received in satisfaction of the loan, or the loan is written off, and will be removed from the pool at the carrying value. If an individual loan is removed from a pool of loans, the difference between its relative carrying amount and the cash, fair value of the collateral, or other assets received will be recognized in income immediately and would not affect the effective yield used to recognize the accretable difference on the remaining pool.
 
The fair value of loans with evidence of credit deterioration are recorded net of a nonaccretable difference and, if appropriate, an accretable yield. The difference between contractually required payments at acquisition and the cash flows expected to be collected at acquisition is the nonaccretable difference, which is included in the carrying amount of acquired loans. Subsequent decreases to the expected cash flows will generally result in a provision for loan and lease losses. Subsequent increases in cash flows result in a reversal of the provision for loan and lease losses to the extent of prior charges, or a reclassification of the difference from nonaccretable to accretable with a positive impact on accretion of interest income in future periods. Further, any excess of cash flows expected at acquisition over the estimated fair value is referred to as the accretable yield and is recognized in interest income over the remaining life of the loan when there is a reasonable expectation about the amount and timing of those cash flows.

Restricted Stock
 
Restricted stock, included in other assets, represents required investment in the capital stock of the Federal Home Loan Bank, the Federal Reserve Bank, and Atlantic Central Bankers Bank and is carried at cost. In December 2009, the FHLB of Pittsburgh notified member banks that it was suspending dividend payments and the repurchase of capital stock.  Management’s determination of whether these investments are impaired is based on their assessment of the ultimate recoverability of their cost rather than by recognizing temporary declines in value.  The determination of whether a decline affects the ultimate recoverability of their cost is influenced by criteria such as (1) the significance of the decline in net assets of the FHLB as compared to the capital stock amount for the FHLB and the length of time this situation has persisted, (2) commitments by the FHLB to make payments required by law or regulation and the level of such payments in relation to the operating performance of the FHLB, and (3) the impact of legislative and regulatory changes on institutions and, accordingly, on the customer base of the FHLB.  Management believes no impairment charge was necessary related to the restricted stock as of December 31, 2011 and 2010.  In February 2012, the FHLB declared a dividend payable to the Bank’s shareholders and also resumed repurchase of excess capital stock.
 
Other Real Estate Owned
 
Real estate properties acquired through, or in lieu of, loan foreclosure are initially recorded at fair value less cost to sell at the date of foreclosure establishing a new cost basis.   After foreclosure, valuations are periodically performed by management and the real estate is carried at the lower of its carrying amount or fair value less the cost to sell. Revenue and expenses from operations and changes in the valuation allowance are included in the statement of operations.   Certain other real estate owned (OREO) that was acquired from USA Bank and ISN Bank or through the foreclosure of loans of those banks is subject to Loss Sharing Agreements with the FDIC.
 
 
 
 
F-19

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 3 – SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)

FDIC Loss Sharing Receivable
 
The FDIC loss sharing receivable was initially recorded at fair value, based on the discounted value of expected future cash flows under the loss share agreements. The difference between the present value and the undiscounted cash flows the Bank expects to collect from the FDIC is accreted into non-interest income over the life of the FDIC loss sharing receivable.
 
The FDIC loss sharing receivable is reviewed quarterly and adjusted for any changes in expected cash flows based on recent performance and expectations for future performance of the covered portfolio. These adjustments are measured on the same basis as the related covered loans and covered other real estate owned. Any increases in cash flow of the covered assets over those expected will reduce the FDIC loss sharing receivable and any decreases in cash flow of the covered assets under those expected will increase the FDIC loss sharing receivable. Increases to the FDIC loss sharing receivable are recorded immediately as adjustments to non-interest income and decreases to the FDIC loss sharing receivable are recognized over the life of the loss share agreements.
 
Bank Owned Life Insurance
 
Bank owned life insurance policies insure the lives of officers of the Bank, and name the Bank as beneficiary. Non-interest income is generated tax-free (subject to certain limitations) from the increase in the policies’ underlying investments made by the insurance company. The Bank is capitalizing on the ability to partially offset costs associated with employee compensation and benefit programs with the bank owned life insurance.
 
Bank Premises and Equipment
 
Bank premises and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation. Depreciation is computed on the straight-line method over the estimated useful lives of the related assets.  Leasehold improvements are amortized over the shorter of the term of the lease or estimated useful life, unless extension of the lease term is reasonably assured.
 
Income Taxes
 
Customers Bank accounts for income taxes under the liability method of accounting for income taxes.  The income tax accounting guidance results in two components of income tax expense: current and deferred.  Current income tax expense reflects taxes to be paid or refunded for the current period by applying the provisions of the enacted tax law to the taxable income or excess of deductions over revenues.  The Bancorp determines deferred income taxes using the liability (or balance sheet) method.  Under this method, the net deferred tax asset or liability is based on the tax effects of the differences between the book and tax bases of assets and liabilities, and enacted changes in tax rates and laws are recognized in the period in which they occur.
 
A tax position is recognized if it is more likely than not, based on the technical merits, that the tax position will be realized or sustained upon examination.  The term more likely than not means a likelihood of more than 50 percent; the terms examined and upon examination also include resolution of the related appeals or litigation process, if any.  A tax position that meets the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold is initially and subsequently measured as the largest amount of tax benefit that has a greater than 50 percent likelihood of being realized upon settlement with a taxing authority that has full knowledge of all relevant information.  The determination of whether or not a tax position has met the more-likely-than-not recognition threshold considers the facts, circumstances, and information available at the reporting date and is subject to management’s judgment.  
 
In assessing the realizability of federal or state deferred tax assets, management considers whether it is more likely than not that some portion or all of the deferred tax assets will not be realized.  The ultimate realization of deferred tax assets is dependent upon the generation of future taxable income during periods in which those temporary differences become deductible.  Management considers the scheduled reversal of deferred tax liabilities, projected future taxable income and prudent, feasible and permissible as well as available tax planning strategies in making this assessment.  Based on the level of historical taxable income and projections for future taxable income over the periods in which the deferred tax assets are deductible as well as available tax planning strategies, management believes it is more likely than not that Bancorp will realize the benefits of these deferred tax assets.
 
Stock-Based Compensation
 
Customers Bank has two active stock-based compensation plans. Stock based compensation accounting guidance requires that the compensation cost relating to share-based payment transactions be recognized in financial statements.  That cost is measured based on the grant-date fair value of the equity or liability instruments issued.
 
 
 
F-20

 
 
  
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 3 – SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)

Stock-Based Compensation (continued)

Compensation cost for all stock awards is calculated and recognized over the employees’ service period, generally defined as the vesting period.  For awards with graded-vesting, compensation cost is recognized on a straight-line basis over the requisite service
period for the entire award.  A Black-Scholes model is used to estimate the fair value of stock options, while the market price of Customers Bank’s common stock at the date of grant is used for restricted stock awards.

Comprehensive Income
 
Comprehensive income (loss) consists of net income (loss) and other comprehensive income.  Other comprehensive income includes unrealized gains and losses on securities available for sale, and unrealized losses related to factors other than credit on debt securities which have been determined to be other-than-temporarily impaired.
 
Earnings per Share
 
Basic earnings per share represents net income divided by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding during the period.  Diluted earnings per share reflects the potential dilution that could occur if (i) options to issue common stock were exercised and (ii) warrants to issue common stock were exercised.  Potential common shares that may be issued related to outstanding stock options are determined using the treasury stock method.
 
Segment Information
 
Customers Bancorp, Inc. has one reportable segment, “Community Banking.”  All of the Company’s activities are interrelated, and each activity is dependent and assessed based on how each of the activities of the Company supports the others.  For example, lending is dependent upon the ability of the Company to fund itself with deposits and borrowings while managing the interest rate and credit risk.  Accordingly, all significant operating decisions are based upon analysis of the Bank as one segment or unit.

New Accounting Pronouncements

In April 2011, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (“FASB”) issued Accounting Standards Update (“ASU”) 2011-02, A Creditor’s Determination of Whether a Restructuring Is a Troubled Debt Restructuring, providing additional guidance to creditors for evaluating troubled debt restructurings. The amendments clarify the guidance in ASC 310-40,  Receivables: Troubled Debt Restructurings by Creditors, which requires a creditor to classify a restructuring as a troubled debt restructuring (TDR) if: (1) the restructuring includes a concession by the creditor to the borrower, and, (2) the borrower is experiencing financial difficulties. The amended guidance requires a creditor to consider all aspects of the restructuring to determine whether it has granted a concession. It further clarifies that a creditor must consider the probability that a debtor could default in the foreseeable future when determining whether the debtor is facing financial difficulty, even though the debtor may not be in default at the date of restructuring. This new guidance requires a company to retrospectively evaluate all restructurings occurring on or after the beginning of the fiscal year of adoption to determine if the restructuring is a TDR.  As a result of the Bancorp’s adoption, the notes to the financial statements have been updated to include the expanded disclosures.

 In April 2011, the FASB issued ASU 2011-03, Reconsideration of Effective Control for Repurchase Agreements. This ASU removes from the assessment of effective control (1) the criterion requiring the transferor to have the ability to repurchase or redeem the financial assets on substantially the agreed terms, even in the event of default by the transferee, and (2) the collateral maintenance implementation guidance related to that criterion. This guidance is effective for the first interim or annual period beginning on or after December 15, 2011. The guidance is to be applied prospectively to transactions or modifications of existing transactions that occur on or after the effective date. Adoption of this guidance is not expected to have a material impact on results of operations or financial condition.
 
In May 2011, the FASB issued ASU 2011-04, Amendments to Achieve Common Fair Value Measurements and Disclosure Requirements in U.S. GAAP and IFRS. The amendments change the wording used to describe many of the requirements in U.S. GAAP for measuring fair value and for disclosing information about fair value measurements. The guidance is effective during interim and annual periods beginning after December 15, 2011. The guidance is to be applied prospectively, and early application by public entities is not permitted. Adoption of the guidance is not expected to have a significant impact on the Bancorp’s financial statements.

 
 
F-21

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 3 – SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES (continued)

In June 2011, the FASB issued ASU 2011-05, Presentation of Comprehensive Income. Under the new guidance, the components of net income and the components of other comprehensive income can be presented either in a single continuous statement of comprehensive income or in two separate but consecutive statements. This guidance eliminates the option to present components of other comprehensive income as part of the changes in shareholders’ equity. This amendment will be applied retrospectively, and the amendments are effective for fiscal years and interim periods ending after December 15, 2012. Early adoption is permitted. Adoption of the guidance is not expected to have a significant impact on the Bancorp’s financial statements.

In September, 2011, the FASB issued ASU 2011-08, Testing Goodwill for Impairment. The purpose of this ASU is to simplify how entities test goodwill for impairment by adding a new first step to the preexisting goodwill impairment test under ASC Topic 350, Intangibles – Goodwill and other. This amendment gives the entity the option to first assess a variety of qualitative factors such as economic conditions, cash flows, and competition to determine whether it was more likely than not that the fair value of goodwill has fallen below its carrying value. If the entity determines that it is not likely that the fair value has fallen below its carrying value, then the entity will not have to complete the original two-step test under Topic 350. The amendments in this ASU are effective for impairment tests performed for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2011. Early adoption is permitted. The Bancorp is evaluating the impact of this ASU on its consolidated financial statements.

In December, 2011, the FASB issued ASU 2011-10, Derecognition of in Substance Real Estate – a Scope Clarification. This ASU clarifies previous guidance for situations in which a reporting entity would relinquish control of the assets of a subsidiary in order to satisfy the nonrecourse debt of the subsidiary. The ASU concludes that if control of the assets has been transferred to the lender, but not legal ownership of the assets; then the reporting entity must continue to include the assets of the subsidiary in its consolidated financial statements. The amendments in this ASU are effective for public entities for annual and interim periods beginning on or after June 15, 2012. Early adoption is permitted. The Bancorp does not expect this ASU to have a significant impact on its consolidated financial statements.

In December, 2011, the FASB issued ASU 2011-11, Disclosures about Offsetting Assets and Liabilities, in an effort to improve comparability between U.S. GAAP and IFRS financial statements with regard to the presentation of offsetting assets and liabilities on the statement of financial position arising from financial and derivative instruments, and repurchase agreements. The ASU establishes additional disclosures presenting the gross amounts of recognized assets and liabilities, offsetting amounts, and the net balance reflected in the statement of financial position. Descriptive information regarding the nature and rights of the offset must also be disclosed. The Bancorp does not expect this ASU to have a significant impact on its consolidated financial statements.

In December, 2011, the FASB issued ASU 2011-12, Deferral of the Effective Date to the Presentation of Reclassifications of Items Out of Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income in Accounting Standards Update 2011-05. In response to stakeholder concerns regarding the operational ramifications of the presentation of these reclassifications for current and previous years, the FASB has deferred the implementation date of this provision to allow time for further consideration. The requirement in ASU 2011-05, Presentation of Comprehensive Income, for the presentation of a combined statement of comprehensive income or separate, but consecutive, statements of net income and other comprehensive income is still effective for fiscal years and interim periods beginning after December 15, 2011 for public companies.  The adoption of this ASU did not have a significant impact on the Company’s consolidated financial statements.



 
 
F-22

 


CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 4 – EARNINGS PER SHARE

Basic earnings per share are computed by dividing net income by the weighted-average number of common shares outstanding during the period.  Diluted earnings per share reflects the potential dilution that could occur if (i) options to purchase common stock were exercised and (ii) warrants to purchase common stock were exercised.  Potential common shares that may be issued related to outstanding stock options are determined using the treasury stock method. The following are the components of the Bancorp’s earnings per share for the periods presented:

   
December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Net income (loss) allocated to common shareholders
  $ 3,990     $ 23,735     $ (13,235 )
   Weighted-average number of common shares outstanding - basic
    10,071,566       6,303,005       1,206,001  
            Stock-based compensation plans
    141,263       97,893        
            Warrants
    71,532       48,115        
Weighted-average number of common shares - diluted
    10,284,361       6,449,013       1,206,001  
                         
Basic earnings (loss) per share
  $ 0.40     $ 3.78     $ (10.98 )
Diluted earnings (loss) per share
  $ 0.39     $ 3.69     $ (10.98 )

Stock options outstanding for 34,130 shares of common stock with exercise prices ranging from $12.96 to $33.00 and warrants for 130,047 shares of common stock with exercise prices ranging from $16.50 to $68.82 for the year ended December 31, 2011 were not dilutive because the exercise prices were greater than the average market price. Stock options outstanding for 9,616 shares of common stock with exercise prices ranging from $30.75 to $33.00 and warrants for 11,197 shares of common stock with an exercise price of $16.50 for the year ended December 31, 2010 were not dilutive because the exercise prices were greater than the average market price.  Stock options outstanding for 14,936 shares of common stock with exercise prices ranging from $30.75 to $33.00 and warrants for 238,973 shares of common stock with an exercise price of $16.50 for the year ended December 31, 2009 were not dilutive due to losses in 2009. 
 
NOTE 5 – INVESTMENT SECURITIES

The amortized cost and approximate fair value of investment securities as of December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010 are summarized as follows:

   
December 31, 2011
 
   
Amortized Cost
   
Gross Unrealized Gains
   
Gross Unrealized Losses
   
Fair Value
 
Available for Sale:
                       
U.S. Treasury and government agencies
 
$
1,002
   
$
   
$
(1)
   
$
1,001
 
Mortgage-backed securities (1)
   
55,818
     
581
     
(107
)
   
56,292
 
Asset-backed securities
   
622
     
5
     
     
627
 
Municipal securities
   
2,071
     
     
(71
)
   
2,000
 
Corporate notes
   
20,000
     
     
(783
)
   
19,217
 
   
$
79,513
   
$
586
   
$
(962
)
 
$
79,137
 
                                 
Held to Maturity:
     
Mortgage-backed securities
 
$
319,547
   
$
11,262
   
$
   
$
330,809
 
 
(1)           Includes an interest only strip security of $2,894. 
 
 
 
F-23

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 5 – INVESTMENT SECURITIES (continued)
 
   
December 31, 2010
 
   
Amortized Cost
   
Gross Unrealized Gains
   
Gross Unrealized Losses
 
Fair Value
 
       
Available for Sale:
                       
U.S. Treasury and government agencies
 
$
1,711
   
$
   
$
(30
)
 
$
1,681
 
Mortgage-backed securities
   
204,182
     
561
     
(3,169
)
   
201,574
 
Asset-backed securities
   
719
     
3
     
     
722
 
Municipal securities
   
2,088
     
     
(237
)
   
1,851
 
   
$
208,700
   
$
564
   
$
(3,436
)
 
$
205,828
 

The following table shows proceeds from the sale of available for sale investment securities, gross gains and gross losses on those sales of securities:

   
December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
 Proceeds from sale of available-for-sale investment securities
  $ 182,743     $ 154,287     $ 11,816  
 Proceeds from sale of held-to-maturity investment securities
    -       -       2,263  
 Gross gains
    2,731       1,117       236  
 Gross losses
    -       (3 )     -  
 Net gains
    2,731       1,114       236  

The following table shows investment securities by stated maturity. Investment securities backed by mortgages have expected maturities that differ from contractual maturities because borrowers have the right to call or prepay, and are, therefore, classified separately with no specific maturity date:
 
 
December 31, 2011
 
 
Available-for-Sale
 
Held-to-Maturity
 
 
Amortized
Cost
 
Fair
Value
 
Amortized
Cost
 
Fair
Value
 
Due in one year or less
 
$
1,102
   
$
1,102
   
$
   
$
 
Due after one year through five years
   
22,477
     
21,626
     
     
 
Due after five years through ten years
   
77
     
78
     
     
 
Due after ten years
   
39
     
39
     
     
 
     
23,695
     
22,845
     
     
 
Mortgage-backed securities (1)
   
55,818
     
56,292
     
319,547
     
330,809
 
Total investment securities
 
$
79,513
   
$
79,137
   
$
319,547
   
$
330,809
 
 
 (1)           Includes an interest only strip security of $2,894.
 
In 2009, the Bancorp’s decision to sell all of its held to maturity securities resulted from concerns of the economy and the resulting impact on asset quality, the opportunity to take advantage of gains that existed in the three securities and to help maintain regulatory capital ratios within the “Well Capitalized” status before raising capital in June 2010.  The Bancorp considered the portfolio tainted and did not utilize held to maturity securities until two years later.
 
 
 
F-24

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 5 – INVESTMENT SECURITIES (continued)

The Bancorp’s investments’ gross unrealized losses and fair value, aggregated by investment category and length of time for individual securities that have been in a continuous unrealized loss position, at December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010 are as follows:

   
December 31, 2011
 
   
Less than 12 months
   
12 months or more
   
Total
 
   
Fair Value
   
Unrealized Losses
   
Fair Value
   
Unrealized Losses
   
Fair Value
   
Unrealized Losses
 
 Available  for Sale:
                                   
 U.S. Treasury and
                                   
     government  agencies
  $ 1,001     $ (1 )   $ -     $ -     $ 1,001     $ (1 )
 Mortgage-backed  securities
    166       (1 )     412       (106 )     578       (107 )
 Municipal securities
    -       -       2,000       (71 )     2,000       (71 )
 Corporate notes
    19,218       (783 )     -       -       19,218       (783 )
     Total investment  securities  available-for-sale
  $ 20,385     $ (785 )   $ 2,412     $ (177 )   $ 22,797     $ (962 )


 
 
December 31, 2010
 
 
Less than 12 months
 
12 months or more
 
Total
 
 
Fair Value
 
Unrealized Losses
 
Fair Value
 
Unrealized Losses
 
Fair Value
 
Unrealized Losses
 
Available for Sale:
                       
U.S. Treasury and government agencies
 
$
1,457
   
$
(29
)
 
$
116
   
$
(1
)
 
$
1,573
   
$
(30
)
Mortgage-backed securities
   
134,068
     
(3,104
)
   
524
     
(65
)
   
134,592
     
(3,169
)
Municipal securities
   
     
     
1,851
     
(237
)
   
1,851
     
(237
)
Total investment securities available-for-sale
 
$
135,525
   
$
(3,133
)
 
$
2,491
   
$
(303
)
 
$
138,016
   
$
(3,436
)

At December 31, 2011, there were ten available for sale investment securities in the less than twelve month category and six available-for-sale investment securities in the twelve month or more category. At December 31, 2010, there were thirty-three available-for-sale investment securities in the less than twelve month category and six available-for-sale investment securities in the twelve month or more category. In management’s opinion, the unrealized losses reflect primarily changes in interest rates, due to changes in economic conditions and the liquidity of the market and not credit quality. In addition, the Bancorp does not believe that it will be more likely than not that the Bancorp will be required to sell the securities prior to maturity or market price recovery.

At December 31, 2011 and 2010, Customers Bank pledged municipal and mortgage-backed securities of $311,442 and $2,062, respectively as collateral for borrowings.
 
 
 
F-25

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 6 - LOANS RECEIVABLE AND ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN AND LEASE LOSSES

The composition of net loans receivable at December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010 is as follows:

   
2011
   
2010
 
Construction
 
$
37,926
   
$
50,964
 
Commercial real estate
   
51,619
     
72,281
 
Commercial and industrial
   
10,254
     
13,156
 
Residential real estate
   
22,465
     
23,822
 
Manufactured housing
   
4,012
     
4,662
 
Total loans receivable covered under FDIC Loss Sharing Agreements (1)
   
126,276
     
164,885
 
Construction
   
15,271
     
13,387
 
Commercial real estate
   
352,635
     
144,849
 
Commercial and industrial
   
69,178
     
35,942
 
Mortgage warehouse
   
619,318
     
186,113
 
Manufactured housing
   
104,565
     
102,924
 
Residential real estate
   
53,476
     
28,964
 
Consumer
   
2,211
     
1,581
 
Deferred (fees) costs, net
   
(389)
     
327
 
Total loans receivable not covered under FDIC Loss Sharing Agreements
   
1,216,265
     
514,087
 
Allowance for loan and lease losses
   
(15,032
)
   
(15,129
)
Loans receivable, net
 
$
1,327,509
   
$
663,843
 
 
(1)  Loans that were acquired in the two FDIC assisted transactions and are covered under Loss Sharing Agreements with the FDIC are referred to as “covered” loans throughout these financial statements.
 
Non-Covered Nonaccrual Loans and Loans Past Due

The following table summarizes non-covered nonaccrual loans and past due loans, by class, as of December 31, 2011:
 
     
30-89 Days
 Past  Due (1)
     
Greater Than
 90 Days (1)
     
Total Past
 Due(1)
     
Non-
 Accrual
     
Current (2)
     
Total Loans
(4)
 
Commercial and industrial
  $     $     $     $ 2,962     $ 66,216     $ 69,178  
Commercial real estate
    1,114             1,114       27,290       324,231       352,635  
Construction
                      5,630       9,641       15,271  
Residential real estate
                                               
First mortgages
    1,051             1,051       1,855       24,784       27,690  
Home equity
    448             448       1,091       24,247       25,786  
Acquired with credit deterioration
                                   
Consumer
    21             21       40       2,150       2,211  
Mortgage warehouse
                            619,318       619,318  
Manufactured housing (3)
    5,162             5,162             99,403       104,565  
                                                 
Total
  $ 7,796     $     $ 7,796     $ 38,868     $ 1,169,990     $ 1,216,654  
 
(1) 
Loan balances do not include non-accrual loans.
(2) 
Loans where payments are due within 29 days of the scheduled payment date.
(3) 
Purchased manufactured housing loans are subject to cash reserves held at the Bank and are used to fund the past due payments when the loan reaches 90 days or more delinquent.
(4) 
Loans exclude deferred costs and fees.
 
 
 
F-26

 
 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
  (Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 6 - LOANS RECEIVABLE AND ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN AND LEASE LOSSES (continued)

The following table summarizes non-covered nonaccrual loans and past due loans, by class, as of December 31, 2010:

   
30-89 Days
 Past  Due(1)
   
Greater Than
 90 Days(1)
   
Total Past
 Due(1)
   
Non-
 Accrual
   
Current(2)
 
Total Loans(4)
 
Commercial and industrial
 
$
   
$
   
$
   
$
705
   
$
35,237
   
$
35,942
 
Commercial real estate
   
3,545
     
     
3,545
     
15,739
     
125,565
     
144,849
 
Construction
   
51
     
     
51
     
4,673
     
8,663
     
13,387
 
Residential real estate
                                               
First mortgages
   
     
     
     
658
     
6,705
     
7,363
 
Home equity
   
400
     
     
400
     
467
     
20,702
     
21,569
 
Acquired with credit deterioration
   
     
     
     
32
     
     
32
 
Consumer
   
17
     
5
     
22
     
     
1,559
     
1,581
 
Mortgage warehouse
   
     
     
     
     
186,113
     
186,113
 
Manufactured housing (3)
   
2,698
     
     
2,698
     
     
100,226
     
102,924
 
Total
 
$
6,711
   
$
5
   
$
6,716
   
$
22,274
   
$
484,770
   
$
513,760
 
 
(1)    Loan balances do not include non-accrual loans.
(2)    Loans where payments are due within 29 days of the scheduled payment date. 
(3)    Purchased manufactured housing loans are subject to cash reserves held at the Bank and are used to fund the past due   payments when the loan reaches 90 days or more delinquent.
(4)    Loans exclude deferred costs and fees.
 
Covered Nonaccrual Loans and Loans Past Due

The following table summarizes covered nonaccrual loans and past due loans, by class, as of December 31, 2011:
 
   
30-89 Days
Past Due (1)
     
Greater Than
 90 Days(1)
     
Total Past
 Due(1)
     
Nona ccrual
     
Current(3)
     
Total Loans
 
Commercial and industrial
                                             
Acquired with credit
$
    $
   
$
   
$
378
   
$
   
$
378
 
deterioration
                                             
Remaining loans (2)
 
2,672
     
     
2,672
     
     
7,204
     
9,876
 
Commercial real estate
                                             
Acquired with credit
 
     
     
     
16,204
     
2,039
     
18,243
 
deterioration
                                             
Remaining loans (2)
 
1,074
     
     
1,074
     
1,462
     
30,840
     
33,376
 
Construction
                                             
Acquired with credit
 
     
     
     
18,896
     
3,266
     
22,162
 
deterioration
                                             
Remaining loans (2)
 
92
     
     
92
     
2,584
     
13,088
     
15,764
 
Residential real estate
                                             
Acquired with credit
 
     
     
     
4,002
     
     
4,002
 
deterioration
                                             
First mortgages (2)
 
570
     
     
570
     
     
8,601
     
9,171
 
Home equity (2)
 
281
     
     
281
     
1,532
     
7,479
     
9,292
 
Manufactured housing
                                             
Acquired with credit
 
     
     
     
77
     
     
77
 
deterioration
                                             
Remaining loans (2)
 
6
     
     
6
     
78
     
3,851
     
3,935
 
 
$
4,695
   
$
   
$
4,695
   
$
45,213
   
$
76,368
   
$
126,276
 
 
(1) Loan balances do not include non-accrual loans.
(2) Loans that were not identified at the acquisition date as a loan with credit deterioration.
(3) Loans where payments are due within 29 days of the scheduled payment date.
 
 
 
F-27

 

CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)
 
NOTE 6 - LOANS RECEIVABLE AND ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN AND LEASE LOSSES (continued)

The following table summarizes covered nonaccrual loans and past due loans, by class, as of December 31, 2010:

   
30-89 Days
   
Greater than
   
Total past
   
Non-
             
   
Past Due (1)
   
90 days (1)
   
due (1)
   
accrual
   
Current(3)
   
Total Loans
 
                                     
Commercial and industrial
                                   
Acquired with credit deterioration
 
$
419
   
$
   
$
419
   
$
1,790
   
$
1,003
   
$
3,212
 
Remaining loans (2)
   
53
     
     
53
     
     
9,891
     
9,944
 
Commercial real estate
                                               
Acquired with credit deterioration
   
1,215
     
     
1,215
     
15,242
     
23,778
     
40,235
 
Remaining loans (2)
   
795
     
     
795
     
433
     
30,818
     
32,046
 
Construction
                                               
Acquired with credit deterioration
   
3,884
     
     
3,884
     
19,869
     
     
23,753
 
Remaining loans (2)
   
     
     
     
1,912
     
25,299
     
27,211
 
Residential real estate
                                               
Acquired with credit deterioration
   
     
     
     
4,013
     
1,751
     
5,764
 
First mortgages (2)
   
     
     
     
     
8,254
     
8,254
 
Home equity (2)
   
248
     
     
248
     
4
     
9,552
     
9,804
 
Manufactured housing
                                               
Acquired with credit deterioration
   
     
     
     
95
     
7
     
102
 
Remaining loans (2)
   
113
     
     
113
     
 96
     
4,351
     
4,560
 
   
$
6,727
   
$
   
$
6,727
   
$
43,454
   
$
114,704
   
$
164,885
 
         
(1) Loan balances do not include non-accrual loans.
       
(2) Loans receivable that were not identified upon acquisition as a loan with credit deterioration.
       
(3) Loans where payments are due within 29 days of the scheduled payment date.
       
 
 
 
 
 
F-28

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 6 - LOANS RECEIVABLE AND ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN AND LEASE LOSSES (continued)

Impaired Loans - Covered and Non-Covered

The following table presents a summary of the impaired loans at December 31, 2011.

 
Unpaid
 Principal
 Balance (1)
 
Related
 Allowance
 
Average
 Recorded
 Investment
 
Interest
 Income
 Recognized
 
With no related allowance recorded:
                       
Commercial and industrial
 
$
6,975
   
$
   
$
7,109
   
$
356
 
Commercial real estate
   
20,431
     
     
21,887
     
792
 
Construction
   
8,773
     
     
8,776
     
255
 
Residential real estate
   
343
     
     
347
     
 
With an allowance recorded:
                               
Commercial and industrial
   
800
     
426
     
815
     
27
 
Commercial real estate
   
12,195
     
2,047
     
12,414
     
555
 
Construction
   
7,369
     
2,986
     
7,369
     
132
 
Consumer
   
22
     
22
     
27
     
1
 
Residential real estate
   
869
     
195
     
904
     
9
 
                                 
Total
 
$
57,777
   
$
5,676
   
$
59,648
   
$
2,127
 
 
(1) Also represents the recorded investment.
 
The following table presents a summary of the impaired loans at December 31, 2010.

 
  
Unpaid
 Principal
 Balance(1)
 
  
Related
 Allowance
 
  
Average
 Recorded
 Investment
 
  
Interest
 Income
 Recognized
 
With no related allowance recorded:
                               
Commercial and industrial
 
$
179
   
$
   
$
83
   
$
2
  
Commercial real estate
   
10,825
     
     
4,737
     
356
  
Construction
   
551
     
     
278
     
 
Consumer
   
     
     
     
 
Residential real estate
   
658
     
     
496
     
22
  
With an allowance recorded:
                               
Commercial and industrial
   
7,382
     
1,456
     
6,383
     
462
  
Commercial real estate
   
18,843
     
6,551
     
11,715
     
857
  
Construction
   
6,168
     
2,006
     
6,198
     
168
  
Consumer
   
     
     
     
 
Residential real estate
   
620
     
305
     
668
     
16
  
                               
  
Total
 
$
45,226
   
$
10,318
   
$
30,558
   
$
1,883
  
 
(1) Also represents the recorded investment.
 
 
 
F-29

 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 6 - LOANS RECEIVABLE AND ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN AND LEASE LOSSES (continued)

Troubled Debt Restructurings
 
At December 31, 2011, there were $9.9 million in loans categorized as troubled debt restructurings (“TDR”). All TDRs are considered impaired loans in the calendar year of their restructuring. In subsequent years, a TDR may cease being classified as impaired if the loan was modified at a market rate and has performed according to the modified terms for at least six months. A loan that has been modified at a below market rate will return to performing status if it satisfies the six month performance requirement; however, it will remain classified as impaired.
 
The following is an analysis of loans modified in a troubled debt restructuring by type of concession for the year ended December 31, 2011. There were no modifications that involved forgiveness of debt.
 
   
TDRs in compliance with their modified terms and accruing interest
   
TDRs that are not accruing interest
   
Total
 
       
Extended under forbearance
 
$
-
   
$
5,151
   
$
5,151
 
Multiple extensions resulting from financial difficulty
   
72
     
-
     
72
 
Interest rate reductions
   
910
     
-
     
910
 
Total
 
$
982
   
$
5,151
   
$
6,133
 
 
 
 
 
F-30

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)
 
NOTE 6 - LOANS RECEIVABLE AND ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN AND LEASE LOSSES (continued)
 
Troubled Debt Restructurings
 
The following table provides, by class, the number of loans and leases modified in troubled debt restructurings, and the recorded investments and unpaid principal balances for the year ended December 31, 2011.
 
  
 
TDRs in compliance with
their modified terms and
accruing interest
   
TDRs that are not
accruing interest
 
   
Number
   
Recorded
   
Number
   
Recorded
 
   
of Loans
   
Investment
   
of Loans
   
Investment
 
Commercial and industrial
   
-
   
$
-
     
-
   
$
-
 
Commercial real estate
   
1
     
613
     
6
     
4,538
 
Construction
   
-
     
-
     
-
     
-
 
Manufactured housing
   
12
     
982
     
-
     
-
 
Residential real estate
   
-
     
-
     
-
     
-
 
Consumer
   
-
     
-
     
-
     
-
 
Total loans and leases
   
13
   
$
1,595
     
6
   
$
4,538
 
 
The following table provides, by class, the number of loans and leases modified in troubled debt restructurings, and the recorded investments and unpaid principal balances for the year ended December 31, 2010.
 
 
  
 
TDRs in compliance with
their modified terms and
accruing interest
   
TDRs that are not
accruing interest
 
   
Number
   
Recorded
   
Number
   
Recorded
 
   
of Loans
   
Investment
   
of Loans
   
Investment
 
Commercial and industrial
   
1
   
$
124
     
4
   
$
617
 
Commercial real estate
   
5
     
2,728
     
9
     
3,501
 
Construction
   
1
     
550
     
-
     
-
 
Manufactured housing
   
-
     
-
     
-
     
-
 
Residential real estate
   
-
     
-
     
1
     
658
 
Consumer
   
1
     
3
     
-
     
-
 
Total loans and leases
   
8
   
$
3,405
     
14
   
$
4,776
 
 
TDR modifications primarily involve interest rate concessions, extensions of term, deferrals of principal, and other modifications. Other modifications typically reflect other nonstandard terms which the Bancorp would not offer in non-troubled situations. During the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively, $2,403 and $1,029 were modified in a troubled debt restructuring. TDR modifications of loans within the commercial and industrial category were primarily interest rate concessions, deferrals of principal and other modifications; modifications of commercial real estate loans were primarily deferrals of principal, extensions of term and other modifications; and modifications of residential real estate loans were primarily interest rate concessions and deferrals of principal.  As of December 31, 2011 and 2010, there were no commitments to lend additional funds to debtors whose terms have been modified in troubled debt structuring.

During the first quarter of 2011, one TDR loan in the amount of $710,000 defaulted on its modified terms and transferred to OREO. The loan was part of the commercial real estate segment and had already been evaluated for impairment with no specific reserve assigned.  There were no valuation losses at the time of the transfer and had no impact on the ALLL. There were no other TDR loans that defaulted during the twelve month period ending December 31, 2011.
 
All loans and leases modified in troubled debt restructurings are evaluated for impairment. The nature and extent of impairment of TDRs, including those which have experienced a subsequent default, is considered in the determination of an appropriate level of allowance for credit losses. There was $352 and $480 in specific reserves resulting from the addition of TDR modifications during the years ended December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.
 
 
 
F-31

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 6 – LOANS RECEIVABLE AND ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN AND LEASE LOSSES (continued)

Credit Quality Indicators

Commercial and industrial, commercial real estate, residential real estate and construction loans are based on an internally assigned risk rating system which are assigned at the loan origination and reviewed on a periodic or on an “as needed” basis. Consumer, mortgage warehouse and manufactured housing loans are evaluated based on the payment activity of the loan. The following presents the credit quality tables as of December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010 for the non-covered loan portfolio.

     
   
December 31, 2011
 
   
Commercial and
Industrial
   
Commercial
Real Estate
   
Construction
   
Residential Real Estate
 
Pass/Satisfactory
 
$
61,327
   
$
308,258
   
$
9,314
   
$
50,517
 
Special Mention
   
57
     
13,402
     
237
     
-
 
Substandard
   
7,472
     
29,312
     
4,349
     
2,959
 
Doubtful
   
322
     
1,663
     
1,371
     
-
 
Total
 
$
69,178
   
$
352,635
   
$
15,271
   
$
53,476
 
 
 
  
Consumer
 
  
Mortgage Warehouse
 
  
Manufactured Housing
 
Performing
  
$
2,171
   
$
619,318
   
$
104,565
  
Nonperforming (1)
  
 
40
     
-
     
-
  
Total
  
$
2,211
   
$
619,318
   
$
104,565
  
 
  
                     
 
(1)               Includes loans that are on non-accrual status or past due ninety days or more at December 31, 2011.

 
 
F-32

 
 
  CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 6 – LOANS RECEIVABLE AND ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN AND LEASE LOSSES (continued)

 
December 31, 2010
   
Commercial and
Industrial
   
Commercial
Real Estate
   
Construction
   
Residential Real Estate
 
Pass/Satisfactory
 
$
27,771
   
$
107,480
   
$
4,653
   
$
27,566
 
Special Mention
   
534
     
8,500
     
1,416
     
 
Substandard
   
7,306
     
25,213
     
6,246
     
1,398
 
Doubtful
   
331
     
3,656
     
1,072
     
 
Total
 
$
35,942
   
$
144,849
   
$
13,387
   
$
28,964
 
 
 
  
Consumer
 
  
Mortgage Warehouse
 
  
Manufactured Housing
 
Performing
  
$
1,559
   
$
186,113
   
$
100,226
  
Nonperforming (1)
  
 
22
     
     
2,698
  
Total
  
$
1,581
   
$
186,113
   
$
102,924
  
 
  (1)
Includes loans that are on non-accrual status or past due ninety days or more at December 31, 2010.
     
 

The following presents the credit quality tables as of December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010 for the covered loan portfolio.

 
December 31, 2011
   
Commercial and
Industrial
   
Commercial
Real Estate
   
Construction
   
Residential Real Estate
 
Pass/Satisfactory
 
$
9,823
   
$
30,998
   
$
5,539
   
$
16,476
 
Special Mention
   
53
     
3,358
     
7,641
     
455
 
Substandard
   
378
     
17,263
     
24,746
     
5,534
 
Doubtful
   
-
     
  -
     
-
     
-
 
Total
 
$
10,254
   
$
51,619
   
$
37,926
   
$
22,465
 
 
 
  
Manufactured Housing
 
Performing
 
$
3,857
  
Nonperforming (1)
   
155
  
Total
 
$
4,012
  
 
  (1)
Includes loans that are on non-accrual status or past due ninety days or more at December 31, 2011.
 
 
 
F-33

 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 6 – LOANS RECEIVABLE AND ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN AND LEASE LOSSES (continued)

 
December 31, 2010
   
Commercial and
Industrial
   
Commercial
Real Estate
   
Construction
   
Residential Real Estate
 
Pass/Satisfactory
 
$
11,134
   
$
38,431
   
$
 23,134
   
$
 17,219
 
Special Mention
   
 1,060
     
 16,118
     
 19,573
     
 3,214
 
Substandard
   
 917
     
 14,736
     
 8,257
     
 1,672
 
Doubtful
   
 45
     
 2,996
     
     
 1,717
 
Total
 
$
 13,156
   
$
72,281
   
$
50,964
   
$
 23,822
 
 
 
  
Manufactured Housing
 
Performing
 
$
4,358
  
Nonperforming (1)
   
304
  
Total
 
$
4,662
  
 
(1)
Includes loans that are on non-accrual status or past due ninety days or more at December 31, 2010.
 
Allowance for loan and lease losses

The changes in the allowance for loan and lease losses as of December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010 and the loans and allowance for loan and lease losses by loan segment based on impairment method are as follows:

Twelve months ended December 31, 2011
 
Commercial and
Industrial
   
Commercial
Real Estate
   
Construction
   
Residential Real Estate
 
Beginning Balance, January 1, 2011
 
$
1,662
   
$
9,152
   
$
2,127
   
$
1,116
 
Charge-offs
   
(2,543
)
   
(5,775
)
   
(1,179
)
   
(109
)
Recoveries
   
11
     
94
     
2
     
 
Provision for loan losses
   
2,311
     
3,558
     
3,706
     
(163
Ending Balance, December 31, 2011
 
$
1,441
   
$
7,029
   
$
4,656
   
$
844
 
 
Loans:
                 
Individually evaluated for impairment
 
$
7,775
   
$
32,625
   
$
16,142
   
$
1,212
 
Collectively evaluated for impairment
   
73,877
     
354,561
     
16,025
     
71,477
 
Loans acquired with credit deterioration
   
885
     
20,962
     
26,428
     
4,731
 
Allowance for loan and lease losses:
                               
Individually evaluated for impairment
 
$
426
   
$
2,047
   
$
2,986
   
$
195
 
Collectively evaluated for impairment
   
911
     
4,063
     
209
     
554
 
Loans acquired with credit deterioration
   
104
     
920
     
1,461
     
94
 
 
 
 
F-34

 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 6 – LOANS RECEIVABLE AND ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN AND LEASE LOSSES (continued)


Twelve months ended December 31, 2011
Manufactured Housing
 
Consumer
 
Mortgage Warehouse
 
Unallocated
 
Total
 
Beginning Balance, January 1, 2011
 
$
   
$
11
   
$
465
   
$
596
   
$
15,129
 
Charge-offs
   
     
(55
   
     
     
(9,661
)
Recoveries
   
     
7
     
     
     
114
 
Provision for loan losses
   
18
     
98
     
464
     
(542
   
9,450
 
Ending Balance, December 31, 2011
 
$
18
   
61
   
929
   
54
   
15,032
 
 
Loans:
   
Individually evaluated for impairment
 
$
   
$
23
   
$
   
$
   
$
57,777
 
Collectively evaluated for impairment
   
113,380
     
6,545
     
619,318
     
     
1,153,029
 
Loans acquired with credit deterioration
   
88
     
     
     
     
155,249
 
Market discounts/premiums/valuation adjustments 
                                   
 (23,514
Total loans 
                                   
1,342,541
 
Allowance for loan and lease losses:
 
Individually evaluated for impairment
 
$
   
$
22
   
$
   
$
   
$
5,676
 
Collectively evaluated for impairment
   
1
     
39
     
929
     
54
     
6,760
 
Loans acquired with credit deterioration
   
17
     
     
     
     
2,596
 
 
The non-covered manufactured housing portfolio was purchased in August 2010.  A portion of the purchase price may be used to reimburse the Bank under the specified terms in the Purchase Agreement for defaults of the underlying borrower and other specified items.  At December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, funds available for reimbursement, if necessary, are $6,534 and $10,419, respectively.   Each quarter, these funds are evaluated to determine if they would be sufficient to absorb probable losses within the manufactured housing portfolio.  
 
 
 
 
 
F-35

 
 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 6 – LOANS RECEIVABLE AND ALLOWANCE FOR LOAN AND LEASE LOSSES (continued)

The analysis of the allowance for loan and lease losses for 2011 and 2010 is as follows:
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Balance, January 1
  $ 15,129     $ 10,032     $ 2,876  
Provision for loan losses
    9,450       10,397       11,778  
Loans charged off
    (9,661 )     (5,265 )     (4,630 )
Recoveries
    114       15       8  
Transfers (1)
    -       (50 )     -  
Balance, December 31
  $ 15,032     $ 15,129     $ 10,032  

(1) At December 31, 2010, the Bancorp had a reserve of $50 for unfunded commitments included within the allowance for loan and lease losses. The reserve for unfunded loan commitments was reclassified to Other Liabilities during the year ended December 31, 2010.

The following tables present the loans with credit deterioration as of acquisition date for acquired loans.   Both the Berkshire Bancorp and Tammac transactions occurred in September 2011. The USA Bank and ISN Bank acquisitions occurred in July and September of 2010, respectively.  The balances presented are estimates based on data collected at the time of the transactions.

   
2011
   
2010
 
Contractually required payments receivable
  $ 175,050     $ 123,100  
Credit discount (nonaccretable difference)
    (24,922 )     (41,792 )
Cash flows expected to be collected
    150,128       81,308  
Market discount (accretable yield)
    (41,306 )     (6,832 )
Fair value of loans acquired with credit deterioration
  $ 108,822     $ 74,476  

The changes in the accretable yield as of December 31:  
 
2011
   
2010
 
Balance, beginning of period
  $ 7,176     $ -  
Additions resulting from acquisition
    41,306       6,832  
Accretion to interest income
    (3,556 )     (971 )
Reclassification (to)/from nonaccretable difference and disposals, net
    432       1,315  
                 
Balance, end of period
  $ 45,358     $ 7,176  

The outstanding balance as defined by ASC 310-30-50-1, of acquired covered loans with credit deterioration is $252,247 with a carrying value of $229,060 at December 31, 2011.  The outstanding balance was $113,279 with a carrying balance of $73,066 at December 31, 2010.
 
FDIC Loss Sharing Receivable
 
Prospective losses incurred on Covered Loans are eligible for partial reimbursement by the FDIC. Subsequent decreases in the amount expected to be collected result in a provision for loan and lease losses, an increase in the allowance for loan and lease losses, and a proportional adjustment to the FDIC loss sharing receivable for the estimated amount to be reimbursed. Subsequent increases in the amount expected to be collected result in the reversal of any previously-recorded provision for loan and lease losses and related allowance for loan and lease and lease losses and adjustments to the FDIC loss sharing receivable, or accretion of certain fair value amounts into interest income in future periods if no provision for loan and lease losses had been recorded.  
 
The following table summarizes the activity related to the FDIC loss sharing receivable as of December 31:
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
             
Balance, beginning of period
  $ 16,702     $ -  
 Acquisitions
    -       27,297  
 Change in FDIC loss sharing receivable
    3,920       520  
 Reimbursement from the FDIC
    (7,545 )     (11,115 )
 Balance, end of period
  $ 13,077     $ 16,702  
 
 
 
F-36

 

 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 7 - BANK PREMISES AND EQUIPMENT
 
The components of bank premises and equipment at December 31, 2011 and 2010 are as follows:

                                                    Expected Useful Life
 
2011
   
2010
 
Leasehold improvements
3 to 25 years
  $ 8,706     $ 3,762  
Furniture, fixtures and equipment
5 to 10 years
    2,666       1,639  
IT equipment and software
3 to 5 years
    3,640       2,490  
Automobiles
5 to 10 years
    127       127  
      15,139       8,018  
Less accumulated depreciation
    (5,719 )     (3,318 )
    $ 9,420     $ 4,700  

Future minimum rental commitments under non-cancelable leases as of December 31, 2011 were as follows:

 2012
  $ 1,859  
 2013
    1,780  
 2014
    1,509  
 2015
    1,089  
 2016
    896  
 Subsequent to 2016
    3,435  
 Total minimum payments
  $ 10,568  

Rent expense, which includes reimbursements to the lessor for real estate taxes, was approximately $1,641, $1,108 and $788 for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, respectively.

NOTE 8 - DEPOSITS
 
The components of deposits at December 31, 2011 and 2010 are as follows:
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
Demand, non-interest bearing
 
$
114,044
   
$
72,268
 
Demand, interest bearing
   
739,463
     
387,013
 
Savings
   
16,922
     
17,649
 
Time, $100,000 and over
   
408,853
     
434,453
 
Time, other
   
303,907
     
334,307
 
Total deposits
 
$
1,583,189
   
$
1,245,690
 
 
At December 31, 2011, the scheduled maturities of time deposits are as follows:
   
2011
 
2012
 
$
495,444
 
2013
   
71,080
 
2014
   
26,969
 
2015
   
7,349
 
2016
   
111,716
 
Thereafter 
   
202
 
   
$
712,760
 

The aggregate amount of demand deposits overdrafts that have been reclassified as loan balances are $49 and $39 as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively.
 
 
 
F-37

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)
 
NOTE 9 – BORROWINGS

From time to time, the Bancorp enters into agreements to sell securities under agreements to repurchase. The agreements are treated as financings, and the obligations to repurchase securities sold are reflected as liabilities in the balance sheet. The amount of the mortgage-backed securities underlying the agreements continues to be carried in the Bancorp’s investment securities portfolio. The Bancorp has agreed to repurchase securities identical to those sold. The securities underlying the agreements are under the Bancorp’s control.  At December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Bancorp had $0 in securities sold under agreements to repurchase and $11,000 in FHLB fixed rate long-term advances outstanding with an average rate of 3.24%.

Short-term debt

At December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Bancorp had $5,000 and $0 in federal funds purchased, respectively at a rate of 0.12%.  In addition, the Bancorp also had $320,000 and $0 of FHLB advances outstanding as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, respectively at a rate of 0.25%.
 
   
2011
 
   
Amount
   
Rate
 
FHLB advances
  $ 320,000       0.25 %
Federal funds purchased
    5,000       0.12  
Total short-term borrowings
  $ 325,000          

Long-term debt

The contractual maturities of long-term advances at December 31, 2011 and 2010 were as follows:

   
2011
   
2010
 
   
Amount
   
Rate
   
Amount
   
Rate
 
2013
  $ 1,000       3.73 %   $ 1,000       3.73 %
2017
    5,000       3.08       5,000       3.08  
2018
    5,000       3.31       5,000       3.31  
    $ 11,000             $ 11,000          
 
$10,000 in Federal Home Loan Bank advances are convertible select advances.  One $5,000 advance may be converted during any quarter to a floating rate advance with a rate of three-month LIBOR plus 17 basis points.  The remaining $5,000 advance may be converted in any quarter to a floating-rate advance with a rate of three month LIBOR plus 18 basis points.  If the Bancorp were to convert these advances to a floating rate, the Bancorp would have the right to prepay the advances with no penalty.
 
Bank has a total borrowing capacity with the Federal Home Loan Bank and Federal Reserve Bank of Philadelphia of approximately $571,258 and $71,965, respectively at December 31, 2011.   Advances under these arrangements are secured by certain qualifying assets of Customers Bancorp, Inc.
 
Subordinated debt

Customers Bank issued a subordinated term note during the second quarter of 2004. The note was issued for $2,000 at a floating rate based upon the three-month LIBOR rate, determined quarterly, plus 2.75% per annum. Quarterly interest payments are made on this note in January, April, July and October. At December 31, 2011, the quarterly rate was 3.17% and the average rate for the year was 3.09%. The note matures in the third quarter of 2014.
 
 
 
 
F-38

 

 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 10 - SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY

TARP Payoff

On December 28, 2011, the Bancorp entered into a letter agreement (the “Letter Agreement”) with the United States Department of Treasury (“Treasury”) pursuant to which the Bancorp repurchased from the Treasury 2,892 shares, constituting all of the issued and outstanding shares, of the Bancorp’s Series A Preferred Stock at a repurchase price equal to the liquidation value of $1,000 per share, or a total of $2,892 plus accrued, unpaid dividends on such shares equal to $17, and 145 shares, constituting all of the issued and outstanding shares, of the Bancorp’s Series B Preferred Stock and, together with the Series A Preferred Stock, (the “preferred shares”), at a repurchase price equal to the liquidation value of $1,000 per share, or a total of $145, plus accrued, unpaid dividends on such shares equal to $2.  The total repurchase price for the preferred shares equaled $3,056, including accrued dividends.

The repurchase of the preferred shares relates to the letter agreement (the “TARP Letter Agreement”) entered into by and among the Bancorp, Berkshire and the Treasury on September 16, 2011.  Pursuant to the TARP Letter Agreement, the Bancorp agreed to assume the due and punctual performance and observance of Berkshire’s covenants, agreements, and conditions under that certain letter agreement, dated as of June 12, 2009, by and between Treasury and Berkshire, incorporating the Securities Purchase Agreement – Standard Terms (the “Securities Purchase Agreement”) and all ancillary documents thereto.  In addition, Bancorp agreed to exchange the outstanding Berkshire TARP Shares Series A and Berkshire TARP Shares Series B Preferred Shares for, (i) 2,892 shares of the Series A Shares, having a liquidation preference of $1,000 per share; and (ii) 145 shares of the Series B Shares, having a liquidation preference of $1,000 per share issued by Bancorp.  The issuance and sale of these securities was a private placement exempt from registration pursuant to Section 4(2) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

Capital Raise

On September 30, 2011, the Bancorp sold 419,000 shares of common stock and 565,848 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock at $13.20 per share with total proceeds of $13,000.  During the first quarter 2011, the Bank sold shares of its common stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock to certain Lead Investors.  Giving effect to the Reorganization, the Bancorp (as successor to the Bank) issued, in connection with this transaction, 668,527 shares of common stock and 363,000 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock at $12.00 per share and 210,916 shares of common stock and 146,310 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock to the Bancorp’s Lead Investors at $10.50 per share.  The proceeds, net of offering costs were $15,526.

In December 2010, the Bancorp sold an aggregate of 744,213 shares, which included 694,947 shares of common stock and 49,266 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock at a weighted-average price of $11.82 per share.  In September 2010, the Bancorp sold an aggregate of 78,699 shares of common stock at an average price of $10.65 with gross proceeds of $852.  In July 2010, the Bancorp sold an aggregate of 101,666 shares, which included 8,333 shares of common stock and 93,333 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock at a price of $10.50 per share with gross proceeds of $1,068.  In March 2010, the Bancorp sold 650,266 total shares, which included 253,865 shares of common stock and 396,400 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock at a price of $11.28 per share. In February 2010, the Bancorp sold 3,359,379 total shares, which included 2,176,516 shares of common stock and 1,182,867 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock at a price of $12.84 per share (collectively, the 2010 Capital Raises).  
 
The proceeds of the 2010 Capital Raises were $59,024, net of offering costs of approximately $1,800. As a result of the July 2010 and March 2010 capital raises at a price less than the original per share purchase price, 1,096,496 shares of common stock and 293,056 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock at a price of $10.50 per share were issued to the existing investors pursuant to anti-dilution agreements between the Bancorp and those investors.  Following the close of these transactions, no investor owned or controlled more than 9.9% of the aggregate outstanding shares of the Bancorp’s Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock, including for purposes of this calculation any shares issuable under unexercised warrants.


 
F-39

 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 10 - SHAREHOLDERS’ EQUITY (continued)

Each investor who participated in the 2010 Capital Raises and owns more than 9% of the common equity of the Bancorp has been identified by the Bancorp as a Lead Investor.  The 2010 Capital Raises resulted in seven Lead Investors who received warrants equal to 5% of the shares that they purchased in 2010 and have exercise prices (after taking into account anti-dilution repricing) of $10.50 per share (collectively, the 2010 Warrants).  The 2010 Warrants are for the issuance of 84,628 shares of the Bancorp’s Common Stock and 68,212 shares of the Bancorp’s Class B Non-Voting Common Stock.  The Lead Investors also had the right to invest in future capital raises until February 17, 2011 at the issuance price of $11.28 per share.
 
The Bancorp agreed to extend and amend the anti-dilution agreements with shareholders who purchased shares in June 2009 or later, to extend anti-dilution protections from June 30, 2010 through March 31, 2011 for any capital raising transactions at a price or value below $10.50 per share, but, after June 30, 2010, only where the capital raising transaction involves share issuances for cash.

NOTE 11 – EMPLOYEE BENEFIT PLANS
 
Customers Bank has a 401(k) profit sharing plan whereby eligible employees may contribute up to 15% of their salary to the Plan. Customers Bank provides a matching contribution equal to 50% of the first 6% of the contribution made by the employee. Employer contributions for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010, and 2009 were approximately $224, $101 and $56, respectively.
 
Supplemental Executive Retirement Plans

Customers Bank entered into a supplemental executive retirement plan (SERP) with its Chairman and Chief Executive Officer that provides annual retirement benefits for a 15 year period upon the later of his reaching the age of 65 or when he terminates employment. The SERP is a defined-contribution type of deferred compensation arrangement that is designed to provide a target annual retirement benefit of $300 per year for 15 years starting at age 65, based on an assumed constant rate of return of 7% per year, but that level of retirement benefit is not guaranteed by the Bank and the ultimate retirement benefit can be less than or greater than the target. The Bank intends to fund its obligations under the SERP with the increase in cash surrender value of a life insurance policy on the life of the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer which is owned by the Bank.  As a result of the acquisition of USA Bank on July 9, 2010, the SERP became effective and the Chairman and Chief Executive Officer is entitled to receive the balance of his account in accordance with the terms of the SERP.  The present value of the amount owed as of December 31, 2011 is $2,485 and is included in other liabilities. 
 

 
 
F-40

 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 12 – STOCK BASED COMPENSATION PLANS

Stock Option Plans
 
During 2010, the shareholders of Customers Bank approved the 2010 Stock Option Plan (“2010 Plan”) and during 2011, the shareholders of Customers Bank approved the Amendmed and Restated 2004 Incentive Equity and Deferred Compensation Plan (“2004 Plan”).  The 2010 Plan and 2004 Plan were subsequently amended to reflect the September 17, 2011 Plan of Merger and Reorganization approved by the shareholders of Customers Bank.   The purpose of these plans is to promote the success and enhance the value of Bancorp by linking the personal interests of the members of the Board of Directors and Customers Bank’s employees, officers and executives to those of Bancorp’s shareholders and by providing such individuals with an incentive for outstanding performance in order to generate superior returns to shareholders of Bancorp. The 2010 Plan and 2004 Plan are intended to provide flexibility to Bancorp in its ability to motivate, attract and retain the services of members of the Board of Directors, employees, officers and executives of Customers Bank.  Stock options granted normally vest on the third or fifth anniversary of the grant date plus the fully diluted tangible book value must increase by 50% for the 2010 Plan and three years for the 2004 Plan plus the fully diluted tangible book value must increase by 50%.
 
The 2010 and 2004 Plans are administered by the Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors.  The 2010 Plan provides exclusively for the grant of stock options, some or all of which may be structured to qualify as Incentive Stock Options, to employees, officers, executives and directors.  The maximum number of shares of common stock and Class B Non-Voting common stock which may be issued under the 2010 Plan is the lesser of (a) 15% of the number of shares of common stock and Class B Non-Voting common stock issued in consideration of cash or other property after December 31, 2009, or (b) 3,333,334 shares. The 2004 Plan provides for the grant of options, some or all of which may be structured to qualify as Incentive Stock Options if granted to employees, stock appreciation rights (“SARS”), restricted stock and unrestricted stock to employees, officers, executives and members of the Board of Directors.  The maximum number of shares of common stock and Class B Non-Voting common stock which may be issued under the 2004 Plan is 500,000 shares.

During the year ended December 31, 2011, the Bancorp (as successor to the Bank) granted to employees options to purchase 200,268 shares of common stock at a weighted-average exercise price of $12.12 per share. The stock options vest on the fifth anniversary after the date of grant plus the fully diluted tangible book value must increase by 50%.

For the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, Customers Bank estimated the fair value of each option grant on the date of grant using the Black-Scholes option pricing model with the following weighted-average assumptions:  
 
     
2011
     
2010
 
Risk-free interest rates
  
 
2.00
   
    2.81
Expected dividend yield
  
 
0.00
   
0.00
Expected volatility
  
 
20.00
   
20.00
Expected lives (years)
  
 
7
  
   
7
  
Weighted average fair value of options granted
  
$
4.14
  
  $
2.68
  

  The following summarizes the changes in stock option activity under the Bancorp’s stock option plans at December 31, 2011:
 
   
Number of shares
   
Weighted average
exercise price
   
Weighted
average
remaining
contractual term
in years
   
Aggregate intrinsic
value
 
Outstanding,  January 1, 2011
    758,244     $ 10.38              
Issued
    375,776       12.41              
Forfeited
    (6,367 )     17.81              
Outstanding, December 31, 2011
    1,127,653     $ 11.00       5.38     $ 2,628  
Options exercisable at December 31, 2011
    6,592     $ 31.75       3.99     $ -  
 
The aggregate intrinsic value in the table above represents the total pre-tax intrinsic value (the difference between the Bancorp’s latest sale price of $13.20 and the exercise price) multiplied by the number of in-the-money options.
 
 
 
F-41

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 12 – STOCK BASED COMPENSATION PLANS (continued)

A summary of the status of the Bancorp’s nonvested options at December 31, 2011 and changes during the year ended December 31, 2011 is as follows:

   
 
Number of shares
   
Weighted average
grant-date
Fair Value
 
Nonvested at January 1, 2011
    746,960     $ 3.12  
Issued
    375,776       5.58  
Forfeited
    (1,675 )     3.09  
Nonvested at December 31, 2011
    1,121,061     $ 3.96  

For the years ended December 31, 2011 and 2010, the Bancorp recognized $704 and $291, respectively in stock option compensation expense as a component of salaries and benefits. The weighted-average remaining contractual life of the outstanding stock options at December 31, 2011 is approximately 5.38 years.  Unvested compensation was $1,587 at December 31, 2011.  The aggregate intrinsic value of options outstanding was $2,152 at December 31, 2011.

Restricted Stock Units

The Bancorp (as successor to the Bank) granted restricted stock units to purchase 35,622 shares of common stock on February 17, 2011. These awards vest on the third anniversary of the grant date. The fair value of the restricted stock units granted on February 17, 2011 was $12.00 per share. Unrecognized compensation expense related to unvested restricted stock units was approximately $304 at December 31, 2011 and is expected to be recognized over a period of 2.87 years.  

Management Stock Purchase Plan
 
The Bancorp initiated a Management Stock Purchase Program (MSPP) in 2010 where certain employees were offered an option to purchase shares of common stock at $1.00 per share for an aggregate issuance of 233,333 shares of common stock.  The MSPP offers vested in accordance with the plan document in the third quarter of 2010 as result of the acquisition of USA Bank on July 9, 2010.  The Bancorp’s common stock had a market value of $10.50 at the offer date and compensation expense of $1,750 was recorded as a component of salaries and benefits during the year ended December 31, 2010.  In December 2010, the offer period was completed and 233,333 shares of common stock were issued.

Bonus Recognition and Retention Program

The Bancorp initiated a Bonus Recognition and Retention Program (BRRP) effective January 1, 2011.  Employees eligible to participate in the BRRP include the Chief Executive Officer and other management and highly compensated employees as determined by the Compensation Committee in its sole discretion.  Under the BRRP, a participant may elect to defer receipt of not less than 25%, nor more than 50%, of his or her bonus payable with respect to each year of participation.  Shares of Voting Common Stock having a value equal to the portion of the bonus deferred by a participant will be allocated to an annual deferral account and a matching amount equal to an identical number of shares of common stock shall be allocated to the annual deferral account.  A participant becomes 100% vested in the annual deferral account on the fifth anniversary date of the initial funding of the account, provided he or she remains continuously employed by us from the date of funding to the anniversary date.  Vesting is accelerated in the event of involuntary termination other than for cause, retirement at or after age 65, death, termination on account of disability, or a change in control of the Bancorp.  Participants were first eligible to make elections under the BRRP with respect to their bonuses for 2011 which were payable in the first quarter of 2012.
 
 
 
F-42

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 13 – INCOME TAXES

The components of income tax (benefit) expense are as follows:
       
                   
 For the year ended December 31,
2011
 
2010
 
2009
 
Current
  $ 4,563     $ 2,914     $ 394  
Deferred
    (2,728 )     1,817       (394 )
    $ 1,835     $ 4,731     $ -  
 
Effective tax rates differ from the federal statutory rate of 35% applied to income (loss) before income tax expense (benefit) due to the following :
 
 
 
                           
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
   
 
Amount
   
% of pretax income
   
 
Amount
   
% of pretax income
   
 
Amount
   
% of pretax income
 
Federal income tax at statutory rate
  $ 2,054       35.00 %   $ 9,552       34.00 %   $ (4,500 )     (34.00 ) %
State income tax
    64       1.09 %     209       0.74 %     -       - %
Tax exempt interest
    (14 )     (0.23 ) %     (74 )     (0.27 ) %     (104       (0.79 ) %
Interest disallowance
    3       0.05 %     4       0.02 %     12       0.09 %
Bank owned life insurance
    (490 )     (8.35 ) %     (67 )     (0.24 ) %     (69 )     (0.53 ) %
(Reversal) recordation of valuation allowance
    -       0.00 %     (6,605 )     (23.51 ) %     4,652       35.15 %
Other
    218       3.71 %     1,712       6.09 %     9       0.08 %
Effective income tax rate
  $ 1,835       31.27 %   $ 4,731       16.83 %   $ -       - %


Deferred income taxes reflect temporary differences in the recognition of revenue and expenses for tax reporting and financial statement purposes, principally because certain items, such as the allowance for loan and lease losses and loan fees are recognized in different periods for financial reporting and tax return purposes.  A valuation allowance has not been established for deferred tax assets.  Realization of the deferred tax assets is dependent on generating sufficient future taxable income.  Although realization is not assured, management believes it is more likely than not that all of the deferred tax asset will be realized.  Deferred tax assets are recorded in other assets.
 
 
 
F-43

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 13 – INCOME TAXES (continued)

The components of the net deferred tax asset (liability) at December 31, 2011 and 2010 are as follows:
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
Deferred tax assets:
     
Allowance for loan and lease losses
  $ 5,261     $ 5,240  
Net unrealized losses on securities
    132       977  
Bank premises and equipment
    -       168  
Impairment charge on securities
    175       304  
OREO expenses
    191       66  
Non-accrual interest
    2,711       576  
Net operating losses
    3,235       1,142  
Deferred compensation
    980       869  
Fair value adjustments on acquisitions
    981       -  
Other
    437       185  
Total deferred tax assets
    14,103       9,527  
Valuation allowance
    -       -  
Total deferred tax assets, net of valuation  allowance
    14,103       9,527  
Deferred tax liabilities:
               
Tax basis discount on acquisitions
    (7,733 )     (9,369 )
Deferred loan costs
    (441 )     (259 )
Bank premises and equipment
    (223 )     -  
Other
    (337 )     (482 )
Total deferred tax liabilities
    (8,734 )     (10,110 )
Net deferred tax asset (liability)
  $ 5,369     $ (583 )

The Bancorp had approximately $9.2 million of federal net operating loss carryovers at December 31, 2011, that expire beginning in 2029 through 2031.

The Bank and its subsidiary are subject to U.S. federal income tax as well as income tax of various states primarily in the mid-Atlantic region of the U.S.  Years that remain open for potential review by the Internal Revenue Service and the state taxing authorities are 2008 through 2010.  Total amount of interest and penalties for 2011 amounted to $30.

NOTE 14 - TRANSACTIONS WITH EXECUTIVE OFFICERS, DIRECTORS AND PRINCIPAL SHAREHOLDERS
 
The Bancorp has had, and may be expected to have in the future, banking transactions in the ordinary course of business with its executive officers, directors, principal shareholders, their immediate families and affiliated companies (commonly referred to as related parties), on the same terms, including interest rates and collateral, as those prevailing at the time for comparable transactions with others.  At December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, these persons were indebted to the Bancorp for loans totaling $3,657, $0 and $0, respectively.  During 2011, $3,660 of new loans were made and repayments totaled $33.

Some current directors, nominees for director and executive officers of the Bancorp and entities or organizations in which they were executive officers or the equivalent or owners of more than 10% of the equity were customers of and had transactions with or involving the Bancorp in the ordinary course of business during the fiscal year ended December 31, 2011.  None of these transactions involved amounts in excess of 5% of the Bancorp’s gross revenues during 2011 nor was the Bancorp indebted to any of the foregoing persons or entities in an aggregate amount in excess of 5% of the Bancorp’s total consolidated assets at December 31, 2011.  Additional transactions with such persons and entities may be expected to take place in the ordinary course of business in the future.
 
 
 
F-44

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 14 - TRANSACTIONS WITH EXECUTIVE OFFICERS, DIRECTORS AND PRINCIPAL SHAREHOLDERS (continued)

On June 17, 2009, the Bank entered into a Consulting Agreement with Kenneth B. Mumma, its former Chairman and CEO, pursuant to which the Bank agreed to engage Mr. Mumma as a consultant until December 31, 2011.  During the period of his engagement, Mr. Mumma agreed to provide from 20 to 40 hours of consulting services per month, for a consulting fee of $13.5 per month plus reimbursement of expenses incurred by him in performing the services.  The agreement also provides non-compete covenants for a period ending one year after the term of the consulting agreement.  During both 2011 and 2010, the Bank paid $162 in consulting fees to Mr. Mumma under the agreement, and also paid him $67.5 under the agreement in 2009.
 
On December 30, 2010, the Bancorp executed a loan participation agreement with Atlantic Coast Bank, a federal savings bank with main offices in Jacksonville, Florida.  Jay Sidhu, the Bancorp’s Chief Executive Officer, is the Non-executive Chairman of the Board, and Bhanu Choudhrie is a director of the Bank and of Atlantic Coast Financial Corporation’s Board.  The loan participation agreement provided for a principal amount up to $6,250. This participating interest is based upon specified Atlantic Coast Bank customer activity and will be repaid to the Bancorp upon the release of the underlying mortgage collateral. This lending transaction was in the ordinary course of the Bancorp’s business, made on substantially the same terms, including interest rates and collateral, as those prevailing at the time for comparable transactions with other non-affiliated customers, and did not involve more than the normal risk of collectability or present other unfavorable features.
 
On August 13, 2010, the Bancorp executed a loan participation agreement in the principal amount of up to $25,000 to Atlantic Coast Bank.  This participating interest is based upon the loan activity by certain mortgage warehouse customer activity and will be repaid upon the release of the underlying mortgage collateral. This lending transaction was in the ordinary course of the Bancorp’s business, made on substantially the same terms, including interest rates and collateral, as those prevailing at the time for comparable transactions with other non-affiliated customers, and did not involve more than the normal risk of collectability or present other unfavorable features. This agreement was terminated on December 30, 2010.
 
On June 30, 2010, the Bancorp extended a term loan in the principal amount of $5,000 to Atlantic Coast Financial Corporation, which is the holding company for Atlantic Coast Bank.  This lending transaction was in the ordinary course of the Bancorp’s business, made on substantially the same terms, including interest rates and collateral, as those prevailing at the time for comparable transactions with other non-affiliated customers, and did not involve more than the normal risk of collectability or present other unfavorable features.  The Bancorp sold the full amount of the term loan to accredited investors in August 2010.  Two of the Bancorp’s directors had material interests in this transaction:  $500 of the loan was participated to a director and $2,000 of the loan was participated to a company for which a director of the Bank’s is a managing member.  This loan was paid off in December 2010.
 
Commerce Street Investment Adviser, LLC is a beneficial holder of more than 5% of the Bancorp’s outstanding Voting Common Stock.  In or around December 2010 through February 2011, Commerce Street Capital, LLC, an affiliate of Commerce Street Investment Adviser, LLC, provided placement agent services in connection with a private placement of the common stock of Customers Bank.  Customers Bank paid Commerce Street Capital, LLC a placement fee in the amount of $231.8.
 
For the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 the Bancorp has paid approximately $344, $300 and $84, respectively to Clipper Magazine and its division, Spencer Advertising Marketing as well as Jaxxon Promotions, Inc.  A director of the Bancorp is the Chief Executive Officer of Clipper Magazine, an affiliate of Gannett Co., Inc., and a 25% shareholder of Jaxxon Promotion, Inc.
 
NOTE 15 - FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS WITH OFF-BALANCE SHEET RISK
 
The Bancorp is a party to financial instruments with off-balance sheet risk in the normal course of business to meet the financing needs of its customers. These financial instruments include commitments to extend credit and letters of credit. Those instruments involve, to varying degrees, elements of credit risk in excess of the amount recognized in the balance sheets.
 
The Bancorp’s exposure to credit loss in the event of nonperformance by the other party to the financial instrument for commitments to extend credit is represented by the contractual amount of those instruments. The Bancorp uses the same credit policies in making commitments and conditional obligations as it does for on-balance sheet instruments.
 
At December 31, 2011 and 2010, the following financial instruments were outstanding whose contract amounts represent credit risk:
 
   
2011
   
2010
 
       
Commitments to fund loans
 
$
106,227
   
$
23,446
 
Unfunded commitments to fund mortgage warehouse loans
   
294,681
     
221,706
 
Unfunded commitments under lines of credit
   
66,936
     
42,840
 
Letters of credit
   
1,374
     
1,085
 
 
 
 
F-45

 
 

 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 15 - FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS WITH OFF-BALANCE SHEET RISK (continued)

Commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to a customer as long as there is no violation of any condition established in the contract.  Since many of the commitments are expected to expire without being drawn upon, the total commitment amounts do not necessarily represent future cash requirements.  Mortgage warehouse loan commitments are agreements to purchase mortgage loans from mortgage bankers that agree to purchase the loans back in a short period of time.  These commitments generally fluctuate monthly as existing loans are repurchased by the mortgage bankers and new loans are purchased by the Bancorp.

Commitments generally have fixed expiration dates or other termination clauses and may require payment of a fee.  The Bancorp evaluates each customer’s credit worthiness on a case-by-case basis.  The amount of collateral obtained, if deemed necessary by
The Bancorp upon extension of credit, is based on management’s credit evaluation.  Collateral held varies but may include personal or commercial real estate, accounts receivable, inventory and equipment.
 
Outstanding letters of credit written are conditional commitments issued by the Bancorp to guarantee the performance of a customer to a third party.  The majority of these standby letters of credit expire within the next year.  The credit risk involved in issuing letters of credit is essentially the same as that involved in extending other loan commitments.  The Bancorp requires collateral supporting these letters of credit as deemed necessary.  Management believes that the proceeds obtained through a liquidation of such collateral would be sufficient to cover the maximum potential amount of future payments required under the corresponding guarantees.  The current amount of the liabilities as of December 31, 2011 and 2010 for guarantees under standby letters of credit issued is not material.


NOTE 16 – OTHER COMPREHENSIVE INCOME (LOSS)

The components of other comprehensive income (loss) are as follows:
 
   
Years Ended December 31,
 
   
2011
   
2010
   
2009
 
Unrealized holding gains (losses) on available for
sale securities
  $ 5,227     $ (1,706 )   $ 556  
Reclassification adjustment for impairment
charges recognized in income on available for
sale securities
       -         -         15  
Reclassification adjustment for gains recognized
in income on available for sale securities
    (2,731 )     (1,114 )     (236 )
Net unrealized gains (losses)
    2,496       (2,820 )     335  
Income tax effect
    (845 )     957       (113 )
Unrealized gains (losses), net of taxes
  $ 1,651     $ (1,863 )   $ 222  

 
 
F-46

 

 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 17 - REGULATORY MATTERS

The Bank and the Bancorp are subject to various regulatory capital requirements administered by the federal banking agencies. Failure to meet the minimum capital requirements can initiate certain mandatory and possibly additional discretionary-actions by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on the Bancorp’s financial statements. Under capital adequacy guidelines and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, the Bank and Bancorp must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of their assets, liabilities and certain off-balance sheet items, as calculated under the regulatory accounting practices.  The capital amounts and classification are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings and other factors.  Prompt corrective action provisions are not applicable to bank holding companies.

Quantitative measures established by regulation to ensure capital adequacy require the Bank and Bancorp to maintain minimum amounts and ratios (set forth in the following table) of total and Tier 1 capital (as defined in the regulations) to risk-weighted assets (as defined) and of Tier 1 capital (as defined) to average assets (as defined).  Management believes, as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, that the Bank and Bancorp meet all capital adequacy requirements to which they are subject.

To be categorized as well capitalized, an institution must maintain minimum total risk based, Tier 1 risk based and Tier 1 leveraged ratios as set forth in the following table:
 
   
Actual
 
 
For Capital Adequacy Purposes
 
To Be Well Capitalized Under
    Prompt Corrective Action
                 Provisions
   
Amount
 
Ratio
 
Amount
 
 
Ratio
 
 
Amount
 
 
Ratio
As of December 31, 2011:
                 
Total capital (to risk weighted assets)
                       
 
Customers Bancorp, Inc.
 
 
$
 
162,228
 
 
11.43
%
 
$
 
113,504
 
>
 
8.0
 
%
 
 
N/A
 
 
N/A
 
Customers Bank
 
$
157,228
 
11.08
%
$
113,504
>
8.0
%
$
141,880
>
10.0
%
                         
Tier 1 capital (to risk weighted assets)
                       
Customers Bancorp, Inc.
 
 
$
 
146,395
 
10.32
%
$
 
56,752
 
>
4.0
%
 
 
N/A
 
 
N/A
 
Customers Bank
 
$
141,395
 
9.97
%
$
56,752
>
4.0
%
$
85,128
>
6.0
%
                         
Tier 1 capital (to average assets)
                       
 
Customers Bancorp, Inc.
 
 
$
 
146,395
 
 
 7.59
%
 
$
 
 77,166
 
>
 
 4.0
 
%
 
 
    N/A
 
 
  N/A
 
Customers Bank
 
$
141,395
 
7.33
%
$
77,166
>
 4.0
%
$
96,457
>
5.0
%
                 
As of December 31, 2010:
               
Total capital (to risk weighted assets)
 
$
115,147
 
21.1
%
43,571
>
8.0
%
$
53,464
>
10.0
%
                                 
Tier 1 capital (to risk weighted assets)
 
107,036
 
19.7
%
21,557
>
4.0
%
32,335
>
6.0
%
                                 
Tier 1 capital (to average assets)
 
107,036
 
8.7
%
49,397
>
4.0
%
61,747
>
5.0
%
 
NOTE 18 - DISCLOSURES ABOUT FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS

The Bancorp uses fair value measurements to record fair value adjustments to certain assets and to disclose the fair value of its financial instruments.  FASB ASC 825,  Financial Instruments , requires disclosure of the estimated fair value of an entity’s assets and liabilities considered to be financial instruments. For the Bancorp, as for most financial institutions, the majority of its assets and liabilities are considered to be financial instruments. However, many of such instruments lack an available trading market as characterized by a willing buyer and willing seller engaging in an exchange transaction. For fair value disclosure purposes, the Bancorp utilized certain fair value measurement criteria under the FASB ASC 820, Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures , as explained below.  
 
 
F-47

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 18 - DISCLOSURES ABOUT FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS (continued)

The following methods and assumptions were used to estimate the fair values of the Bancorp’s financial instruments at December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010:

Cash and cash equivalents:
The carrying amounts reported in the balance sheet for cash and short-term instruments approximate those assets’ fair values.

Investment securities:
The fair value of investment securities available-for-sale and held-to-maturity are determined by obtaining quoted market prices on nationally recognized securities exchanges (Level 1), matrix pricing (Level 2), which is a mathematical technique used widely in the industry to value debt securities without relying exclusively on quoted market prices for the specific securities but rather by relying on the securities’ relationship to other benchmark quoted prices, or externally developed models that use unobservable inputs due to limited or no market activity of the instrument (Level 3) and are included in investment securities, available for sale.
 
The carrying amount of restricted investment in Bancorp stock approximates fair value, and considers the limited marketability of such securities.
 
Interest-only strips:
To obtain fair values, quoted market prices are used if available. Quotes are generally not available for interests that continue to be held by the transferor, so the Bancorp generally estimates fair value based on the future expected cash flows estimated using management’s best estimates of the key assumptions, credit losses and discount rates, commensurate with the risks involved. At December 31, 2011, the Bancorp had interest-only strips measured at fair value on a recurring basis classified within Level 3 and are included in investment securities, available for sale.
 
Loans held for sale:
Loans originated with the intent to sell in the secondary market are carried at the lower of cost or fair value, determined in the aggregate. These loans are sold on a non-recourse basis with servicing released. Gains and losses on the sale of loans recognized in earnings are measured based on the difference between proceeds received and the carrying amount of the loans, inclusive of deferred origination fees and costs, if any.
 
As a result of changes in events and circumstances or developments regarding management’s view of the foreseeable future, loans not originated or acquired with the intent to sell may subsequently be designated as held for sale. These loans are transferred to the held for sale portfolio at the lower of amortized cost or fair value.

The fair value of loans receivable held for sale is based on commitments on hand from investors within the secondary market for loans with similar characteristics.

Loans receivable, net:
The fair values of loans are estimated using discounted cash flow analyses, using market rates at the balance sheet date that reflect the credit and interest rate-risk inherent in the loans.  Projected future cash flows are calculated based upon contractual maturity or call dates, projected repayments and prepayments of principal. Generally, for variable rate loans that reprice frequently and with no significant change in credit risk, fair values are based on carrying values.

Impaired loans:
Impaired loans are those that are accounted for under FASB ASC 450, Contingencies , in which the Bancorp has measured impairment generally based on the fair value of the loan’s collateral.  Fair value is generally determined based upon independent third-party appraisals of the properties, or discounted cash flows based upon the expected proceeds.  These assets are included as Level 3 fair values, based upon the lowest level of input that is significant to the fair value measurements.
 
FDIC loss sharing receivable:
The FDIC loss sharing receivable is measured separately from the related covered assets, as it is not contractually embedded in the assets and is not transferable with the assets should the assets be sold. Fair value is estimated using projected cash flows related to the Loss Sharing Agreements based on the expected reimbursements for losses using the applicable loss share percentages and the estimated true-up payment. These cash flows are discounted to reflect the estimated timing of the receipt of the loss share reimbursement from the FDIC.
 
 
 
F-48

 
 

 
  CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)
 
NOTE 18 - DISCLOSURES ABOUT FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS (continued)
 
Other Real Estate Owned (“OREO”):
The fair value is determined using appraisals, which may be discounted based on management’s review and changes in market conditions (Level 3 Inputs). All appraisals must be performed in accordance with the Uniform Standards of Professional Appraisal Practice (“USPAP”). Appraisals are certified to the Bancorp and performed by appraisers on the Bancorp’s approved list of appraisers. Evaluations are completed by a person independent of management.

Accrued interest receivable and payable:
The carrying amount of accrued interest receivable and accrued interest payable approximates its fair value.

Deposits:
The fair values disclosed for deposits (e.g., interest and noninterest checking, passbook savings and money market accounts) are, by definition, equal to the amount payable on demand at the reporting date (i.e., their carrying amounts).  Fair values for fixed-rate certificates of deposit are estimated using a discounted cash flow calculation that applies interest rates currently being offered in the market on certificates to a schedule of aggregated expected monthly maturities on time deposits.

Federal funds purchased :
Due to the short term nature of Fed Funds purchased, the carrying amount is considered a reasonable estimate of fair value.

Borrowings :
Borrowings consist of long-term and short-term FHLB advances.  For the short-term borrowings, the carrying amount is considered a reasonable estimate of fair value.  Fair values of long-term FHLB advances are estimated using discounted cash flow analysis, based on quoted prices for new FHLB advances with similar credit risk characteristics, terms and remaining maturity. These prices obtained from this active market represent a market value that is deemed to represent the transfer price if the liability were assumed by a third party.

Subordinated debt :
Fair values of subordinated debt are estimated using discounted cash flow analysis, based on market rates currently offered on such debt with similar credit risk characteristics, terms and remaining maturity.
 
 
 
F-49

 
 

 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 18 - DISCLOSURES ABOUT FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS (continued)

Off-balance sheet financial instruments :

Fair values for the Bancorp’s off-balance sheet financial instruments (lending commitments and letters of credit) are based on fees currently charged in the market to enter into similar agreements, taking into account the remaining terms of the agreements and the counterparties’ credit standing.

The estimated fair values of the Bancorp’s financial instruments were as follows at December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010.
 
     
2011
     
2010
 
     
Carrying
Amount
     
Fair
Value
     
Carrying
Amount
     
Fair
Value
 
Assets:
                               
Cash and cash equivalents
 
$
73,570
   
$
73,570
   
$
238,724
   
$
238,724
 
Investment securities, available-for-sale
   
79,137
     
79,137
     
205,828
     
205,828
 
Investment securities, held–to-maturity
   
319,547
     
330,809
     
     
 
Loans held for sale
   
174,999
     
174,999
     
199,970
     
199,970
 
Loans receivable, net
   
1,327,509
     
1,339,633
     
663,843
     
661,320
 
FDIC loss sharing receivable
   
13,077
     
13,077
     
16,702
     
16,702
 
Restricted stock
   
21,818
     
21,818
     
4,267
     
4,267
 
Accrued interest receivable
   
5,011
     
5,011
     
3,196
     
3,196
 
                                 
Liabilities:
                               
                                 
Deposits
 
$
1,583,189
   
 $
1,610,977
   
$
1,245,690
   
 $
1,247,535
 
Federal funds purchased
   
5,000
     
5,000
             
 
Subordinated debt
   
2,000
     
2,000
     
2,000
     
2,000
 
Borrowings
   
331,000
     
332,847
     
11,000
     
10,756
 
Accrued interest payable
   
1,478
     
1,478
     
1,657
     
1,657
 
 
In accordance with FASB ASC 820, Fair Value Measurements and Disclosures , the fair value of a financial instrument is the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date.  Fair value is best determined based upon quoted market prices.  However, in many instances, there are no quoted market prices for the Bancorp’s various financial instruments.  In cases where quoted market prices are not available, fair values are based on estimates using present value or other valuation techniques.  Those techniques are significantly affected by the assumptions used, including the discount rate and estimates of future cash flows.  Accordingly, the fair value estimates may not be realized in an immediate settlement of the instrument.

The fair value guidance provides a consistent definition of fair value, focusing on an exit price in an orderly transaction (that is, not a forced liquidation or distressed sale) between market participants at the measurement date under current market conditions.  If there has been a significant decrease in the volume and level of activity for the asset or liability, a change in valuation technique or the use of multiple valuation techniques may be appropriate.  In such instances, determining the price at which willing market participants would transact at the measurement date under current market conditions depends on the facts and circumstances and requires the use of significant judgment.  The fair value is a reasonable point within the range that is most representative of fair value under current market conditions.

Level 1:
Unadjusted quoted prices in active markets that are accessible at the measurement date for identical, unrestricted assets or liabilities.
Level 2:
Quoted prices in markets that are not active, or inputs that are observable either directly or indirectly, for substantially the full term of the asset or liability.
Level 3:
Prices or valuation techniques that require inputs that are both significant to the fair value measurement and unobservable (i.e., supported with little or no market activity).
 
 
 
F-50

 
 

CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 18 - DISCLOSURES ABOUT FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS (continued)

An asset’s level within the fair value hierarchy is based on the lowest level of input that is significant to the fair value measurement.  
 
For financial assets measured at fair value on a recurring basis, the fair value measurements by level within the fair value hierarchy used at December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010 are as follows:
 
        December 31, 2011  
     
(Level 1)
Quoted Prices in
Active Markets for Identical Assets
     
(Level 2)
Significant Other
Observable Inputs
     
(Level 3)
Significant
Unobservable Inputs
     
Total Fair
Value
 
                                 
                                 
U.S. Treasury and government agencies
  $ -     $ 1,001     $ -     $ 1,001  
Mortgage-backed securities
    -       53,398       2,894       56,292  
Asset-backed securities
    -       627       -       627  
Corporate bonds
    -       -       19,217       19,217  
Municipal securities
    -       2,000       -       2,000  
    $ -     $ 57,026     $ 22,111     $ 79,137  
 
   
December 31, 2010
 
   
(Level 1) Quoted Prices in Active Markets for Identical Assets
   
(Level 2) Significant Other Observable Inputs
   
(Level 3) Significant Unobservable Inputs
   
Total Fair Value
 
U.S. Treasury and government agencies
  $     $ 1,681     $     $ 1,681  
Mortgage-backed securities
    39       201,535             201,574  
Asset-backed securities
          722             722  
Municipal securities
          1,851             1,851  
    $ 39     $ 205,789     $     $ 205,828  
                                 
 The changes in Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis as of December 31, 2011 are summarized as follows:
 
                   
   
Mortgage-backed
             
   
Securities
   
Corporate Notes
   
Total
 
Balance at January 1, 2011
  $ -     $ -     $ -  
Total gains (losses) included in other
                       
Comprehensive income (before taxes)
    -       (783 )     (783 )
Purchases
    2,894       20,000       22,894  
Balance at December 31, 2011
  $ 2,894     $ 19,217     $ 22,111  
 
 
 
 
F-51

 

 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 18 - DISCLOSURES ABOUT FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS (continued)

The following table summarizes financial assets and financial liabilities measured at fair value on a nonrecurring basis as of December 31, 2011 and December 31, 2010, segregated by the level of the valuation inputs within the fair value hierarchy utilized to measure fair value:
   
December 31, 2011
 
   
(Level 1)
Quoted Prices in Active Markets for Identical Assets
   
(Level 2)
Significant Other
Observable Inputs
   
(Level 3)
Significant
Unobservable Inputs
   
Total Fair
Value
 
Impaired loans, net of specific reserves of $5,676
 
$
   
$
   
$
15,579
   
$
15,579
 
Other real estate owned
   
             
2,648
     
2,648
 
   
$
   
$
   
$
18,227
   
$
18,227
 

   
December 31, 2010
 
   
(Level 1)
Quoted Prices in Active Markets for Identical Assets
   
(Level 2)
Significant Other Observable Inputs
   
(Level 3)
Significant Unobservable Inputs
   
Total Fair Value
 
Impaired loans, net of specific reserves of $10,318
 
$
   
$
   
$
22,695
   
$
22,695
 
Other real estate owned
   
     
     
1,361
     
1,361
 
   
$
   
$
   
$
24,056
   
$
24,056
 
 
The above information should not be interpreted as an estimate of the fair value of the entire Bancorp since a fair value calculation is only provided for a limited portion of the Bancorp’s assets.  Due to a wide range of valuation techniques and the degree of subjectivity used in making the estimates, comparisons between the Bancorp’s disclosures and those of other companies may not be meaningful.
 
NOTE 19 - LEGAL CONTINGENCIES

On November 15, 2010, Customers Bank filed suit against Open Solutions, Inc. (“OSI”) in the United States District Court for the Eastern District of Pennsylvania, seeking damages for failure to assist in the conversion of system and customer information associated with the former USA Bank and requesting injunctive relief to compel OSI to assist with the deconversion of the former USA Bank’s systems. OSI filed counterclaims against Customers Bank on November 24, 2010, asserting claims for breach of contract and breach of settlement agreement. In support of its breach of contract claim, OSI alleged that Customers Bank “assumed” the former-USA Bank agreements and is bound by those agreements. OSI claimed that it has sustained damages in excess of $1 million. Customers Bank disputed that it has any liability to OSI. Prior to trial, OSI dismissed with prejudice its settlement agreement claim.  Trial was held on February 24, 2011.  On March 7, 2011, the Court ruled against Customers Bank and in favor of OSI as follows: judgment was entered against Customers on OSI’s claim that the agreements between OSI and USA Bank were assumed by Customers Bank and judgment was entered against Customers on its claims against OSI; judgment was entered for OSI on its breach of contract claim under one agreement, in the amount of $104,000; the Court found there was no breach of the second agreement by Customers Bank and no proof of damages.  OSI has filed a motion for payment of legal fees and costs associated with the litigation, which are estimated to be around $205,000.  Customers Bank has filed a motion with the District Court to vacate the judgment and to enter judgment in favor of Customers on OSI’s counterclaim.  In addition, the FDIC has filed a motion to intervene in the litigation, and has also sought dismissal of OSI’s counterclaims on jurisdictional grounds.  On May 3, 2011, the Court granted the FDIC’s motion to intervene, and directed that OSI respond to the motion to dismiss the counterclaim.  On August 9, 2011, the District Court granted the FDIC’s motion to dismiss and vacated the judgment entered against Customers Bank.  The Court denied the Bank’s post-trial motion as moot because of the Court’s vacatur of the judgment.
 
 
 
F-52

 
 

 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)


NOTE 19 - LEGAL CONTINGENCIES (Continued)

On September 2, 2011, OSI filed a notice of appeal to the United States Court of Appeals for the Third Circuit, in which OSI appeals from the Court’s August 9, 2011 Order granting the FDIC’s motion to dismiss.  The Third Circuit has not yet set a schedule for briefing or argument.
  
NOTE 20 - CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF PARENT COMPANY
     
 
On September 17, 2011, Customers Bank and Customers Bancorp, Inc. completed a Plan of Merger and reorganization pursuant to which all of the issued and outstanding common stock of the Bank was exchanged on a three-to-one basis for shares of common stock and non-voting common stock of the Bancorp.
 
Balance Sheet
     
   
December 31, 2011
 
Assets
     
Cash in subsidiary bank
  $ 4,999  
Investment in and receivable due from subsidiary
    142,749  
Total assets
  $ 147,748  
         
Shareholders’ Equity
  $ 147,748  
         
         
Income Statement
       
   
Year Ended
 
   
December 31, 2011
 
Equity in undistributed income of subsidiary
  $ 4,034  
Net income
    4,034  
Dividends on preferred stock
    44  
Net income available to common shareholders
  $ 3,990  











 
F-53

 


CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)


NOTE 20 - CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS OF PARENT COMPANY (CONTINUED)
 
 
 
    Year Ended
      December 31, 2011
Statement of Cash Flows
       
Cash Flows from Operating Activities:
       
Net income
 
$
4,034
 
Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash used
     
in operating activities:
       
Equity in undistributed earnings of subsidiary
 
(4,034)
 
Net Cash Used in Operating Activities
   
-
 
Cash Flows from Investing Activities:
       
Payments for investments in and advances to
     
subsidiaries
   
(4,420)
 
Net Cash Used by investing activities
   
(4,420)
 
Cash Flows from Financing Activities:
       
Proceeds from issuance of common stock
 
13,000
 
Purchase of treasury stock
   
(500)
 
Repayment of TARP
   
(3,037)
 
Dividends paid
   
(44)
 
Net Cash Provided by Financing Activities
   
9,419
 
Net Increase in Cash and Cash Equivalents
 
4,999
 
Cash and Cash Equivalents - Beginning
   
-
 
Cash and Cash Equivalents - Ending
 
$
4,999
 
 
 
 
 
F-54

 

 

CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)

NOTE 21 - SELECTED QUARTERLY FINANCIAL DATA (UNAUDITED)
 

Quarterly Consolidated Results of Operations
( in thousands, except share and per share data )
(unaudited)
 
      2011  
Quarter Ended
   
December 31
     
September 30
     
June 30
     
March 31
 
Interest income
  $ 19,494     $ 15,409     $ 14,697     $ 11,839  
Interest expense
    5,422       5,696       5,790       5,555  
Net interest income
    14,072       9,713       8,907       6,284  
Provision for loan losses
    2,900       900       2,850       2,800  
Non-interest income
    4,406       3,591       2,519       3,136  
Non-interest expenses
    10,822       9,129       8,366       8,992  
Income (loss) before income taxes
    4,756       3,275       210       (2,372 )
Provision for (benefit from) income taxes
    1,536       930       65       (696 )
Net income (loss)
    3,220       2,345       145       (1,676 )
Preferred stock dividends
    39       5       -       -  
Net income (loss) applicable to common shareholders
  $ 3,181     $ 2,340     $ 145     $ (1,676 )
Earnings per common share:
                               
     Basic
  $ 0.28     $ 0.24     $ 0.01     $ (0.20 )
     Diluted
    0.27       0.23       0.01       (0.20 )
 
      2010  
Quarter Ended
   
December 31
     
September 30
     
June 30
     
March 31
 
Interest income
  $ 11,767     $ 9,466     $ 5,754     $ 3,920  
Interest expense
    4,565       3,220       2,124       1,637  
Net interest income
    7,202       6,246       3,630       2,283  
Provision for loan losses
    850       4,075       1,100       4,372  
Non-interest income
    1,845       41,660       1,512       653  
Non-interest expenses
    7,481       11,542       3,612       3,533  
Income (loss) before income taxes
    716       32,289       430       (4,969 )
Provision for income taxes
    276       4,455       -       -  
Net income (loss)
  $ 440     $ 27,834     $ 430     $ (4,969 )
Earnings per common share:
                               
     Basic
  $ 0.06     $ 3.86     $ 0.06     $ (1.39 )
     Diluted
    0.06       3.81       0.06       (1.39 )


 
F-55

 

CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. AND SUBSIDIARY
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
(Dollars in thousands except for per share data)
 
NOTE 22 - SUBSEQUENT EVENTS

Due to our significant growth and evolution as a bank since 2009, including raising more than $100 million in equity, increasing assets to over $2 billion and significantly increasing our equity base, in February 2012 the Compensation Committee recommended and the board of directors approved a restricted stock reward program that provided for the grant of restricted stock units to certain directors and senior executives of the Bancorp and the Bank.  Pursuant to the program, restricted stock units for 185,185 shares of our common stock and 211,640 shares of our Class B Non-Voting common stock were granted on February 16, 2012 pursuant to the 2004 Plan.  Of this amount, our executive officers received restricted stock units for 126,984 shares of common stock and 211,640 shares of Class B Non-Voting common stock in the aggregate and our non-employee directors received 15,876 shares of common stock in the aggregate.  One requirement for vesting is that the recipient of the restricted stock units remains an employee or director through December 31, 2016, subject to earlier vesting upon a change in control resulting in any one shareholder owning more than 24.9% of the outstanding stock of the Bancorp.  The second vesting requirement for each award (both must be met to vest) is that our common stock trades at a price greater than $18.90 per share (adjusted for any stock splits or stock dividends) for at least 5 consecutive trading days during the five year period ending DEcember 31, 2016.  If the restricted stock units vest, the recipient will receive shares of our common stock on December 31, 2016.  The fair value of this award at the date of grant is $5 million and will be expensed over the requisite service period of 5 years.

 

 
F-56

 

 
 
Through and including ______________________ (25 days after the date of this prospectus), all dealers that buy, sell or trade our Voting Common Stock, whether or not participating in this offering, may be required to deliver a prospectus.  This delivery requirement is in addition to the obligation of dealers to deliver a prospectus when acting as underwriters and with respect to their unsold allotments or subscriptions.
 

 
 

 
 
PROSPECTUS
 


 

 
        Shares
 

 
Customers Bancorp, Inc.
 
Voting Common Stock
 

 

 


 
Macquarie Capital

 
Keefe, Bruyette & Woods
 
 
 

 
 
 
 
INFORMATION NOT REQUIRED IN PROSPECTUS
 
Item 13. Other Expenses of Issuance and Distribution.
 
The following table sets forth the costs and expenses, other than underwriting discounts and commissions, payable by us in connection with the sale of the Voting Common Stock being registered. All amounts, except the SEC registration fee and the FINRA filing fee, are estimates.

SEC registration fee
  $ 13,179
FINRA filing fee
    12,000
Nasdaq Global Market listing fees and expense
     
Transfer agent and registrar fees and expenses
      *
Printing fees and expenses
      *
Legal fees and expenses
      *
Accounting fees and expenses
      *
Blue sky fees and expenses
      *
Miscellaneous
      *
Total
  $   *
* Item to be furnished by Amendment
       

 
Item 14. Indemnification of Directors and Officers.

Subchapter D of the Pennsylvania Business Corporation Law (“PBCL”) provides for indemnification of, and insurance for any person who is or was a representative of Customers Bancorp and specifically empowers us to indemnify, subject to the standards therein prescribed, any person who is or was a representative of Customers Bancorp in connection with any action, suit or proceeding brought or threatened by reason of the fact that he is or was a representative of Customers Bancorp. Article 8.02 of Customers Bancorp’s Bylaws requires us to indemnify each of our directors and officers in such capacity in which any such director or officer acts for or on behalf of Customers Bancorp including as an employee or agent.
 
Article Eight of our bylaws limits the personal liability of directors for monetary damages and provides for indemnification of officers and directors, as described below.  These provisions may not be amended to increase the directors’ exposure to liability or to decrease the indemnification to directors, officers or others except by the affirmative vote of 2/3 of the entire board of directors or 80% of the votes which all shareholders are entitled to cast.
 
Section 8.01 provides that, to the fullest extent permitted under Subchapter B of Chapter 17 of the PBCL, our directors shall not be personally liable to us or our shareholders or others for monetary damages for any action taken or any failure to take any action unless the director has breached or failed to perform the duties of his or her office and such breach or failure constitutes self-dealing, willful misconduct or recklessness.  This section does not apply to the responsibility or liability of such director under any criminal statute or with respect to the payment of taxes pursuant to local, state or federal law.
 
Section 8.02(a) requires Customers Bancorp to indemnify any person who was or is a party or is threatened to be made a party to any threatened, pending or completed action, suit or proceeding, whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative by reason of the fact such person was a director, officer, employee or agent of Customers Bancorp or its bank subsidiaries, or any other direct or indirect subsidiary of Customers Bancorp, or is or was serving at the request of Customers Bancorp as a director, officer, employee or agent of another corporation or entity, against expenses (including attorney’s fees), judgments, fines and amounts paid in settlement actually and reasonably incurred by such person in connection with such action, suit or proceeding, to the fullest extent authorized or permitted by the laws of the Commonwealth of Pennsylvania.
 
Section 8.02(b) requires us to pay the expenses (including attorney’s fees) incurred in defending a civil or criminal action, suit or proceeding in advance of the final disposition of any action, suit or proceeding upon the receipt of (i) an undertaking by or on behalf of the director, officer, employee or agent to repay such amount if it is ultimately determined that he or she is not entitled to be indemnified as authorized under the bylaws and (ii) if requested at the discretion of the board of directors, adequate security or a bond to cover such amounts for which it is ultimately determined that he or she is not entitled to such indemnity.
 
 
 
II-1

 
 
 
Section 8.02(c) provides the right to indemnification and advancement of expenses is not exclusive of any other right to which such persons seeking indemnification and advancement of expenses may be entitled under any agreement, vote of shareholders or disinterested directors, or otherwise.
 
Section 8.02(d) provides that we may purchase and maintain insurance on behalf of any person, may enter into contracts of indemnification with any person and may create a fund of any nature for the benefit of any person and may otherwise secure in any manner our obligations with respect to indemnification and advancement of expenses regardless of the source of the indemnification right and without respect to whether or not we would have the power to indemnify such person under the bylaws.
 
Under current Pennsylvania law we do not have the power to indemnify any person for his or her willful misconduct or recklessness.
 
 
 
 
II-2

 
 
Item 15. Recent Sales of Unregistered Securities.

Below is a chart that provides information relating to all unregistered offers of securities by us in the past three fiscal years.  The securities in the two 2011 3rd Quarter Private Offers were offered and sold in reliance on an exemption under 4(2) of the Securities Act for securities issued pursuant to a transaction by an issuer not involving any public offering.  These offers and sales were made to an accredited investor under Rule 501 of Regulation D promulgated under the Securities Act, and no advertising or general solicitation was employed. The securities in all other offerings noted below were offered and sold in reliance on an exemption under 3(a)(5) of the Securities Act for securities issued by a bank.
 
OFFERING
TYPES AND NUMBERS OF SECURITIES SOLD
AGGREGATE PURCHASE PRICE PAID OR OTHER CONSIDERATION GIVEN FOR SECURITIES
DATE OF COMPLETION OF OFFERING
TYPES OF INVESTORS
2011 3rd Quarter
Private Offer
419,000 shares of Voting Common Stock
565,848 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock
$13,000,000
September 30, 2011
Accredited Investor
2011 3rd Quarter Private Offer
2,892 shares of Series A Shares and 145 shares of Series B Shares.
Exchange for Berkshire TARP Shares Series A and Berkshire TARP Shares Series B
September 17, 2011
United States Department of Treasury
2011 1st Quarter
Private Offer
879,577 shares of Voting Common Stock
509,308 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock
$16,130,875
March 31, 2011
Institutional and Accredited Investors
2010 December
Private Offer
694,947 shares of Voting Common Stock
49,266 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock
$8,788,744
December 28, 2010
Institutional and Accredited Investors
2010 July
Private Offer
8,333 shares of  Voting Common Stock
96,666 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock
$1,067,500
July 14, 2010
Institutional and Accredited Investors
2010 March
Private Offer
253,865 shares of Voting Common Stock
396,400 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock
16,034 warrants to purchase Voting Common Stock
16,035 warrants to purchase Class B Non-Voting Common Stock
$7,335,003
March 29, 2010
Institutional and Accredited Investors
2010 February
Private Offer
2,176,516 shares of Voting Common Stock
1,182,863 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock
68,593 warrants to purchase Voting Common Stock
52,177 warrants to purchase Class B Non-Voting Common Stock
$43,134,433
February 17, 2010
Institutional and Accredited Investors
2009 Private Offer
(1)
333,186 shares of Voting Common Stock
227,776 warrants to purchase Voting Common Stock
$17,106,300
July 31, 2009
Institutional and Accredited Investors

(1)
In conjunction with our 2009 private offering, all shares of 10% Series A Non-Cumulative Perpetual Convertible Preferred Stock issued in this offering were exchanged for 59,388 shares of Voting Common Stock at an average per share price of $16.50 per share, and 8,166 warrants to purchase Voting Common Stock at an exercise price of $16.50 per share.
 
 
 
II-3

 
 

 
In addition to the foregoing, since January 1, 2009 we granted certain of our officers, directors and employees options to purchase an aggregate of 1,219,771 shares of our common stock under our 2010 Plan and restricted stock units to acquire 552,475 shares of our common stock under our 2004 Plan and the BRRP.  We received no consideration for these awards.  We believe that these awards were not subject to the registration requirements of Section 5 of the Securities Act, as amended (the “Securities Act”), as the issuance without payment of any consideration therefor does not constitute a "sale" under Section 2(3) of the Securities Act.  We also believe these issuances would be exempt under either (i) Section  3(a)(5) of the Securities Act for securities issued by a bank, (ii) Rule 701 as they were offered under written compensatory benefit plans, or (iii) Section 4(2) of the Securities Act as transactions by an issuer not involving a public offering with no advertising or general solicitation being employed.
 
Item 16. Exhibits Financial Statements Schedules.
 
(a)   Exhibits: The list of exhibits is set forth under "Exhibit Index" at the end of this registration statement and is incorporated herein by reference.
 
(b)   Financial Statement Schedules: None.
 
Item 17. Undertakings.
 
Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, may be permitted to directors, officers and controlling persons of the registrant pursuant to the foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the registrant has been advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange Commission such indemnification is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and is, therefore, unenforceable. In the event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities (other than the payment by the registrant of expenses incurred or paid by a director, officer or controlling person of the registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling person in connection with the securities being registered, the registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in the Securities Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of such issue.
 
The undersigned registrant hereby undertakes that:
 
 
(1)
For purposes of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, the information omitted from the form of prospectus filed as part of this registration statement in reliance upon Rule 430A and contained in a form of prospectus filed by the registrant pursuant to Rule 424(b)(1) or (4) or 497(h) under the Securities Act shall be deemed to be part of this registration statement as of the time it was declared effective.
 
 
(2)
For the purpose of determining any liability under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, each post-effective amendment that contains a form of prospectus shall be deemed to be a new registration statement relating to the securities offered therein, and the offering of such securities at that time shall be deemed to be the initial bona fide offering thereof.
 
 
 
 
II-4

 

 
 
SIGNATURES
 

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, the Registrant has duly caused this Registration Statement to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of Wyomissing, Commonwealth of Pennsylvania, on March 28, 2012.
 

 
 
Customers Bancorp, Inc.
 
 
 
By:             /s/ Thomas Brugger                                                       
 
Thomas Brugger
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer

 
Each person whose signature appears below hereby constitutes and appoints Jay S. Sidhu and Thomas Brugger, and each of them acting individually, as his true and lawful attorneys-in-fact and agents, with full power of substitution and resubstitution, to execute for him and in his name, place and stead, in any and all capacities, any and all amendments (including post-effective amendments) to this registration statement and any registration statement for the same offering covered by this registration statement that is to be effective upon filing pursuant to Rule 462 promulgated under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, as the attorney-in-fact and to file the same, with all exhibits thereto and any other documents required in connection therewith with the Securities and Exchange Commission, granting unto said attorneys-in-fact and agents and their substitutes, and each of them, full power and authority to do and perform each and every act and thing requisite and necessary to be done in connection therewith, as fully as he might or could do in person, herby ratifying and confirming all that said attorneys-in-fact and agents, or any of them, or their or his substitutes may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.
 
In accordance with the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this Registration Statement was signed by the following persons in the capacities indicated on March 28, 2012.
 

Signature
 
Title(s)
/s/ Jay S. Sidhu
 
Chairman, Chief Executive Officer and Director
Jay S. Sidhu
 
(principal executive officer)
     
/s/ Thomas Brugger
 
Executive Vice President and Chief Financial Officer
Thomas Brugger
 
(principal financial officer and principal accounting officer)
     
/s/ Daniel K. Rothermel
 
Director
 
Daniel K. Rothermel
 
 
 
       
/s/ John R. Miller
 
Director
 
John R. Miller
 
 
 
       
/s/ T. Lawrence Way
 
Director
 
T. Lawrence Way
 
 
 
       
/s/ Steven J. Zuckerman
 
Director
 
Steven J. Zuckerman
 
 
 
 
 
 
II-5

 
 
 
INDEX TO EXHIBITS
 
Exhibit No.
Description
1.1
Underwriting Agreement by and among Customers Bancorp, Keefe, Bruyette & Woods and Macquarie Capital (to be filed by amendment)
   
2.1
Plan of Merger and Reorganization, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 22, 2010
   
2.2
Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of August 23, 2010, by and among Customers Bank, Customers Bancorp, Berkshire Bank and Berkshire Bancorp, Inc., incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.2 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1/A filed with the SEC on January 13, 2011
   
2.3
Purchase and Assumption Agreement, dated as of July 9, 2010, by and among Customers Bank, the FDIC as Receiver of USA Bank, and the FDIC acting in its corporate capacity, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.3 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1/A filed with the SEC on January 13, 2011
   
2.4
Purchase and Assumption Agreement, dated as of September 17, 2010, by and among Customers Bank, the FDIC as Receiver of ISN Bank, and the FDIC acting in its corporate capacity, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.4 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1/A filed with the SEC on January 13, 2011
   
2.5
Amendment to Agreement and Plan of Merger, dated as of April 27, 2011, by and among Berkshire Bancorp, Inc., Berkshire Bank, Customers Bancorp and Customers Bank, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.5 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1/A filed with the SEC on June 13, 2011
   
3.1
   
3.2
Bylaws of Customers Bancorp, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.2 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 22, 2010
   
3.3
Certificate of Designations relating to Customers Bancorp’s Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to Customers Bancorp’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on September 22, 2011
   
3.4
Certificate of Designations relating to Customers Bancorp’s Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series B, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to Customers Bancorp’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on September 22, 2011
   
4.1
Specimen stock certificate of Customers Bancorp common stock, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 22, 2010
   
4.2
Specimen stock certificate of Customers Bancorp Class B Non-Voting Common Stock, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 22, 2010
   
4.3
Indenture, dated as of June 29, 2004, by and between New Century Bank and Wilmington Trust Company, relating to Floating Rate Subordinated Debt Securities Due 2014, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 22, 2010
   
 
 
 
 
II-6

 
 
 
 
 
4.4
Form of Anti-Dilution Agreement entered into by Customers Bank with each of the lead investors in our March and February 2010 private offerings, and all investors in our 2009 private offering, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.4 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 22, 2010
   
4.5
Form of Modification to Anti-Dilution Agreement entered into by Customers Bank with each of the lead investors in our March and February 2010 private offerings, and all investors in our 2009 private offering, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.5 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 22, 2010
   
4.6
Stock Option Agreement, dated as of March 23, 2005, by and between New Century Bank and Univest Corporation of Pennsylvania, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.6 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 22, 2010
   
4.7
Stock Option Agreement, dated as of July 10, 1997, by and between New Century Bank and NexTier Bank, f/k/a Citizens Incorporated, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.7 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 22, 2010
   
4.8
Form of Warrant issued to investors in New Century Bank’s March and February 2010 private offerings, 2009 private offering, and in partial exchange for New Century Bank’s shares of 10% Series A Non-Cumulative Perpetual Convertible Preferred Stock in June 2009, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.8 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 22, 2010
   
4.9
Warrants issued to Jay S. Sidhu, June 30, 2009, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.9 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 22, 2010
   
4.10
Form of Share Certificate relating to Customers Bancorp’s Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series B, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.3 to Customers Bancorp’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on September 22, 2011
   
4.11
Form of Share Certificate relating to Customers Bancorp’s Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series A, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.4 to Customers Bancorp’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on September 22, 2011
   
5.1
Opinion of Stradley Ronon Stevens & Young, LLP (to be filed by amendment)
   
10.1
New Century Bank Management Stock Purchase Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 22, 2010
   
10.2
Customers Bancorp 2010 Stock Option Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form 10-K filed with the SEC on March 21, 2012
   
10.3
   
10.4
   
10.5
   
10.6
Agreement, dated as of May 19, 2009, by and between New Century Bank and Jay Sidhu, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 22, 2010
 
 
 
 
 
II-7

 
 

 
10.7
Amended and Restated Customers Bancorp 2004 Incentive Equity and Deferred Compensation Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form 10-K filed with the SEC on March 21, 2012

10.8
Lease Agreement, dated January 5, 2007, by and between New Century Bank and Gateway Partnership LLC, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.10 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 22, 2010

10.9
Amendment to Lease, dated May 4, 2007, by and between New Century Bank and Gateway Partnership LLC, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.11 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 22, 2010

10.10
Letter Agreement dated as of December 28, 2011 by and among Customers Bancorp and Treasury, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Customers Bancorp’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on January 4, 2012

10.11 
Warrant issued to Jay S. Sidhu, June 30, 2009 (included in Exhibit 4.9)

10.12
Subscription Agreement, dated May 19, 2009, by and between New Century Bank and Jay S. Sidhu, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.13 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 22, 2010

10.13
Amendment to Subscription Agreement, dated June 29, 2009, by and between New Century Bank and Jay S. Sidhu, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.14 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 22, 2010

10.14
Amendment #2 to Subscription Agreement, dated as of June 30, 2009, by and between New Century Bank and Jay S. Sidhu, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.15 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1 filed with the SEC on April 22, 2010

10.15
Customers Bancorp Bonus Recognition and Retention Plan, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.15 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form 10-K filed with the SEC on March 21, 2012

10.16
Supplemental Executive Retirement Plan of Jay S. Sidhu, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.15 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form S-1/A filed with the SEC on April 18, 2011

10.17
Form of Restricted Stock Agreement, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.17 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form 10-K filed with the SEC on March 21, 2012

10.18
Form of Stock Option Agreement, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.18 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form 10-K filed with the SEC on March 21, 2012

10.19
TARP Letter Agreement, dated as of September 16, 2011, by and among Customers Bancorp, Berkshire Bancorp, Inc. and Treasury, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to Customers Bancorp’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on September 22, 2011

10.20
ARRA Letter Agreement, dated as of September 16, 2011, by and among Customers Bancorp and Treasury, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to Customer Bancorp’s Form 8-K filed with the SEC on September 22, 2011

21.1
List of Subsidiaries of Customers Bancorp, incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.18 to the Customers Bancorp’s Form 10-K filed with the SEC on March 21, 2012

23.1 
Consent of Stradley Ronon Stevens & Young, LLP (to be filed by amendment)

 
 
 
 
 
II-8

 
 

 
24.1
Powers of Attorney (contained on the signature page of the registration statement on Form S-1)

101
Interactive Data Files regarding (a) the Bancorp’s Balance Sheets as of December 31, 2011 and 2010, (b) Customers Bancorp’s Statements of Operations for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, (c) Customers Bancorp’s Statements of Cash Flows for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009, (d) Statements of Changes in Shareholders’ Equity for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 and (e) Notes to Financial Statements for the years ended December 31, 2011, 2010 and 2009 (to be filed by amendment)
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
II-9
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
 
Exhibit 3.1
 
ARTICLES OF INCORPORATION
OF
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC.

FIRST. The name of the Corporation is Customers Bancorp, Inc.
 
SECOND. The location and post office address of the Corporation’s registered office in this Commonwealth is 1015 Penn Avenue, Suite 103, Wyomissing, Pennsylvania 19610.
 
THIRD. The Corporation is being incorporated under the provisions of the Business Corporation Law of 1988, as amended (the “Pennsylvania Business Corporation Law”). The corporation is being organized on a stock share basis.  The purpose of the Corporation is and it shall have unlimited power to engage in and to do any lawful act concerning any or all lawful business for which corporations may be incorporated under such Law.
 
FOURTH. The term of the Corporation’s existence is perpetual.
 
FIFTH. A. Authorized Shares .  The aggregate number of shares of capital stock which the Corporation shall have authority to issue is 300,000,000 shares, divided into three classes consisting of:
 
(a)  
100,000,000 shares of common stock, par value $1.00 per share (“Common Stock”);
(b)  
100,000,000 shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock, par value $1.00 per share, with the rights, designations, preferences and limitations provided more fully in Sub-Article B of this Article below (“Class B Non-Voting Common Stock”); and
(c)  
100,000,000 shares of preferred stock, having such par value, or no par value, as the board of directors shall fix and determine as provided in Article SIXTH below or as may be permitted by applicable law (“Preferred Stock”).

B.   Statement of Designations Applicable to Class B Non-Voting Common Stock .

Section 1. General .  The Class B Non-Voting Common Stock shall have the rights, designations, preferences and limitations set forth in this Sub-Article.

Section 2. Ranking . In the event of the voluntary or involuntary liquidation, dissolution, distribution of assets or winding-up of the Corporation, holders of Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock shall be entitled to receive an equal amount per share of all the assets of the Corporation of whatever kind available for distribution to holders of Common Stock, after the rights of the holders of preferred stock have been satisfied.

Section 3. Definitions . As used herein with respect to the Class B Non-Voting Common Stock:

Articles of Incorporation ” shall mean these articles of incorporation of the Corporation, as they have been or may hereafter be amended from time to time.

Board of Directors ” means the board of directors of the Corporation or any committee thereof duly authorized to act on behalf of such board of directors.

Bylaws ” means the Bylaws of the Corporation, as they have been or may hereafter be amended from time to time.

Common Stock ” means the voting common stock, par value $1.00 per share, of the Corporation.

Depositary ” means DTC or its nominee or any successor depositary appointed by the Corporation.

DTC ” means The Depository Trust Company and its successors or assigns.

Securities Act ” means the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.
 
 
 
 
-1-

 
 

 
Holder ” means the Person in whose name the shares of the Class B Non-Voting Common Stock are registered, which may be treated by the Corporation, Transfer Agent, Registrar and paying agent as the absolute owner of the shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock for the purpose of making payment and for all other purposes.

Person ” means a legal person, including any individual, corporation, estate, partnership, joint venture, association, joint-stock company, limited liability company or trust.

Registrar ” shall mean the Transfer Agent acting in its capacity as registrar for the Class B Non-Voting Common Stock, and its successors and assigns or any other registrar duly appointed by the Corporation.

Transfer Agent ” means the Corporation, acting as Transfer Agent, Registrar and paying agent for the Class B Non-Voting Common Stock, and its successors and assigns, including any successor transfer agent appointed by the Corporation.  The Corporation may act as its own transfer agent.

Section 4. Dividends and Other Distributions .  The holders of the Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock shall be entitled to receive an equal amount of dividends per share if, as and when declared from time to time by the Board of Directors. In no event shall any stock dividends or stock splits or combinations of stock be declared or made on Common Stock or Class B Non-Voting Common Stock unless the shares of Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock at the time outstanding are treated equally and identically, provided that, in the event of a dividend of Common Stock, shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock shall only be entitled to receive shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock and shares of Common Stock shall only be entitled to receive shares of Common Stock.

Section 5. Voting Rights . Except as otherwise required by law, herein or as otherwise provided in any statement of designation for any series of preferred stock, the holders of Common Stock shall exclusively possess all voting power and each share of Common Stock shall be entitled to one vote, and the holders of the Class B Non-Voting Common Stock shall have no voting power, and shall not have the right to participate in any meeting of stockholders or to have notice thereof, except as required by applicable law and except that any action that would significantly and adversely affect the rights of the Class B Non-Voting Common Stock with respect to the modification of the terms of the securities or dissolution, shall require the approval of the Class B Non-Voting Common Stock voting separately as a class.

Section 6. Other Rights, Preferences and Privileges .  Except as expressly provided in this Article FIFTH(B), the rights, preferences and privileges of the Common Stock and Class B Non-Voting Common Stock shall be in all respects and for all purposes and in all circumstances absolutely and completely identical.

Section 7. Redemptions . The Class B Non-Voting Common Stock shall not be redeemable either at the Corporation’s option or at the option of Holders at any time. The Class B Non-Voting Common Stock shall not be subject to any sinking fund or other obligation to redeem, repurchase or retire the Class B Non-Voting Common Stock.

Section 8. Listing; Registration . In the event the Corporation lists the Common Stock on any national securities exchange or quotation system or registers the Common Stock under the Securities Act, it shall also list the shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock at the same time, to the extent such listing or registration is permitted by applicable laws, rules and regulations, and reasonably feasible.

Section 9. Transfer Agent, Registrar and Paying Agent . The duly appointed Transfer Agent, Registrar and paying agent for the Class B Non-Voting Common Stock shall initially be the Corporation. The Corporation may, in its sole discretion, remove itself or any appointed successor as Transfer Agent; provided that the Corporation shall appoint a successor transfer agent who shall accept such appointment prior to the effectiveness of such removal.
 
Section 10. Miscellaneous .

(i) The Corporation will pay any and all documentary stamp or similar issue or transfer taxes payable in respect of the conversion of shares of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock into shares of Common Stock; provided, however, that the Corporation shall not be required to pay any tax that may be payable in respect of any transfer involved in the issue or delivery of shares of Common Stock or other securities or property in a name other than that of the Holder of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock to be converted and no such issue or delivery shall be made unless and until the person requesting such issue or delivery has paid to the Corporation the amount of any such tax or established, to the reasonable satisfaction of the Corporation, that such tax has been paid.
 
 
 
 
-2-

 
 

 
(ii) Whenever possible, each provision hereof shall be interpreted in a manner as to be effective and valid under applicable law, but if any provision hereof is held to be prohibited by or invalid under applicable law, such provision shall be ineffective only to the extent of such prohibition or invalidity, without invalidating or otherwise adversely affecting the remaining provisions hereof. If a court of competent jurisdiction should determine that a provision hereof would be valid or enforceable if a period of time were extended or shortened or a particular percentage were increased or decreased, then such court may make such change as shall be necessary to render the provision in question effective and valid under applicable law.

(iii) The headings of the various subdivisions of this Article FIFTH are for convenience of reference only and shall not affect the interpretation of any of the provisions hereof.

(iv) If any of the voting powers, preferences and relative participating, optional and other special rights of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock and qualifications, limitations and restrictions thereof set forth herein is invalid, unlawful or incapable of being enforced by reason of any rule of law or public policy, all other voting powers, preferences and relative participating, optional and other special rights of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock and qualifications, limitations and restrictions thereof set forth herein that can be given effect without the invalid, unlawful or unenforceable voting powers, preferences and relative participating, optional and other special rights of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock and qualifications, limitations and restrictions thereof shall, nevertheless, remain in full force and effect, and no voting powers, preferences and relative participating, optional or other special rights of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock and qualifications, limitations and restrictions thereof herein set forth shall be deemed dependent upon any other such voting powers, preferences and relative participating, optional or other special rights of Class B Non-Voting Common Stock and qualifications limitations and restrictions thereof unless so expressed herein.

SIXTH. There is hereby expressly granted to and vested in the board of directors of the Corporation authority to, pursuant to and in accordance with the Section 1522(b) of the Business Corporation Law and any amendment to or restatement of such section, divide the authorized and unissued shares of the Corporation into classes or series, or both, and to fix and determine (except as fixed and determined herein), by resolution, the par value, voting powers, full or limited, or no voting powers, and such designations, preferences and relative, participating, optional or other special rights, if any, and the qualifications, limitations or restrictions thereof, if any, including specifically, but not limited to, the dividend rights, conversion rights, redemption rights and liquidation preferences, if any, of any wholly unissued series of Common Stock, Class B Non-Voting Common Stock or Preferred Stock (or any entire class if none of the shares in such class have been issued), the number of shares constituting any such series or class, and the terms and conditions of the issue thereof.

SEVENTH. Each holder of record of Common Stock, to the extent such Common Stock has voting rights, shall have the right to one vote for each share of Common Stock standing in such holder’s name on the books of the Corporation. No shareholder shall be entitled to cumulate any votes for the election of directors.

EIGHTH. The management, control and government of the Corporation shall be vested in a board of directors consisting of not less than six (6) nor more than twenty-five (25) members in number, as fixed by the board of directors of the Corporation from time to time. The directors of the Corporation shall be divided into three classes: Class I, Class II and Class III. Each Class shall be as nearly equal in number as possible; subject to the foregoing, the number of Class I, Class II or Class III directors may be changed from time to time by a majority vote of the board of directors. The term of office of each Class shall be three (3) years, so that the term of office of one class of directors shall expire each year when their respective successors have been duly elected by the shareholders and qualified. At each annual election by the shareholders of the Corporation, the directors chosen to succeed those whose terms then expire shall be identified as being of the same class as the directors they succeed. If, for any reason, a vacancy occurs on the board of directors of the Corporation, a majority of the remaining directors shall have the exclusive power to fill the vacancy by electing a director to hold office for the unexpired term in respect of which the vacancy occurred. No director of the Corporation shall be removed from office by the vote of shareholders, unless the votes of shareholders cast in favor of the resolution for the removal of such director constitute at least a majority of the votes which all shareholders would be entitled to cast at an annual election of directors.
 
 
 
 
-3-

 
 

 
NINTH. Any or all classes of shares of the Corporation, or any part thereof, may be represented by uncertificated shares to the extent determined by the Board of Directors, except that shares represented by a certificate that is issued and outstanding shall be represented thereby until the certificate is surrendered to the Corporation.

TENTH. No holder of any class of capital stock of the Corporation shall have preemptive rights, and the Corporation shall have the right to issue and to sell to any person or persons any shares of its capital stock or any option, warrant or right to acquire capital stock, or any securities having conversion or option rights without first offering such shares, rights or securities to any holder of any class of capital stock of the Corporation.

ELEVENTH . Except as set forth below, the affirmative vote of shareholders entitled to cast at least 80 percent (80%) of the votes which all shareholders of the Corporation are entitled to cast, and if any class of shares is entitled to vote as a separate class, the affirmative vote of shareholders entitled to cast at least a majority of the votes entitled to be cast by the outstanding shares of such class (or such greater amount as required by the provisions of these Articles of Incorporation establishing such class) shall be required to approve any of the following ---

(a) any merger or consolidation of the Corporation with or into any other organization;

(b) any share exchange in which an organization, person or entity acquires the issued or outstanding shares of capital stock of the Corporation pursuant to a vote of shareholders;

(c) any sale, lease, exchange or other transfer of all, or substantially all, of the assets of the Corporation to any other organization, person or entity; or

(d) any transaction similar to, or having similar effect as, any of the foregoing transactions;

--- if, in any of the foregoing cases, as of the record date for the determination of shareholders entitled to notice thereof and to vote thereon, such other organization, person or entity is the beneficial owner, directly or indirectly, of shares of capital stock of the Corporation issued, outstanding and entitled to cast five percent (5%) or more of the votes which all shareholders of the Corporation are then entitled to cast.

If any of the transactions identified above in this Article ELEVENTH is with an organization, person or entity that is not the beneficial owner, directly or indirectly, of shares of capital stock of the Corporation issued, outstanding and entitled to cast five percent (5%) or more of the votes which all shareholders of the Corporation are then entitled to cast, then the affirmative vote of shareholders entitled to cast at least a majority of the votes which all shareholders are entitled to cast shall be required to approve any such transaction. An affirmative vote as provided in the foregoing provisions shall, to the extent permitted by law, be in lieu of the vote of the shareholders otherwise required by law.

The board of directors of the Corporation shall have the power and duty to determine, for purposes of this Article ELEVENTH, on the basis of information known to the board, if and when such other corporation, person or entity is the beneficial owner, directly or indirectly, of shares of capital stock of the Corporation issued, outstanding and entitled to cast five percent (5%) or more of the votes which all shareholders of the Corporation are then entitled to cast, and/or if any transaction is similar to, or has an effect similar to, any of the transactions identified above in this Article ELEVENTH. Any such determination shall be conclusive and binding for all purposes of this Article ELEVENTH. The Corporation may voluntarily completely liquidate and/or dissolve only in accordance with all applicable laws and only if the proposed liquidation and/or dissolution is approved by the affirmative vote of shareholders entitled to cast at least 80 percent (80%) of the votes which all shareholders are entitled to cast.   The provisions of this Article ELEVENTH shall not apply to any transaction which is approved in advance by 66-2/3 percent (66-2/3%) of the members of the board of directors of the Corporation, at a meeting duly called and held.
 
 
 
 
-4-

 
 

 
Notwithstanding any provision of this Article or any other provision of these Articles of Incorporation or the Corporation’s bylaws, a plan of merger or consolidation may be approved and adopted without the approval of the Corporation’s shareholders in those circumstances where the applicable law, rules and regulations permit the plan to be approved by the board of directors without the approval of the shareholders.

TWELFTH. No action required to be taken or which may be taken at any annual or special meeting of shareholders of the Corporation may be taken without a meeting, and the power of the shareholders of the Corporation to consent in writing to action without a meeting is specifically denied. The presence, in person or by proxy, of shareholders entitled to cast at least a majority of the votes which all shareholders are entitled to cast shall constitute a quorum of shareholders at any annual or special meeting of shareholders of the Corporation.

THIRTEENTH. The authority to make, amend, alter, change or repeal the Corporation’s bylaws is hereby expressly and solely granted to and vested in the board of directors of the Corporation, subject always to the power of the shareholders to change such action by the affirmative vote of shareholders of the Corporation entitled to cast at least 66-2/3 percent (66-2/3%) of the votes which all shareholders are entitled to cast, except that Article Eight of the Corporation’s bylaws relating to limitations on directors’ liabilities and indemnification of directors, officers and others may not be amended to increase the exposure to liability for directors or to decrease the indemnification of directors, officers and others except by the affirmative vote of 66-2/3 percent (66-2/3%) of the entire board of directors or by the affirmative vote of shareholders of the Corporation entitled to cast at least 80 percent (80%) of the votes which all shareholders are entitled to cast.

FOURTEENTH. The board of directors of the Corporation, when evaluating any offer of another party to (a) make a tender or exchange offer for any equity security of the Corporation, (b) merge or consolidate the Corporation with another corporation, (c) purchase or otherwise acquire all or substantially all of the properties and assets of the Corporation, or (d) engage in any transaction similar to, or having similar effects as, any of the foregoing transactions, shall, in connection with the exercise of its judgment in determining what is in the best interests of the Corporation and its shareholders, give due consideration to all relevant factors, including without limitation the social and economic effects of the proposed transaction on the depositors, employees, suppliers, customers and other constituents of the Corporation and its subsidiaries and on the communities in which the Corporation and its subsidiaries operate or are located, the business reputation of the other party, and the board of directors’ evaluation of the then value of the Corporation in a freely negotiated sale and of the future prospects of the Corporation as an independent entity.

FIFTEENTH. If any corporation, person, entity, or group becomes the beneficial owner, directly or indirectly, of shares of capital stock of the Corporation having the right to cast in the aggregate 25 percent (25%) or more of all votes entitled to be cast by all issued and outstanding shares of capital stock of the Corporation entitled to vote, such corporation, person, entity or group shall within thirty (30) days thereafter offer to purchase all shares of capital stock of the Corporation issued, outstanding and entitled to vote. Such offer to purchase shall be at a price per share equal to the highest price paid for shares of the respective class or series of capital stock of the Corporation purchased by such corporation, person, entity or group within the preceding twelve months. If such corporation, person, entity or group did not purchase any shares of a particular class or series of capital stock of the Corporation within the preceding twelve months, such offer to purchase shall be at a price per share equal to the fair market value of such class or series of capital stock on the date on which such corporation, person, entity or group becomes the beneficial owner, directly or indirectly, of shares of capital stock of the Corporation having the right to cast in the aggregate 25 percent (25%) or more of all votes entitled to be cast by all issued and outstanding capital stock of the Corporation. Such offer shall provide that the purchase price for such shares shall be payable in cash. The provisions of this Article FIFTEENTH shall not apply if 80 percent (80%) or more of the members of the board of directors of the Corporation approve in advance the acquisition of beneficial ownership by such corporation, person, entity or group, of shares of capital stock of the Corporation having the right to cast in the aggregate 25 percent (25%) or more of all votes entitled to be cast by all issued and outstanding shares of capital stock of the Corporation.

SIXTEENTH. The Corporation’s board of directors may amend, alter, change or repeal any provision contained in its Articles of Incorporation in the manner now or hereafter prescribed by statute and all rights conferred upon shareholders and directors herein are hereby granted subject to this reservation; provided, however, that the provisions set forth in Articles SEVENTH, EIGHTH, ELEVENTH and TWELFTH through FOURTEENTH, inclusive, of these Articles of Incorporation may not be repealed, altered or amended, in any respect whatsoever, unless such repeal, alteration or amendment is approved by either (a) the affirmative vote of shareholders of the Corporation entitled to cast at least 80 percent (80%) of the votes which all shareholders of the Corporation are then entitled to cast or (b) the affirmative vote of 80 percent (80%) of the members of the board of directors of the Corporation and the affirmative vote of shareholders of the Corporation entitled to cast at least a majority of the votes which all shareholders of the Corporation are then entitled to cast.

 
 
 
-5-

 
 
 
SEVENTEENTH. The Control Transactions provisions of Section 2541 of the Business Corporation Law and any amendment to or restatement of such section, shall not be applicable to the Corporation. The Disgorgement By Certain Controlling Shareholders Following Attempt to Acquire Control provisions of Section 2571 of the Business Corporation Law and any amendment to or restatement of such section, shall not be applicable to the Corporation.

NINETEENTH.  The name and address, including number and street, if any, of each incorporator is as follows:

Name
 
Address
Jay S. Sidhu
5 Chardonnay Circle, Mohnton, PA 19540
Richard A. Ehst
1309 East Wyomissing Boulevard, Reading, PA 19611
Thomas Brugger
1142 Lehigh Avenue, Wyomissing, PA 19610

IN TESTIMONY WHEREOF, the Incorporators have signed these Articles of Incorporation this 6th day of April, 2010.


     
Jay S. Sidhu, Incorporator
 
Richard A. Ehst, Incorporator
     
     
     
Thomas Brugger, Incorporator
   

 
 
 
 

 
-6-

 
 
Exhibit 10.3
 
AMENDED AND RESTATED
EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT
 
 
THIS AGREEMENT, made as of this 26th day of March, 2012, is by and between CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. (“Company") and JAY S. SIDHU (“Executive").
 
 
Background
 
A.           Customers Bank, formerly known as New Century Bank (“Bank”) and Executive are parties to an Employment Agreement dated as of June 17, 2009 (“Effective Date”).

B.           Pursuant to the Plan of Merger and Reorganization approved by the shareholders of the Bank, which became effective as of September 17, 2011, the Company assumed the Bank’s obligations under said Employment Agreement.

C.           Company wishes to retain and secure the services of Executive as the Company's Chief Executive Officer and the Bank’s Chief Executive Officer on the terms and conditions set forth herein.
 
D.           Subject to the terms and conditions hereinafter, Executive is willing to enter into this Amended and Restated Employment Agreement (this "Agreement") upon the terms and conditions set forth.
 
E.           The Company's Board of Directors has approved this Agreement.
 
NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual promises and agreements set forth herein, the parties agree as follows:
 
1.           Employment. Subject to the terms and conditions of the Agreement between the Bank and Executive dated May 19, 2009 ("Definitive Agreement"), Company agrees to employ Executive as its Chief Executive Officer and the Chief Executive Officer during the remainder of the "Term" defined in Section 2 of this Agreement. Executive shall report to and be subject solely to direction of the Boards of Directors of the Company and the Bank.  Executive shall have the powers and authority ordinarily given to the respective positions described above as provided under the respective Bylaws of the Company and the Bank. Executive will have such duties as normally apply to such positions. Hereinafter, the term “Company” as used herein shall mean the Company, or the Bank, or both, as the context requires.  Executive shall devote a substantial portion of his working time, abilities and attention to the business of the Company, and will fulfill all of the duties required of him as Chief Executive Officer. The Company acknowledges that Executive may serve as the chief executive officer of one, non-competing financial institution. The Board of Directors will consult with Executive from time to time to develop a plan with respect to the time and structure of his activities on behalf of Company in light of his other business activities. The services of Executive shall be rendered principally in Wyomissing, PA, but Executive shall undertake such traveling on behalf of Company as may be reasonably required.
 
 
 
 
 

 
 

2.           Term of Employment. Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, the initial term of employment hereunder shall be for the three (3)-year period commencing on the Effective Date and ending on the day preceding the three (3)-year anniversary of the Effective Date. As of each one (1)-year anniversary of the Effective Date, the term of employment hereunder shall be extended for another one (1) year, automatically, unless either party delivers notice to the contrary to the other party at least sixty (60) days prior to such one (1)-year anniversary, in which case the term of employment hereunder shall expire as of the date to which it was last extended pursuant to this sentence. Such notice shall be delivered in a manner consistent with the requirements of Section 13. References in this Agreement to the "Term" shall refer both to such initial term and any successive terms.
 
3.           Compensation. In consideration of the services to be rendered by Executive, Company shall pay to Executive during the initial Term:
 
(a)           A base salary of not less than Two Hundred and Twenty Five Thousand dollars ($225,000) per annum for each year of the Term, payable in equal installments over such payroll cycles as the Company pays its executive officers generally, with any salary for initial or final partial months or other payroll periods being prorated based on the number of calendar days in question. It is understood that the Board of Directors of the Company shall review Executive's performance and make a determination regarding increases in his salary at least once in every calendar year during the Term.
 
(b)           Incentive Compensation in such amount, form, and at such time as is provided in such executive incentive plan for Executive as shall be approved by the Board of Directors of the Company and in effect from time to time. Such incentive compensation may take the form of cash payments ("Cash Bonus"), transfers of stock or stock options (collectively, "Equity Awards"). Equity Awards shall be subject to such restrictions, vesting and other conditions and limitations as set forth in the executive incentive plan developed for Executive.
 
(c)           In addition to any Equity Awards which may be granted to Executive pursuant to Section 3(b) above, Executive and the Company agree that in connection with one or more successful acquisitions by the Company of other financial institutions after December 31, 2008, or the issuance of shares of common stock of the Company to raise capital after December 31, 2008, the Company shall issue to Executive options or warrants to acquire various percentages of the shares issued in connection with any such acquisition or capital-raising transaction, as set forth below, with appropriate consideration given to the then authorized capital levels as approved by the shareholders of the Company.
 
 
 
 
2

 
 

 
(i)           In connection with acquisitions by the Company or capital-raising transactions in an aggregate value not exceeding four hundred million dollars ($400,000,000), such options or warrants shall be issued with respect to ten percent (10%) of the shares issued in connection with such acquisitions or capital-raising transactions.  The vesting requirements for such options or warrants shall be (A) a five-year employment requirement from the date of the applicable acquisition or capital-raising transaction (with a waiver of such requirement in the event of a change in control of the Company, or Executive’s death or termination of employment without Cause), and (B) a fifty percent (50%) increase in the value of the Company from the date of grant of such options or warrants through the expiration of their term.

(ii)           In connection with further acquisitions by the Company or capital-raising transactions, beyond those described in clause (i) above, in an aggregate value not exceeding three hundred and fifty million dollars ($350,000,000), such options or warrants shall be issued with respect to six and seven-tenths percent (6.7%) of the shares issued in connection with such acquisitions or capital-raising transactions.  The vesting requirements for such options or warrants shall be a five-year employment requirement from the date of the applicable acquisition or capital-raising transaction (with a waiver of such requirement in the event of a change in control of the Company, or Executive’s death or termination of employment without Cause).

(iii)           In connection with further acquisitions by the Company or capital-raising transactions, beyond those described in clauses (i) and (ii) above, such options or warrants shall be issued with respect to three and four-tenths percent (3.4%) of the shares issued in connection with such acquisitions or capital-raising transactions.  The vesting requirements for such options or warrants shall be a five-year employment requirement from the date of the applicable acquisition or capital-raising transaction (with a waiver of such requirement in the event of a change in control of the Company, or Executive’s death or termination of employment without Cause).
 
4.           Reimbursement of Expenses; Retirement Plan.
 
4.1           Reimbursement of Expenses. During the Term, Company shall reimburse Executive for reasonable expenses incurred by him in the performance of his duties, as well as those incurred in furtherance of or in connection with the business of Company, including but not limited to traveling, entertainment, dining and other expenses. In lieu of reimbursement of Executive of his costs of using his personal automobile for business purposes pursuant to the immediately preceding sentence, Company shall provide a car allowance to Executive of up to one thousand dollars ($1,000) per month.
 
4.2           Retirement Plan. The Board of Directors shall develop and implement a nonqualified retirement income plan for Executive which shall be designed to provide him with an annual pension commencing upon his retirement from the Company at or after age sixty-five (65), subject to the Executive's ability to qualify for a variable life insurance policy, which the Company will own to informally fund such obligation. The goal of the plan shall be to provide an annual pension of two hundred thousand dollars ($200,000) for fifteen (15) years, but the annual amount will be less or more than the target depending upon the performance of the investments inside the informal funding vehicle. The Board of Directors will review the plan on or about the fourth anniversary of the Effective Date and determine whether it is appropriate to increase the target amount and the informal funding thereof in light of Executive's compensation at that time.  Executive shall become vested in this pension after completing seven (7) years of continuous service with the Company, or upon his termination of employment under circumstances that would result in the Company's obligation to pay Severance Compensation under Section 5.5 below (and as defined therein).
 
 
 
3

 
 
 
 

5.           Termination of Employment.
 
5.1           Termination by Company; "Cause." Company shall have the right to terminate Executive's employment hereunder at any time, with or without "Cause" (as defined below). In the event of any termination by Company, Company shall give Executive forty-five (45) days prior notice of any termination without Cause, but shall not be obligated to give Executive prior notice of a termination with Cause. Company shall nevertheless be obligated to pay Executive such compensation and severance, if any, as may be provided for in this Agreement under the applicable circumstances. Company will give Executive notice of termination of his employment pursuant to a "Notice of Termination" (as defined below).
 
5.2           No Right to Compensation or Benefits Except as Stated. If the Company terminates Executive's employment for Cause, Executive shall have no right to severance compensation of any kind, or any right to salary or other benefits for any period after such date of termination. If Executive is terminated by Company other than for Cause, Executive's rights to compensation and benefits under this Agreement shall be as set forth in Section 5.5.
 
5.3           Termination by Executive. Executive shall have the right to terminate his employment, whether or not for "Good Reason" (as hereinafter defined), but, in all events, Executive shall give Company notice pursuant to a written "Notice of Termination" (as defined below). If the termination by Executive is other than for Good Reason: (i) Executive must give Company a Notice of Termination not less than forty five (45) days prior to the date his termination of employment will be effective, and (ii) Executive shall have no right to severance compensation of any kind, or any right to salary or other benefits for any period after such date of termination. If termination is by Executive for Good Reason, Executive's rights to compensation and benefits under this Agreement shall be as set forth in Section 5.5.
 
 
 
 
4

 
 
 
 
5.4           Certain Definitions.
 
(a)           In connection with a termination of Executive's employment by the Company, "Cause" shall mean any one or more of the following reasons: (1) the willful material failure by the Executive to perform the duties required of him hereunder (other than any such failure resulting from incapacity due to physical or mental illness of the Executive or material changes in the direction and policies of the Board of Directors of Company), if such failure continues for fifteen (15) days afer a written demand for substantial performance is delivered to the Executive by the Company which specifically identifies the manner in which it is believed that the Executive has failed to attempt to perform his duties hereunder; (2) the willful engaging by the Executive in willful misconduct materially injurious to the Company; (3) receipt by the Company of a notice (which shall not have been appealed by Executive or shall have become final and non-appealable) of any governmental body or entity having jurisdiction over the Company requiring termination or removal of the Executive from his then present position, or receipt of a written directive or order of any governmental body or entity having jurisdiction over the Company (which shall not have been appealed by Executive or shall have become final and non-appealable) requiring termination or removal of the Executive from his then present position; (4) personal dishonesty, incompetence, willful misconduct, willful breach of fiduciary duty involving personal profit or conviction of a felony; or (5) material breach of any provision set forth in Paragraphs 7, 8, or 10, to the extent applicable. For purposes of this paragraph, no act, or failure to act, on the Executive's part shall be considered "willful" unless done or omitted to be done by Executive in bad faith and without reasonable belief that his action or omission was in the best interest of Company. Any act or omission to act by the Executive in reliance upon a written opinion of counsel to Company shall not be deemed to be willful.
 
(b)           Good Reason. For purposes of this Agreement, "Good Reason" shall mean (1) a material breach by Company of the provisions of this Agreement, which failure has not been cured within 30 days after a written notice of such noncompliance has been given by Executive to Company; (2) any purported termination of Executive's employment which is not effected in compliance with the requirements of this Agreement; (3) any reduction in title or a material adverse change in Executive's responsibilities or authority which are inconsistent with, or the assignment to Executive of duties inconsistent with, Executive's status as Chief Executive Officer of Company; or (4) any reduction in Executive's annual base salary as in effect on the date hereof or as the same may be increased from time to time.
 
(c)           Notice of Termination. Any termination of Executive's employment by Company or by Executive shall be communicated by written Notice of Termination to the other party hereto. For purposes of this Agreement, a "Notice of Termination" shall mean a dated notice which shall (1) indicate the specific termination provision in this Agreement relied upon; (2) set forth in reasonable detail the facts and circumstances claimed to provide a basis for termination of Executive's employment under the provision so indicated; and (3) be given in a manner consistent with the requirements of Section 13.
 
 
 
 
5

 
 
 
 
5.5           Compensation Upon Certain Types of Termination. If Executive shall terminate his employment for Good Reason during the Term, or if Executive's Employment is terminated by the Company other than for Cause during the Term, or if Executive's Employment is terminated for any reason other than Cause upon expiration of the Term, then in lieu of any salary or damages payments to Executive for periods subsequent to the date of termination, Company shall pay as "Severance Compensation" to Executive, in lieu of all other damages, compensation and benefits other than any benefits the right to which shall have previously vested, an amount (the "Severance Compensation") equal to the following, depending upon whether a "Change in Control" (as defined below) shall have occurred at the time of termination of employment:
 
(a)           If a Change in Control shall not have occurred within twelve (12) months prior to the date of termination of Executive's employment with the Company, the Company shall pay Executive the following Severance Compensation, payable at the respective times and on the respective conditions set forth in this subsection for each type of Severance Compensation:
 
(i)           Cash Severance Compensation. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary elsewhere in this Agreement, Executive shall be entitled to receive a dollar amount equal to the sum of Executive's then current base salary plus the average of the annual Cash Bonuses paid to him with respect to the three (3) fiscal years of the Company immediately preceding the fiscal year of termination, for the greater of one (1) year or the period of time remaining in the Term. This element of Severance Compensation shall be payable in equal installments on the normal pay dates following Executive's separation from service with the Company within the meaning of Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code"), and the Treasury Regulations promulgated thereunder (such Section and regulations are sometimes referred to in this Agreement as "Section 409A"). If, as of the date of the Executive's separation from service, stock of the Company or a holding company or other parent entity with respect to the Company is publicly traded on an established securities market or otherwise, and if necessary to comply with Section 409A, payments otherwise due during the six (6)-month period following his separation from service shall be suspended and paid in a lump sum upon completion of such six (6)-month period, at which time the balance of the payments shall commence in installments as described in the preceding sentence. Payments shall be subject to deduction for such tax withholdings as Company may be obligated to make;
 
(ii)           Equity Awards. All Equity Awards shall be vested in full;
 
(iii)           Cash Bonus. Executive shall be entitled to a fraction of any Cash Bonus for the fiscal year of the Company within which Executive's termination of employment occurs which, based upon the criteria established for such Cash Bonus, would have been payable to Executive had he remained employed through the date of payment, the numerator of which is the number of days of such fiscal year prior to his termination of employment and the denominator of which is three hundred and sixty-five (365); and
 
 
 
 
6

 
 
 
 
 
(iv)           Company shall continue to provide health insurance (including dental if applicable) and any life or disability insurance benefits for the shorter of (i) the length of the severance measurement period set forth in Section 5.5(a)(i) above, or (ii) the maximum period the Company is then permitted to extend each individual benefit under the applicable plan or policy or applicable law.
 
(b)           If a Change in Control shall have occurred within twelve (12) months prior to the date of termination of Executive's employment with the Company, the Company shall pay Executive Severance Compensation equal to three hundred percent (300%) of the sum of Executive's then current base salary plus the average of the annual Cash Bonuses paid to him with respect to the three (3) fiscal years of the Company immediately preceding the fiscal year of termination. The Severance Compensation shall be payable in a single lump sum within thirty (30) days following Executive's separation from service within the meaning of Section 409A. If, as of the date of the Executive's separation from service, stock of the Company or a holding company or other parent entity with respect to the Company is publicly traded on an established securities market or otherwise, and if necessary to comply with Section 409A, payment of the lump sum shall be suspended and paid within the thirty (30)-day period following the close of the six (6) month period following his separation from service. Payments shall be subject to deduction for such tax withholdings as Company may be obligated to make. In addition to the aforesaid Executive Severance Compensation, additional Executive Severance Compensation shall be provided as set forth below.

(i)           Equity Awards. All Equity Awards shall be vested in full,
 
(ii)           Cash Bonus. Executive shall be entitled to a fraction of any Cash Bonus for the fiscal year of the Company within which Executive's termination of employment occurs which, based upon the criteria established for such Cash Bonus, would have been payable to Executive had he remained employed through the date of payment, the numerator of which is the number of days of such fiscal year prior to his termination of employment and the denominator of which is three hundred and sixty-five (365);
 
(iii)           Company shall continue to provide health insurance (including dental if applicable) and any life or disability insurance benefits for the shorter of (i) the length of the severance measurement period set forth in above in this Section 5.5(b), or (ii) the maximum period the Company is then permitted to extend each individual benefit under the applicable plan or policy or applicable law; and
 
(iv)           If, as a result of payments provided for under or pursuant to this Agreement together with all other payments in the nature of compensation provided to or for the benefit of Executive under any other agreement in connection with a Change in Control, Executive becomes subject to taxes of any state, local or federal taxing authority that would not have been imposed on such payments but for the occurrence of a Change in Control, including any excise tax under Section 4999 of the Code and any successor or comparable provision, then, in addition to any other benefits provided under or pursuant to this Agreement or otherwise, Company (including any successor to Company) shall pay to Executive at the time any such payments are made under or pursuant to this or the other agreements, an amount equal to the amount of any such taxes imposed or to be imposed on Executive (the amount of any such payment, the "Parachute Tax Reimbursement"). In addition, Company (including any successor to Company) shall "gross up" such Parachute Tax Reimbursement by paying to Executive at the same time an additional amount equal to the aggregate amount of any additional taxes (whether income taxes, excise taxes, special taxes, employment taxes or otherwise) that are or will be payable by Executive as a result of the Parachute Tax Reimbursement being paid or payable to Executive and/or as a result of the additional amounts paid or payable to Executive pursuant to this sentence, such that after payment of such additional taxes Executive shall have been paid on a net after-tax basis an amount equal to the Parachute Tax Reimbursement. The amount of any Parachute Tax Reimbursement and of any such gross-up amounts shall be determined by Company's independent auditing firm, whose determination, absent manifest error, shall be treated as conclusive and binding absent a binding determination by a governmental taxing authority that a greater amount of taxes is payable by Executive.
 
 
 
 
7

 
 
 
 

(c)           For purposes of this Agreement, "Change in Control" means the occurrence of any one or more of the following events:
 
(i)           There occurs a merger, consolidation or other business combination or reorganization to which the Company is a party, whether or not approved in advance by the Board of Directors of the Company, in which (A) the members of the Board of Directors of the Company immediately preceding the consummation of such transaction do not constitute a majority of the members of the Board of Directors of the resulting corporation and of any parent corporation thereof immediately after the consummation of such transaction, and (B) the shareholders of the Company immediately before such transaction do not hold more than fifty percent (50%) of the voting power of securities of the resulting corporation;
 
(ii)           There occurs a sale, exchange, transfer, or other disposition of substantially all of the assets of the Company to another entity, whether or not approved in advance by the Board of Directors of the Company (for purpose of this Agreement, a sale of more than one-half of the branches of the Company would constitute a Change in Control, but for purposes of this paragraph, no branches or assets will be deemed to have been sold if they are leased back contemporaneously with or promptly after their sale);
 
(iii)           A plan of liquidation or dissolution is adopted for the Company; or
 
 
 
8

 
 
 
 
 
(iv)           Any "person" or any group of "persons" (as such term is defined in Sections 13(d) and 14(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the "Exchange Act"), as if such provisions were applicable to the Company, other than the holders of shares of the Company's common stock in existence on the date of the Opening for Business, is or shall become the "beneficial owner" (as defined in Rule 13d-3 under the Exchange Act), as if such rule were applicable to the Company, directly or indirectly, of securities of the Company representing 50% or more of the combined voting power of the Company's then outstanding securities.
 
(d)           In the event that the Executive's employment is terminated during the Term as a result of his death or disability, he (or his estate, as the case may be) shall not be entitled to any payments or other benefits pursuant to this Section 5.5 or otherwise.
 
5.6           Mitigation by Executive. Executive shall not be required to mitigate the amount of any payment provided for in Section 5.5 by seeking other employment or otherwise.
 
6.           Effect of TARP Participation.
 
6.1           Basic Agreement re Effect of TARP Participation. It is anticipated by Executive and Company that Company may elect to participate in the Troubled Assets Relief Program ("TARP") established under the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008 ("EESA"), as amended by the American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009 ("ARRA") and any subsequent legislation whether heretofore or hereafter enacted ("Subsequent Legislation") and as implemented by present and future regulations of applicable federal government agencies ("Implementing Regulations") (the requirements of EESA, ARRA, Subsequent Legislation and Implementing Regulations that may be applicable to the Company or Executive or the compensation or benefits provided to Executive under this Agreement or otherwise as a result of the Company's participation in TARP are sometimes referred to herein as the "TARP Provisions"). In that event, if the compensation and benefits to be provided to Executive pursuant to Sections 3, 4 and 5 of this Agreement, or any portion or element thereof, or any other compensation, benefits or perquisites hereafter agreed upon by the parties, must be reduced, delayed or otherwise modified in order for the Company to comply with any of the TARP Provisions, as interpreted and implemented by regulations of the U. S. Department of the Treasury and the terms of any contract between Company or Executive and said Department or any other agency of the federal government (""TARP Requirements"), this Agreement and all such other compensation, benefits and perquisites and agreements relating to any of the foregoing shall automatically be deemed amended to cause the Company to be in compliance at all times with the TARP Requirements. Executive and Company shall negotiate in good faith to document, by amendment or amendments to this Agreement or any other agreements, plans or benefits, the modifications so required, but the parties' failure to reach final agreement shall not negate the provisions of this Section.
 
 
 
 
9

 
 
 
 
6.2           Agreements Supporting TARP Waiver. In consideration for the benefits Executive will receive under this Agreement and potentially as a result of Company's participation in TARP, Executive hereby voluntarily waives any claim against the Company for any changes to Executive's compensation or benefits that are required for Company to comply with TARP Requirements. This waiver includes all claims Executive may have under the laws of the United States or any state related to the requirements imposed by any of the TARP Requirements, including without limitation a claim for any compensation or other payments Executive would otherwise receive, any challenge to the process by which any of the TARP Requirements were adopted and any tort or constitutional claim about the effect of any of the TARP Requirements on Executive's employment relationship with Company. Executive agrees to execute such waivers and other agreements as may be requires by the U.S. Treasury Department in connection with Company's participation in TARP.
 
7.           Non-Disclosure. The Executive covenants and agrees that Executive will not at any time, either during the Term or thereafter, use, disclose or make accessible to any other person, firm, partnership, corporation or any other entity any Confidential and Proprietary Information (as defined herein), other than to (a) Executive's attorney or spouse in confidence, (b) while employed by the Company, in the business and for the benefit of the Company, or (c) when required to do so by a court of competent jurisdiction, any government agency having supervisory authority over the business of the Executive or the Company or any administrative body or legislative body, including a committee thereof, with jurisdiction.
 
For purposes of this Agreement, "Confidential and Proprietary Information" shall mean non-public, confidential, and proprietary information provided to the Executive concerning, without limitation, the Company's financial condition and/or results of operations, statistical data, products, ideas and concepts, strategic business plans, lists of customers or customer information, information relating to marketing plans, management development reviews, including information regarding the capabilities and experience of the Company's employees, compensation, recruiting and training, and human resource policies and procedures, policy and procedure manuals, together with all materials and documents in any form or medium (including oral, written, tangible, intangible, or electronic) concerning any of the above, and other non-public, proprietary and confidential information of the Company; provided, however, that Confidential and Proprietary Information shall not include any information that is known generally to the public or within the industry other than as a result of unauthorized disclosure by the Executive. It is specifically understood and agreed by the Executive that any non-public information received by the Executive during Executive's employment by the Company is deemed Confidential and Proprietary Information for purposes of this Agreement. In the event the Executive's employment is terminated for any reason, the Executive shall immediately return to the Company upon request all Confidential and Proprietary Information in Executive's possession or control.
 
8.           Non-Solicitation. Executive agrees that during the Term and for a period of twelve (12) months thereafter, unless the Executive obtains the Company's prior written permission, which may be granted or denied at the Company's sole and absolute discretion, the Executive shall not:
 
 
 
10

 
 
 
 
 

(a)           solicit or divert to any competitor of the Company or, upon termination of the Executive's employment with the Company, accept any business from any individual or entity that is a customer or a prospective customer of the Company, to the extent that such prospective customer was identifiable as such prior to the date of the Executive's termination, except that this covenant of non-solicitation shall not apply with respect to anyone who, while having previously been a customer or prospect of the Company, is no longer a customer or prospect of the Company at the time of the solicitation; and/or
 
(b)           induce or encourage any officer and/or employee of the Company to leave the employ of the Company, hire any individual who was an employee of the Company as of the date of the termination of the Executive's, or induce or encourage any customer, vendor, participant, agent or other business relation of the Company to cease or reduce doing business with the Company or in any way interfere with the relationship between any such customer, vendor, participant, agent or other business relation and the Company.
 
9.           Noncompete Agreement. For a period of twelve (12) months after any resignation or termination of Executive's employment for any reason, Executive shall not, directly or indirectly, within 25 miles of any office of the Company, enter into or engage directly or indirectly in competition with the Company or any subsidiary or other company under common control with the Company, in any financial services business conducted by the Company or any such subsidiary at the time of such resignation or termination, either as an individual on his own or as a partner or joint venturer, or as a director, officer, shareholder, employee, agent, independent contractor, nor shall Executive assist any other person or entity in engaging directly or indirectly in such competition.
 
10.           Non-Disparagement. During the Term, after its expiration and following the termination of this Agreement by the Company or the Executive for any reason, each party agrees not to make any statements, in writing or otherwise, that disparage the reputation or character of the other party or, in the case of the Company, any subsidiaries or affiliates of the Company or any of their respective managers, directors, officers, stockholders, partners, members or employees, at any time for any reason whatsoever, except that nothing in this Section shall prohibit any party from giving truthful testimony in any litigation or administrative proceedings either between the Executive and the Company or in connection with which such party is subpoenaed and required by law to give testimony, including without limitation, any action by the Executive to enforce Executive's rights hereunder.
 
11.           Severance Compensation Conditional; Remedies for Breach of Sections 7, 8, 9 and 10; Independence of Covenants; Notice to Others; Savings Clause.
 
11.1           Severance Compensation Independent. Company's obligation to pay Severance Compensation is conditioned on Executive's compliance with Paragraphs 7, 8, 9 and 10 of this Agreement and Company shall not be obligated to pay such Severance Compensation in the event of any breach by Executive of such Paragraphs.
 
 
 
 
11

 
 
 

11.2           Remedies for Breach of Sections 7, 8, 9 and 10. Executive and Company agree that the covenants in Sections 7, 8. 9 and 10 are reasonable covenants under the circumstances. Executive agrees that any breach of the covenants set forth in Sections 7, 8, 9 and 10 of this Agreement will irreparably harm the Company. The Executive and the Company agree that in the event of any breach by the Executive of the provisions set forth in Section 7, 8, 9 and 10 of this Agreement, the Company shall be entitled to all rights and remedies available at law or in equity, including without limitation, the following cumulative and not alternative rights:
 
(a)           the right to obtain injunctive or other equitable relief to restrain any breach or threatened breach or otherwise to specifically enforce the provisions of this Agreement, it being agreed that monetary damages alone would be inadequate to compensate the Company, the amount of such damages will be difficult (if not impossible) to prove precisely, and would be an inadequate remedy for such breach;
 
(b)           the right to institute civil suit to recover damages suffered by the Company;
 
(c)           the right to recover actual reasonable attorneys' fees and other costs incurred by the Company in connection with pursuing remedies hereunder; and
 
(d)           the right to seek an equitable accounting of all earnings, profits and other benefits arising from any such violation.
 
11.3           Independence of Covenants. The existence of any claim or cause of action of the Executive against the Company, whether predicated on this Agreement or otherwise, shall not constitute a defense to the enforcement by the Company of the provisions of Sections 7, 8, 9 and 10.
 
11.4           Notice to Others. Executive agrees to notify any future prospective employers and future employers, and any future joint venturers, partners and contracting parties of Executive, whose activities may be deemed to compete with Company of the existence of each of the covenants contained in Sections 7, 8, 9 and 10 of this Agreement.
 
11.5           Savings Clause. In the event that any provision or provisions of any of the covenants in Section 7, 8, 9 and 10 would otherwise be determined by any court of competent jurisdiction to be unenforceable in whole or in part by reason of being for too great a period of time or covering too great a geographical area or too broad a product market, or for any other reason, each such covenant shall nevertheless remain in full force and effect and be construed so as to be enforceable as to that period of time and geographical area and product market, and on such other conditions, as may be determined to be reasonable by the court.
 
 
 
 
12

 
 
 
 
 
12.           Amendments. No amendments to this Agreement shall be binding unless in writing and signed by both parties.
 
13.           Notices. All notices under this Agreement shall be in writing and shall be deemed effective (i) when delivered in person or by facsimile, telecopier, telegraph or other electronic means capable of being embodied in written form, or (ii) forty-eight (48) hours after deposit thereof in the U.S. mails by certified or registered mail, return receipt requested, postage prepaid, addressed, in the case of Executive, to his last known address as carried on the personnel records of Company and, in the case of Company, to the corporate headquarters, attention of the Chairman of the Board of Directors (or if Executive is at that time the Chairman of the Board of Directors, then to the Secretary of the Company), or to such other address as the party to be notified may specify by notice to the other party.
 
14.           Entire Agreement. This Agreement is the entire agreement of the parties with respect to its subject matter and supersedes and replaces all other negotiations, discussions and prior or contemporaneous agreements between the parties, whether oral or written, with respect to the subject matter of Executive's employment with Company.
 
15.           Binding Effect and Benefits. The rights and obligations of Company and Executive under this Agreement shall inure to the benefit of and shall be binding upon the respective heirs, personal representatives, successors and assigns of Company and Executive.
 
16.           Construction. This Agreement shall be construed under the laws of the Commonwealth of Pennsylvania, as they may be preempted by federal laws and regulations. Section headings are for convenience only and shall not be considered a part of the terms and provisions of the Agreement.
 
17.           Governing Law; Jurisdiction; Venue. The validity, interpretation, construction, performance and enforcement of this Agreement shall be governed by the internal laws of the Commonwealth of Pennsylvania, without regard to its conflicts of law rules, and by federal law to the extent it pre-empts state law. For purposes of any action or proceeding, the Executive irrevocably submits to the exclusive jurisdiction of the courts of the Commonwealth Pennsylvania and the courts of the United States of America located in Pennsylvania for the purpose of any judicial proceeding arising out of or relating to this Agreement or otherwise. The Executive irrevocably agrees to service of process by certified mail, return receipt requested, to the Executive at the addressed listed in the records of the Company. The proper venue for all such disputes, actions or proceedings shall be Chester County. The parties agree that in any action or proceeds arising under this Agreement, attorneys' fees and costs shall be awarded to the prevailing party.
 
 
 
13

 
 
 
 

18.           Executive's Acknowledgment of Terms and Right to Separate Counsel. Executive acknowledges that he has read this Agreement fully and carefully, understands its terms and that it has been entered into by Executive voluntarily. Executive further acknowledges that Executive has had sufficient opportunity to consider this Agreement and discuss it with Executive's own advisors, including Executive's attorney and accountants and that Executive has made Executive's own free decision whether and to what extent to do so.
 
19.           Legal Expenses. Company shall pay to Executive all reasonable legal fees and expenses incurred by him in seeking to obtain or enforce any rights or benefits provided by this Agreement to the extent he prevails in such efforts.
 
20.           Indemnification of Executive. Company shall indemnify Executive against any liability incurred in connection with any proceeding in which the Executive may be involved as a party or otherwise by reason of the fact that Executive is or was serving as Chief Executive Officer to the extent permitted by the Company's articles of incorporation, bylaws and applicable law. To further effect, satisfy or secure the indemnification obligations provided herein or otherwise, the Company shall cause its director and officer liability insurance to cover Executive during the Term and for such period thereafter as the Company's liability insurance policy permits coverage for actions or omissions of former directors or officers.
 
IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused the due execution of this Agreement as of the date first set forth above.

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC.
   
   
Attest: /s/ Gertrude M. Hackney
By: /s/ Daniel K. Rothermel
 
 
 
JAY S. SIDHU
   
   
Witness: /s/ Carlyn A. D’Amico
/s/ Jay S. Sidhu
 
signature
 
 

 

14


 
 
 
 
 
Exhibit 10.4

AMENDED AND RESTATED
EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT
 
 
THIS AGREEMENT, made as of this 26th day of March, 2012, is by and between CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. (“Company") and RICHARD EHST (“Executive").
 
Background
 
A.           Customers Bank (“Bank”) and Executive are parties to an Employment Agreement dated as of February 17, 2011 (“Effective Date”).

B.           Pursuant to the Plan of Merger and Reorganization approved by the shareholders of the Bank, which became effective as of September 17, 2011, the Company assumed the Bank’s obligations under said Employment Agreement.

C.           Company wishes to retain and secure the services of Executive as the Company's Chief Operating Officer and the Bank’s Chief Operating Officer on the terms and conditions set forth herein.
 
D.           Subject to the terms and conditions hereinafter, Executive is willing to enter into this Amended and Restated Employment Agreement (this "Agreement") upon the terms and conditions set forth.
 
E.           The Company's Board of Directors has approved this Agreement.
 
NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual promises and agreements set forth herein, the parties agree as follows:
 
1.           Employment.  Company agrees to employ Executive as its Chief Operating Officer and the Chief Operating Officer of the Bank during the remainder of the "Term" defined in Section 2 of this Agreement. Executive shall report to and be subject solely to direction of the Chief Executive Officer of the Company and the Chief Executive Officer of the Bank and the Boards of Directors of the Company and the Bank.  Executive shall have the powers and authority ordinarily given to the respective positions described above as provided under the respective Bylaws of the Company and the Bank. Executive will have such duties as normally apply to such positions. Hereinafter, the term “Company” as used herein shall mean the Company, or the Bank, or both, as the context requires.  Executive shall devote a substantial portion of his working time, abilities and attention to the business of the Company, and will fulfill all of the duties required of him as Chief Operating Officer.  The services of Executive shall be rendered principally in Wyomissing, PA, but Executive shall undertake such traveling on behalf of Company as may be reasonably required.

 
 

 

2.           Term of Employment. Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, the initial term of employment hereunder shall be for the three (3)-year period commencing on the Effective Date and ending on the day preceding the three (3)-year anniversary of the Effective Date. As of each one (1)-year anniversary of the Effective Date, the term of employment hereunder shall be extended for another one (1) year, automatically, unless either party delivers notice to the contrary to the other party at least sixty (60) days prior to such one (1)-year anniversary, in which case the term of employment hereunder shall expire as of the date to which it was last extended pursuant to this sentence. Such notice shall be delivered in a manner consistent with the requirements of Section 13. References in this Agreement to the "Term" shall refer both to such initial term and any successive terms.
 
3.           Compensation. In consideration of the services to be rendered by Executive, Company shall pay to Executive during the initial Term:
 
(a)           A base salary of not less than the highest base salary for each year of the Term, payable in equal installments over such payroll cycles as the Company pays its executive officers generally, with any salary for initial or final partial months or other payroll periods being prorated based on the number of calendar days in question. It is understood that the Board of Directors of the Company shall review Executive's performance and make a determination regarding increases in his salary at least once in every calendar year during the Term.
 
(b)           Incentive Compensation in such form, and at such time as is provided in such executive incentive plan for Executive as shall be approved by the Board of Directors of the Company and in effect from time to time. Such incentive compensation may take the form of cash payments ("Cash Bonus"), transfers of stock or stock options (collectively, "Equity Awards"). Equity Awards shall be subject to such restrictions, vesting and other conditions and limitations as set forth in the executive incentive plan developed for Executive.
 
(c)           In addition to any Equity Awards which may be granted to Executive pursuant to Section 3(b) above, Executive and the Company agree that in connection with one or more successful acquisitions by the Company of other financial institutions after December 31, 2008, or the issuance of shares of common stock of the Company to raise capital after December 31, 2008, the Company shall issue to Executive options or warrants to acquire various percentages of the shares issued in connection with any such acquisition or capital-raising transaction, as set forth below, with appropriate consideration given to the then authorized capital levels as approved by the shareholders of the Company.


 
2

 

(i)           In connection with acquisitions by the Company or capital-raising transactions in an aggregate value not exceeding four hundred million dollars ($400,000,000), such options or warrants shall be issued with respect to one and five-tenths percent (1.5%) of the shares issued in connection with such acquisitions or capital-raising transactions.  The vesting requirements for such options or warrants shall be (A) a five-year employment requirement from the date of the applicable acquisition or capital-raising transaction (with a waiver of such requirement in the event of a change in control of the Company, or Executive’s death or termination of employment without Cause), and (B) a fifty percent (50%) increase in the value of the Company from the date of grant of such options or warrants through the expiration of their term.

(ii)           In connection with further acquisitions by the Company or capital-raising transactions, beyond those described in clause (i) above, in an aggregate value not exceeding three hundred and fifty million dollars ($350,000,000), such options or warrants shall be issued with respect to one percent (1.0%) of the shares issued in connection with such acquisitions or capital-raising transactions.  The vesting requirements for such options or warrants shall be a five-year employment requirement from the date of the applicable acquisition or capital-raising transaction (with a waiver of such requirement in the event of a change in control of the Company, or Executive’s death or termination of employment without Cause).

(iii)           In connection with further acquisitions by the Company or capital-raising transactions, beyond those described in clauses (i) and (ii) above, such options or warrants shall be issued with respect to five-tenths of one percent (0.5%) of the shares issued in connection with such acquisitions or capital-raising transactions.  The vesting requirements for such options or warrants shall be a five-year employment requirement from the date of the applicable acquisition or capital-raising transaction (with a waiver of such requirement in the event of a change in control of the Company, or Executive’s death or termination of employment without Cause).
 
4.           Reimbursement of Expenses.
 
4.1           Reimbursement of Expenses. During the Term, Company shall reimburse Executive for reasonable expenses incurred by him in the performance of his duties, as well as those incurred in furtherance of or in connection with the business of Company, including but not limited to traveling, entertainment, dining and other expenses.
 
5.           Termination of Employment.
 
5.1           Termination by Company; "Cause." Company shall have the right to terminate Executive's employment hereunder at any time, with or without "Cause" (as defined below). In the event of any termination by Company, Company shall give Executive forty-five (45) days prior notice of any termination without Cause, but shall not be obligated to give Executive prior notice of a termination with Cause. Company shall nevertheless be obligated to pay Executive such compensation and severance, if any, as may be provided for in this Agreement under the applicable circumstances. Company will give Executive notice of termination of his employment pursuant to a "Notice of Termination" (as defined below).
 
 

 
3

 

5.2           No Right to Compensation or Benefits Except as Stated. If the Company terminates Executive's employment for Cause, Executive shall have no right to severance compensation of any kind, or any right to salary or other benefits for any period after such date of termination. If Executive is terminated by Company other than for Cause, Executive's rights to compensation and benefits under this Agreement shall be as set forth in Section 5.5.
 
5.3           Termination by Executive. Executive shall have the right to terminate his employment, whether or not for "Good Reason" (as hereinafter defined), but, in all events, Executive shall give Company notice pursuant to a written "Notice of Termination" (as defined below). If the termination by Executive is other than for Good Reason: (i) Executive must give Company a Notice of Termination not less than forty five (45) days prior to the date his termination of employment will be effective, and (ii) Executive shall have no right to severance compensation of any kind, or any right to salary or other benefits for any period after such date of termination. If termination is by Executive for Good Reason, Executive's rights to compensation and benefits under this Agreement shall be as set forth in Section 5.5.
 
5.4           Certain Definitions.
 
(a)           In connection with a termination of Executive's employment by the Company, "Cause" shall mean any one or more of the following reasons: (1) the willful material failure by the Executive to perform the duties required of him hereunder (other than any such failure resulting from incapacity due to physical or mental illness of the Executive or material changes in the direction and policies of the Board of Directors of Company), if such failure continues for fifteen (15) days afer a written demand for substantial performance is delivered to the Executive by the Company which specifically identifies the manner in which it is believed that the Executive has failed to attempt to perform his duties hereunder; (2) the willful engaging by the Executive in willful misconduct materially injurious to the Company; (3) receipt by the Company of a notice (which shall not have been appealed by Executive or shall have become final and non-appealable) of any governmental body or entity having jurisdiction over the Company requiring termination or removal of the Executive from his then present position, or receipt of a written directive or order of any governmental body or entity having jurisdiction over the Company (which shall not have been appealed by Executive or shall have become final and non-appealable) requiring termination or removal of the Executive from his then present position; (4) personal dishonesty, incompetence, willful misconduct, willful breach of fiduciary duty involving personal profit or conviction of a felony; or (5) material breach of any provision set forth in Paragraphs 7, 8, or 10, to the extent applicable. For purposes of this paragraph, no act, or failure to act, on the Executive's part shall be considered "willful" unless done or omitted to be done by Executive in bad faith and without reasonable belief that his action or omission was in the best interest of Company. Any act or omission to act by the Executive in reliance upon a written opinion of counsel to Company shall not be deemed to be willful.
 
 

 
4

 

(b)           Good Reason. For purposes of this Agreement, "Good Reason" shall mean (1) a material breach by Company of the provisions of this Agreement, which failure has not been cured within 30 days after a written notice of such noncompliance has been given by Executive to Company; (2) any purported termination of Executive's employment which is not effected in compliance with the requirements of this Agreement; (3) any reduction in title or a material adverse change in Executive's responsibilities or authority which are inconsistent with, or the assignment to Executive of duties inconsistent with, Executive's status as Chief Operating Officer of Company; or (4) any reduction in Executive's annual base salary as in effect on the date hereof or as the same may be increased from time to time.
 
(c)           Notice of Termination. Any termination of Executive's employment by Company or by Executive shall be communicated by written Notice of Termination to the other party hereto. For purposes of this Agreement, a "Notice of Termination" shall mean a dated notice which shall (1) indicate the specific termination provision in this Agreement relied upon; (2) set forth in reasonable detail the facts and circumstances claimed to provide a basis for termination of Executive's employment under the provision so indicated; and (3) be given in a manner consistent with the requirements of Section 13.
 
5.5           Compensation Upon Certain Types of Termination. If Executive shall terminate his employment for Good Reason during the Term, or if Executive's Employment is terminated by the Company other than for Cause during the Term, or if Executive's Employment is terminated for any reason other than Cause upon expiration of the Term, then in lieu of any salary or damages payments to Executive for periods subsequent to the date of termination, Company shall pay as "Severance Compensation" to Executive, in lieu of all other damages, compensation and benefits other than any benefits the right to which shall have previously vested, an amount (the "Severance Compensation") equal to the following, depending upon whether a "Change in Control" (as defined below) shall have occurred at the time of termination of employment:
 
(a)           If a Change in Control shall not have occurred within twelve (12) months prior to the date of termination of Executive's employment with the Company, the Company shall pay Executive the following Severance Compensation, payable at the respective times and on the respective conditions set forth in this subsection for each type of Severance Compensation:
 
(i)           Cash Severance Compensation. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary elsewhere in this Agreement, Executive shall be entitled to receive a dollar amount equal to the sum of Executive's then current base salary plus the average of the annual Cash Bonuses paid to him with respect to the three (3) fiscal years of the Company immediately preceding the fiscal year of termination, for the greater of  two (2) years or the period of time remaining in the Term. This element of Severance Compensation shall be payable in equal installments on the normal pay dates following Executive's separation from service with the Company within the meaning of Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code"), and the Treasury Regulations promulgated thereunder (such Section and regulations are sometimes referred to in this Agreement as "Section 409A"). If, as of the date of the Executive's separation from service, stock of the Company or a holding company or other parent entity with respect to the Company is publicly traded on an established securities market or otherwise, and if necessary to comply with Section 409A, payments otherwise due during the six (6)-month period following his separation from service shall be suspended and paid in a lump sum upon completion of such six (6)-month period, at which time the balance of the payments shall commence in installments as described in the preceding sentence. Payments shall be subject to deduction for such tax withholdings as Company may be obligated to make;
 
 

 
5

 

(ii)           Equity Awards. All Equity Awards shall be vested in full;
 
(iii)           Cash Bonus. Executive shall be entitled to a fraction of any Cash Bonus for the fiscal year of the Company within which Executive's termination of employment occurs which, based upon the criteria established for such Cash Bonus, would have been payable to Executive had he remained employed through the date of payment, the numerator of which is the number of days of such fiscal year prior to his termination of employment and the denominator of which is three hundred and sixty-five (365); and
 
(iv)           Company shall continue to provide health insurance (including dental if applicable) and any life or disability insurance benefits for the shorter of (i) the length of the severance measurement period set forth in Section 5.5(a)(i) above, or (ii) the maximum period the Company is then permitted to extend each individual benefit under the applicable plan or policy or applicable law.
 
(b)           If a Change in Control shall have occurred within twelve (12) months prior to the date of termination of Executive's employment with the Company, the Company shall pay Executive Severance Compensation equal to three hundred percent (300%) of the sum of Executive's then current base salary plus the average of the annual Cash Bonuses paid to him with respect to the three (3) fiscal years of the Company immediately preceding the fiscal year of termination. The Severance Compensation shall be payable in a single lump sum within thirty (30) days following Executive's separation from service within the meaning of Section 409A. If, as of the date of the Executive's separation from service, stock of the Company or a holding company or other parent entity with respect to the Company is publicly traded on an established securities market or otherwise, and if necessary to comply with Section 409A, payment of the lump sum shall be suspended and paid within the thirty (30)-day period following the close of the six (6) month period following his separation from service. Payments shall be subject to deduction for such tax withholdings as Company may be obligated to make. In addition to the aforesaid Executive Severance Compensation, additional Executive Severance Compensation shall be provided as set forth below.

(i)           Equity Awards. All Equity Awards shall be vested in full;
 
(ii)           Cash Bonus. Executive shall be entitled to a fraction of any Cash Bonus for the fiscal year of the Company within which Executive's termination of employment occurs which, based upon the criteria established for such Cash Bonus, would have been payable to Executive had he remained employed through the date of payment, the numerator of which is the number of days of such fiscal year prior to his termination of employment and the denominator of which is three hundred and sixty-five (365);
 
 

 
6

 

(iii)           Company shall continue to provide health insurance (including dental if applicable) and any life or disability insurance benefits for the shorter of (i) the length of the severance measurement period set forth in above in this Section 5.5(b), or (ii) the maximum period the Company is then permitted to extend each individual benefit under the applicable plan or policy or applicable law; and
 
(iv)           If, as a result of payments provided for under or pursuant to this Agreement together with all other payments in the nature of compensation provided to or for the benefit of Executive under any other agreement in connection with a Change in Control, Executive becomes subject to taxes of any state, local or federal taxing authority that would not have been imposed on such payments but for the occurrence of a Change in Control, including any excise tax under Section 4999 of the Code and any successor or comparable provision, then, in addition to any other benefits provided under or pursuant to this Agreement or otherwise, Company (including any successor to Company) shall pay to Executive at the time any such payments are made under or pursuant to this or the other agreements, an amount equal to the amount of any such taxes imposed or to be imposed on Executive (the amount of any such payment, the "Parachute Tax Reimbursement"). In addition, Company (including any successor to Company) shall "gross up" such Parachute Tax Reimbursement by paying to Executive at the same time an additional amount equal to the aggregate amount of any additional taxes (whether income taxes, excise taxes, special taxes, employment taxes or otherwise) that are or will be payable by Executive as a result of the Parachute Tax Reimbursement being paid or payable to Executive and/or as a result of the additional amounts paid or payable to Executive pursuant to this sentence, such that after payment of such additional taxes Executive shall have been paid on a net after-tax basis an amount equal to the Parachute Tax Reimbursement. The amount of any Parachute Tax Reimbursement and of any such gross-up amounts shall be determined by Company's independent auditing firm, whose determination, absent manifest error, shall be treated as conclusive and binding absent a binding determination by a governmental taxing authority that a greater amount of taxes is payable by Executive.
 
(c)            For purposes of this Agreement, "Change in Control" means the occurrence of any one or more of the following events:
 
(i)           There occurs a merger, consolidation or other business combination or reorganization to which the Company is a party, whether or not approved in advance by the Board of Directors of the Company, in which (A) the members of the Board of Directors of the Company immediately preceding the consummation of such transaction do not constitute a majority of the members of the Board of Directors of the resulting corporation and of any parent corporation thereof immediately after the consummation of such transaction, and (B) the shareholders of the Company immediately before such transaction do not hold more than fifty percent (50%) of the voting power of securities of the resulting corporation;
 
 

 
7

 

(ii)            There occurs a sale, exchange, transfer, or other disposition of substantially all of the assets of the Company to another entity, whether or not approved in advance by the Board of Directors of the Company (for purpose of this Agreement, a sale of more than one-half of the branches of the Company would constitute a Change in Control, but for purposes of this paragraph, no branches or assets will be deemed to have been sold if they are leased back contemporaneously with or promptly after their sale);
 
(iii)           A plan of liquidation or dissolution is adopted for the Company; or
 
(iv)           Any "person" or any group of "persons" (as such term is defined in Sections 13(d) and 14(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the "Exchange Act"), as if such provisions were applicable to the Company, other than the holders of shares of the Company's common stock in existence on the date of the Opening for Business, is or shall become the "beneficial owner" (as defined in Rule 13d-3 under the Exchange Act), as if such rule were applicable to the Company, directly or indirectly, of securities of the Company representing 50% or more of the combined voting power of the Company's then outstanding securities.
 
(d)            In the event that the Executive's employment is terminated during the Term as a result of his death or disability, he (or his estate, as the case may be) shall not be entitled to any payments or other benefits pursuant to this Section 5.5 or otherwise.
 
5.6            Mitigation by Executive. Executive shall not be required to mitigate the amount of any payment provided for in Section 5.5 by seeking other employment or otherwise.
 
6.           Effect of TARP Participation.
 
6.1           Basic Agreement re Effect of TARP Participation. It is anticipated by Executive and Company that Company may elect to participate in the Troubled Assets Relief Program ("TARP") established under the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008 ("EESA"), as amended by the American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009 ("ARRA") and any subsequent legislation whether heretofore or hereafter enacted ("Subsequent Legislation") and as implemented by present and future regulations of applicable federal government agencies ("Implementing Regulations") (the requirements of EESA, ARRA, Subsequent Legislation and Implementing Regulations that may be applicable to the Company or Executive or the compensation or benefits provided to Executive under this Agreement or otherwise as a result of the Company's participation in TARP are sometimes referred to herein as the "TARP Provisions"). In that event, if the compensation and benefits to be provided to Executive pursuant to Sections 3, 4 and 5 of this Agreement, or any portion or element thereof, or any other compensation, benefits or perquisites hereafter agreed upon by the parties, must be reduced, delayed or otherwise modified in order for the Company to comply with any of the TARP Provisions, as interpreted and implemented by regulations of the U. S. Department of the Treasury and the terms of any contract between Company or Executive and said Department or any other agency of the federal government (""TARP Requirements"), this Agreement and all such other compensation, benefits and perquisites and agreements relating to any of the foregoing shall automatically be deemed amended to cause the Company to be in compliance at all times with the TARP Requirements. Executive and Company shall negotiate in good faith to document, by amendment or amendments to this Agreement or any other agreements, plans or benefits, the modifications so required, but the parties' failure to reach final agreement shall not negate the provisions of this Section.
 
 

 
8

 

6.2           Agreements Supporting TARP Waiver. In consideration for the benefits Executive will receive under this Agreement and potentially as a result of Company's participation in TARP, Executive hereby voluntarily waives any claim against the Company for any changes to Executive's compensation or benefits that are required for Company to comply with TARP Requirements. This waiver includes all claims Executive may have under the laws of the United States or any state related to the requirements imposed by any of the TARP Requirements, including without limitation a claim for any compensation or other payments Executive would otherwise receive, any challenge to the process by which any of the TARP Requirements were adopted and any tort or constitutional claim about the effect of any of the TARP Requirements on Executive's employment relationship with Company. Executive agrees to execute such waivers and other agreements as may be requires by the U.S. Treasury Department in connection with Company's participation in TARP.
 
7.           Non-Disclosure. The Executive covenants and agrees that Executive will not at any time, either during the Term or thereafter, use, disclose or make accessible to any other person, firm, partnership, corporation or any other entity any Confidential and Proprietary Information (as defined herein), other than to (a) Executive's attorney or spouse in confidence, (b) while employed by the Company, in the business and for the benefit of the Company, or (c) when required to do so by a court of competent jurisdiction, any government agency having supervisory authority over the business of the Executive or the Company or any administrative body or legislative body, including a committee thereof, with jurisdiction.
 
For purposes of this Agreement, "Confidential and Proprietary Information" shall mean non-public, confidential, and proprietary information provided to the Executive concerning, without limitation, the Company's financial condition and/or results of operations, statistical data, products, ideas and concepts, strategic business plans, lists of customers or customer information, information relating to marketing plans, management development reviews, including information regarding the capabilities and experience of the Company's employees, compensation, recruiting and training, and human resource policies and procedures, policy and procedure manuals, together with all materials and documents in any form or medium (including oral, written, tangible, intangible, or electronic) concerning any of the above, and other non-public, proprietary and confidential information of the Company; provided, however, that Confidential and Proprietary Information shall not include any information that is known generally to the public or within the industry other than as a result of unauthorized disclosure by the Executive. It is specifically understood and agreed by the Executive that any non-public information received by the Executive during Executive's employment by the Company is deemed Confidential and Proprietary Information for purposes of this Agreement. In the event the Executive's employment is terminated for any reason, the Executive shall immediately return to the Company upon request all Confidential and Proprietary Information in Executive's possession or control.
 
 

 
9

 

8.           Non-Solicitation. Executive agrees that during the Term and for a period of twelve (12) months thereafter, unless the Executive obtains the Company's prior written permission, which may be granted or denied at the Company's sole and absolute discretion, the Executive shall not:
 
(a)           solicit or divert to any competitor of the Company or, upon termination of the Executive's employment with the Company, accept any business from any individual or entity that is a customer or a prospective customer of the Company, to the extent that such prospective customer was identifiable as such prior to the date of the Executive's termination, except that this covenant of non-solicitation shall not apply with respect to anyone who, while having previously been a customer or prospect of the Company, is no longer a customer or prospect of the Company at the time of the solicitation; and/or
 
(b)           induce or encourage any officer and/or employee of the Company to leave the employ of the Company, hire any individual who was an employee of the Company as of the date of the termination of the Executive's, or induce or encourage any customer, vendor, participant, agent or other business relation of the Company to cease or reduce doing business with the Company or in any way interfere with the relationship between any such customer, vendor, participant, agent or other business relation and the Company.
 
9.           Noncompete Agreement. For a period of twelve (12) months after any resignation or termination of Executive's employment for any reason, Executive shall not, directly or indirectly, within 25 miles of any office of the Company, enter into or engage directly or indirectly in competition with the Company or any subsidiary or other company under common control with the Company, in any financial services business conducted by the Company or any such subsidiary at the time of such resignation or termination, either as an individual on his own or as a partner or joint venturer, or as a director, officer, shareholder, employee, agent, independent contractor, nor shall Executive assist any other person or entity in engaging directly or indirectly in such competition.
 
10.           Non-Disparagement. During the Term, after its expiration and following the termination of this Agreement by the Company or the Executive for any reason, each party agrees not to make any statements, in writing or otherwise, that disparage the reputation or character of the other party or, in the case of the Company, any subsidiaries or affiliates of the Company or any of their respective managers, directors, officers, stockholders, partners, members or employees, at any time for any reason whatsoever, except that nothing in this Section shall prohibit any party from giving truthful testimony in any litigation or administrative proceedings either between the Executive and the Company or in connection with which such party is subpoenaed and required by law to give testimony, including without limitation, any action by the Executive to enforce Executive's rights hereunder.
 
 

 
10

 

11.           Severance Compensation Conditional; Remedies for Breach of Sections 7, 8, 9 and 10; Independence of Covenants; Notice to Others; Savings Clause.
 
11.1           Severance Compensation Independent. Company's obligation to pay Severance Compensation is conditioned on Executive's compliance with Paragraphs 7, 8, 9 and 10 of this Agreement and Company shall not be obligated to pay such Severance Compensation in the event of any breach by Executive of such Paragraphs.
 
11.2            Remedies for Breach of Sections 7, 8, 9 and 10. Executive and Company agree that the covenants in Sections 7, 8. 9 and 10 are reasonable covenants under the circumstances. Executive agrees that any breach of the covenants set forth in Sections 7, 8, 9 and 10 of this Agreement will irreparably harm the Company. The Executive and the Company agree that in the event of any breach by the Executive of the provisions set forth in Section 7, 8, 9 and 10 of this Agreement, the Company shall be entitled to all rights and remedies available at law or in equity, including without limitation, the following cumulative and not alternative rights:
 
(a)            the right to obtain injunctive or other equitable relief to restrain any breach or threatened breach or otherwise to specifically enforce the provisions of this Agreement, it being agreed that monetary damages alone would be inadequate to compensate the Company, the amount of such damages will be difficult (if not impossible) to prove precisely, and would be an inadequate remedy for such breach;
 
(b)            the right to institute civil suit to recover damages suffered by the Company;
 
(c)            the right to recover actual reasonable attorneys' fees and other costs incurred by the Company in connection with pursuing remedies hereunder; and
 
(d)            the right to seek an equitable accounting of all earnings, profits and other benefits arising from any such violation.
 
11.3           Independence of Covenants. The existence of any claim or cause of action of the Executive against the Company, whether predicated on this Agreement or otherwise, shall not constitute a defense to the enforcement by the Company of the provisions of Sections 7, 8, 9 and 10.
 
11.4           Notice to Others. Executive agrees to notify any future prospective employers and future employers, and any future joint venturers, partners and contracting parties of Executive, whose activities may be deemed to compete with Company of the existence of each of the covenants contained in Sections 7, 8, 9 and 10 of this Agreement.
 
 

 
11

 

11.5           Savings Clause. In the event that any provision or provisions of any of the covenants in Section 7, 8, 9 and 10 would otherwise be determined by any court of competent jurisdiction to be unenforceable in whole or in part by reason of being for too great a period of time or covering too great a geographical area or too broad a product market, or for any other reason, each such covenant shall nevertheless remain in full force and effect and be construed so as to be enforceable as to that period of time and geographical area and product market, and on such other conditions, as may be determined to be reasonable by the court.
 
12.           Amendments. No amendments to this Agreement shall be binding unless in writing and signed by both parties.
 
13.            Notices. All notices under this Agreement shall be in writing and shall be deemed effective (i) when delivered in person or by facsimile, telecopier, telegraph or other electronic means capable of being embodied in written form, or (ii) forty-eight (48) hours after deposit thereof in the U.S. mails by certified or registered mail, return receipt requested, postage prepaid, addressed, in the case of Executive, to his last known address as carried on the personnel records of Company and, in the case of Company, to the corporate headquarters, attention of the Chairman of the Board of Directors (or if Executive is at that time the Chairman of the Board of Directors, then to the Secretary of the Company), or to such other address as the party to be notified may specify by notice to the other party.
 
14.            Entire Agreement. This Agreement is the entire agreement of the parties with respect to its subject matter and supersedes and replaces all other negotiations, discussions and prior or contemporaneous agreements between the parties, whether oral or written, with respect to the subject matter of Executive's employment with Company.
 
15.            Binding Effect and Benefits. The rights and obligations of Company and Executive under this Agreement shall inure to the benefit of and shall be binding upon the respective heirs, personal representatives, successors and assigns of Company and Executive.

 
12

 



16.           Construction. This Agreement shall be construed under the laws of the Commonwealth of Pennsylvania, as they may be preempted by federal laws and regulations. Section headings are for convenience only and shall not be considered a part of the terms and provisions of the Agreement.
 
17.           Governing Law; Jurisdiction; Venue. The validity, interpretation, construction, performance and enforcement of this Agreement shall be governed by the internal laws of the Commonwealth of Pennsylvania, without regard to its conflicts of law rules, and by federal law to the extent it pre-empts state law. For purposes of any action or proceeding, the Executive irrevocably submits to the exclusive jurisdiction of the courts of the Commonwealth Pennsylvania and the courts of the United States of America located in Pennsylvania for the purpose of any judicial proceeding arising out of or relating to this Agreement or otherwise. The Executive irrevocably agrees to service of process by certified mail, return receipt requested, to the Executive at the addressed listed in the records of the Company. The proper venue for all such disputes, actions or proceedings shall be Chester County. The parties agree that in any action or proceeds arising under this Agreement, attorneys' fees and costs shall be awarded to the prevailing party.
 
18.            Executive's Acknowledgment of Terms and Right to Separate Counsel. Executive acknowledges that he has read this Agreement fully and carefully, understands its terms and that it has been entered into by Executive voluntarily. Executive further acknowledges that Executive has had sufficient opportunity to consider this Agreement and discuss it with Executive's own advisors, including Executive's attorney and accountants and that Executive has made Executive's own free decision whether and to what extent to do so.
 
19.            Legal Expenses. Company shall pay to Executive all reasonable legal fees and expenses incurred by him in seeking to obtain or enforce any rights or benefits provided by this Agreement to the extent he prevails in such efforts.
 
20.           Indemnification of Executive. Company shall indemnify Executive against any liability incurred in connection with any proceeding in which the Executive may be involved a party or otherwise by reason of the fact that Executive is or was serving as Chief Operating Officer to the extent permitted by the Company's articles of incorporation, bylaws and applicable law. To further effect, satisfy or secure the indemnification obligations provided herein or otherwise, the Company shall cause its director and officer liability insurance to cover Executive during the Term and for such period thereafter as the Company's liability insurance policy permits coverage for actions or omissions of former directors or officers.

 
13

 


 
 
IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused the due execution of this Agreement as of the date first set forth above.

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC.
   
   
Attest: /s/ Gertrude M. Hackney
By: /s/ Jay S. Sidhu
 
 
 
RICHARD EHST
   
   
Witness: /s/ Carlyn A. D’Amico
/s/ Richard Ehst
 
signature

 
 

 
 
 
 

14

 
Exhibit 10.5
 
AMENDED AND RESTATED
EMPLOYMENT AGREEMENT
 
 
THIS AGREEMENT, made as of this 26th day of March, 2012, is by and between CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC. (“Company") and THOMAS BRUGGER (“Executive").
 
Background
 
A.           Customers Bank (“Bank”) and Executive are parties to an Employment Agreement dated as of February 17, 2011 (“Effective Date”).

B.           Pursuant to the Plan of Merger and Reorganization approved by the shareholders of the Bank, which became effective as of September 17, 2011, the Company assumed the Bank’s obligations under said Employment Agreement.

C.           Company wishes to retain and secure the services of Executive as the Company's Chief Financial Officer and the Bank’s Chief Financial Officer on the terms and conditions set forth herein.
 
D.           Subject to the terms and conditions hereinafter, Executive is willing to enter into this Amended and Restated Employment Agreement (this "Agreement") upon the terms and conditions set forth.
 
E.           The Company's Board of Directors has approved this Agreement.
 
NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual promises and agreements set forth herein, the parties agree as follows:
 
1.           Employment.  Company agrees to employ Executive as its Chief Financial Officer and the Chief Financial Officer of the Bank during the remainder of the "Term" defined in Section 2 of this Agreement. Executive shall report to and be subject solely to direction of the Chief Executive Officer of the Company and the Chief Executive Officer of the Bank and the Boards of Directors of the Company and the Bank.  Executive shall have the powers and authority ordinarily given to the respective positions described above as provided under the respective Bylaws of the Company and the Bank. Executive will have such duties as normally apply to such positions. Hereinafter, the term “Company” as used herein shall mean the Company, or the Bank, or both, as the context requires.  Executive shall devote a substantial portion of his working time, abilities and attention to the business of the Company, and will fulfill all of the duties required of him as Chief Financial Officer.  The services of Executive shall be rendered principally in Wyomissing, PA, but Executive shall undertake such traveling on behalf of Company as may be reasonably required.
 
 

 
 

 

2.           Term of Employment. Subject to the terms and conditions of this Agreement, the initial term of employment hereunder shall be for the two (2)-year period commencing on the Effective Date and ending on the day preceding the two (2)-year anniversary of the Effective Date. As of each one (1)-year anniversary of the Effective Date, the term of employment hereunder shall be extended for another one (1) year, automatically, unless either party delivers notice to the contrary to the other party at least sixty (60) days prior to such one (1)-year anniversary, in which case the term of employment hereunder shall expire as of the date to which it was last extended pursuant to this sentence. Such notice shall be delivered in a manner consistent with the requirements of Section 13. References in this Agreement to the "Term" shall refer both to such initial term and any successive terms.
 
3.           Compensation. In consideration of the services to be rendered by Executive, Company shall pay to Executive during the initial Term:
 
(a)           A base salary of not less than the highest base salary for each year of the Term, payable in equal installments over such payroll cycles as the Company pays its executive officers generally, with any salary for initial or final partial months or other payroll periods being prorated based on the number of calendar days in question. It is understood that the Board of Directors of the Company shall review Executive's performance and make a determination regarding increases in his salary at least once in every calendar year during the Term.
 
(b)           Incentive Compensation in such form, and at such time as is provided in such executive incentive plan for Executive as shall be approved by the Board of Directors of the Company and in effect from time to time. Such incentive compensation may take the form of cash payments ("Cash Bonus"), transfers of stock or stock options (collectively, "Equity Awards"). Equity Awards shall be subject to such restrictions, vesting and other conditions and limitations as set forth in the executive incentive plan developed for Executive.
 
(c)           In addition to any Equity Awards which may be granted to Executive pursuant to Section 3(b) above, Executive and the Company agree that in connection with one or more successful acquisitions by the Company of other financial institutions after December 31, 2008, or the issuance of shares of common stock of the Company to raise capital after December 31, 2008, the Company shall issue to Executive options or warrants to acquire various percentages of the shares issued in connection with any such acquisition or capital-raising transaction, as set forth below, with appropriate consideration given to the then authorized capital levels as approved by the shareholders of the Company.


 
2

 

(i)           In connection with acquisitions by the Company or capital-raising transactions in an aggregate value not exceeding four hundred million dollars ($400,000,000), such options or warrants shall be issued with respect to one and five-tenths percent (1.5%) of the shares issued in connection with such acquisitions or capital-raising transactions.  The vesting requirements for such options or warrants shall be (A) a five-year employment requirement from the date of the applicable acquisition or capital-raising transaction (with a waiver of such requirement in the event of a change in control of the Company, or Executive’s death or termination of employment without Cause), and (B) a fifty percent (50%) increase in the value of the Company from the date of grant of such options or warrants through the expiration of their term.

(ii)           In connection with further acquisitions by the Company or capital-raising transactions, beyond those described in clause (i) above, in an aggregate value not exceeding three hundred and fifty million dollars ($350,000,000), such options or warrants shall be issued with respect to one percent (1.0%) of the shares issued in connection with such acquisitions or capital-raising transactions.  The vesting requirements for such options or warrants shall be a five-year employment requirement from the date of the applicable acquisition or capital-raising transaction (with a waiver of such requirement in the event of a change in control of the Company, or Executive’s death or termination of employment without Cause).

(iii)           In connection with further acquisitions by the Company or capital-raising transactions, beyond those described in clauses (i) and (ii) above, such options or warrants shall be issued with respect to five-tenths of one percent (0.5%) of the shares issued in connection with such acquisitions or capital-raising transactions.  The vesting requirements for such options or warrants shall be a five-year employment requirement from the date of the applicable acquisition or capital-raising transaction (with a waiver of such requirement in the event of a change in control of the Company, or Executive’s death or termination of employment without Cause).
 
4.           Reimbursement of Expenses.
 
4.1           Reimbursement of Expenses. During the Term, Company shall reimburse Executive for reasonable expenses incurred by him in the performance of his duties, as well as those incurred in furtherance of or in connection with the business of Company, including but not limited to traveling, entertainment, dining and other expenses.
 
5.           Termination of Employment.
 
5.1           Termination by Company; "Cause." Company shall have the right to terminate Executive's employment hereunder at any time, with or without "Cause" (as defined below). In the event of any termination by Company, Company shall give Executive forty-five (45) days prior notice of any termination without Cause, but shall not be obligated to give Executive prior notice of a termination with Cause. Company shall nevertheless be obligated to pay Executive such compensation and severance, if any, as may be provided for in this Agreement under the applicable circumstances. Company will give Executive notice of termination of his employment pursuant to a "Notice of Termination" (as defined below).
 
 

 
3

 

5.2           No Right to Compensation or Benefits Except as Stated. If the Company terminates Executive's employment for Cause, Executive shall have no right to severance compensation of any kind, or any right to salary or other benefits for any period after such date of termination. If Executive is terminated by Company other than for Cause, Executive's rights to compensation and benefits under this Agreement shall be as set forth in Section 5.5.
 
5.3           Termination by Executive. Executive shall have the right to terminate his employment, whether or not for "Good Reason" (as hereinafter defined), but, in all events, Executive shall give Company notice pursuant to a written "Notice of Termination" (as defined below). If the termination by Executive is other than for Good Reason: (i) Executive must give Company a Notice of Termination not less than forty five (45) days prior to the date his termination of employment will be effective, and (ii) Executive shall have no right to severance compensation of any kind, or any right to salary or other benefits for any period after such date of termination. If termination is by Executive for Good Reason, Executive's rights to compensation and benefits under this Agreement shall be as set forth in Section 5.5.
 
5.4           Certain Definitions.
 
(a)           In connection with a termination of Executive's employment by the Company, "Cause" shall mean any one or more of the following reasons: (1) the willful material failure by the Executive to perform the duties required of him hereunder (other than any such failure resulting from incapacity due to physical or mental illness of the Executive or material changes in the direction and policies of the Board of Directors of Company), if such failure continues for fifteen (15) days afer a written demand for substantial performance is delivered to the Executive by the Company which specifically identifies the manner in which it is believed that the Executive has failed to attempt to perform his duties hereunder; (2) the willful engaging by the Executive in willful misconduct materially injurious to the Company; (3) receipt by the Company of a notice (which shall not have been appealed by Executive or shall have become final and non-appealable) of any governmental body or entity having jurisdiction over the Company requiring termination or removal of the Executive from his then present position, or receipt of a written directive or order of any governmental body or entity having jurisdiction over the Company (which shall not have been appealed by Executive or shall have become final and non-appealable) requiring termination or removal of the Executive from his then present position; (4) personal dishonesty, incompetence, willful misconduct, willful breach of fiduciary duty involving personal profit or conviction of a felony; or (5) material breach of any provision set forth in Paragraphs 7, 8, or 10, to the extent applicable. For purposes of this paragraph, no act, or failure to act, on the Executive's part shall be considered "willful" unless done or omitted to be done by Executive in bad faith and without reasonable belief that his action or omission was in the best interest of Company. Any act or omission to act by the Executive in reliance upon a written opinion of counsel to Company shall not be deemed to be willful.
 
 

 
4

 

(b)           Good Reason. For purposes of this Agreement, "Good Reason" shall mean (1) a material breach by Company of the provisions of this Agreement, which failure has not been cured within 30 days after a written notice of such noncompliance has been given by Executive to Company; (2) any purported termination of Executive's employment which is not effected in compliance with the requirements of this Agreement; (3) any reduction in title or a material adverse change in Executive's responsibilities or authority which are inconsistent with, or the assignment to Executive of duties inconsistent with, Executive's status as Chief Financial Officer of Company; or (4) any reduction in Executive's annual base salary as in effect on the date hereof or as the same may be increased from time to time.
 
(c)           Notice of Termination. Any termination of Executive's employment by Company or by Executive shall be communicated by written Notice of Termination to the other party hereto. For purposes of this Agreement, a "Notice of Termination" shall mean a dated notice which shall (1) indicate the specific termination provision in this Agreement relied upon; (2) set forth in reasonable detail the facts and circumstances claimed to provide a basis for termination of Executive's employment under the provision so indicated; and (3) be given in a manner consistent with the requirements of Section 13.
 
5.5           Compensation Upon Certain Types of Termination. If Executive shall terminate his employment for Good Reason during the Term, or if Executive's Employment is terminated by the Company other than for Cause during the Term, or if Executive's Employment is terminated for any reason other than Cause upon expiration of the Term, then in lieu of any salary or damages payments to Executive for periods subsequent to the date of termination, Company shall pay as "Severance Compensation" to Executive, in lieu of all other damages, compensation and benefits other than any benefits the right to which shall have previously vested, an amount (the "Severance Compensation") equal to the following, depending upon whether a "Change in Control" (as defined below) shall have occurred at the time of termination of employment:
 
(a)           If a Change in Control shall not have occurred within twelve (12) months prior to the date of termination of Executive's employment with the Company, the Company shall pay Executive the following Severance Compensation, payable at the respective times and on the respective conditions set forth in this subsection for each type of Severance Compensation:
 
(i)           Cash Severance Compensation. Notwithstanding anything to the contrary elsewhere in this Agreement, Executive shall be entitled to receive a dollar amount equal to the sum of Executive's then current base salary plus the average of the annual Cash Bonuses paid to him with respect to the three (3) fiscal years of the Company immediately preceding the fiscal year of termination, for the greater of  two (2) years or the period of time remaining in the Term. This element of Severance Compensation shall be payable in equal installments on the normal pay dates following Executive's separation from service with the Company within the meaning of Section 409A of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code"), and the Treasury Regulations promulgated thereunder (such Section and regulations are sometimes referred to in this Agreement as "Section 409A"). If, as of the date of the Executive's separation from service, stock of the Company or a holding company or other parent entity with respect to the Company is publicly traded on an established securities market or otherwise, and if necessary to comply with Section 409A, payments otherwise due during the six (6)-month period following his separation from service shall be suspended and paid in a lump sum upon completion of such six (6)-month period, at which time the balance of the payments shall commence in installments as described in the preceding sentence. Payments shall be subject to deduction for such tax withholdings as Company may be obligated to make;
 
 

 
5

 

(ii)           Equity Awards. All Equity Awards shall be vested in full;
 
(iii)           Cash Bonus. Executive shall be entitled to a fraction of any Cash Bonus for the fiscal year of the Company within which Executive's termination of employment occurs which, based upon the criteria established for such Cash Bonus, would have been payable to Executive had he remained employed through the date of payment, the numerator of which is the number of days of such fiscal year prior to his termination of employment and the denominator of which is three hundred and sixty-five (365); and
 
(iv)           Company shall continue to provide health insurance (including dental if applicable) and any life or disability insurance benefits for the shorter of (i) the length of the severance measurement period set forth in Section 5.5(a)(i) above, or (ii) the maximum period the Company is then permitted to extend each individual benefit under the applicable plan or policy or applicable law.
 
(b)           If a Change in Control shall have occurred within twelve (12) months prior to the date of termination of Executive's employment with the Company, the Company shall pay Executive Severance Compensation equal to three hundred percent (300%) of the sum of Executive's then current base salary plus the average of the annual Cash Bonuses paid to him with respect to the three (3) fiscal years of the Company immediately preceding the fiscal year of termination. The Severance Compensation shall be payable in a single lump sum within thirty (30) days following Executive's separation from service within the meaning of Section 409A. If, as of the date of the Executive's separation from service, stock of the Company or a holding company or other parent entity with respect to the Company is publicly traded on an established securities market or otherwise, and if necessary to comply with Section 409A, payment of the lump sum shall be suspended and paid within the thirty (30)-day period following the close of the six (6) month period following his separation from service. Payments shall be subject to deduction for such tax withholdings as Company may be obligated to make. In addition to the aforesaid Executive Severance Compensation, additional Executive Severance Compensation shall be provided as set forth below.

(i)           Equity Awards. All Equity Awards shall be vested in full;
 
(ii)           Cash Bonus. Executive shall be entitled to a fraction of any Cash Bonus for the fiscal year of the Company within which Executive's termination of employment occurs which, based upon the criteria established for such Cash Bonus, would have been payable to Executive had he remained employed through the date of payment, the numerator of which is the number of days of such fiscal year prior to his termination of employment and the denominator of which is three hundred and sixty-five (365);
 
 

 
6

 

(iii)           Company shall continue to provide health insurance (including dental if applicable) and any life or disability insurance benefits for the shorter of (i) the length of the severance measurement period set forth in above in this Section 5.5(b), or (ii) the maximum period the Company is then permitted to extend each individual benefit under the applicable plan or policy or applicable law; and
 
(iv)           If, as a result of payments provided for under or pursuant to this Agreement together with all other payments in the nature of compensation provided to or for the benefit of Executive under any other agreement in connection with a Change in Control, Executive becomes subject to taxes of any state, local or federal taxing authority that would not have been imposed on such payments but for the occurrence of a Change in Control, including any excise tax under Section 4999 of the Code and any successor or comparable provision, then, in addition to any other benefits provided under or pursuant to this Agreement or otherwise, Company (including any successor to Company) shall pay to Executive at the time any such payments are made under or pursuant to this or the other agreements, an amount equal to the amount of any such taxes imposed or to be imposed on Executive (the amount of any such payment, the "Parachute Tax Reimbursement"). In addition, Company (including any successor to Company) shall "gross up" such Parachute Tax Reimbursement by paying to Executive at the same time an additional amount equal to the aggregate amount of any additional taxes (whether income taxes, excise taxes, special taxes, employment taxes or otherwise) that are or will be payable by Executive as a result of the Parachute Tax Reimbursement being paid or payable to Executive and/or as a result of the additional amounts paid or payable to Executive pursuant to this sentence, such that after payment of such additional taxes Executive shall have been paid on a net after-tax basis an amount equal to the Parachute Tax Reimbursement. The amount of any Parachute Tax Reimbursement and of any such gross-up amounts shall be determined by Company's independent auditing firm, whose determination, absent manifest error, shall be treated as conclusive and binding absent a binding determination by a governmental taxing authority that a greater amount of taxes is payable by Executive.
 
(c)           For purposes of this Agreement, "Change in Control" means the occurrence of any one or more of the following events:
 
(i)           There occurs a merger, consolidation or other business combination or reorganization to which the Company is a party, whether or not approved in advance by the Board of Directors of the Company, in which (A) the members of the Board of Directors of the Company immediately preceding the consummation of such transaction do not constitute a majority of the members of the Board of Directors of the resulting corporation and of any parent corporation thereof immediately after the consummation of such transaction, and (B) the shareholders of the Company immediately before such transaction do not hold more than fifty percent (50%) of the voting power of securities of the resulting corporation;
 
 

 
7

 

(ii)           There occurs a sale, exchange, transfer, or other disposition of substantially all of the assets of the Company to another entity, whether or not approved in advance by the Board of Directors of the Company (for purpose of this Agreement, a sale of more than one-half of the branches of the Company would constitute a Change in Control, but for purposes of this paragraph, no branches or assets will be deemed to have been sold if they are leased back contemporaneously with or promptly after their sale);
 
(iii)           A plan of liquidation or dissolution is adopted for the Company; or
 
(iv)           Any "person" or any group of "persons" (as such term is defined in Sections 13(d) and 14(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the "Exchange Act"), as if such provisions were applicable to the Company, other than the holders of shares of the Company's common stock in existence on the date of the Opening for Business, is or shall become the "beneficial owner" (as defined in Rule 13d-3 under the Exchange Act), as if such rule were applicable to the Company, directly or indirectly, of securities of the Company representing 50% or more of the combined voting power of the Company's then outstanding securities.
 
(d)           In the event that the Executive's employment is terminated during the Term as a result of his death or disability, he (or his estate, as the case may be) shall not be entitled to any payments or other benefits pursuant to this Section 5.5 or otherwise.
 
5.6           Mitigation by Executive. Executive shall not be required to mitigate the amount of any payment provided for in Section 5.5 by seeking other employment or otherwise.
 
6.           Effect of TARP Participation.
 
6.1           Basic Agreement re Effect of TARP Participation. It is anticipated by Executive and Company that Company may elect to participate in the Troubled Assets Relief Program ("TARP") established under the Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008 ("EESA"), as amended by the American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009 ("ARRA") and any subsequent legislation whether heretofore or hereafter enacted ("Subsequent Legislation") and as implemented by present and future regulations of applicable federal government agencies ("Implementing Regulations") (the requirements of EESA, ARRA, Subsequent Legislation and Implementing Regulations that may be applicable to the Company or Executive or the compensation or benefits provided to Executive under this Agreement or otherwise as a result of the Company's participation in TARP are sometimes referred to herein as the "TARP Provisions"). In that event, if the compensation and benefits to be provided to Executive pursuant to Sections 3, 4 and 5 of this Agreement, or any portion or element thereof, or any other compensation, benefits or perquisites hereafter agreed upon by the parties, must be reduced, delayed or otherwise modified in order for the Company to comply with any of the TARP Provisions, as interpreted and implemented by regulations of the U. S. Department of the Treasury and the terms of any contract between Company or Executive and said Department or any other agency of the federal government (""TARP Requirements"), this Agreement and all such other compensation, benefits and perquisites and agreements relating to any of the foregoing shall automatically be deemed amended to cause the Company to be in compliance at all times with the TARP Requirements. Executive and Company shall negotiate in good faith to document, by amendment or amendments to this Agreement or any other agreements, plans or benefits, the modifications so required, but the parties' failure to reach final agreement shall not negate the provisions of this Section.
 
 

 
8

 

6.2           Agreements Supporting TARP Waiver. In consideration for the benefits Executive will receive under this Agreement and potentially as a result of Company's participation in TARP, Executive hereby voluntarily waives any claim against the Company for any changes to Executive's compensation or benefits that are required for Company to comply with TARP Requirements. This waiver includes all claims Executive may have under the laws of the United States or any state related to the requirements imposed by any of the TARP Requirements, including without limitation a claim for any compensation or other payments Executive would otherwise receive, any challenge to the process by which any of the TARP Requirements were adopted and any tort or constitutional claim about the effect of any of the TARP Requirements on Executive's employment relationship with Company. Executive agrees to execute such waivers and other agreements as may be requires by the U.S. Treasury Department in connection with Company's participation in TARP.
 
7.           Non-Disclosure. The Executive covenants and agrees that Executive will not at any time, either during the Term or thereafter, use, disclose or make accessible to any other person, firm, partnership, corporation or any other entity any Confidential and Proprietary Information (as defined herein), other than to (a) Executive's attorney or spouse in confidence, (b) while employed by the Company, in the business and for the benefit of the Company, or (c) when required to do so by a court of competent jurisdiction, any government agency having supervisory authority over the business of the Executive or the Company or any administrative body or legislative body, including a committee thereof, with jurisdiction.
 
For purposes of this Agreement, "Confidential and Proprietary Information" shall mean non-public, confidential, and proprietary information provided to the Executive concerning, without limitation, the Company's financial condition and/or results of operations, statistical data, products, ideas and concepts, strategic business plans, lists of customers or customer information, information relating to marketing plans, management development reviews, including information regarding the capabilities and experience of the Company's employees, compensation, recruiting and training, and human resource policies and procedures, policy and procedure manuals, together with all materials and documents in any form or medium (including oral, written, tangible, intangible, or electronic) concerning any of the above, and other non-public, proprietary and confidential information of the Company; provided, however, that Confidential and Proprietary Information shall not include any information that is known generally to the public or within the industry other than as a result of unauthorized disclosure by the Executive. It is specifically understood and agreed by the Executive that any non-public information received by the Executive during Executive's employment by the Company is deemed Confidential and Proprietary Information for purposes of this Agreement. In the event the Executive's employment is terminated for any reason, the Executive shall immediately return to the Company upon request all Confidential and Proprietary Information in Executive's possession or control.
 
8.           Non-Solicitation. Executive agrees that during the Term and for a period of twelve (12) months thereafter, unless the Executive obtains the Company's prior written permission, which may be granted or denied at the Company's sole and absolute discretion, the Executive shall not:
 
 

 
9

 

(a)           solicit or divert to any competitor of the Company or, upon termination of the Executive's employment with the Company, accept any business from any individual or entity that is a customer or a prospective customer of the Company, to the extent that such prospective customer was identifiable as such prior to the date of the Executive's termination, except that this covenant of non-solicitation shall not apply with respect to anyone who, while having previously been a customer or prospect of the Company, is no longer a customer or prospect of the Company at the time of the solicitation; and/or
 
(b)           induce or encourage any officer and/or employee of the Company to leave the employ of the Company, hire any individual who was an employee of the Company as of the date of the termination of the Executive's, or induce or encourage any customer, vendor, participant, agent or other business relation of the Company to cease or reduce doing business with the Company or in any way interfere with the relationship between any such customer, vendor, participant, agent or other business relation and the Company.
 
9.           Noncompete Agreement. For a period of twelve (12) months after any resignation or termination of Executive's employment for any reason, Executive shall not, directly or indirectly, within 25 miles of any office of the Company, enter into or engage directly or indirectly in competition with the Company or any subsidiary or other company under common control with the Company, in any financial services business conducted by the Company or any such subsidiary at the time of such resignation or termination, either as an individual on his own or as a partner or joint venturer, or as a director, officer, shareholder, employee, agent, independent contractor, nor shall Executive assist any other person or entity in engaging directly or indirectly in such competition.
 
10.           Non-Disparagement. During the Term, after its expiration and following the termination of this Agreement by the Company or the Executive for any reason, each party agrees not to make any statements, in writing or otherwise, that disparage the reputation or character of the other party or, in the case of the Company, any subsidiaries or affiliates of the Company or any of their respective managers, directors, officers, stockholders, partners, members or employees, at any time for any reason whatsoever, except that nothing in this Section shall prohibit any party from giving truthful testimony in any litigation or administrative proceedings either between the Executive and the Company or in connection with which such party is subpoenaed and required by law to give testimony, including without limitation, any action by the Executive to enforce Executive's rights hereunder.
 
11.           Severance Compensation Conditional; Remedies for Breach of Sections 7, 8, 9 and 10; Independence of Covenants; Notice to Others; Savings Clause.
 
 

 
10

 

11.1           Severance Compensation Independent. Company's obligation to pay Severance Compensation is conditioned on Executive's compliance with Paragraphs 7, 8, 9 and 10 of this Agreement and Company shall not be obligated to pay such Severance Compensation in the event of any breach by Executive of such Paragraphs.
 
11.2           Remedies for Breach of Sections 7, 8, 9 and 10. Executive and Company agree that the covenants in Sections 7, 8. 9 and 10 are reasonable covenants under the circumstances. Executive agrees that any breach of the covenants set forth in Sections 7, 8, 9 and 10 of this Agreement will irreparably harm the Company. The Executive and the Company agree that in the event of any breach by the Executive of the provisions set forth in Section 7, 8, 9 and 10 of this Agreement, the Company shall be entitled to all rights and remedies available at law or in equity, including without limitation, the following cumulative and not alternative rights:
 
(a)           the right to obtain injunctive or other equitable relief to restrain any breach or threatened breach or otherwise to specifically enforce the provisions of this Agreement, it being agreed that monetary damages alone would be inadequate to compensate the Company, the amount of such damages will be difficult (if not impossible) to prove precisely, and would be an inadequate remedy for such breach;
 
(b)           the right to institute civil suit to recover damages suffered by the Company;
 
(c)           the right to recover actual reasonable attorneys' fees and other costs incurred by the Company in connection with pursuing remedies hereunder; and
 
(d)           the right to seek an equitable accounting of all earnings, profits and other benefits arising from any such violation.
 
11.3           Independence of Covenants. The existence of any claim or cause of action of the Executive against the Company, whether predicated on this Agreement or otherwise, shall not constitute a defense to the enforcement by the Company of the provisions of Sections 7, 8, 9 and 10.
 
11.4           Notice to Others. Executive agrees to notify any future prospective employers and future employers, and any future joint venturers, partners and contracting parties of Executive, whose activities may be deemed to compete with Company of the existence of each of the covenants contained in Sections 7, 8, 9 and 10 of this Agreement.
 
11.5           Savings Clause. In the event that any provision or provisions of any of the covenants in Section 7, 8, 9 and 10 would otherwise be determined by any court of competent jurisdiction to be unenforceable in whole or in part by reason of being for too great a period of time or covering too great a geographical area or too broad a product market, or for any other reason, each such covenant shall nevertheless remain in full force and effect and be construed so as to be enforceable as to that period of time and geographical area and product market, and on such other conditions, as may be determined to be reasonable by the court.
 
 

 
11

 

12.           Amendments. No amendments to this Agreement shall be binding unless in writing and signed by both parties.
 
13.           Notices. All notices under this Agreement shall be in writing and shall be deemed effective (i) when delivered in person or by facsimile, telecopier, telegraph or other electronic means capable of being embodied in written form, or (ii) forty-eight (48) hours after deposit thereof in the U.S. mails by certified or registered mail, return receipt requested, postage prepaid, addressed, in the case of Executive, to his last known address as carried on the personnel records of Company and, in the case of Company, to the corporate headquarters, attention of the Chairman of the Board of Directors (or if Executive is at that time the Chairman of the Board of Directors, then to the Secretary of the Company), or to such other address as the party to be notified may specify by notice to the other party.
 
14.           Entire Agreement. This Agreement is the entire agreement of the parties with respect to its subject matter and supersedes and replaces all other negotiations, discussions and prior or contemporaneous agreements between the parties, whether oral or written, with respect to the subject matter of Executive's employment with Company.
 
15.           Binding Effect and Benefits. The rights and obligations of Company and Executive under this Agreement shall inure to the benefit of and shall be binding upon the respective heirs, personal representatives, successors and assigns of Company and Executive.

 
12

 



16.           Construction. This Agreement shall be construed under the laws of the Commonwealth of Pennsylvania, as they may be preempted by federal laws and regulations. Section headings are for convenience only and shall not be considered a part of the terms and provisions of the Agreement.
 
17.           Governing Law; Jurisdiction; Venue. The validity, interpretation, construction, performance and enforcement of this Agreement shall be governed by the internal laws of the Commonwealth of Pennsylvania, without regard to its conflicts of law rules, and by federal law to the extent it pre-empts state law. For purposes of any action or proceeding, the Executive irrevocably submits to the exclusive jurisdiction of the courts of the Commonwealth Pennsylvania and the courts of the United States of America located in Pennsylvania for the purpose of any judicial proceeding arising out of or relating to this Agreement or otherwise. The Executive irrevocably agrees to service of process by certified mail, return receipt requested, to the Executive at the addressed listed in the records of the Company. The proper venue for all such disputes, actions or proceedings shall be Chester County. The parties agree that in any action or proceeds arising under this Agreement, attorneys' fees and costs shall be awarded to the prevailing party.
 
18.           Executive's Acknowledgment of Terms and Right to Separate Counsel. Executive acknowledges that he has read this Agreement fully and carefully, understands its terms and that it has been entered into by Executive voluntarily. Executive further acknowledges that Executive has had sufficient opportunity to consider this Agreement and discuss it with Executive's own advisors, including Executive's attorney and accountants and that Executive has made Executive's own free decision whether and to what extent to do so.
 
19.           Legal Expenses. Company shall pay to Executive all reasonable legal fees and expenses incurred by him in seeking to obtain or enforce any rights or benefits provided by this Agreement to the extent he prevails in such efforts.
 
20.           Indemnification of Executive. Company shall indemnify Executive against any liability incurred in connection with any proceeding in which the Executive may be involved as a party or otherwise by reason of the fact that Executive is or was serving as Chief Financial Officer to the extent permitted by the Company's articles of incorporation, bylaws and applicable law. To further effect, satisfy or secure the indemnification obligations provided herein or otherwise, the Company shall cause its director and officer liability insurance to cover Executive during the Term and for such period thereafter as the Company's liability insurance policy permits coverage for actions or omissions of former directors or officers.

 
13

 


 
 
IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties hereto have caused the due execution of this Agreement as of the date first set forth above.

 
 
 
CUSTOMERS BANCORP, INC.
   
   
Attest: /s/ Gertrude M. Hackney
By: /s/ Jay S. Sidhu
 
 
 
THOMAS BRUGGER
   
   
Witness: /s/ Carlyn A. D’Amico
/s/ Thomas Brugger
 
signature

 
 

 
 
 
 
 
 
14

 
 
Exhibit 23.2
 
 

 
Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

 

 

 
Customers Bancorp, Inc.
Wyomissing, Pennsylvania
 
We hereby consent to the use in the prospectus constituting a part of this Registration Statement on Form S-1 of our report dated March 20, 2012, relating to the financial statements of Customers Bancorp, Inc. which is contained in this prospectus.
 
We also consent to the reference to us under the caption “Experts” in the prospectus.
 

/s/ ParenteBeard LLC

Lancaster, Pennsylvania
March 27, 2012